Professional Documents
Culture Documents
HERENO MAN
HASGONE BEFORE
A History
ofApolloLunarExploration
Missions
Office of Management
_I__A National Aeronautics and Space Administration
Scientific and Technical Information Division
Washington, DC t989
Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data
The purpose of this book is only partly to record the engineering and scientific
accomplishments of the men and women who made it possible for a human
to step away from his home planet for the first time. It is primarily an attempt
to show how scientists interested in the moon and engineers interested in
landing people on the moon worked out their differences and conducted a pro-
gram that was a major contribution to science as well as a stunning engineering
accomplishment.
When scientific requirements began to be imposed on manned space flight
operations, hardly any aspect was unaffected. The choice of landing sites, the
amount of scientific equipment that could be carried, and the weight of lunar
material that could be brought back all depended on the capabilities of the space-
craft and mission operations. These considerations limited the earliest missions
and constituted the challenge of the later ones.
President John F. Kennedy's decision to build the United States' space pro-
gram around a manned lunar landing owed nothing to any scientific interest in
the moon. The primary dividend was to be national prestige, which had suffered
from the Soviet Union's early accomplishments in space. A second, equally impor-
tant result of a manned lunar landing would be the creation of a national capabil-
ity to operate in space for purposes that might not be foreseeable. Finally, Kennedy
felt the need for the country to set aside "business as usual" and commit itself
with dedication and discipline to a goal that was both difficult and worthwhile.
Kennedy had the assurance of those in the best position to know that it was
technologically possible to put a human on the moon within the decade. His polit-
ical advisers, while stressing the many benefits (including science) that would
accrue from a strong space program, recognized at once that humans were the
key. If the Soviets sent men and women to the moon, no American robot, how-
ever sophisticated or important, would produce an equal impact on the world's
consciousness. Hence America's leadership in space would be asserted by land-
ing humans on the moon.
This line of reasoning was convincing enough for most congressional leaders,
who would have to provide the money, and was accepted by a majority of Ameri-
cans. But Apollo was conceived and developed in an era when the scientific com-
munity was emerging as a political force in the country. Scientific research was
becoming a big business in the late 1950s and early 1960s, sustained by
unprecedented financial support from the federal government. Science had con-
stituted the major portion of NASA's early space program and was the rationale
for the space program in the first place; hence scientists considered space to be
their province. The investigations of the pioneer space scientists did not require
a human's presence; hence man had, in their view, no important role in space.
Since Apollo was not a scientific project, it was unnecessary; because it would
be expensive, it probably would be detrimental to the legitimate space program
already under way.
V
Where No Man Has Gone Before
In one respect the critics were right: Apollo was not primarily a scientific pro-
ject. The engineers charged with accomplishing the lunar landing within the decade
had far too many problems to solve to give much thought to secondary matters--a
category to which they relegated scientific experiments. Some may have felt that
the landing itself was enough; the President had called for nothing more. Most
probably reasoned that someone else would specify what the astronauts would
do on the moon. For the engineers responsible for carrying it out, Apollo required
a strict ordering of priorities: be sure we can get the crew there and back; then
provide for other objectives. Risks abounded, and the glare of publicity surround-
ing Apollo made it certain that the loss of a single astronaut's life could imperil
the project's very existence.
Objections by the scientists had no effect on the nation's determination to carry
out the manned lunar landing. Science would, however, considerably affect the
conduct of the lunar missions that followed the first landing. By the time the pro-
ject ended in December 1972, engineers and scientists had developed a mutual
respect and a commonality of aims. No one lamented more strongly than the
scientists--not, for the most part, the same ones who had objected so vigorously
to the program in the early days--the cancellation in 1970 of three planned lunar
exploration missions.
Apollo might have been considered complete when the crew of the spacecraft
Columbia came aboard the U.S.S. Hornet in the Pacific Ocean on July 24, 1969.
Indeed, for some years after President Kennedy proposed it, the first lunar land-
ing was regarded as the objective of Apollo. Planning for manned space flights
to follow the lunar landing began in 1963 with studies on how the Apollo space-
craft could be modified to extend the duration of the missions and increase the
payload that could be carried to the moon. In 1965 a program called "Apollo Appli-
cations" emerged, which included long-duration earth-orbital flights as well as
lunar exploration. It would build and launch a few Apollo spacecraft and Saturn
rockets each year, sustaining the nation's manned space capability and produc-
ing useful information while the nation decided what the next major step in
manned space exploration would be.
By late 1967, however, it was clear that that decision would not come early,
and that post-Apollo programs other than lunar exploration required more
thought. An Office of Lunar Exploration Programs was opened in NASA Head-
quarters to direct the continued exploration of the moon under the Apollo ban-
ner, and the earth-orbital portion of Apollo Applications, which would evolve
into Skylab, was split off.*
The development of the spacecraft, rockets, and launch facilities necessary to
accomplish the primary goal of Apollo has been described in three prior volumes
in the NASA history series.** The story of the lunar spacecraft and the flight pro-
gram up to the return of Apollo 11 is detailed in Chariots for Apollo. The present
*See W. David Compton and Charles D. Benson, Living and Working in Space:A History of Skylab,
NASA SP-4208 (Washington, 1983).
**Courtney G. Brooks, James M. Grimwood, and Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., Chariotsfor Apollo: A His-
tory of Manned Lunar Spacecraft,NASA SP-4205 (Washington, 1979); Roger E. Bilstein, Stages to Saturn"
A TechnologicalHistory ofthe ApolloSaturn LaunchVehicles,NASA SP-4206 (Washington, 1980); Charles
D. Benson and William Barnaby Faherty, Moonport:A History of Apollo Launch Facilitiesand Operations,
NASA SP-4204 (Washington, 1978).
vi
Preface
vii
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
in detail, dramatic as it was, would have lengthened the story unacceptably; and
since other authors have dealt with it in detail (see n. 78, chapter 11), I decided
to treat the essentials of the accident, the management of the flight, and the results
of the investigation in appendix 8. The safe return of the crippled spacecraft and
its three crewmen is a monument to the skill and determination of hundreds of
dedicated individuals; the subsequent investigation was a masterly piece of
engineering detec4ive work, lacking a "body"--the failed spacecraft itself--to pro-
vide clues; but space did not permit full treatment of the flight in all its aspects.
As for its impact on lunar science, Apollo 13 created a delay of a few months,
giving scientists a little breathing space, which they welcomed, to refine plans
fqr later missions. The loss of one load of lunar samples and the data from one
more set of surface experiments was of small importance in the end. More than
that was lost a few months later when two of the remaining six missions were
canceled.
In writing this history I was granted unrestricted access to the extensive
Historian's Source Files at the Lyndon B. Johnson Space Center in Houston, to
the files in the History Office at NASA Headquarters, and to documents stored
at the various Federal Archives and Records Centers. To the extent possible within
the time constraints of my contract, participants reviewed my drafts and offered
comments. They also corrected factual errors where they found them. Their com-
ments were given thoughtful consideration and incorporated into the history
whenever the documentation seemed to support them or when an insider's view-
point yielded insights the historian cannot glean from the documents alone. The
interpretations of events here recorded, as well as any errors that remain, are
my responsibility.
I have tried to define fairly and accurately the arguments on both sides of the
scientific and technological issues that bore on the conduct of the Apollo explo-
ration missions. I found it somewhat difficult to treat the opposition to the Apollo
program voiced by many prominent scientists. Of course the scientists who spoke
against Apollo and later criticized NASA's management of it were merely exer-
cising their right to political expression. One reviewer who took exception to my
treatment noted that this was the only avenue open to the scientists, who were
put off by the engineers and had no choice but to "'go public" with their objec-
tions, in the hope that political pressure would gain what their efforts within the
system had not. Nevertheless, their objections, usually based on the unspoken
assumption that purely scientific projects were entitled to privileged treatment,
often smacked of intellectual arrogance. More irritating still--even to an outsider--
few of those who criticized the project wanted to assume any responsibility for
managing it. On the whole the objectors preferred to remain outside, where they
could pursue their rewarding scientific careers while freely criticizing NASA--
often in ignorance of the political, operational, and cost restrictions within which
the space agency had to operate. Those scientists who made a commitment to
the program and stayed with it to the end, establishing close relationships with
mission planners and scaling their objectives to the capability of the system,
deserve more credit than they usually get for the ultimate scientific productivity
of Apollo.
The reader who suspects that I have a lingering bias in favor of Apollo's
engineers is probably correct. I would not dispute the scientists' assertion that
VIll
Preface
W.D.C.
Houston, 1987
ix
ii
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
The onerous task of acquiring, sorting, and culling the Apollo documentation
at Johnson Space Center had been all but completed when I undertook this his-
tory. Chief among those responsible for acquiring these records and putting them
in order are James M. Grimwood, historian at JSC from 1962 to 1979, and the
late Sally D. Gates, editor and archivist in the JSC History Office until her death
in 1980.
By helping me learn to find my way through this morass while I worked on
an earlier project, Jim Grimwood and Sally Gates earned my lasting gratitude.
Similarly the staff of the Headquarters History Office--Monte D. Wright, direc-
tor, Frank W. Anderson, Jr., assistant director, Carrie Karegeannes, editor, and
Lee D. Saegesser, archivist--provided moral support, critical evaluation, and sub-
stantial assistance in my early days. Sylvia D. Fries, who took over as director
in 1983, was no less helpful and encouraging on the present project than her
predecessor. In the later stages of research and writing I was fortunate to have
a sympathetic and helpful technical monitor in William E. Waldrip of the Manage-
ment Analysis Office at JSC. Not only did he help in working with the NASA
bureaucracy; he also took a deep and genuine interest in the organization and
content of the book and offered perceptive comments whileI was writing it.
Mrs. Sarah C. Arbuckle deserves mention for the hundreds of hours of tedious
labor she applied to preparing the computerized index to the Apollo files, which
was one of the tasks required by my contract. Although the results of her efforts
do not appear in this book, the index was of great help in research in the later
stages of its preparation. Researchers who use these files in the future will surely
be grateful for her work.
Captain Alan L. Bean, USN 0Ret.), artist and former astronaut, generously
provided the frontispiece: a reproduction of his picture, "The Hammer and the
Feather,'" which depicts the demonstration performed by David R. Scott on Apollo
15. No photograph of this demonstration was taken on the moon; the only ones
available were taken from the television screen on which earth viewers saw it
performed.
Finally, my thanks go to the participants in Apollo who provided interviews
and criticized the manuscript.
xi
Page
Preface .............................................................. v
Acknowledgments ................................................... xi
1 America Starts for the Moon: 1957-1963 .............................. 1
2 Linking Science to Manned Space Flight ............................. 13
3 Apollo's Lunar Exploration Plans ................................... 27
4 Handling Samples from the Moon .................................. 41
5 Selecting and Training the Crews ................................... 55
6 Mission and Science Planning: 1963-1966 ............................ 73
7 Setback and Recovery: 1967 ........................................ 91
8 Final Preparations: 1968 ........................................... 113
9 Primary Mission Accomplished: 1969 ............................... 135
10 Lunar Exploration Begins ......................................... 157
11 First Phase of Lunar Exploration Completed: 1969-1970 ............... 177
12 Apollo Assumes Its Final Form: 1970-1971 .......................... 201
13 Lunar Exploration Concluded ..................................... 225
14 Project Apollo: The Conclusion .................................... 255
Source Notes ....................................................... 271
Appendix
1 Organization Charts .............................................. 313
2 Apollo Funding History .......................................... 329
3 Lunar Exploration Planning, 1961-1967 ............................. 331
4 Chronology of Major Events in Manned Space Flight and in Project
Apollo, 1957-1975 .............................................. 349
5 Summary Data on Apollo Missions ................................ 361
6 Prime and Backup Crews, Support Crews, and Capsule Communicators
for Apollo Lunar Missions ...................................... 367
7 Crew Training and Simulations .................................... 382
8 The Flight of Apollo 13 ........................................... 386
Bibliographic Essay ................................................. 394
Index .............................................................. 403
The Author ........................................................ 413
oo,
Xlll
1
When the crew of Apollo 11 splashed down in the Pacific Ocean on July 24,
1969, Americans hailed the successful completion of the most audacious and com-
plex technological undertaking of the 20th century: landing humans on the moon
and returning them safely to earth. Just over eight years before, when President
John F. Kennedy proposed the manned lunar landing as the focus of the United
States' space program, only one American--Lt. Comdr. Alan B. Shepard, Jr.-
had been into space, on a suborbital lob shot lasting 15 minutes. At the end of
the first lunar landing mission, American astronauts had logged more than 5,000
man-hours in space. To the extent that any single event could, the first success-
ful lunar landing mission marked the National Aeronautics and Space Adminis-
tration's development of the capability to explore space by whatever means were
appropriate for whatever purposes seemed to serve the national interest.
To many, Apollo 11 demonstrated that the United States had clearly won the
"'space race" with the Soviet Union, which had been one of the space program's
major purposes. By the time that was done, other issues dominated the scene.
National interests were not the same in mid-1969 as they had been in 1961. Of
the public reaction after Apollo 11, a congressional historian has written,
The high drama of the first landing on the Moon was over. The players and
stagehands stood around waiting for more curtain calls, but the audience drifted
away .... The bloody carnage in Vietnam, the plight of the cities, the revolt
on the campuses, the monetary woes of budget deficits and inflation, plus a
widespread determination to reorder priorities pushed the manned space effort
lower in national support. 1
Project Apollo encompassed more than simply sending men to the moon and
back. It reflected a determination to show that humans had an important role
to play in exploring space, as they had in exploring the unknown corners of the
earth in earlier centuries. That proposition was not universally accepted. From
the time the space agency determined to put humans into space, many Ameri-
cans argued vigorously against manned space flight on the grounds that it was
unnecessary and inordinately expensive. Space scientists had already shown how
much could be done with instruments, and planners were designing spacecraft
that would revolutionize communications, weather forecasting, and observation
of the earth, all without requiting the presence of people in space.
These arguments were difficult to refute. Only when it came to exploring other
planets did humans seem superior. For all of their limitations, humans were far
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
The Soviet Union's launch of the world's first man-made satellite (Sputnik) on
October 4, 1957, concentrated America's attention on its own fledgling space
efforts. Congress, alarmed by the perceived threat to American security and tech-
nological leadership, urged immediate and strong action; the President and his
advisers counseled more deliberate measures. Several months of debate produced
agreement that a new federal agency was needed to conduct all nonmilitary activity
in space. On July 29, 1958, President Dwight D. Eisenhower signed the National
Aeronautics and Space Act of 1958 establishing the National Aeronautics and
Space Administration (NASA). 2
When it opened for business on October 1, 1958, NASA consisted mainly of
the four laboratories and some 8,000 employees of the government's 43-year-old
research agency in aeronautics, the National Advisory Committee for Aeronau-
tics (NACA).* Within a few months NASA acquired the Vanguard satellite pro-
ject, along with its 150 researchers from the Naval Research Laboratory; plans
and funding for several space and planetary probes from the Army and the Air
Force; and the services of the Jet Propulsion Laboratory 0PL) outside Pasadena,
California, where scientists were planning an unmanned spacecraft (Ranger) that
would take close-up television pictures of the lunar surface before crashing into
the moon. 3
Vanguard and JPL brought a strong scientific component into NASA's activi-
ties. Many of the Vanguard scientists became administrative and technical leaders
at NASA Headquarters and at its new space science center (Goddard Space Flight
Center**) at Greenbelt, Maryland. JPL's contributions to the space program would
be strongest in instrumented spacecraft for the planetary programs. It also shared
with Goddard major responsibility for development and operation of the track-
ing and telemetry network used in deep space operations, including Apollo. 4
*NACA' s installations were Langley Memorial Aeronautical Laboratory, Langley Field, Va., with
its subsidiary Pilotless Aircraft Research Station at Wallops Island, Va.; Ames Aeronautical Labora-
tory, Moffett Field, Calif.; Lewis Flight Propulsion Laboratory, Cleveland, Ohio; and the High-Speed
Flight Station at Edwards Air Force Base, Calif. Langley, Ames, and Lewis became "Research Centers"
under NASA, and the High-Speed Flight Station was renamed the Flight Research Center, later the
Hugh L. Dryden Flight Research Facility (honoring NASA's first Deputy Administrator and long-
time Director of NACA, who died in 1965).
**Named in honor of the American pioneer of liquid-fueled rockets, Dr. Robert H. Goddard
(1882-1945).
AmericaStartsfor theMoon:1957-1963
These new acquisitions were grafted onto NACA, an organization that had
played a leading role in the development of aircraft technology since 1914. After
World War II, new aerodynamic and control problems had to be solved as the
demand for military aircraft to perform at greater speeds and higher altitudes
increased. By 1957 the X-15, one of a series of rocket-propelled piloted aircraft,
was on the drawing boards. It was intended to be capable of exceeding Mach
6 (six times the speed of sound) and of climbing beyond 107,000 meters (67
miles)--above nearly all the sensible atmosphere. NACA was, in fact, approach-
ing the conditions of space flight by extension of the operational limits of manned
aircraft.
Other NACA engineers were working on other space-related problems. At
Langley's Pilotless Aircraft Research Division, aerodynamicists were acquiring
important data on aerodynamic heating at speeds of Mach 10, unattainable in
the wind tunnels of the time, by flying models of aircraft and missiles mounted
on rockets. 5 When Sputnik went up, many of these engineers were already talk-
ing about the problems of putting humans in an earth-orbiting spacecraft. 6
The necessity for thinking about humans in space was made apparent when,
less than a month after Sputnik, the Soviets orbited Sputnik//, a 500-kilogram
(1,100-pound) satellite carrying a living passenger--a dog named Laika. With this
clear evidence that the Russians intended to send men into space, both the Army
and the Air Force resurrected dormant schemes to follow suit. Neither could pro-
duce a credible mission for humans in space, and both lost out to the new space
agency in 1958, when President Eisenhower assigned all manned space flight
projects to NASA. 7 Before NASA was a month old, Administrator T. Keith Glen-
nan chartered a Space Task Group (STG) at Langley and charged it with manag-
ing the United States' first project to put man in space: Project Mercury. In 1961
STG was redesignated the Manned Spacecraft Center, a connotation of its newly
expanded responsibility for all manned projects, and located on 1,660 acres (6.5
square kilometers) of fiat Texas pasture land 22 miles (35 kilometers) southeast
of downtown Houston. 8
Crucial to any ambitious program in space was the ability to launch large
payloads into earth orbit and to send instrument payloads to the planets. Rockets
far exceeding the capacity of existing launch vehicles were required, but only one
was being seriously pursued. At the Army's Redstone Arsenal just outside Hunts-
ville, Alabama, the Free World's most experienced rocket engineers--Wernher
yon Braun and the team built around the hundred-odd Germans who developed
the V-2 rocket during World War U--were about to undertake construction of a
vehicle called Saturn I, five times as powerful as the biggest then available. By
1959, however, the Army had lost its last tenuous foothold on space flight and
had no use for Saturn--nor could it provide any other pioneering work for the
ambitious yon Braun. On July 1, 1960, rocket development at Redstone Arsenal
followed some earlier Army space programs into NASA when von Braun and
4,600 employees, along with many of the facilities at Redstone, became the George
C. Marshall Space Flight Center. 9
Thus by the end of 1960 NASA had the elements of a comprehensive space
program in place. Marshall Space Flight Center would design, test, and launch*
*Marshall maintained a subsidiary Launch Operations Directorate at the Air Force's Eastern Test
3
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
the rockets and oversee their production by industry. The Manned Spacecraft
Center would manage spacecraft design and testing, conduct flight operations,
and train the astronauts. Goddard and JPL would be responsible for tracking,
communication, and data management. At Headquarters, a triumvirate compris-
ing the Administrator, Deputy Administrator, and Associate Administrator
managed the overall program, determining policy, preparing budget requests,
and defending the program and the budgets before congressional committees.
Agency programs--science, manned space flight, advanced research--were
managed by directors of Headquarters program offices. The field centers reported
to the Associate Administrator, who coordinated the program offices and allo-
cated resources to the centers.
During NASA's first two years, manned space flight managers struggled with
the problems of organizing extremely complex and technologically demanding
projects. The established space science programs continued to produce new data
on the earth and its space environment. President Eisenhower, among others,
favored continuing the productive (and comparatively inexpensive) unmanned
science programs and withholding judgment on manned programs. In his depart-
ing budget message to Congress, the retiring president noted that more work
would be needed "to establish whether there are any valid scientific [emphasis
added] reasons for extending manned spaceflight beyond the Mercury pro-
gram."1° In early 1961, a committee of scientists appointed by newly elected Presi-
dent John F. Kennedy recommended that "we should stop advertising Mercury as
our major objective in space activities [emphasis in the original]," and instead try
to "find effective means to make people appreciate the cultural, public service,
and military importance of space activities other than space travel."u So problem-
ridden did Mercury seem that Kennedy's advisers felt the new president should
not endorse it and thereby risk being blamed for possible future failures; better,
the scientists believed, to emphasize the successful science and applications pro-
grams and the tangible benefits they could be expected to produce.
In spite of Mercury's early problems, manned space flight enthusiasts were
thinking far beyond manned earth-orbital flights. NASA's engineers were confi-
dent that they could send people to the moon and back. A moon flight was an
obvious goal for the manned programs. It would be an end in itself, needing no
justification in terms of its contribution to some larger goal, and it would demon-
strate the nation's superiority in space technology to all the world. Preliminary
work and discussion during 1959 turned up no insurmountable obstacles, and
in mid-1960 NASA announced its intention to award contracts to study the feasi-
bility of a manned lunar mission. The project even had a name: Apollo. On
October 25, study contracts were let to three aerospace firms. 12
NASA might conduct studies to show that man could go to the moon, and
scientists might argue that manned space flight was of doubtful valuG but Con-
Range at Cape Canaveral, Fla., which was made autonomous in 1962 as the Launch Operations Center
(renamed the John E Kennedy Space Center in December 1963), responsible for final assembly,
checkout, and launching of manned space vehicles.
AmericaStartsfor the Moon: 1957-1963
gress and the president would have to make the commitment, and the decisive
stimulus was still lacking. Then on April 12, 1961, the Soviets once more spurred
a major advance in the American space program by sending Major Yuri A. Gaga-
rin into space for one orbit of the earth. Congressional advocates of an all-out
effort to "beat the Russians" renewed their cries; influential media organs saw
a challenge to America's world leadership, as did many high government offi-
cials. President Kennedy called on Vice-President Lyndon Johnson, chairman of
the National Space Council, to survey the national space program and determine
what project promised dramatic results that would show the United States'
supremacy in space. Johnson immediately began consultations with NASA and
Defense Department officials and with key members of Congress. 13
Kennedy's desire for "dramatic results" did not coincide with what others had
in mind for the space program--especially the scientists. Neither Eisenhower's
nor Kennedy's science advisers believed that any results from manned space flight
could compare with those expected from space science and applications programs.
During the debate on the creation of a space agency, the President's Science Advi-
sory Committee (PSAC) issued an "Introduction to Outer Space," which asserted
that "scientific questions come first" and that "'it is in these [i.e., scientific] terms
that we must measure the value of launching satellites and sending rockets into
space."14 Eisenhower's chief scientific adviser, James R. Killian, former president
of Massachusetts Institute of Technology and chairman of PSAC, said after leav-
ing his White House position in 1960 that the Soviets' space exploits were attempts
"to present spectacular accomplishments in space as an index of national
strength." He deplored the tendency to design American programs to match the
Soviet Union's and urged that the United States define its own objectives and
pursue them on its own schedule, not indulge in costly competition for prestige
in space exploration--by which he apparently meant manned space flight. "Many
thoughtful citizens," Killian said, "are convinced that the really exciting discov-
eries in space can be realized better by instruments than by man."ls His views
were shared by many scientists, including Jerome Wiesner, a member of PSAC
since its formation who became principal scientific adviser to John Kennedy. What
the scientists could not, or would not, recognize was that their excitement was
neither understood nor shared by any substantial majority of the people.
Some scientists, however, believed the space program should include elements
with strong public appeal. The Space Science Board of the National Academy
of Sciences,* NASA's officially designated source of scientific advice, discussed
the question of man in space early in 1961 and later that year adopted a position
paper on "Man's Role in the National Space Program." The board asserted that
the goal of the nation's space program should be the scientific exploration of the
moon and the planets but recognized that nontechnical factors were vital to pub-
lic acceptance of a space program. Human exploration of the moon and planets
"The National Academy of Sciences is a private, nongovernmental body chartered in 1863 to promote
the advancement of science and to provide advice, when asked, to the government on scientific mat-
ters. Membership in the Academy is regarded as recognition of eminence in research and is the highest
honor an American scientist can be awarded short of the Nobel prize. See Daniel S. Greenberg, "The
National Academy of Sciences: Portrait of an Institution," Sc/ence156 (1967):222-29, 360--64,and 488-93.
In June 1958 the Academy created a Space Science Board to advise the government on the space science
program.
5
ORIGINAL: PAGE"
Where No Man Has Gone Before BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
"I believe that this nation should commit itself to achieving the goal, before this decade is out, of
landing a man on the moon and returning him safely to the earth .... " President John F. Kennedy
issues the challenge of Apollo, May 25, I961. Behind him, Vice-president Lyndon B. Johnson (left)
and House Speaker Sam Rayburn.
would be "potentially the greatest inspirational venture of this century and one
in which the world can share; inherent here are great and fundamental philosophi-
cal and spiritual values which find a response in man's questing spirit .... "Thus
the space exploration program must be developed "on the premise that man will
be included. Failure to adopt.., this premise will inevitably prevent man's inclu-
sion," presumably because of the costs involved. "From a scientific standpoint,"
the paper went on, "there seems little room for dissent that man's participation
in the exploration of the Moon and planets will be essential, if and when it becomes
technologically feasible to include him. ,,16 This endorsement of man's participa-
tion in space exploration was at variance with a substantial body of opinion in
the American scientific community, as events of the next two years would show;
and the board's adduction of nonscientific values to justify manned space flight
would later draw pontifical rebuke from an influential scientific organization. 17
On May 8, 1961, Lyndon Johnson's survey of the space program culminated
in a lengthy report drafted by NASA and Defense Department officials. The report
recommended strengthening the civilian space program in all areas. Particularly
pressing was the need for new and much more powerful launch vehicles. As for
the best way to put the nation ahead of the Soviets, the report chose a manned
lunar landing: "It is man, not mere machines, in space that captures the imagi-
nation of the world." However small its value in military or scientific terms, such
AmericaStartsfor theMoon:1957-1963
With this strong endorsement of a lunar landing project, and after Alan
Shepard's successful suborbital Mercury flight on May 5, Kennedy put together
a message to Congress on "Urgent National Needs," which he delivered in per-
son on May 25, 1961. While the speech covered many issues, its major impact
was on the space program. In it Kennedy expressed his belief that a manned lunar
landing, "before this decade is out,'" should be the principal goal of the Ameri-
can space effort. Stressing that this meant a long and costly development pro-
gram to reestablish the nation's world leadership in technology, he cautioned
that "if we are to go only halfway, or reduce our sights in the face of diffi-
culty.., it would be better not to go at all. ''19 It was a call for the country to
commit itself wholeheartedly to a long-term project that required sustained effort,
substantial cost, and determination to see it through to a successful conclusion.
If congressional reaction was less than enthusiastic, as Kennedy is reported to
have felt afterwards, _° events of the following summer proved that Congress was
solidly behind the venture. The supplemental budget request to get Apollo under
way--S675 million over Eisenhower's proposed $1.1 billion--carried both houses
with large majorities after little debate and suffered only minor reduction by the
House Appropriations Committeed _ Congress and the nation were eager to see
Apollo succeed; but NASA engineers, while confident that it could be done, bet-
ter understood the magnitude of the task. Robert R. Gilruth, head of the Space
Task Group, recalled later that he was simply aghast at what NASA was being
asked to do. z_
Support for the Apollo commitment was not unanimous, either in Congress
or among the public. The public opposition most often questioned the wisdom
of spending so much money on space when so many domestic problems con-
fronted the country. Those who spoke for science often shared this concern, but
their special objection was Apollo's distortion of priorities within the space pro-
gram. One unidentified astronomer was reported to have complained to Senator
Paul Douglas of Illinois that the space program was becoming "an engineering
binge instead of a scientific project."23 Petulant as that comment may sound, it
epitomized what many space scientists most feared about the lunar landing pro-
ject. Space science was a rapidly expanding field, offering almost limitless possi-
bilities for exploitation by ambitious investigators. It had been generously
supported by NASA for three years and had produced a rich harvest of scientific
knowledge, much of it unfamiliar to the public. Manned space flight, merely
because of man's participation, drew attention that gave it prominence far out
of proportion to its scientific value. The pioneers of space science were what one
historian has called "sky scientists"--mainly astronomers and physicists interested
in studying the sun and stars and particles, fields, and radiation in near-earth
space. 24 Sky scientists could well have believed that their projects would suffer
as lunar and planetary science gained support. Lunar science, which stood to
Where No Man Has Gone Before
gain the most from Apollo, counted only a few practitioners who did not yet have
the influence of the established space science programs.
American science generally was still riding a wave of public esteem and govern-
ment subsidy that had begun in the early 1950s and had swelled again after Sput-
nik. Basing their arguments on the indisputable contributions made by scientists
to the war effort during World War II, American scientists had worked long and
hard after the war to convince the public and the Congress that America's stan-
dard of living and position in world affairs depended on a strong scientific base,
which in turn depended on generous funding of basic research. By the mid-1950s
government support of basic research had risen to a level that prewar researchers
could not have dreamed of. This new status had not been easily achieved and
often had to be defended; many congressmen would have preferred to support
practical projects rather than pure research, which often seemed pointless.
(Indeed, congressmen and journalists frequently enjoyed making fun of research
projects that had absurd-sounding titles, such as the reproductive physiology of
the screwworm fly.2S) But scientists had grown increasingly influential in gov-
ernmental affairs. Prominent scientists found their counsel being sought more
and more frequently by government at all levels, and science had enough influen-
tial friends in and out of government to ensure the continuity of a substantial
level of support throughout the postwar years. 26
Nonetheless, the most prominent and influential spokesmen for science seemed
to feel uneasy about the viability of their favored status. Their behavior was charac-
terized by one critical observer of the science-government interaction as "not
unlike [that of] a nouveau riche in a fluctuating market." Every threat, real or
imagined, to reduce the support of science--or even to reduce its rate of growth--
was regarded as a potential catastrophe. 27 So the space scientists may have per-
ceived Apollo as a threat. No one could accurately predict its ultimate cost--
estimates ranged upward from $20 billion--but it would be expensive enough
that Congress might trim other programs to provide its funds.
Scientists' misgivings about Apollo were expressed intramurally in the summer
of 1962 at the Space Science Board's first summer study of NASA's science pro-
grams. Convened at the request of NASA, the six-week summer study brought
together more than a hundred participants from universities and industry to evalu-
ate NASA's past activities and recommend future policies and programs. The
final report of the study, noting that "there is considerable confusion about the
Apollo mission and its proper justifications,'" stated that Apollo was just what
Kennedy had said it was: a program to put America first in space, with no neces-
sary commitment to science. Until the success of the lunar landing could be clearly
foreseen, Apollo was, and must be, an engineering effort, "and the engineers
must be protected in their ability to do their jobs." Scientific investigations would
be phased into the program later; still later, assuming intermediate success, "scien-
tific investigations will become the primary goals." It was evident that these con-
siderations were not well understood--and perhaps not accepted--by the scientific
community, for the report urged NASA to work harder to make them clear. 28
This section of the report was addressed primarily to the scientific community
rather than to NASA, but whether it allayed any fears is debatable. If it did, events
of the following fall could well have raised stronger ones. In November, manned
space flight projects were severely cramped by lack of funds, and Brainerd Holmes,
8
America Starts for the Moon: 1957-1963
. *Science, the weekly journal of the American Association for the Advancement of Science (AAAS),
probably reaches more scientists in different disciplines than any other single scientific publication.
(In 1963, AAAS numbered about 76,000 members.) Besides publishing technical papers, Science pro-
vides news and analysis of many subjects of interest to the scientific community. Acerbic and out-
spoken, Abelson characterized himself as "a damned maverick" in testimony before the Senate space
committee later in the year.
Where No Man Has Gone Before
scientist was not sent on the first landing mission. More and better data could
be obtained by unmanned probes, at about one percent of the cost. In Abelson's
view, neither the military advantages nor the "technological fallout" cited by advo-
cates could justify the cost of sending men to the moon. 3s
After Abelson's editorial, many other scientists expressed their reservations
concerning the space program, and a general debate ensued in the press. 36 Criti-
cism focused on several points: the lunar landing program had almost no scien-
tific value and science would be advanced much more by spending the same
money on unmanned projects; the space program lured promising young talent
away from other worthwhile research, creating an imbalance in the nation's overall
scientific effort; and the money spent on Apollo could be better invested in educa-
tional, social, and environmental programs. Some seemed to feel that Apollo had
been promoted as a scientific program and to resent the confusion in the public
mind. Hugh Dryden reminded the critics that "no one in NASA had ever said
[Apollo] was decided upon solely on the basis of its scientific content."37 Other
scientists agreed with Dryden and expressed their acceptance of the lunar land-
ing on its own terms. 3s
Senator Clinton P. Anderson, chairman of the Senate Committee on Aeronau-
tical and Space Sciences, which was then considering NASA's authorization bill
for fiscal 1964, reacted to this debate by inviting several prominent scientists to
present their views to the committee. During two days of hearings, ten scientists
(including Philip Abelson, who was the first to be heard) ranged over most of
the ground covered in the public debate. If there was any general agreement,
it was that the time limit set for Apollo was probably conducive to waste, and
that many national problems deserved equal attention; but there was no agree-
ment that American science was being skewed by so much attention to space.
The strongest protest against the program was a written statement provided by
Warren Weaver, vice-president of the Alfred P. Sloan Foundation, who listed
many good things that could be bought with $30 billion*--a price he said was
"undoubtedly an underestimate"** of Apollo's ultimate cost. 39
Senator Anderson got what he wanted from the scientists--a variety of views
that improved his perspective of the space program. 4° The disapproving witnesses"
doubts were echoed in Congress. NASA's budget did not go through unscathed,
but the cuts actually made were less than some in Congress would have liked.
When the House approved NASA's authorization bill on August 1, support for
the space program was still strong: the majority was six to one. 41 After three more
months of debate and cuts totaling $612 million, NASA's appropriation ($5.1 bil-
lion) passed both houses by large majorities. 42 Many opponents of expensive
*Thirty billion dollars, Weaver said, would give every teacher in the U.S. a 10 percent annual raise
for 10 years; give $10 million each to 200 small colleges; provide 7-year scholarships at $4,000 per
year to produce 50,000 new Ph.D. scientists and engineers; give $200 million each to 10 new medical
schools; build and endow complete universities for 53 underdeveloped nations; create 3 more Rock-
efeller Foundations; and leave $100 million over "for a program of informing the public about science."
**The official estimate provided to Congress in 1973 was $25.4 billion. House, Subcommittee on
Manned Space Flight of the Committee on Science and Astronautics, 1974 NASA Authorization, Hear-
ings on H.R. 4567, 93/2, Part 2, p. 1271.
10
AmericaStartsfortheMoon: 1957-1963
manned space flight programs would express their objections over the next
decade, but Apollo would go forward, carrying--as some thought--the rest of
the space program with it. 43
What might have been, if there had been no lunar landing project, can be (and
was) long debated. Over and over, advocates of the manned programs pointed
out the reality of the situation: the nation could afford whatever it valued enough
to pay for. Social welfare and other desirable programs had to win support on
their own merits and would not necessarily be given Apollo's $3 billion a year
if it were canceled. The politics of a technological project with a clear goal and
self-evident success or failure were much simpler than any plan to conquer pov-
erty, rebuild the cities, or clean up the environment.
No proof is possible that space science (or science generally) would have been
better supported if Apollo had not been claiming such a large fraction of the space
budget. In fiscal 1964, when NASA's budget request first encountered serious
resistance in Congress, space science was authorized $617.5 million; its spend-
ing authority grew to $621.6 million and then to $664.9 million in the next two
fiscal years. 44 (The entire Mercury project, from 1958 to 1966, cost about $400
million. 45) But manned space flight budgets were three to four times those
amounts, and Homer Newell, director of NASA's science programs for the first
nine years, would later recall that space scientists never hesitated "to complain
about not getting their fair share of the space budget." Newell, a space scientist
himself and as active an advocate as space science had, understood and accepted
the overall priorities of the space program, as the scientists apparently did not,
and they sometimes tried his patience. He would later remark that "whatever
complaint there might have been about either the absolute or relative level of the
space science budget .... there can be little doubt that it represented a substan-
tial program. "'46
Apollo survived the debate of 1963, as it would survive worse troubles later,
but the cut in NASA'S budget request (more than 10 percent) left its mark. The
following spring Administrator James Webb would not assure Congress, as he
had in the past, that he was confident the lunar landing would be accomplished
within the decade--only that it was possible, if everything went well. 4z
And much could yet go wrong. Spacecraft design and the basic mission opera-
tions plan had been settled and the major contracts had been let. Years of testing
and design refinement lay ahead. An entire project, Gemini, was still to be con-
ducted, to establish the feasibility of rendezvous--bringing two spacecraft together
in orbit--on which the success of Apollo depended. In terms of technical mile-
stones, the lunar landing was still a long way off. The science community had
registered its objections to Apollo, as had other concerned citizens, and the nation
had reaffirmed the commitment asked of it by its late president. Those same objec-
tions would continue to be voiced, but the lunar landing would remain the major
driving force behind the national space program.
One thing that could be clearly seen at the end of 1963 was that manned space
flight had an important interest in reaching some kind of accommodation with
11
WhereNo ManHasGoneBefore
science. Over the next four years NASA officials and members of the science com-
munity worked to establish a program of scientific exploration that would become
the primary purpose of the later Apollo missions.
12
2
LINKING SCIENCE TO
MANNED SPACE FLIGHT
Scientific exploration of the moon required close cooperation between two quite
different organizations within the space agency. Space science was an active field
of research when NASA was created, with a well-organized constituency and
established procedures for generating and developing experiments. The Office
of Space Sciences, which managed these projects, relied heavily on scientists out-
side the agency for advice on policy and regarded itself as an operational arm
of the nation's scientific community, providing opportunities for that commu-
nity to conduct the research it deemed important. The Office of Manned Space
Flight, on the other hand, had no interested constituency outside of the space
agency. Having been handed their primary assignment by the President in 1961,
engineers of the manned space flight organization reported to the NASA Adminis-
trator and to Congress on the progress of their projects.
To get these two offices working together on exploration of the moon was not
simple. Starting in 1962, Homer Newell, director of the Office of Space Sciences,
began to lay the organizational foundations on which eventual collaboration would
be built. The Office of Manned Space Flight, feeling the pressure of the Apollo
deadline, was at first reluctant to spend much time preparing for science. By the
end of 1963, however, much of the preliminary work had been done and the broad
outlines of a lunar science program were taking shape.
NASA's initial space science programs were largely defined by the projects
transferred from other agencies and were mainly concerned with the study of
phenomena in near-earth space. But shortly after taking over direction of space
sciences, Homer Newell established a Theoretical Division to support programs
in planetology and lunar science. 1 Unlike space physicists and astronomers, those
interested in the moon and planets had little hard data to work with. Lunar and
planetary science in 1960 was a field for theoreticians, and few scientists devoted
their entire attention to it. So when Robert Jastrow, whom NewelI appointed to
head the new division, set out to learn all he could about current theories and
research in that area, he had a very short list of sources to consult. High on the
list was the name of Harold C. Urey, professor at large at the University of Califor-
nia at San Diego.
13
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Urey, a chemist whose scientific career spanned four decades, had won the
Nobel Prize in chemistry in 1934. During the second World War he had directed
one of the major projects for concentrating uranium-235, the fissionable material
of the first atomic bomb. A scientist of catholic interests, Urey became fascinated
by the distribution of the chemical elements within the earth and in the solar sys-
tem. Noting that there had been an extensive separation of iron from the rocky
materials of the earth and meteorites, he began to consider possible mechanisms
for the accretion of the planets out of the primordial matter of the solar system.
In 1952 he published a book on the origin of the planets, in which he asserted
his belief that the moon might provide the key to understanding the formation
of the solar system. On retiring from the University of Chicago in 1958 at age
65, he continued to teach and conduct research in California, devoting consider-
able time to cosmology. 2
Urey brought a chemist's approach to a subject that had previously been the
province of astronomers and astrophysicists. Like almost any chemist of his era,
he would have preferred to have samples that he could study in the laboratory.
Lacking lunar samples, he used information from meteorites, plus such physical
data as were available concerning the moon, to construct working hypotheses.
When Apollo was created, Urey supported it for the contributions it could make
to his own research interests, but he was conscious of its nonscientific value as
well. In 1961 he thought that the lunar landing was too expensive for its poten-
tial scientific return, but on reflection he decided that if the money were not spent
on Apollo it might well go to less productive projects and changed his mind. 3
Urey never failed to criticize NASA's practices when he felt criticism was justi-
fied, but on the whole he was a dependable supporter of the lunar landing
program. 4
Impressed by Urey's exposition of his theories and the potential they held for
space investigation, Jastrow brought him to Headquarters to confer with Newell
about possible NASA programs for lunar exploration. Their enthusiasm convinced
Newell that space science should make room for a program in lunar and plane-
tary sciences, and in January 1959 he appointed an ad hoc Working Group on
Lunar Exploration to coordinate the efforts of NASA and academic scientists and
to evaluate proposals for lunar experiments. 5
Such interest as there was in lunar missions in early 1959 was at the Jet Propul-
sion Laboratory (JPL).* Even there, however, many scientists favored missions
to Venus and Mars rather than to the moon, partly because the best opportuni-
ties for launch to the near planets occurred less frequently. 6 The moon--in earth's
back yard, so to speak--offered an optimum launch opportunity once every lunar
month, and if one were missed because of problems with a launch vehicle the
delay was only four weeks, whereas a mission to Mars would have to wait two
years if an optimum launch date were missed. While JPL was developing a plan
for 12 deep-space missions, including 5 moon probes, Jastrow was urging Newell
to accelerate NASA's lunar exploration programs.
Once again, however, the Soviets' eagerness to achieve space "firsts" exerted
its pernicious influence on American space programs. Even before the Working
*JPL's director William Picketing had proposed an unmanned lunar probe as a response to Sputnik
but had found no support for it.
14
ii
Linking Science to Manned Space Flight
When the engineers of Robert R. Gilruth's Space Task Group began work on
Project Mercury in 1958, they could not--as the space scientists could--draw on
10 years of experience in designing their spacecraft and conducting their missions.
Aviation experience was helpful in some aspects of manned space flight, but in
many others they faced new problems. Apollo posed many more. The engineers
did not lack confidence that the President's goal could be met, but they knew
only too well how much they had to learn to achieve it. A sense of urgency per-
15
Where No Man Has Gone Before
vaded the manned space flight program from the beginning right up to the return
of Apollo 11--an urgency that determined priorities for engineers at the centers.
Every ounce of effort went into rocket and spacecraft development and opera-
tions planning. Science was considerably farther down the list, and for the first
five years they gave it little thought.
Manned space flight projects were ruled by constraints that were less impor-
tant to science projects. One was safety. Space flight was a risky business, obvi-
ously, but the risks had to be minimized. No matter that the astronauts themselves
(all experienced test pilots in the beginning, accustomed to taking risks) under-
stood and accepted the risks. From the administrator down to the rank-and-file
engineer, everyone knew that the loss of an astronaut's life could mean indefinite
postponement of man's venture into space. Moreover, NASA was in a race, com-
peting against a competent adversary and working in the public eye, where its
failures as well as its successes were immediately and widely publicized.
Reliability was one key to safety, and spacecraft engineers strove for reliability
by design and by testing. With few exceptions, critical systems--those that could
endanger mission success or crew safety if they failed--were duplicated. If redun-
dancy was not feasible, systems were built with the best available parts under
strict quality control, and tested under simulated mission conditions to assure
reliability. 1° The measures taken to ensure reliability and safety contributed to
the fact that manned spacecraft invariably tended to grow heavier as they matured,
making weight control a continuing worry.
Those constraints were not so vital in the unmanned programs. Instruments
needed no life-support systems and required no protection from reentry heat;
scientific satellites were usually expendable. Being smaller than manned space-
craft, they required smaller and less expensive launch vehicles. Furthermore, those
vehicles could be less reliable. More science could be produced for the money
if experimenters would accept less than 100-percent success in launches, and space
scientists were content with this. u The loss of a scientific payload, though seri-
ous to the investigators whose instruments were aboard, did not cost a life.
On the whole the engineers were content to go their way while the scientists
went theirs. But the scientists were not (see Chapter 1), and their protests seemed
to require a response. Manned space flight enthusiasts spoke of the superiority
of humans as scientific investigators and of the benefits to science that would
result from putting trained crews in space or on the moon to make scientific obser-
vations. No existing instrument, they said, could approach a human's innate abil-
ity to react to unexpected observations and change a preplanned experimental
program; if such an instrument could be built, it would be far more expensive
than putting people into space. _2
This argument did not move the space scientists, most of whom worked in dis-
ciplines where human senses were useless in gathering the primary scientific data.
The role of a person in space science was not to make the observations but to
conceive the experiment, design the instruments to carry it out, and interpret
the results. 13 Cleverness in these aspects of investigation was the mark of emi-
nence in scientific research. The early manned programs offered space scientists
no opportunities that could not be provided more cheaply by the unmanned
programs.
The relationship between the manned and unmanned programs--essentially
16
Linking Science to Manned Space Flight
one of independence--took quite a different turn with the Apollo decision. Within
two weeks of President Kennedy's proposal to Congress, NASA Deputy Adminis-
trator Hugh L. Dryden told the Senate space committee that Apollo planners
would have to draw heavily on the unmanned lunar programs for information
about the lunar surface. Knowledge of lunar topography and the physical charac-
teristics of the surface layer was vital to the design of a lunar landing craft. Ranger
was the only active project that could obtain this information, and to provide it,
NASA asked Congress for funds to support four additional Ranger missions. The
day after Dryden testified, NASA Headquarters directed the Jet Propulsion Labora-
tory to examine how to reorient Ranger to satisfy Apollo's needs. 14
This directive was received with mixed feelings by the participants in Ranger.
JPL's project managers favored a narrower focus, because the scientific experi-
ments were giving them technical headaches that threatened project schedules.
They proposed to equip the four new Rangers with high-resolution television
cameras and to leave off the science experiments, using the payload space to
add systems that would improve the reliability of the spacecraft. Scientists who
had experiments on the Ranger spacecraft, however, were upset by the proposed
change. When they complained to Newell, he and his Lunar and Planetary Pro-
grams director reasserted the primacy of science in Ranger and did everything
they could to keep the experiments on all the flights. But the difficulties with
the Ranger hardware and the pressure of schedules proved too much. In the end,
the problem-plagued Ranger carried no space science experiments on its successful
flights, but did return photographs showing lunar craters and surface debris less
than a meter across. *is
Apollo could command enough influence to affect the unmanned lunar pro-
grams, but science had no such leverage on manned flights. For that matter, scien-
tists had little interest in Mercury; its cramped spacecraft and severe weight limits,
plus the short duration of its flights, made it unattractive to most experimenters.
Still, the Mercury astronauts conducted a few scientific exercises, mostly visual
and photographic observations of astronomical phenomenaA 6 Comparatively
unimportant in themselves, these experiments pointed up the need for close coor-
dination between the scientists (and the Office of Space Sciences) and the manned
space flight engineers. After John Glenn's first three-orbit flight on February 28,
1962, the Office of Space Sciences and the Office of Manned Space Flight began
to look toward the moon and what humans should and could do there. _7
Apollo managers had spent the second half of 1961 making the critical deci-
sions about launch vehicle and spacecraft design; in the spring of 1962 they were
wrestling with the question of mission mode. Should they plan to go directly
from earth to the moon, landing the whole crew along with the return vehicle
and all its fuel on the lunar surface? Or would it be better to assemble the lunar
vehicle in earth orbit--which would require smaller launch vehicles but would
entail closely spaced multiple launches, rendezvous of spacecraft and lunar rocket,
and the unexplored problems of transferring fuel in zero gravity from earth-
orbiting tankers to the lunar booster? Or was the third possible method, lunar-
*Ranger's results came too late (1964-1966) to affect the design of the Apollo lunar module; they
did confirm that the designers' assumptions about the lunar surface were satisfactory and that the
lunar module needed no modification.
17
Where No Man Has Gone Before
The question of science on Apollo was far down the list of priorities in the Office
of Manned Space Flight during 1961, behind such overriding questions as the
choice of mission mode and the configuration of the launch vehicle. Elsewhere,
however, stirrings of scientists' interest in the lunar mission began to appear.
The director of MIT's Instrumentation Laboratory, which was designing the navi-
gation system for Apollo, proposed that at least one Apollo crewman should be
a scientist, since the major interest in the moon would be scientific. Furthermore,
he said, it would be easier to train a scientist to pilot the spacecraft than to make a
scientist out of a test-pilot astronaut. 19 A similar suggestion was made by a group
of scientists working with the Lunar Exploration Committee of OSS, who asserted
that the scientist should be a geologist, or at least a scientist well versed in geol-
ogy and geophysics. They further proposed that NASA begin to recruit astronaut
trainees from the ranks of professional scientists. 2°
That the Office of Manned Space Flight and the Office of Space Sciences would
have to coordinate their efforts became evident early in 1962. When Homer Newell
appeared before the Space Sciences Subcommittee of the House Committee on
Science and Astronautics to defend NASA's authorization request, he was point-
edly questioned about the support his office was providing for Apollo. 21This line
of questioning evidently perturbed Newell, for he subsequently wrote a personal
letter to the subcommittee chairman explaining that the specific information
needed by Apollo would become available through the normal course of lunar
scientific investigations. Newell acknowledged the importance of the lunar land-
ing, but could not agree that concentrating on the immediate needs of Apollo's
engineers would best serve the overall space program. Newell's attitude gave
rise to a feeling, even within OSS, that "space sciences was rather unbending
in not getting scientific data which would assist the manned program," in the
words of a Langley official. Langley had proposed that future Ranger missions
should carry an experiment to measure the load-bearing capacity of lunar soil
intended to assist in the design of the Apollo lunar landing craft, but the proposal
had been rejected in favor of a purely scientific exercise in lunar seismometry. 22
Newell, far from being indifferent to the needs of Apollo or unconscious of its
importance, was simply trying to conduct his programs in the best interests of
space science. Mindful of space scientists' increasing discontent over Apollo and
its effect on NASA's budgets, he was trying to avoid alienating his major constit-
18
LinkingScience to Manned Space Flight
uency. As nearly as Newell could make it, the Office of Space Sciences was run
along lines that suited the scientific community. Advice on policy--the general
lines that OSS programs should follow--was provided by the Space Science Board
of the National Academy of Sciences and reflected the best consensus the space
science community could reach. The content of space science projects was deter-
mined (within rather broad limits) by the interests of individual investigators,
evaluated and endorsed by the Space Sciences Steering Committee and conducted
under the direction of the investigator who proposed it. No one in OSS would
have dreamed of telling scientists what experiments they should conduct with
the expectation of having their instructions followed or their advice appreciated.
Indeed, had anyone in OSS attempted to direct the course of a scientist's experi-
ment, he would have brought down the wrath of the entire scientific community
on the space science program. The prerogative of individual scientists to explore
problems of their choice, with the endorsement of their scientific peers, is one
of the hallmarks of basic research, and probably the most jealously guarded. 23
While Newell might have been able to find a way to supply the data Apollo
needed, he risked losing the confidence of the scientists in doing it. At a meeting
of OSS field directors in June 1962, Newell's director of Lunar and Planetary
Projects reiterated that "pure science experiments will provide the engineering
answers for Apollo. ''24
The issue was focused more sharply in mid-June, when Brainerd Holmes issued
a document specifying the information Apollo required: the radiation environ-
ment in cislunar space, the physical properties of lunar soil, and the topography
of the moon, including photos and maps to permit selection of a landing site.
All groups conducting lunar investigations were asked to give top priority to
obtaining the specified data. z_ The curt wording of the document and its assump-
tion of overriding importance for the lunar landing project were not calculated
to win friends in the space science programs, where managers had been strug-
gling with the Jet Propulsion Laboratory over the same issue on Ranger and Sur-
veyor. As events developed, it was JPL's director, William C. Pickering, who
forced the issue later in the summer by urging Associate Administrator Robert
C. Seamans, Jr., to seek an agreement between the Office of Space Sciences and
the Office of Manned Space Flight that would allow JPL to define Ranger's objec-
tives more clearly. Pickering's inclination was to support Holmes, because the
science experiments were among Ranger's prime sources of difficulty. 26
While unintentionally stirring up resentment on one front, the Office of Manned
Space Flight was more cooperatively seeking assistance on another. In March 1962
the Space Sciences Steering Committee, at OMSF's request, established an ad
hoc working group to recommend scientific tasks to be performed on the moon
by the Apollo crews. Not less important, the group would recommend a course
of scientific instruction for astronauts in training. Chaired by Charles P. Sonett
of the Lunar and Planetary Programs Office, the working group initially included
five members from the Office of Space Sciences and one from the Office of Manned
Space Flight; membership was later expanded to thirteen and a roster of some
dozen consultants was added. 27
The Sonett committee first met on March 27, 1962, to hear William A. Lee,
assistant director for systems in OMSF, explain what his office wanted it to do.
19
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
As the minutes of the meeting recorded it, Lee's approach was far from peremp-
tory and demanding; rather, he explained,
the Office of Manned Space Flight now wants very much to have on Apollo
moon flights experiments which are of fundamental significance scientifically.
They would like the Working Group to consider these experiments without
constraints set in advance by OMSF. OMSF will attempt to tailor flights and
flight equipment to meet these needs. As examples, it is expected that the dura-
tion of stay on the moon may be largely determined by space science require-
ments and that if necessary, one or more members of the crew could be
professional scientists trained as test pilots .... They welcome suggestions
from the Group as to astronaut selection procedure with respect to scientific
background; OMSF will handle physiological and psychological factors in
astronaut selection .... Unmanned and earth-based scientific experiments
which tie in with or prepare for manned experiments will be undertaken by
OMSF as part of Apollo; suggestions by the Group are desired. 28
At the committee's third meeting on April 17, Lee presented the engineering
guidelines to be considered by the group in proposing experiments. OMSF
expected to fly the first mission "before 1970" and subsequent missions at inter-
vals of about six months. The mission mode, not yet selected, was not to be con-
sidered by the committee, nor were engineering and operational details of the
flights. Landing sites would be chosen by manned space flight officials, but the
Sonett committee was encouraged to indicate the desirability of particular areas.
OMSF considered it "possible that one of the flight crew might be a professional
scientist trained to perform flight operations .... [But this] would significantly
complicate our selection and training program, and should not be done unneces-
sarily." Lee urged the committee to assume no additional constraints. Even if
some experiments required difficult engineering development, OMSF wanted the
committee to list them so that the requirements could be considered in designing
the Apollo spacecraft. 29
The guidelines Lee provided stated that the Office of Manned Space Flight
would consider the committee's report "a major factor" in determining some
characteristics of the proposed missions. For example, the planned number of mis-
sions ("more than one but less than ten") and time to be spent on the lunar sur-
face ("between 4 and 24 hours") might be strongly influenced by scientific
considerations. If enough worthwhile scientific work could be done, "stays up
to 7 days are not impossible." Similarly the planned payload (100 to 200 pounds,
45 to 90 kilograms) might be increased and the mobility of the astronauts on the
surface might be extended, for example by providing a motorized vehicle and
tailoring the space suit for increased ease of manipulation, if the increased scien-
tific return justified the added expense. A soft-landing unmanned supply vehi-
cle carrying up to 30,000 pounds (13,600 kilograms) of support equipment and
supplies was under active consideration; this vehicle might carry additional heavy
or bulky scientific equipment. 3°
Lee's presentation indicated that the Office of Manned Space Flight was will-
ing to be as accommodating as possible in providing for scientific exploration of
the lunar surface. But the qualifiers in Lee's guidelines suggest that OMSF left
itself many escape clauses that could have important effects on the scientific
program.
20
Linking Science to Manned Space Flight
With these guidelines in mind, the Sonett committee began to collect sugges-
tions for lunar surface experiments. Their criteria, established early, were sim-
ple: experiments must be scientifically feasible and important, capable of being
performed only on the moon, significantly improved by having a human aboard,
and likely to lead to additional scientific and technological progress. Three basic
types of experiments were suggested: measurements and qualitative observations
to be made by the astronauts on the lunar surface; experiments to be performed
on samples selected and brought back by the crews; and instruments to be
emplaced by the astronauts and left on the moon to transmit data to earth. 31
A point that seriously concerned the Sonett committee was the background
and training of the lunar explorers. As a basic requirement, the group suggested
sufficient scientific judgment and maturity to recognize and act appropriately upon
unexpected phenomena. They noted that scientist-astronauts might be caught
in a serious conflict between acquiring proficiency in spacecraft operation and
maintaining their skills in research32--a question that was to complicate relations
between the science community and NASA's operations experts for the next
10 years.
Sonett's committee submitted a draft report in early July 1962; its recommen-
dations, considered in the following weeks by the first of NASA's Summer Studies
and endorsed by the external scientific community, would form the basis for the
initial planning of Apollo's lunar exploration program. Meanwhile, the commit-
tee's work, together with the controversy over the content of the Ranger mis-
sions, emphasized the desirability of continuous contact between the offices of
Space Sciences and Manned Space Flight on scientific matters. The experience
in developing the scientific exercises carried out by the Mercury astronauts showed
that overlapping responsibilities requiring close supervision would develop when
science went aboard manned spacecraft, and some kind of formal liaison needed
to be established.
Homer Newell moved to provide coordination in September 1962 when he
proposed to establish a Joint Working Group to replace the ad hoc arrangements
that were proving cumbersome. The basic tasks of this group would be to recom-
mend to manned space flight planners a detailed program of scientific explora-
tion, and to suggest to the Office of Space Sciences a program of data acquisition
to ensure that Apollo's needs were met. It would also keep the field centers and
outside scientists informed of the science programs planned for manned space
flight. In carrying out its functions, the group would have the implicit responsi-
bility of assuring that NASA's interface with the scientific community remained
where it belonged--within the Office of Space Sciences--and to assure that each
program office's projects were maximally responsive to the interests of the other.
The group's chairman was to be assigned to OSS for administrative purposes
but functionally would be a member of both offices, reporting to the Lunar and
Planetary Programs Office in OSS and the Office of Systems Studies in OMSF. 33
Newell would later remark that this official "had two bosses to try to satisfy, which
is universally recognized as unsatisfactory"34; but no better alternative seemed
available.
To chair this Working Group, Newell appointed Eugene M. Shoemaker, a
geologist from the U.S. Geological Survey who had recently been assigned for
a one-year stint to NASA from the Survey's Astrogeology Branch. Shoemaker
21
Where No Man Has Gone Before
had received his doctorate from Princeton under Harry H. Hess, chairman of the
Space Science Board from 1962 to 1968 and an enthusiastic promoter of space
science. 3s Since October 1961 Shoemaker had been a co-investigator for the tele-
vision experiment on Ranger. 36 Having been a space enthusiast since pre-Sputnik
days, he had consciously fashioned his professional career with an eye to becoming
a scientist-astronaut.Z7 Although he never realized that ambition, for seven years
starting in 1962 he would contribute to the design of Apollo's lunar surface activi-
ties and help to train the men who would be his surrogates on the moon.
For the first several months Shoemaker's new job took him into a tangle of
uncharted responsibilities and unclear jurisdictions. At Headquarters, Newell's
Office of Space Sciences had asserted its responsibility for all of NASA's science,
manned or unmanned; in the opinion of many scientists in OSS, neither the Office
of Manned Space Flight nor the Manned Spacecraft Center had a staff qualified
to manage scientific experiments, but both were considering adding their own
science people. 38 Newell and his staff expected to plan and develop the manned
science program and to help select and train the astronauts. The Office of Manned
Space Flight, foreseeing the many complex interactions that such divided respon-
sibility would require, felt that it was simply not feasible to allow anything--
even the science--to be managed by another office. 39 When scientists showed
interest in the Mercury project, the Manned Spacecraft Center 0V[SC) had quickly
moved to establish a Mercury Scientific Experiments Panel to screen proposed
scientific observations and prevent any interference with the program's primary
purposes. *°
Shoemaker spent much of 1962 devising a structure for the working group and
soliciting support from the centers. 41 Toward the end of the year he recommended
to Newell that the group should comprise an executive board and two panels:
one on data requirements generated by OMSF, the other on scientific missions
recommended by OSS for manned space flight. The executive board would recom-
mend projects to the respective directors (Holmes and Newell). 42 It would, how-
ever, neither initiate nor manage specific scientific projects. 43
In the first months of 1963 Homer Newell moved steadily to bring manned space
science under his office's direction. He also began a campaign to persuade the
Manned Spacecraft Center that science was something more than a means of
acquiring the data required to design their spacecraft. ,4 Shoemaker, who had been
urging MSC to start training astronauts in geology, had found a few receptive
minds at the Houston center--among them Max Faget, director of engineering
and development--who understood that "it wouldn't look very good if we went
to the moon and didn't have something to do when we got there.' '¢_In late March,
Faget drafted a letter for MSC Director Robert R. Gilruth's signature, formally
requesting the U.S. Geological Survey to assign six of its scientists to the Hous-
ton center. Newell had paved the way for this cooperation in informal discus-
sions with the Survey's director, who agreed to Gilruth's request. 46 Newell saw
no need to establish a geological competence in NASA, and both he and Shoe-
maker preferred to have the Geological Survey staff the Apollo science program
rather than geologists hired by MSC.
Meanwhile Newell and Holmes, anticipating a need for increased cooperation
as Project Gemini progressed, were negotiating a formal division of responsibil-
ity for manned science projects between their offices. Newel] insisted that the
22
1
Linking Science to Manned Space Flight
Office of Space Sciences had the responsibility to solicit, select, and approve all
of NASA's scientific experiments; Holmes similarly asserted the Office of Manned
Space Flight's responsibility to approve any hardware that went into a manned
spacecraft and any procedure that affected the flight plan. Between the selection
of an experiment and its execution on a flight was a large area where responsibil-
ity for funding and management of design, fabrication, and integration into the
spacecraft of the scientific instruments had to be worked out.
After considerable negotiation, deputies for Newell and Holmes signed a
memorandum of agreement on July 25, 1963, spelling out the responsibilities of
their two offices. Planning and development of all manned space science projects
was assigned to the Office of Space Sciences, as well as any research and develop-
ment necessary to support them. This meant that OSS would select the experi-
ments and principal investigators and undertake preliminary development of the
necessary instruments, in consultation with the Office of Manned Space Flight
and the appropriate field center. OMSF agreed to develop and integrate flight
hardware and work the scientific objectives into mission plans, usually acting
through the Manned Spacecraft Center. OSS took on the job of formulating a
science training program for the astronauts, which OMSF would conduct.
Newell's office would also establish the scientific qualifications for scientist-
astronauts (though none had yet been selected) and would participate in selec-
tion of scientists for astronaut training. Each office would budget the funds for
its part of experiment development. Fabrication, testing, and installation of the
flight instruments would be supervised by the same team that monitored its design
and early development. 47 This agreement proved to be about as workable an
arrangement as possible, given the division of responsibility inherent in the Head-
quarters organization. With minor changes, it governed OSS-OMSF relations in
manned space science throughout the Apollo program.
While the new agreement was being worked out, Newell reorganized
Shoemaker's working group as the Manned Space Science Division on July 30,
1963. The new division reported to both program offices as before, but at a higher
level, and it would be the focus of OSS's management of manned science experi-
ments. Shoemaker, however, did not stay to direct the lunar science program
from this position. When his tour of duty with NASA ended in November 1963
he returned to the Geological Survey to continue his work with Ranger and Sur-
veyor. He was succeeded by Willis B. Foster, who had served in the Pentagon
as Deputy Assistant Director for Research in the Directorate of Defense Research
and Engineering. 48
23
Where No Man Has Gone Before
for Space Science and Applications,* and for Advanced Research and Technol-
ogy. This change greatly simplified the lines of authority between the program
offices and the centers, as well as freeing NASA's three top managers to attend
to matters of broader concern. The greater autonomy of the program offices, how-
ever, tended to make them more self-sufficient and parochial and to make
interoffice cooperation more cumbersome. 49
In September 1963 Brainerd Holmes, who had steered the lunar landing program
through some of its most critical decisions, left NASA to return to private indus-
try. His replacement was George E. MueUer. Headquarters scientists did not know
what to expect from the new chief of manned space flight, but they could hardly
anticipate less consideration than Holmes had given their projects. One historian
has characterized Holmes as "masterful, abrasive, and determined to get what
he needed to carry out his assignment, even at the expense of other programs."50
Considering the state of the manned space flight organization when Holmes took
charge and the development problems that had to be solved to put men on the
moon by 1970, it is hardly surprising that he gave science such a low priority;
but the science community was not inclined to accept that as an excuse for his
indifference to their suggestions.
Mueller, like Holmes, was an electrical engineer. He had managed Air Force
missile and space development projects for Space Technology Laboratories, Inc.,
for five years before joining NASA. But he also held a Ph.D. in physics, and his
experience included several years of teaching and research at Ohio State Univer-
sity; _1 it was at least conceivable that his attitude toward science might be differ-
ent from Holmes's. No less committed than Holmes to the success of Apollo and
no less determined to have his own way, s2 Mueller came to Washington about
the time the public debates concerning Apollo and the space science program
had subsided (see Chapter 1), so he was in a position to see that it would be polit-
ically advantageous to accommodate the scientists if he could.
Mueller moved quickly to reorganize his office and strengthen its lines of
communication with the centers. He also brought in several high-ranking Air Force
officers familiar with his management style to fill key positions in OMSF. One
of Mueller's first priorities was to evaluate the general health of the Apollo proj-
ect. He detailed two experienced Headquarters officials to study the progress of
its components and estimate its chances for success by 1970. After surveying cur-
rent plans in light of recent progress and anticipated funding, they reported that
in their judgment the project had about one chance in ten of meeting its stated
goal. Mueller then imposed some drastic changes on the Saturn program: he can-
celed the scheduled earth-orbital test flights of the Apollo spacecraft on the
Saturn I and ordered that the Saturn V be tested "all up"--with all stages and
systems complete and functioning from the first test flight--rather than proving
each stage's readiness separately. 53 Then, while the centers adjusted to their new
boss's ways, he turned his attention to the science program.
Mueller believed that his office had to have ultimate control over every part
of every manned space program, including the science experiments; and by the
*Newell's responsibilities were extended to encompass the space applications program (communi-
cations, weather, and navigation projects), which since 1961 had been managed by the Office of Appli-
cations (abolished in the reorganization).
24
LinkingScience
to Manned Space Flight
end of the year he had decided to set up a Manned Space Flight Experiments
Board (MSFEB) to review all experiments proposed for manned missions. The
board's charter established four categories of experiments (scientific, technologi-
cal, medical, and Department of Defense*) and the channels through which they
were to be submitted. Assessment of the scientific merit of a proposed experi-
ment was left to the sponsoring agency. The board would assess the operational
feasibility of each proposal by referring the experiment plans to the appropriate
field center (usually MSC) for review. In case the board could not agree on whether
to fly any particular experiment, Mueller, as chairman, could make the final deci-
sion. Experiments accepted by the MSFEB and assigned a priority comprised a
list from which those to be flown on a particular mission were to be taken. Mueller
assigned responsibility for developing the flight hardware for each experiment
to the field center involved (again, normally MSC), which appointed a technical
monitor to work with the experiment's principal investigator in developing the
flight-qualified instrument. 54
Not everyone was happy with the new experiments board; some space science
officials protested that Mueller was usurping their prerogatives to select and evalu-
ate experiments.SS Experimenters complained that Mueller's system took too much
time and paperwork and unduly increased the cost of manned space science.
Nonetheless, Mueller had to ensure that a proposed experiment was compatible
with the spacecraft in all respects and that it could be carried out without inter-
fering with mission operations. As long as OMSF was still learning how to get
people to the moon and back, science took second place when it came aboard at all.
As 1963 ended, manned space flight officials could look back at two and a half
years of intense activity and considerable progress. Project Mercury had flown
four earth-orbital missions, the last one remaining aloft for 34 hours. A new pro-
ject, Gemini, was under way; its objectives were to explore some of the prob-
lems posed by the lunar landing mission, especially rendezvous. 56 Apollo
managers had made several critical decisions, including the choice of lunar-orbit
rendezvous, the basic design of the two lunar spacecraft, and the configuration
of the three-stage Saturn V lunar launch vehicle. Nine of the 12 men who would
ultimately walk on the moon were in training for their part in the program. A
new NASA Administrator, James E. Webb, had taken control, and the agency
had been restructured for better support of Apollo. The new president, Lyndon
Baines Johnson, had more experience with the space program than any other poli-
tician in Washington and would remain committed to it despite severe criticism
and unforeseen tragedy.
*For the involvement of DoD in the early manned space flight programs, see Barton C. Hacker
and James M. Grimwood, On the Shoulders of Titans: A History of Project Gemini, NASA SP-4203
(Washington, 1977), pp. 117-22, and W. Fred Boone, "NASA Office of Defense Affairs: The First
Five Years," NASA Historical Report HHR-32 (Washington, 1970).
25
Where No Man Has Gone Before
The dominant position Apollo occupied in the space program was indicated
by the changes imposed on Ranger and Surveyor in 1962 and 1963. Space science
officials tried hard to preserve the priority of science in both projects, but with
limited success. After thorough examination of the lunar exploration projects,
the Space Science and Space Vehicle Panels of the President's Science Advisory
Committee came down on the side of the Office of Manned Space Flight. In a
mid-October report they concluded that Ranger and Surveyor must be planned
so that the first few successful missions would provide the information engineers
needed to design the lunar landing craft, and that those projects' technical
management and funding should be integrated with Apollo's. Notwithstanding
that concession, the panels insisted that after the first couple of landings science
should determine the content of lunar missions and that the lunar surface activi-
ties must be planned with the full participation of the scientific community, s7
Lunar science planning had begun, in the broadest sense, by the end of 1963,
but how much science could actually be done during Apollo was still a question.
Planners were contemplating as many as 10 lunar missions; what could be done
on each one would have to await events. If the first lunar landing attempt did
not succeed, and several attempts had to be made, science might have to wait.
As 1964 began, Headquarters was preparing to deal with the details of the lunar
missions: choosing landing sites, deciding what specific experiments would be
done on the moon, and selecting the experimenters.
26
3
The years from 1963 to 1966 were the busiest of the lunar landing project, no
less for science planners than for the spacecraft and rocket builders. After the
major decisions made in 1962 provided a basis for planning, the Office of Space
Sciences called on its academic advisory bodies to define first the broad outlines
of a program of lunar and planetary exploration, then more specific plans for the
moon, based on the clearer definition of the Apollo project that was emerging
during the period.
In the two and a half centuries since Galileo first turned his crude telescope
on the moon, astronomers have mapped its surface features, measured the height
of its mountains and the depth of its craters, and calculated its size, mass, and
orbital parameters with increasing accuracy over the years. Even so, the best opti-
cal telescopes, under the best observing conditions, could not show any detail
smaller than about 300 meters across (1,000 feet, about the size of the capitol build-
ing in Washington); so information concerning the nature and texture of the sur-
face was limited.
To the telescopic observer, the moon's surface shows two distinct types of
regions: 1. the mafia (Latin -- "seas"; singular mare)--dark, apparently smooth,
and roughly circular areas extending over hundreds of kilometers; and 2. the
highlands, mostly mountainous regions much lighter in color. Among the most
striking features are the craters--tens of thousands of circular depressions rang-
ing in diameter from 180 miles (290 kilometers) down to the limit of telescopic
resolution. Most large craters have high walls and a depressed floor, and many
have a central peak or ridge. Some are centers from which streaks of light-colored
material (rays) extend for considerable distances. Besides the craters, the lunar
surface shows domes, ridges, and rilles--long, narrow channels resembling dry
watercourses--that run for several kilometers. 1 Measurements of reflected light
indicate that the lunar surface is covered with a layer of finely pulverized mate-
rial. Airless and arid, the lunar surface is subjected to temperature changes of
more than 200°C (360°F) during the course of a lunar day. 2
For decades these features fascinated astronomers and cosmologists, who have
generated volumes of speculation as to the moon's origin and history. Three
hypotheses attracted adherents: one, that the moon was spun off from a molten
proto-earth; a second, that the moon was formed in a separate event and later
27
Where No Man Has Gone Before
THE MOON
The earth-facing side of the moon, depicted in an artist's rendition based on scientific findings.
North is at the top; east is to the right. Especially noticeable is the contrast between the dark, relatively
smooth areas (the "seas" or "mar/a"), mostly in the upper half of the picture, and the lighter, heavily
centered areas in the lower right. The large circular feature in the upper left quadrant is Mare
Imbrium, bounded on the southeastern edge by the Apennine Range and on the southwest by the
Carpathian Mountains. East of Mare Imbrium lies Mare Serenetatis, with the Taurus Mountains
on its eastern edge. Mare Tranquilitatis joins Mare Serenetatis on the southeast. The near-circular
area in the upper right is Mare Crisium; below it lies Mare Fecunditatis. Spreading irregularly over
the area west and south of center is Oceanus Procellarum. Two smaller maria, Mare Humorum and
Mare Nectaris, lie to the south and southeast.
The lighter-colored areas are marked by an abundance of craters, in contrast to the maria; this
has led scientists to believe that the maria are younger features, perhaps filled with lava. Lunar craters
range in size from hundreds of kilometers to less than a meter. Many of the larger ones have prominent
central peaks while others have relatively fiat floors. A prominent crater visible here is Copernicus,
west-southwest of the center, from which streaks of light-colored material ("rays") extend into Mare
Imbrium. Farther west is Kepler, a rayed crater surrounded by a light-colored blanket. In the south-
west quadrant, two prominent parallel rays point toward Tycho. Relatively inconspicuous in this
view, Tycho is a medium-sized crater with a central peak about one-fourth of the way from the bottom
of the photograph to the center.
28 ORIGINAL PAGE'
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAp/q
J
Apollo's Lunar Exploration Plans
captured by the earth; and the third, that the earth and moon formed at about
the same time in the same region of space (this hypothesis was considered some-
what less likely than the first two). Those who believed the moon was formed
by accretion of smaller bodies generally supposed that during its evolution the
moon, like the earth, went through a molten stage in which its components were
chemically fractionated, with iron and nickel being separated from the rocky
minerals as the moon cooled. A smaller body of opinion held that the moon never
grew large enough to be completely melted by the heat generated as its compo-
nent particles coalesced, and would not be chemically differentiated. 3
All of these assumptions led to difficulties when examined in light of accepted
celestial mechanics. If the moon separated from the earth at some early stage in
its formation, its orbital plane should lie in the plane of the earth's equator, but
it does not. If, on the other hand, the moon was formed elsewhere in the solar
system, its capture by the earth would be highly improbable and its present orbit
difficult to account for. Finally, if the earth and moon were formed out of the
same primordial matter by any mechanism, it is hard to explain the fact that the
earth is nearly half again as dense as the moon. 4
None of the hypotheses could be proved or disproved on the basis of the
evidence available from visual observation alone. Both led to logical conclusions
concerning the chemical composition and internal structure of the moon that could
not be tested. Scientists who held that the moon was once molten regarded the
maria as massive lava flows from volcanoes or fissures in the lunar crust, similar
to known examples on earth, and pointed to the domes and certain craters that
are much like well known terrestrial volcanic structures. Advocates of the "cold
moon" theory considered the maria to be the solidified remains of large bodies
of molten rock created by collision with meteorites or asteroids, or perhaps by
localized heating due to some other cause.S The origin of lunar craters was a mat-
ter for debate. Some had undoubtedly been produced by impacts of cosmic debris,
but strong arguments could be made that others were volcanic in origin. It was
generally accepted that the moon's surface, unaffected by wind and water,
preserved a record of cosmic events which the earth must also have undergone;
on earth, however, the effects have been obliterated by erosion. 6
Crucial to the confirmation of either hypothesis, or to the creation of an
alternative, was information that could be obtained only by direct examination
of the moon. Analysis of samples of the lunar surface would show whether the
moon was chemically similar to the earth and whether the lunar material had
ever been extensively melted. Measurement of the flow of heat from the moon's
interior to the surface would show whether it was still cooling from a molten state.
Other important investigations included the seismic properties of the moon, which
could reveal its interior structure. Some of this information could be provided
by instruments, perhaps induding remotely controlled samplers capable of return-
ing lunar material to earth. But some tasks, such as examining the moon's sur-
face and selecting samples on the basis of that examination, could better be done
by humans. With the advent of the space age, lunar scientists could look for-
ward to sending instruments to the lunar surface; only after the decision to land
people on the moon could they hope to send a trained explorer.
29
WhereNo ManHas Gone Before
Homer Newell set lunar exploration planning in motion in 1962 with the
appointment of the Sonett committee on Apollo scientific experiments and train-
ing (see Chapter 2). After three months of consultation with leading experts in
the scientific fields related to lunar exploration, the committee outlined its con-
ception of the scope of Apollo lunar science. The primary objectives were exami-
nation of the lunar surface in the immediate area of the landed spacecraft, geologic
mapping of the landing area, investigation of the moon's interior by means of
emplaced instruments, studies of the lunar atmosphere, and radio astronomy from
the lunar surface. 7 No specific experiments were recommended, but the criteria
used in developing the objectives limited the possibilities. The experiments should
be scientifically important and feasible, possible only on the lunar surface and
only with a human on the mission, and likely to lead to further scientific and
technological development3
A week after the Sonett committee issued its draft report, NASA committed
Apollo to lunar-orbit rendezvous. This decision, probably the most thoroughly
debated of the entire program, directly affected the scope of lunar science. The
mission mode determined how many men and how much equipment could be
landed on the moon. Whereas the other possible modes (direct ascent and earth-
orbit rendezvous) contemplated a single large spacecraft that would land with
its entire three-person crew on the moon, lunar-orbit rendezvous would put down
a separate specialized landing craft and a crew of two. 9
With that decision made, Associate Administrator Robert C. Seamans, Jr., asked
Newell to present several questions to NASA's outside scientific advisers for dis-
cussion. What should be the preferred scientific objectives of the earliest lunar
landings? Would the acquisition of scientific data require more than two persons
on the moon at the same time? Were there sufficient scientific reasons to estab-
lish a semipermanent station on the moon for extended exploration? Advice on
these questions would be important in establishing policy with respect to lunar
science and could have direct influence on the design of the lunar landing craft. 10
An appropriate forum for such a discussion was already in session that
summer--the first summer study conducted by the Space Science Board, meet-
ing on the campus of the State University of Iowa (see Chapter 2). Manned space
science programs were not the study's primary concern, but two working groups,
one on lunar and planetary exploration and one on the scientific role of humans
in space, provided opportunities to examine the plans for Apollo's experiments
and put some of the scientists" concerns on record. 1I
At the start of the summer study the chairman of the Space Science Board, Lloyd
V. Berkner, instructed the participants that their advice on the existence of a
national space program and the division of effort among its projects was not
sought. Nonetheless, because of mounting fears for what it would do to NASA's
space science budget, Apollo was never far below the surface, and objections to
the manned programs were repeatedly voiced. Berkner, Newell, and others tried
to steer the discussions into more productive channels, such as how the capabil-
ity being developed for Apollo might be exploited for scientific purposes; but many
30
!I
!
i
i
i
i
i
i
i
!
Apollo's Lunar Exploration Plans
of the participants could not be dissuaded from protesting the priority assigned
to the lunar landing project. TM
Seamans's questions were aired, in substance at least, and the summer study"s
final report contained recommendations concerning the points he had raised. The
working group on the scientific role of humans in space endorsed the findings
of the Sonett committee but recommended that experiments that only used the
moon as a base for observation (e.g., radio astronomy) be relegated to later mis-
sions. It found that there was indeed a valid scientific requirement for a lunar
surface laboratory for long-term investigations. The working group on lunar and
planetary exploration reached similar conclusions and called for increased empha-
sis in the Ranger and Surveyor programs on providing necessary engineering
information for Apollo. 13
Of much more concern to the summer study participants was the scientific
competence of the men who would land on the moon. Acknowledging a con-
tinuing need for astronauts whose primary skills were in spacecraft operation,
the study report nonetheless urged the inclusion of a professional scientist among
the crew of the first lunar landing mission. To ensure that such a person would
be ready for the first landing, NASA should recruit qualified scientists at once
and begin training them as astronauts. The science community insisted that these
scientist-astronauts be given the means to maintain their scientific competence
while acquiring piloting skills. To that end, a space institute should be established
convenient to the astronaut training center, a facility "'of the very highest scien-
tific calibre [maintaining] liaison with major centers of research in the space
sciences [and functioning] as a graduate school offering advanced degrees in var-
ious fields of science.'" It should either be operated "under contract with a major
university" or administered by "that office of NASA responsible for scientific
research and planning,"14 (i.e., the Office of Space Sciences). This "space univer-
sity" proposal--which Newell later remarked never had the slightest chance of
being accepted by NASA_5--was soon abandoned, but the demand for scientist-
astronauts was reiterated by the science community right down to the end of the
Apollo project.
With the modifications made by the Iowa summer study and with the
imprimatur of the National Academy of Sciences, the Sonett committee's recom-
mendations formed the framework of Apollo's initial lunar science planning.
Shortly after its establishment in July 1963 the Manned Space Science Division
promulgated the first scientific guidelines for Apollo, which reflected this prepara-
tory work. The primary scientific activity was to be the study of the moon itself.
First priority among the various lunar studies was given to geologic mapping,
followed by collection of samples for return to earth and emplacement of instru-
ments to return data by telemetry. TM
While working out arrangements for cooperation with the Office of Manned
Space Flight, Newell and his staff also had to establish working relationships with
the Manned Spacecraft Center (MSC). In early 1963 MSC's only experience with
31
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
science had been the visual and photographic experiments made on the first three
Mercury orbital missions. 17These somewhat hurriedly improvised "experiments"
produced some useful data, but mainly they served to show that people could
conduct scientific exercises in orbit. 18 They also showed that both scientists and
engineers had much to learn about each other's objectives and methods. One
result was that MSC acquired a reputation among space scientists of being at best
indifferent and at worst hostile toward scientific investigations. 19 Eugene Shoe-
maker, always an enthusiastic supporter of manned space flight, was "utterly
dismayed" by the attitude of the MSC representatives at the Iowa summer study:
"we don't need your help; don't bother us." This experience led Shoemaker to
agree to spend a year at NASA Headquarters to try to establish a lunar science
program; unless someone concentrated on that task, lunar science might never
get done at all, because "there was no planning for it [and] no program for it.-2o
Some of MSC's indifference to science was the predictable consequence of the
formidable development tasks the center faced and its intense concentration in
1962 on learning to operate in space. But Newell felt that the Houston center's
engineers and managers (also engineers, for the most part) simply did not appreci-
ate what space s,:ience and manned space flight could do for each other. Hous-
ton had no scientific research under way; the few scientists who worked there
were mostly inexperienced in research and served almost entirely in support roles,
providing data to the engineers. Newell spent considerable effort in 1963 trying
to create a more receptive attitude toward science at MSC. 2_ One of Shoemaker's
first accomplishments after he came to Headquarters was to persuade MSC to
expand its small Space Environment Division, a branch of the Engineering and
Development Directorate that existed mainly to collect environmental data affect-
ing the design of spacecraft and mission plans. One geologist joined the division
in 1963, and a team of specialists from the U.S. Geological Survey was assigned
later that same year. Their functions were to set up a research and training pro-
gram in geology, develop a model of the lunar surface for use by the spacecraft
designers and mission planners, assist in the evaluation of lunar scientific instru-
ments, and develop plans for geologic field work on the moon. 22
Lunar surface science, though important, was only part of the larger question
of manned space science, and Newell, looking ahead to the earth-orbital flights
of Gemini and Apollo, wanted to establish a place for science on those missions
as well. The agreement worked out between Newell and Brainerd Holmes
for developing experiments called for the appropriate manned space flight
center (usually MSC) to oversee the development of experiment hardware once
the basic design had been worked out by the Office of Space Sciences. As OSS
saw it, this would require more scientific competence than the Houston center
had. Up to mid-1963 MSC's concern for experiments had been limited to assur-
ing that they fit into the spacecraft and the flight plan and did not compromise
a mission, a task carried out by an Experiments Coordination Office in the Flight
Operations Division. 23 Now, OSS saw a need to establish what would amount
to a space sciences division at Houston. Discussions with MSC produced agree-
ment that the Space Environment Division would be the nucleus of the prospec-
tive science branch. 24
The Office of Space Sciences and the Manned Spacecraft Center spent the rest
of 1963 defining their relationship. Newell firmly maintained his office's respon-
32
Apollo's Lunar Exploration Plans
sibility for all of NASA's science programs, while MSC occasionally displayed
reluctance, to say the least, to accept direction from Headquarters3 s In the old
days of NACA the field laboratories had enjoyed considerable independence in
the conduct of their programs, and all of MSC's top managers were old NACA
hands. At times they seemed inclined to insist on running their programs their
way, including the science. But by the end of the year MSC had agreed in princi-
ple to set up a scientific program manager on Director Robert Gilruth's immedi-
ate staff, and Headquarters and center elements were beginning to work out a
description of that person's responsibilities. 26
Early in 1964 the Office of Space Science and Applications (OSSA) began to
define the Apollo lunar science project more narrowly. Rather than issue a request
for experiment proposals to the scientific community at large, which was the usual
procedure for soliciting experiments, Newell and his manned space flight coun-
terpart George Mueller agreed that initially a few selected scientists should be
called upon to identify the most important experiments within the areas agreed
on by the Sonett committee and the Iowa summer study. A representative of
Headquarters's Manned Space Science Division and the chairman of the Space
Science Board then compiled a list of experts who met on January 30 to begin
the process. 27 The first investigations agreed on by this planning group comprised
geology (field geology, petrography and mineralogy, and sample collection),
geochemistry, and geophysics (seismology, magnetic measurements, heat-flow
measurements, and gravity measurements). For each area the group suggested
several prominent scientists to work out detailed experiment plans3 s In April the
first Apollo science planning teams, groups of experts in subdisciplines of the
earth sciences, began meeting to define more specifically the lunar surface experi-
ments and instruments. Later, teams would be established for lunar atmospheric
studies and biosciences. 29
At Houston, meanwhile, mission planners had started defining the lunar
landing mission in detail. In late 1963 the first set of operational ground rules
was established, listing mission objectives and constraints and identifying criti-
cal points where a flight might have to be aborted or diverted to an alternate mis-
sion in case of failure of some essential system. Using these ground rules and
the latest available weight and performance data for the launch vehicle and space-
craft, planners then prepared the "'reference trajectory," a detailed description
of the mission from liftoff to splashdown.* For planning purposes the reference
trajectory listed 10 landing sites within a zone 85 miles (137 kilometers) wide and
1,480 miles (2,380 kilometers) long stretching along the equator on the moon's
*The reference trajectory was one of the most important mission planning documents. It enabled
flight planners to evaluate the effect of changes in spacecraft weight, propulsion capability, mission
requirements, etc., on every phase of the mission. An initial reference trajectory was often based
on many assumptions, but as test data and operational experience accumulated, the trajectory was
updated.
33
WhereNoManHas Gone Before
visible side. It assumed that the lunar landing module would stay on the moon
for 24 hours. 3°
Science and mission planning came together in mid-June of 1964 when Houston
hosted a lunar landing symposium to give each group a look at the other's prelimi-
nary plans. MSC representatives presented their concepts of a lunar landing mis-
sion, described the two spacecraft and what they could be expected to carry to
and from the moon, and outlined the current astronaut training course. Mem-
bers of the Apollo science planning teams sketched out their tentative plans for
surface activities and experiments. After four days of discussion, both groups
went home to refine their concepts. 31
The June symposium defined the operational bounds within which the lunar
science planning teams had to work, and after five more months of deliberation
the planning teams' report went to the Office of Space Science and Applications.
Distributing the report for comment, Headquarters noted that its recommenda-
tions would eventually become the basis for a lunar exploration science program
definition document on which final instrument and experiment designs would
be based. First, however, OSSA was planning to have the report discussed at
another summer study, scheduled for 1965. 32
As the planning teams saw it, the ultimate objective of the lunar science program
was simply the same as that of all science: to add to human knowledge. More
specifically, lunar studies could lead to a better understanding of the solar sys-
tem and its origin, of primary forces that shaped the earth, and of geological
processes whose effects have been obscured on earth by erosion and other secon-
dary processes not operating on the moon. (Making the obligatory gesture toward
practical results, the report mentioned that lunar studies "may have direct bear-
ing towards more intelligent search for mineral resources on Earth," though it
did not specify how.) The larger objectives, however, could scarcely be met in
the short times the early Apollo missions would stay on the lunar surface. Really
productive lunar studies required more time on the moon, greater mobility for
the astronauts, and logistic support. 33
For the approved Apollo missions the planning teams stressed field work,
sampling, and emplacement of instruments, all planned to yield the maximum
information in the time available. Instruments relaying data by telemetry were
preferred for measurement of gravity, magnetism, magnetic phenomena, and seis-
mic studies. The geochemistry and bioscience planning teams emphasized the
importance of bringing back the greatest possible weight of lunar material in the
form of carefully selected and documented samples for laboratory study. Eugene
Shoemaker's field geology team stressed visual observation and panoramic pho-
tography from the lunar module, followed by surface traverses during which the
astronauts would collect samples, emplace instruments, and describe the impor-
tant geologic features of the landing area. Both the geology and geophysics teams
listed the tools and instruments that should be taken along, as well as prelimi-
nary estimates of weight, volume, power, and telemetry requirements. The report
included tentative operations plans for several lunar surface missions, taking into
account operational constraints and certain contingencies that might require
changing plans during the mission. 34
With these recommendations in hand, Headquarters and MSC began making
plans for managing the experiments. In mid-January 1965 Houston's Space
34
Apollo's Lunar Exploration Plans
In the summer of 1965 the Space Science Board again convened a conference
to consider NASA's plans for space research. The Iowa summer study three years
before had reviewed current programs and recommended changes of emphasis;
the 1965 study at Woods Hole, Massachusetts, was charged with recommending
directions and priorities for the next 10 to 20 years. The major topics considered
were lunar and planetary exploration, astronomy, and the role of humans in space
exploration. 42
The Woods Hole conference report made many detailed recommendations in
individual areas of research. Space research, the study found, required the use
*Houston Division of Bendix Corp., Ann Arbor, Mich.; Space-General Corp., E1Monte, Calif.; and
TRW Systems Corp., Redondo Beach, Calif.
35
Where No Man Has Gone Before
The group did not concede that people could be replaced by instruments in every
imaginable case:
if the presence of man in the system were already considered essential, the
scientist would assign many scientific tasks to man because of the greater relia-
bility and flexibility he would bring to the system. 44
On the question of selection and training of scientists for space missions, the
scientists were of much the same mind as those in 1962:
For some tasks--those requiring scientific insight--it would seem better to have
a scientist possessing judgment, experience, and imagination and to train him
as an astronaut to the extent required.
Again conceding that test pilots had the edge in some areas, the working group
nonetheless concluded that
the astronaut selection and training program [should] take into account pro-
gress in manned space flight. Successes so far[*] may be viewed as evidence
*Four successful manned flights had been made in the past three years, including two of the two-
man Gemini spacecraft.
36
Apollo'sLunar Exploration Plans
that it may be possible to relax the present high physical standards at a pace
faster than has yet been contemplated. 45
Concerning the lunar exploration program, the Woods Hole study report
confined itself to defining the major scientific questions in lunar exploration. Three
basic problems should be explored: structure and processes of the lunar interior,
the composition and structure of the moon's surface and the processes that have
modified it, and the sequence of events by which the moon has arrived at its pres-
ent configuration. As guidelines for exploring these problems, the report listed
15 specific scientific questions that should direct lunar exploration, both manned
and unmanned (see Appendix 3). 46
One question that assumed increasing importance as planetary exploration
became more realistic was the existence of life forms or their precursors on the
moon or the planets. The working group on biology concluded that the evolu-
tion of organisms or prebiotic materials was most likely to have occurred on Mars.
However, the group affirmed the necessity to avoid contaminating any celestial
body, including the moon, with terrestrial organisms or organic materials that
might invalidate later experiments attempting to detect life. As to the need for
protecting earth from biological contamination by material from the moon, the
group believed the hazards were small but that NASA should be safe rather than
sorry: "the consequences of misjudgment are potentially catastrophic.'47 Opin-
ion on this point was not unanimous throughout the conference, however, for
the working group on lunar exploration noted only a "minor possibility of find-
ing prebiotic material, either buried or in sheltered locations. "'48
The Woods Hole conference was, as far as Apollo was concerned, a policy-
setting meeting. When it adjourned, many of the participants stayed on at nearby
Falmouth for a two-week conference dealing with details of lunar exploration and
science on Apollo. The Falmouth conference elaborated on the previous year's
work of the Apollo lunar science planning teams in light of plans for manned
space flight for the 10 years following the first Apollo landing. As plans then stood,
the first few landings--the exact number was not certain--comprised the Apollo
program; it was assumed that these landings would be minimal missions to estab-
lish confidence in the Apollo systems. They were to be followed by flights using
improved spacecraft that could carry larger payloads and stay longer on the lunar
surface.* Ultimately, perhaps in the last few years of the post-Apollo period, a
lunar base might be available for scientific studies. Falmouth planners structured
their discussions around this idealized schedule. °
At Falmouth, members of the lunar science planning teams collaborated with
NASA and academic scientists to take the first steps in detailed scientific opera-
tions planning. As specifically as they could, disciplinary working groups laid
*In 1965 plans for manned space flight after Apollo were still in the formative stage. OMSF had
conducted several studies on "Apollo Extension Systems" to determine how far the propulsion, life-
support, and electrical power systems on the Apollo spacecraft could be upgraded without major
redesign. These "extended Apollo" components would be used in missions--earth- and lunar-orbital
flights as well as lunar surface missions, lasting from 10 to 45 days--that would sustain the manned
programuntil the next majorprogram could be defined. See W. David Compton and Charles D. Benson,
Living and Working in Space:A History of Skylab,NASA SP-4208 (Washington, 1983), Chaps. 1, 3, and
5; also George Mueller's presentations to the House and Senate space committees in the NASA authori-
zation hearings for fiscal 1966 and 1967.
37
WhereNoMan Has Gone Before
out their requirements for procedures and equipment. For the first time, an
astronaut in training described the mission's essential constraints from the
astronaut's point of view, stressing the limitations of space suits, life-support
equipment, and operational contingencies (such as an aborted landing). 5° For some
scientists this was the first time they had had to consider their own experiments
in the context of other scientific work and operational restrictions, and one par-
ticipant reported a noticeable change in attitudes as the discussions progressed, sl
In its final report the Falmouth conference summarized its recommendations
for the early landings, the "post-Apollo" (advanced) missions, and the more dis-
tant future when a lunar base could be contemplated (see Appendix 3). Highest
priority on the early landings was assigned to returning the greatest number and
variety of samples as feasible; emplacement of long-lived surface instruments was
next, followed by geologic exploration of the landing area by the astronauts. The
early missions could only sample isolated areas of the lunar surface. A survey
of the entire moon, plus detailed studies of the equatorial belt, should be the objec-
tive of later missions. These advanced missions, five or six landings flown at the
rate of one or two per year, should be supported by an unmanned logistics sys-
tem that would land additional consumable supplies and scientific equipment.
Crews might stay as long as 14 days and explore as far as 15 kilometers (9 miles)
from the landing site. The additional equipment should include some analytical
instruments for on-the-spot discriminatory tests on lunar material, so that
astronauts could select a wider variety of samples. Surface transportation should
be provided--a wheeled vehicle with a range of 8 to 15 kilometers (5 to 9 miles) and
a flying vehicle that could carry 135 kilograms (300 pounds) of instruments from
point to point over a 15-kilometer range. With the flying unit, astronauts could
secure samples from otherwise inaccessible locations, such as a crater wall. s2
Falmouth provided the best scientific advice NASA could get at the time, and
its recommendations formed the basis for the earliest mission planning. It was
the first of several iterations of scientific planning that would take place during
the rest of the Apollo program. NASA would make every effort to carry out as
much of the program as could be done within a changing context of available
resources. Progress often seemed intolerably slow to some scientists, s3 but in the
end a gratifying proportion of the Falmouth recommendations would appear in
mission plans.
The visible face of the moon offered scores of interesting sites for scientific explo-
ration. As far back as 1961, Harold Urey, responding to a question from Homer
Newell, listed five general regions of high scientific interest: high latitudes, to
determine whether water might exist where temperature extremes were less
marked; two maria, to determine whether they were of different composition;
inside a large crater; near one of the great wrinkles in the maria; and in a moun-
tainous area. Assuming that equatorial sites would draw the most attention any-
way, Urey offered no suggestions concerning them. s4 Eugene Shoemaker noted
not long afterward that scientific objectives would be subordinate to operational
38
Apollo's Lunar Exploration Plans
requirements, at least on the early missions, and that the sites most operation-
ally suitable for an Apollo landing--level, featureless maria, most likely--would
be the least suited to determination of geologic relationships, s5
Operations planning for the earliest Apollo missions was designed to assure
the safe return of the astronauts. The spacecraft, still attached to the Saturn upper
stage, would be inserted into an earth-circling "parking orbit" so that mission
control could verify that all systems were working properly. Lunar landings were
to be made in direct sunlight and at specific times of the lunar day chosen for
optimum visibility; return to earth must take place in daylight; and allowance
would be made for possible interference with communication caused by solar
activity. 56 These rules, along with constraints on the lunar orbit of the command
module, defined a landing zone along the moon's equator within which the first
mission would have to land.
Equally important for selecting a landing site was the nature of the lunar
surface--how much weight it could support and how many rocks and small craters
were present. For this purpose, high-resolution photographs of the lunar sur-
face were required, which were to be supplied initially by the Ranger spacecraft
(see Chapter 2). To supplement Ranger's photographs and also to provide direct
information about the surface, a second unmanned spacecraft, Surveyor, would
be built. One version would soft-land on the moon and transmit scientific data
and television pictures; a second version would be an orbiter that would circle
the moon, photographing large portions of its surface. But when Apollo engineers
specified the detail required for their purposes, the Surveyor orbiter as then
defined could not meet them. s7
To supply the high-resolution photographs needed to certify landing sites, both
OMSF and OSSA endorsed a new lunar-orbiting spacecraft. Preliminary studies
indicated that the project was feasible, and after briefly considering giving the
orbiter to the Jet Propulsion Laboratory, Headquarters officials decided to assign
it to Langley Research Center. By the end of August 1963 Langley had drawn
up specifications for the spacecraft and camera system and called for bids. Before
the year ended, project officials had selected the Boeing Company as the prime
contractor. Boeing proposed a solar-powered satellite, attitude-stabilized in three
axes, carrying a film camera system designed by the Eastman Kodak Company.
Film was to be developed aboard the spacecraft and the images were to be trans-
mitted to earth by an optical scanning and telemetry system. Five photographic
missions were planned; the first Lunar Orbiter would be ready for flight less than
three years after the contract was let. 58
In Ranger and Surveyor, the two projects that contributed most to early Apollo
site selection, the Manned Spacecraft Center had worked closely with the Jet
Propulsion Laboratory to coordinate Apollo's requirements with mission plans
(see Chapter 6). s9 As late as 1964, no single organization was responsible for col-
lecting the data needed to evaluate Apollo landing sites and recommending the
final choice for each mission. 6° In mid-1965, acting on a recommendation from
39
Where No Man Has Gone Before
*Bellcomm, Inc., was a systems-engineering organization created in 1962 by the American Tele-
phone & Telegraph Co. at NASA's request for the purpose of conducting independent analyses of
many aspects of the Apollo program. It employed about 500 people at peak strength (1969). In 1972,
its work_for NASA completed, Bellcomm was merged with Bell Laboratories. J. O. Cappellari, Jr.,
"Where on the Moon? An Apollo Systems Engineering Problem," The Bell System Technical Journal
51 (5) (1972): 955.
4O
4
The samples of rock and soil brought back from the moon would be a priceless
scientific resource, and for scientists to be able to extract the maximum informa-
tion from them, the samples would have to be carefully protected. Minute traces
of earthborne contaminants could lead to completely erroneous interpretations
of laboratory results. In 1964 scientists at the Manned Spacecraft Center proposed
that NASA provide a laboratory in which lunar samples would be cataloged and
subjected to preliminary examination, so that the requirements of principal inves-
tigators for specific types of material could be met. There were, as well, certain
time-critical examinations that would have to be done as soon as possible after
the samples were returned to earth.
To provide for these requirements would have required only a modest facility.
But as plans for managing the samples developed, NASA came under pressure
from space biologists and the U.S. Public Health Service to protect the earth
against the introduction of alien microorganisms that might exist in lunar soil.
What would have been a small laboratory designed to protect lunar samples
against contamination grew into an elaborate, expensive quarantine facility that
greatly complicated operations on the early lunar landing missions.
41
Where No Man Has Gone Before
ations within the chamber, which would be sterile, chemically clean, and used
for no other purpose. 2
Faget recognized the importance of the proposed facility to the lunar science
program and encouraged King and Flory to expand their concept. The second
version of the "sample transfer facility" was considerably larger and more sophisti-
cated. A 2,500-square-foot (232-square-meter) clean room contained several ana-
lytical instruments for performing preliminary tests on the samples. Within this
area was a high-vacuum system containing remote manipulators and a separate
sterile laboratory for biological testing. The vacuum chamber was equipped to
prepare mineralogical and petrological specimens as well as divide and repack-
age the samples. The atmosphere in the entire area would be closely monitored
so that subsequent investigators would know what contaminants might be pres-
ent in their samples. 3
These preliminary studies received considerable support in June 1964 when the
Apollo science planning teams (see Chapter 3) met at Houston. Both the
geochemistry and mineralogy-petrology teams emphasized the importance of con-
trolling the environment in which the sample containers were first opened and
the need for extensive preliminary examination of the samples at the receiving
site. 4 After discussions with members of these teams, King and Flory reworked
their proposal and described an elaborate lunar sample laboratory. Projected at
more than 8,000 square feet (740 square meters) of floor space, their third con-
cept included offices for 30 visiting scientists as well as laboratories for chemical
analysis, low-level short-lived radioactivity measurements, biological examina-
tion, and mineralogical and petrological preparations. This facility was not a mere
sample-receiving and -packaging laboratory, but the center for much of the prelimi-
nary scientific work that would be done on the lunar samples. 5 They presented
this concept to MSC's director, Bob Gilruth, on August 13. Gilruth approved,
and Faget set about preparing to'contract for design studies for it. 6
MSC's plans required Headquarters approval and funding, and when Faget
explained the project Willis Foster's Manned Space Science Division reacted cau-
tiously, to say the least. While agreeing in general terms with the concept, Foster
noted that it was a Headquarters responsibility and that the laboratory would
be only a "receiving laboratory." The detailed preliminary studies Houston was
proposing should be left to outside investigators. In response to Faget's request
for $300,000 to conduct the design study, Foster replied that he could allot only
$100,000. 7 In view of the alarm with which some of his people viewed the size
of the project MSC was proposing, Foster appointed an ad hoc group of Head-
quarters and MSC scientists to review it. 8
The group's first meeting in early November was, from Houston's point of view,
disappointing. Few of the participants had given much thought to the require-
ments for a receiving laboratory, and the discussion was long and inconclusive.
The group's chairman seemed determined to keep the size and cost of the pro-
posed lab to the absolute minimum. Most members seemed to feel that a facility
such as MSC was proposing would take much of the lunar science program out
of the hands of academic investigators. In spite of MSC's insistence that time
was short, the group adjourned without taking any useful action. 9 But the sec-
ond meeting, a month later, produced enough progress that MSC's representa-
tive felt Houston could go ahead with initial engineering studies. TM
42
Handling Samples from the Moon
While Foster's ad hoc group ruminated on the need for a receiving laboratory,
Homer Newell--probably sensing that it would entail a considerable increase in
the costs of lunar exploration--felt that an independent assessment by the scien-
tific community was needed. Early in December he wrote to Harry H. Hess, chair-
man of the Space Science Board, requesting the board's judgment on the kinds
of analysis that should be performed on the lunar samples as soon as they were
returned, the facilities needed to do that work, and the staffing that would be
required, u A five-man committee--three members of the Space Science Board
and two academic scientists--met in Washington on January 14, 1965, to discuss
Newell's questions and to confer with members of the ad hoc group.
Three weeks later Hess reported to Newell that a sample receiving laboratory
having a relatively restricted mission was indeed needed. The only critical exami-
nation was measurement of radioactivity induced in the lunar surface material
by cosmic-ray bombardment, which would have to be measured as soon as pos-
sible because it quickly dropped to a very low level. The committee raised a ques-
tion that Newell had not put to it: its members foresaw a need to quarantine the
lunar samples until they proved biologically innocuous. A simple, general bio-
logical examination could be done at some existing Public Health Service or Army
installation. Without specific information or plans to comment on, the commit-
tee could give only rough estimates of staffing requirements and probable costs.
A minimal quarantine facility with a radiation-counting laboratory might be built
for $2.5 million; it would require between 12 and 30 professional scientists plus
a supporting staff. 12
Hess's committee emphatically asserted that the studies MSC was proposing
should not be done in the receiving laboratory--or, Sor that matter, by any single
group, inside or outside government--but should be entrusted to the scientific
community at large. Neither did they see a compelling need to locate the labora-
tory at Houston, although "it may seem desffable that MSC have a part in the
activity by virtue of its Apollo role.'" If the Houston center could properly staff
such a laboratory, however, it might "add to the overall environment at MSC."
On the other hand, since the radiation-counting laboratory would have to be built
deep underground to shield it from natural radiation, the waterlogged soil of the
Texas coast might make construction more expensive there, and thus some other
site might be preferable. The committee also cautioned that such a laboratory
would have to operate continuously to conduct worthwhile research; it could not
be geared up to operate whenever a new set of samples was available and then
shut down until another lunar mission was flown, 1_ which, they evidently sus-
pected, was the way MSC was likely to operate the laboratory in light of its mini-
mal scientific capability.
Manned Spacecraft Center officials, meanwhile, were anxious to get their
preliminary engineering studies under way. Preliminary studies, design studies,
contractor selection, and contract negotiations had to be disposed of as quickly
as possible. Cost estimates and justifications had to be prepared for inclusion in
the center's budget proposals for fiscal 1967, when construction would have to
start. According to early 1965 estimates, the laboratory would have to be opera-
tional by January 1969 to support the first lunar mission. Many critical and com-
plex operations in the laboratory would have to be checked out beforehand, and
managers estimated that a 9- to 12-month shakedown would be needed. 14
43
Where No Man Has Gone Before
The sense of urgency felt at MSC was not shared in Washington, however.
Faget wrote to Foster in mid-January 1965 urging him to release funds for prelimi-
nary engineering studies for the laboratory and suggesting that Headquarters'
ad hoc committee be replaced by a standing committee to oversee the incorpora-
tion of scientific requirements into the laboratory during construction. A month
later Foster replied that study funds could not be released until the ad hoc com-
mittee made its report. He concurred with Faget's desire for a standing commit-
tee and urged him to appoint one of his staff to it, pointing to the value of "a
greater understanding by MSC of the scientific objectives of the laboratory," which
would enhance Houston's chances of getting the facility. "Other NASA centers,'"
Foster said, "are submitting 'bids' for the laboratory. ''15
For the next several weeks, MSC and Headquarters discussed management of
the laboratory, finally reaching an understanding as to future activity on the proj-
ect. Foster would appoint a standing committee that would be given free access
to design reviews and relevant program materials, so that Headquarters could
be assured that the science requirements levied on the laboratory were being met.
At Faget's insistence, however, the committee would have no right to approve
plans; their advice would be made available through the committee chairman to
MSC's point of contact for the receiving laboratory. Except for the specialized
radiation-counting equipment, the cost of the laboratory would be included in
MSC's construction of facilities budget for fiscal 1967.16 Some discrepancy still
existed between Headquarters's and Houston's cost estimates. Foster's office
seemed be thinking of a $1- to $2-million facility; the figure included in MSC's
preliminary 1967 budget was $6.5 million. 17
Houston's planning for the sample receiving laboratory was vastly complicated
the following summer by a question Hess's committee had emphasized in its
February report. They stated a clear requirement for quarantine of the lunar mate-
rial until biologists could ascertain that it harbored no living organisms that might
threaten the earth's biosphere. TM
The possibility that life exists or has existed elsewhere in the universe--even
within our solar system--evolved from a science-fiction fantasy to a serious scien-
tific question within a few decades. Although no positive evidence has ever been
found to indicate that even the simplest living organisms exist elsewhere, a con-
siderable accumulation of evidence that life might appear, under the right condi-
tions, has led to a widespread conviction that it has appeared, somewhere. .19
*The argument runs roughly as follows. Simple organic molecules related to the substances out
of which living matter is made have been detected in space. Other organic material, possibIy derived
from living organisms, has been found in meteorites. Conclusive experiments have shown that precur-
sors to living matter can be built from chemically simple substances under conditions presumed to
have existed on the ancient earth. Given the vast number of galaxies observable in the universe (a
billion billion, according to one estimate) it seems probable that solar systems like our own exist some-
where in those galaxies, and that conditions favoring the origin of life exist on an appreciable num-
ber of planets similar to earth.
44
Handling Samples from the Moon
As early as 1960 the Space Science Board had advised that NASA and other
concerned government agencies (e.g., the Public Health Service) should estab-
lish an interagency committee on interplanetary quarantine to formulate a national
policy for handling spacecraft and material returned from other planets. 2° Two
years later, the working group on biology of the Iowa summer study (see Chap-
ter 1) noted that
the introduction into the Earth's biosphere of destructive alien organisms could
be a disaster .... We can conceive of no more tragically ironic consequence
of our search for extraterrestrial life.
These cautions had little effect on NASA's plans--in part because the danger
seemed remote in the early 1960s, but also because no one in the space agency
spoke for the life sciences. .22 In the early days of space flight few biologists were
interested in the space environment; the frontiers of biology were on earth. The
life-science community created no demand for NASA support comparable to that
created by space physics and astronomy. 23
As the Apollo program progressed, however, and the prospect of people return-
ing from the moon with boxes of lunar rocks and soil became increasingly likely,
concerned biologists continued to call attention to the need for precautions against
contamination of the earth by organisms from the moon. On July 29, 1964, the
Space Science Board convened a conference of representatives from the Public
Health Service, the Department of Agriculture, the Fish and Wildlife Service, the
National Academy of Sciences, and NASA to assess the back-contamination prob-
lem and recommend courses of action. The conference concluded that
To contain any alien life forms, astronauts, spacecraft, and lunar materials com-
ing back from the moon should be placed immediately in an isolation unit; the
*See NeweU, Beyond the Atmosphere, chap. 16 ("Life Sciences: No Place in the Sun"). Of all the
life sciences, space medicine--the effects of the space environment on human physiology--was the
only one of prime concern to manned space flight; but it was only a subsidiary effort in Mercury
and Gemini and was concerned mainly with settling some crucial operational questions. See John
A. Pitts, The Human Factor: Biomedicine in the Manned Space Program to 1980, NASA SP-4213 (Washing-
ton, I985).
**This statement is quite correct; experimental proof of a negative postulate, such as "life does not
exist on Mars," is, in any practical sense, impossible. But many must have felt like one anonymous
reader at MSC, who pencilled opposite the sentence in the margin of his copy of the report: "Like
witches.'"
45
WhereNo ManHasGoneBefore
astronauts
should be held in rigid quarantine for at least three weeks; and prelimi-
nary examination of the samples should be conducted behind "absolute biologi-
cal barriers, under rigid bacterial and chemical isolation." NASA should
immediately take steps to work out the operational details of these procedures. 24
When Harry Hess's committee, speaking for the Space Science Board, reported
its position on back-contamination the following February, both Headquarters
and the Manned Spacecraft Center realized that quarantine was a more serious
concern than they had anticipated.2S Although the director of Biosciences Programs
in the Office of Space Science and Applications had kept in contact with the
National Academy of Sciences and the Public Health Service, the emphasis on
the possible dangers of lunar material came as a surprise to him. 26Most specula-
tion about extraterrestrial life excluded the moon. At Houston, the report por-
tended serious complications in the design of the receiving laboratory and probably
in flight operations as well, and Faget's organization took steps to clarify the
quarantine requirements. 27 Action at higher levels was slow in coming, however.
Only in May did the NASA Administrator and the Surgeon General (chief of the
Public Health Service [PHS]) discuss the matter, agreeing to set up an interagency
advisory committee to deal with back-contamination. 28
By the end of July 1965, MSC had incorporated a general requirement for quaran-
tine into its justification for building the receiving lab, but time was growing short
and detailed specifications were needed. Then-current plans required the labora-
tory to be in operation by January 1, 1969. Allowing a year or more for engineer-
ing and design studies, another six months for checking out the equipment and
procedures, and six months to correct deficiencies uncovered in the shakedown,
just over a year would be left to build the laboratory and install the special scien-
tific equipment. Procedures and space requirements for quarantine had to be set-
tled as soon as possible. MSC already had an outside engineering firm working
on a preliminary engineering survey, which would define the laboratory's spe-
cial requirements and determine what additional studies might be needed to
specify its specialized scientific equipment. 29
Others at MSC were working to formulate a center policy on quarantine in the
hope that it could be simplified as much as possible. In late July, Headquarters
arranged for an informal meeting of PHS and manned space flight representa-
tives to discuss quarantine and the lunar sample receiving laboratory. 30 Know-
ing that MSC had little chance of convincing the PHS that no hazard existed,
Elbert King consulted with center medical experts and prepared a statement assert-
ing that only subsurface samples should be treated as potential hazards and that
quarantine could be terminated as soon as returned samples were found free of
exotic organisms. He also set down several important policy questions concern-
ing quarantine to serve as the basis for discussions with the PHS. 31
When the two groups met at Houston on September 27, 1965, it soon became
apparent that MSC's evaluation of the hazard presented by lunar material was
not shared by PHS officials. King argued that the lunar surface could be consid-
ered sterile: it was in a high vacuum, devoid of water, exposed to intense ultravio-
let radiation and subatomic particles from the solar wind, and subjected to severe
temperature changes. "If you really wanted to try to design a sterile surface,"
King later summarized his argument, "'this was it." Thus surface material and
the astronauts who came in contact only with it should not require such rigorous
46
Handling Samples from the Moon
isolation as samples taken from greater depths. The PHS representative, Dr. James
Goddard, chief of the Communicable Disease Center in Atlanta, was unmoved
by these arguments. He asked whether anyone could be certain that no microor-
ganisms could survive anywhere on the moon--in sheltered areas, for example.
When no one could offer such assurance, Goddard insisted that quarantine must
be strict. He and other PHS officials were upset, in fact, that MSC had taken such
a casual view of the biological hazard. Even if it cost $50 million to implement
an effective quarantine, Goddard said, the importance of the issues justified the
added expense. 32 When MSC asked whether the PHS's immigration officers
would allow the Apollo astronauts to enter the United States if they were han-
dled in the same way the Gemini crews had been, the reply was emphatic: they
would not. 33
When the conference was over MSC officials knew that the lunar receiving
laboratory would have to be even larger and more expensive than they had
expected. Quarantine would require astronauts and a fairly large support staff
to live in isolation for at least three weeks. The numerous postmission debrief-
ings would have to be conducted through the biological barrier. Not only that,
but recovery operations would be much more difficult. PHS officials wanted to
prevent exposure ot the command module's interior to the earth's atmosphere
from the moment it splashed down in the ocean, and the astronauts would have
to be isolated at once--even in the rubber rafts used by the recovery crews. On
reaching the recovery ship they would be led straight to a mobile quarantine cham-
ber that could be flown back to the mainland. Passing the word to all branches
of the Systems Engineering Division at MSC, Division Chief Owen Maynard
directed them to show what measures were being taken to comply with these
requirements. "Rather than assume the standard answer that no changes can
be made within present weight, cost and schedule limitations," he said, "you
should assume that [we are] morally obligated to prevent any possible contami-
nation of the earth.'" Initial examination should be based on the ground rule that
"no [command module] components can be exposed to the earth's atmosphere
following entry, except those components external to the pressure shell which
cannot be contaminated by the cabin environment." While conceding that the
first look might show the problems to be insurmountable, Maynard noted that
the hazards should be completely documented so that action could be taken as
needed. 34
Maynard's instructions to his division probably reflected a widespread mood
of resignation to working around the difficulties that would result from imposi-
tion of strict quarantine, which, in the view of some, was unnecessary. 3s But the
question of back-contamination had been raised by the scientific community and
recognized as important by the Space Science Board and thus had the potential
to become a political issue that could create much adverse publicity for the Apollo
program.
Toward the end of 1965 it was generally accepted that crew and samples would
have to be strictly quarantined. On November 15 NASA's Deputy Administra-
tor, Hugh L. Dryden, wrote to the Surgeon General proposing that a formal liai-
son office with the Public Health Service be established, that a NASA-PHS
advisory committee be set up to establish guidelines for back-contamination con-
trol and oversee NASA's efforts to avoid infecting the earth, and that the PHS
47
Where No Man Has Gone Before
recommend the kind of facilities and staff required to carry out those efforts. 36
The Surgeon General's reply a month later paved the way for establishing for-
mal cooperation in managing quarantine in the Apollo program. 37
MSC had initially projected the cost of building the lunar receiving laboratory
at $6.5 million, but providing for quarantine would increase that considerably.
Before going ahead with plans to enlarge the laboratory, George Mueller, no doubt
with a view to minimizing the cost increase, directed MSC to conduct a quick
survey of quarantine facilities around the country that might serve to isolate crews
and support staff following Apollo missions. 38 Houston evaluated 12 hospitals
and research installations that were equipped for biological containment against
the requirements imposed on Apollo, and concluded that none would be satis-
factory. Only one, in fact, an Army hospital at Fort Detrick, Maryland (which
provided care for personnel working with highly dangerous microorganisms),
even came close. Converting it to accommodate Apollo, however, would require
major new construction and would interfere with the Army's research programs. 39
If the Apollo crews were to be quarantined, NASA evidently would have to build
its own isolation ward for the purpose, and in spite of its cost Mueller believed
he had adequate justification for it.
But lean years were beginning for manned space flight. President Lyndon John-
son pressed hard for expanded domestic social programs while announcing his
intention to keep the federal budget under $100 billion. At the same time the
nation's involvement in southeast Asia deepened; troop commitments increased
eightfold as the United States sent combat units to Vietnam. Other programs,
including space, would be squeezed hard to keep costs down. 40
Administrator James Webb went to Congress in the spring of 1966 with an
authorization request for $5.012 billion, 60 percent of it for manned space flight.
It was an austere budget, Webb said, that provided "no margins of time or of
resources to counter the effects of setbacks or failures. 41 Manned programs
required $54.4 million for construction of facilities--a sharp increase from the previ-
ous year's request, but only one-fourth of what NASA had received two years
before. 42 The largest single amount, $36.5 million, went to Kennedy Space Cen-
ter, most of it for completion of the Saturn V launch complex. The Manned Space-
craft Center needed $13.8 million, of which $9.1 million was allocated to the lunar
receiving laboratory. 43
The House subcommittee on manned space flight was generally sympathetic
to Apollo's other requests, but it gave the lunar receiving laboratory unusually
close scrutiny. In response to questions submitted by the subcommittee after the
initial hearings on February 24, 1966, the Office of Manned Space Flight supplied
for the record a detailed history, including statements from the Public Health Ser-
vice, of the requirements imposed by the scientific community and NASA's efforts
to satisfy them. _ But when William Lilly, Headquarters Apollo Program Control
Director, and George Low, MSC's Deputy Director, faced the subcommittee on
March 1, some members apparently had not had time to study OMSF's responses.
Congressman Donald Rumsfeld suspected the receiving lab was NASA's attempt
48
Handling Samples from the Moon
to get a foot in the door for substantial expenditures later, and he saw no valid
reason to build the lab at MSC. 4s Ranking minority member James Fulton of Penn-
sylvania, like Rumsfeld, did not see why the lab had to be at Houston; but he
also faulted NASA for not planning to use existing facilities and questioned
NASA's assertion that the laboratory was needed. 46 Whatever the reasons for
the congressmen's antagonism to the receiving lab, Lilly and Low had an unex-
pectedly rough day. Olin Teague, chairman of the subcommittee and an unswerv-
ing supporter of manned space flight, did not preside at these hearings, and his
absence undoubtedly deprived them of a friendly interrogator who would have
helped them make their case. The following week the subcommittee, not con-
vinced that NASA had justified the receiving laboratory, struck it out of the
authorization billy
The loss of the laboratory was a blow to MSC and to Apollo; without it, NASA
could not meet the scientific requirements imposed on the lunar landing missions.
Mueller ordered a more detailed study of existing facilities that might serve either
to quarantine the crews and samples or to conduct the required scientific studies.4S
MSC immediately appointed a site survey board to evaluate possible alternate
locations. From a list of 27 facilities a group of 8 was selected for detailed investi-
gation.* The board then prepared a list of detailed criteria for the laboratory, based
primarily on its requirements for two-way biological containment, handling of
samples under high vacuum, and low-level radiation counting. Secondary but
important considerations included space, administrative and technical support
services, and availability of utilities. Finally, the board was to consider logistics,
principally the problem of travel to and from the site by engineers and others
who needed to debrief the astronauts.
Since time was limited, the board split up into two teams, one to survey the
eastern sites and one the western. Each team had a member who could estimate
the cost of modifying and operating the candidate facilities. During the week of
March 16-23 the teams inspected the eight establishments, conferring with offi-
cials at each site to assess the impact of Apollo's requirements on local programs
and their willingness to accept the project. The board then summarized its
findings:
1. There is no single facility that will meet the criteria standards for any one
of the major functional areas of the Lunar Receiving Laboratory, without
extensive modification.
3. The use of any one of the sites investigated will result in reduction or
reprogramming of some phase of nationally significant research effort.
*USPHS Communicable Disease Center, Atlanta, Ga.; Army Biological Center, Ft. Detrick, Md.;
National Institutes of Health, Bethesda, Md.; Oak Ridge National Laboratory, Oak Ridge, Tenn.; USAF
School of Aviation Medicine, Brooks AFB, Tex.; NASA Ames Research Center, Moffett Field, Calif.;
Navy Biological Laboratories, Oakland, Calif.; and Los Alamos Scientific Laboratory, Los Alamos,
N. Mex.
49
Where No Man Has Gone Before
The final report stressed the last point: efficient management of Apollo required
the astronauts, spacecraft, and lunar samples to be as close as possible
to Houston's engineers and physicians, especially in the first few weeks after
recovery, s0
While this survey proceeded, Headquarters gathered more supporting infor-
mation in preparation for a rehearing, sl On March 31 Mueller, armed with the
site survey report and stacks of extra facts, appeared before the subcommittee.
In great detail he explained the history of the receiving lab, in particular the emer-
gence of the requirement for quarantine, stressing NASA's cooperation with the
Public Health Service and the Space Science Board. Since some subcommittee
members apparently felt that NASA had sprung a surprise in proposing the new
facility, Mueller pointed out that chairman Teague had been informed of the prob-
able need for a receiving laboratory in August 1965. Col. John Picketing, who
had headed the site-evaluation survey, then explained that group's operation and
reiterated its conclusions. 5z
This time the subcommittee was convinced and restored funds for the labora-
tory to the authorization bill. sa Fulton, however, held out. He put his objections
on record in the full committee's report to the House, discounting the danger
of back-contamination, asserting that the site survey teams had been packed with
members predisposed to choose Houston as the site for the lab, and disputing
the need to centralize all the operations in one place. Contrary to NASA's own
findings, many other facilities in the country could be used with minor modifica-
tion, Fulton said. 54 When the authorization bill came to the House floor, it passed
with the lunar receiving laboratory's $9.1 million intact, though Fulton tried once
more to kill it. "We simply have no facts," he told his colleagues, "on which
to build a practical foundation and a laboratory. ''ss
The lunar receiving laboratory survived the authorization hearings but fared
somewhat less well in the Appropriations Committee,* which cut out $26.5 mil-
lion in construction funds. The committee did not eliminate or reduce any specific
projects; it was simply not convinced that they should all be started immediately.
Some projects (presumably the receiving laboratory, although it was not men-
tioned by name), the committee report pointed out, would not be needed until
after the lunar landing. 56 The Senate Committee on Aeronautical and Space
Sciences was more specific, reducing funds for the laboratory by $1 million and
warning NASA to keep a tight rein on its costs and provide only the necessary
minimum of specialized facilities. 57
In the final appropriations bill passed by Congress, NASA's budget request
for fiscal 1967 was cut by $44 million, bringing funding for space below $5 billion
*Manned space flight (and the Manned Spacecraft Center) had lost a powerful friend in Congress
a few weeks earlier. Representative Albert Thomas of Houston, chairman of the subcommittee that
passed on NASA's appropriation bills, died on February 15, 1966.
5O
HandlingSamples
from theMoon
for the first time since fiscal 1963. s8 Research and development, the category that
covered most of the agency's expenses for space flight hardware and operations,
suffered the smallest reduction, only $1.6 million out of $4,246.6 million requested.
Construction of facilities was reduced by $18.2 million and administrative opera-
tions by $23.9 million; 59 both of these reductions would have a considerable impact
on construction and operation of the lunar receiving laboratory.
While most of the early planning for the lunar receiving laboratory necessarily
concentrated on the building and its equipment, the scientists who were draw-
51
Where No Man Has Gone Before
*The Space Sciences Steering Committee, composed entirely of NASA employees, was responsible
for recommending science programs and projects to the Associate Administrator for Space Science
and Applications. Seven subcommittees, each having about half its members from the outside scien-
tific community, advised the main committee on specific areas of space science.
52
Handling Samples from the Moon
53
Where No Man Has Gone Before
In fact, MSC officials had finally come to recognize the need for more than just
a staff and organization for the receiving laboratory. By mid-December the Hous-
ton center had decided to create a Science and Applications Directorate, organiza-
tionally on a par with Max Faget's Engineering and Development Directorate,
in which all the center's scientific activity would be centralized (see Chapter 6).
It would take over the activities of the Experiments Program Office and the Space
Sciences Division as well as a number of other scientific functions scattered around
the center. Robert O. Piland, chief of the Experiments Program Office, would
act as director while a search was instituted for an established scientist to fill the
position. 83 No director was named for the lunar receiving laboratory; pending
a permanent appointment, Joseph V. Piland, project manager for LRL construc-
tion, was named acting manager.
To provide the laboratory technicians who would prepare the lunar receiving
laboratory for operation, MSC turned to its support contractors. In mid-January
1967 Gilruth notified Headquarters that he intended to extend an existing con-
tract with Brown & Root-Northrop, which would furnish technicians for the receiv-
ing laboratory under the direction of the project manager. 84 Between completion
of the laboratory and the first lunar mission, Brown & Root-Northrop would train
its employees in laboratory operations and maintenance and prepare for an oper-
ational readiness inspection and a rehearsal of a complete cycle of laboratory
operation.
The Manned Spacecraft Center had recognized the need for a lunar sample
receiving laboratory and was willing to support it, but many MSC engineers--
and a few scientists as well--felt that the quarantine facility and its elaborate
precautions were unnecessary impediments to Apollo operations. But however
insignificant manned space flight officials believed the risk of back-contamination
to be, it was a risk NASA could not afford to take. If they were wrong, the conse-
quences would be, as the scientists said, disastrous.
54
5
From the moment the lunar landing was proposed as the primary goal of
manned space flight, NASA officials and outside scientists debated the qualifica-
tions of the people who would land on the moon. Scientists urged that at least
one of the crew should be a scientist with enough experience to assess the sig-
nificant features of the landing site quickly and accurately and to collect samples
with discrimination. Those responsible for mission operations and crew training
insisted that mission success and crew safety could be assured only if every crew
member were a skilled pilot, preferably a test pilot, able to complete a mission
alone if that unl/kely situation should ever arise. Once the many unknowns in
lunar landing operations were better understood, it might be considered safe to
take along a person with different qualifications. 1
Finding crew members who combined the experience of a scientist with the
skills of a test pilot proved impossible. For the first five years, during the
experimental and developmental phase of the Apollo program, piloting experience
took precedence over scientific training as a requirement for admission to the
astronaut corps. Later, as missions devoted largely to scientific operations were
contemplated, scientists were admitted and trained as pilots.
Test-Pilot Astronauts
Before Project Mercury, design concepts for manned spacecraft were constrained
by a lack of hard facts about the human ability to function in the space environ-
ment. Many believed that electronic systems, controlled from the ground or pro-
grammed for specific contingencies, offered the only safe and practical means
of operating a spacecraft. From this point of view, the person in the spacecraft
was simply a passenger, an experimental subject whose main function would
be to provide the physiological data needed to define the limits of a human's
role in space. Mercury's designers did not completely agree with this philoso-
phy; they conceived a spacecraft in which the pilot could take control of critical
systems if necessary and would have some measure of control at all times. 2
Within months of the start of Project Mercury NASA selected its first group
of pilots for the early earth-orbital flights. The "Original Seven," all military test
55
Where No Man Has Gone Before
pilots* with strong engineering backgrounds, were volunteers picked from a list
of more than a hundred men provided by the Pentagon (see Appendix 6). 3 In
view of Mercury's experimental character, the choice of test pilots was appropri-
ate; they were accustomed to dealing with emergencies under stressful condi-
tions and were familiar with the physical and psychological stresses of high-speed
flight in unproven aircraft.
In choosing test pilots as its first astronauts, NASA came down on the side
of people as active participant in spacecraft operations. It was yet to be shown
how much humans could effectively participate, but the astronauts in the first
group insisted on giving the pilot as much responsibility for control of the space-
craft as feasible; if the pilot did not operate the spacecraft, what was the point
of a person in space (especially a test pilot)? Most of the engineers in the Space
Task Group agreed with this viewpoint. In light of their long NACA experience
with piloted aircraft, they too inclined toward giving pilots all the control they
could safely handle. 4
When the first group of astronauts entered the program in April 1959, Project
Mercury and the Space Task Group were organizationally in flux. As a result,
the Original Seven defined the role of the astronaut for the entire Apollo pro-
gram. Administratively they reported not to any project office but directly to
Robert R. Gilruth, director of the Space Task Group. For most of Gilruth's career
in NACA he had worked with pilots, and he took a special interest in this group.
Shortly after the astronauts reported aboard he assured them that whenever they
had serious concern with any aspect of spacecraft design or mission operations
he would see that they were listened to. 5
The first two astronaut classes (1963). Seated, left to right, the "Original Seven": L. Gordon
Cooper, Jr., Virgil I. (Gus) Grissom, M. Scott Carpenter, Walter M. Schirra, Jr., John H. Glenn,
Jr., Alan B. Shepard, Jr., and Donald K. (Deke) Slayton. Standing, left to right: Edward H. White
II, James A. McDivitt, John M. Young, Elliot M. See, Jr., Charles Conrad, Jr., Frank Borman,
NeiI A. Armstrong, Thomas P. Stafford, and James A. Lovell, Jr.
*NASA originally intended to issue a general solicitation of applications for the position of "research
astronaut-candidate," and considered that several occupations besides test pilot might qualify. President
Eisenhower, however, directed the agency to select its astronauts from the ranks of military test pilots;
this would simplify selection, keep out undesirable applicants, and eliminate the need to run secu-
rity checks on the candidates.
ORIGINAL PAGE
56
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Selecting and Training the Crews
Given this kind of autonomy the astronauts were considerably more than pilots
in training to operate a new vehicle. While undergoing training they also took
an active part in reviews of spacecraft design and operations planning, offered
suggestions from the pilot's point of view, and contributed to the design of the
flight simulators that soon became an important part of astronaut training. Each
person was assigned an area of spacecraft systems or operations planning (e.g.,
attitude-control systems, communications, recovery operations) as a prime respon-
sibility; in his specialty he closely followed developments and served as the point
of contact between his astronaut colleagues and project engineers .6 Training was
strongly engineering- and operations-oriented, a pattern that would be carried
into subsequent projects.
NASA's scientific advisory community first addressed the role of the astronaut
in space science at the Iowa Summer Study in 1962 (see Chapters I and 3). Con-
cerning humans on the moon, the study report stated the belief that
it is extremely important for at least one crew member of each Apollo lunar
mission to possess the maximum scientific ability and training consistent with
his required contribution to spacecraft operations.
This person should participate "in the earliest possible lunar missions," and, since
the chosen mode of operations called for only two men on the lunar surface, "the
maximum scientific return will be achieved only if the scientist himself lands on
the Moon. ''7
A working group of the 1962 summer study considered in detail the role of
people in space exploration, formulating the scientists" position with reference
to science missions of many types, not merely lunar exploration. The group
defined several combinations of scientific and astronautic skills that would be
appropriate for different degrees of scientific participation in manned space mis-
sions. At the top of the scale was the "scientist-astronaut"; fully trained both
as a scientist and as an astronaut, he could operate the spacecraft as well as make
valid scientific observations. For the long term, the working group recommended
creating an Institute for Advanced Space Study--a graduate-level institute with
a unique curriculum in which candidates holding bachelor's degrees would be
trained as scientist-astronauts (see Chapter 3). Meanwhile, aspirants to this posi-
tion should be recruited from among qualified scientists and trained to achieve
comparable qualifications as astronauts, s
The working group recognized that no such scientist-astronauts could be trained
in time for a lunar landing within the decade. For the short term, they
acknowledged that the best course was to give qualified astronauts as much train-
ing in science as possible, so that they could be useful observers for the scientist
on the ground. These "astronaut-observers" were expected to play a role in lunar
exploration even after fully trained scientist-astronauts became available. Others
who would be important in conducting space science missions were the "ground
scientist," a scientist thoroughly familiar with all the details of space flight oper-
57
Where No Man Has Gone Before
ations, who would direct the activities of the astronaut-observer from the ground;
and the "scientist passenger,"* a scientist physically qualified for space flight
but not trained to operate the spacecraft. 9
Not surprisingly, the summer study report repeatedly emphasized the need
for the scientist-astronaut to keep up with his science; the scientist who does not
maintain a continuous research program falls behind his colleagues who do and
loses his standing in the scientific community. At the same time, the tone of the
working group's findings implied that the techniques of operating the spacecraft
could be learned by any intelligent person in a couple of years and were there-
fore of subsidiary importance. The level of comprehension of the astronaut's task
was indicated by the responses--summarized in the report--to a questionnaire
sent by the Space Science Board to a number of scientists. On the question of
whether the first scientist on the moon should also be an astronaut, the consensus
of those responding was:
Of course. He should be familiar with all aspects of the spacecraft and be able
to take over in an emergency. However, his qualification as a crew member
would not depend so much on his ability as a space-pilot as on his scientific
aptitude.
In 1962, of course, few people fully understood the demands that would be made
of Apollo crews; but if these statements reflected opinions widely held in the
science community concerning the training required to become a proficient
astronaut, it is not surprising that misunderstandings developed when the time
came to choose crews for the lunar landing missions.
The first group of astronauts immediately became public figures, and as Mercury
shifted into flight operations in the closing days of 1961, demands on their time
for interviews and personal appearances multiplied. NASA welcomed the pub-
licity for the space program, but this aspect of the astronauts' status often made
impossible demands on their heavy training schedule. And when a second pro-
gram, Gemini, was established late in the year, it was clear that more astronauts
would be entering the program, further complicating training and flight prepa-
rations. When Space Task Group managers decided that someone should be
*Fifteen years would pass before NASA had scientist-passengers, now known as "mission specialists"
and "payload specialists," who began flying on Shuttle missions in the early 1980s.
58
Selecting and Training the Crews
*The title "Assistant Director for .... " meant "assistant to the director of MSC in charge of...'"
but was applied to the heads of directorates. This confusing designation was later dropped and chiefs
of directorates were called simply "directors of .... "
59
Where No Man Has Gone Before
or had been Air Force, Navy, or Marine officers. He encouraged open communi-
cation between himself and the astronauts, but expected that when a decision
had been made the discussion was finished. As one of the astronauts character-
ized Slayton's management style, the astronaut's job was "to do what the com-
manding officer says, and if you (didn't) want to .... the door was always
open"lS--the door marked "this way out." Astronauts came into the program
voluntarily and they could always leave the same way.
Slayton well understood the position manned space flight occupied in the
national space program as a consequence of its prominence in the public eye:
any failure, especially one that endangered or killed an astronaut, could set back
the lunar landing for years, and might even kill the manned space flight pro-
gram. His contribution to avoiding failure was to pick the best people for the crews,
and as long as manned space flight entailed any hazardous uncertainties, the best
people would be experienced test pilots.
While much was learned from Mercury, much more had to be learned before
a lunar mission could be planned. Even before President Kennedy's decision to
go to the moon was announced, Space Task Group engineers were planning the
second phase of manned space flight. Project Gemini, approved in early Decem-
ber 1961, would test various techniques of rendezvous, determine whether men
and systems could survive and function during long missions, investigate the
radiation environment in near-earth space, and develop techniques for controlled
landings. Twelve missions were planned, ten of them manned, to start in the
spring of 1964 and fly at two-month intervals. 16
Additional missions required additional astronauts, and on April 18, 1962,
NASA announced it would accept applications for trainees. Once more test pilots
were given preference, but the required number of flying hours was reduced,
and civilians as well as military pilots were eligible. The upper age limit was
reduced from 40 to 35 and the education qualification broadened to include degrees
in physical or biological sciences as well as engineering. 17A list of more than 250
applicants was cut to 32 by preliminary physical and psychological screening.
After intensive evaluation in Houston, nine new astronaut trainees were chosen
in September 1962: two civilians, four Air Force pilots, and three Navy officers,
including some who had applied for the first group but had not been selected
(see Appendix 6). TM Selection of this group virtually depleted the pool of quali-
fied candidates from the small corps of test pilots in the country, and it was the
last group for which test-pilot certification would be a requirement. TM
The new trainees reported at Houston in October 1962 to begin a two-year train-
ing course. A four-day work week was normally scheduled, the fifth day being
reserved for public relations duties or for travel. 2° After two weeks of orientation
to NASA's organization and familiarization with the near-complete Mercury proj-
ect, the second class, joined by the first group, started on a three-month "basic
science" course interspersed with briefings on Gemini and Apollo projects and
systems. The classroom work covered astronomy, aerodynamics, rocket propul-
6O
Selecting
and Training the Crews
sion, and the physics of orbital flight and re-entry; it included lectures on com-
puters, space physics, and the medical aspects of space flight. Almost one-third
of the classroom time was spent on navigation and guidance. In mid-January 1963
the class flew to Flagstaff, Arizona, for a series of geology lectures and field trips
conducted by Eugene Shoemaker. 21
As the Apollo program came into clearer focus in 1962, MSC officials saw that
they needed still more astronauts. At the end of the year projected manned flights
included four development flights of the Saturn I, four of the Saturn IB (an
"'uprated'" version of the Saturn I), and one of the Saturn V, starting in late 1964
and flying at three-month intervals until mid 1967. 22 The 16 astronauts in train-
ing would not be enough to staff the 10 Gemini missions plus the 9 scheduled
for Apollo, and in April 1963 MSC announced its intention to recruit a third class
of trainees. 23 On June 18 the Houston center issued its formal call for applica-
tions. For this group the requirement for flight experience was relaxed still fur-
ther: 1,000 hours of jet time could substitute for test-pilot certification. The selection
board might consider advanced degrees in engineering or science as offsetting
some lack of flight experience. Industry, professional organizations, and the armed
services were asked to recommend candidates. 24 Manned space flight chief
Brainerd Holmes, acknowledging the Space Science Board's Iowa summer study
recommendations, indicated to Congress that scientific qualifications would be
taken into account in selecting this group, z5
Of 271 applicants responding, 30 were selected for final screening. On October
18, 1963, MSC announced the names of the newest class of astronaut trainees
(see Appendix 6). Again military officers outnumbered civilians, by 12 to 2. 26 (At
the end of 1963 the astronaut corps comprised 26 military pilots and 4 civilians,
all trained in military service? 7) The new group was distinguished by a large hum-
The third class of astronauts, selected October 18, 1963. Seated, left to right: Edwin E. (Buzz)
Aldrin, Jr., William A. Anders, Charles A. Bassett II, Alan L. Bean, Eugene A. Cernan, Roger
B. Chaffee. Standing, left to right: Michael Collins, R. Walter Cunningham, Donn F. Eisele,
Theodore C. Freeman, Richard F.Gordon, Jr., Russell L. Schweickart, David R. Scott, and Clifton
C. Williams, Jr. Four members of this class died during training: Bassett, Freeman, and Williams,
killed in aircraft crashes, and Chaffee, killed in the AS-204 fire on January 27, 1967.
ORIGINAL PAdIE 61
BI:ACK AND WHITE p!-;,'-I,
TP,nRApH
Where No Man Has Gone Before
ber of advanced degrees: 8 of the 14 had master's degrees and one held a doc-
torate in astronautics. The two civilians were scientists actively engaged in
research. Most of the military officers held engineering degrees. In spite of MSC's
obvious preference for pilots, the scientific community raised no outcry about
the lack of scientists in the astronaut program. Harold Urey, however, publicly
reproved the agency, late in the year, for not recruiting geologists to explore the
moon. 2S
When the new group reported to Houston in January 1964, Slayton had 29 pilots
to look after, including 5 Mercury veterans.* The first four men who would walk
on the moon were in training, but at the time all attention focused on Gemini,
whose first manned launch was scheduled for November 1964. 29
Classroom work began in February with a new basic science program, a 20-week
series of lectures, briefings, and field trips, strongly oriented toward Gemini but
also including substantial chunks of time devoted to geology, which was entirely
an Apollo concern. The veterans of the previous year's training skipped parts
of this course to spend time in the Gemini simulators, but the geology sessions
were required of everyone. Geologists from MSC and from the Geological Sur-
vey guided them through the equivalent of a one-semester college course in land
forms and land-forming geologic processes, minerals and their origin, and topo-
graphic and geologic mapping. Lectures and laboratory work were supplemented
by field trips to study the Grand Canyon, the Big Bend area of west Texas, and
the volcano fields near Flagstaff, Arizona, and Cimarron, New Mexico. 3° No one
Astronauts Edgar Mitchell (right) and Alan Shepard (second from right) and three geology
instructors examine a small crater near Flagstaff, Arizona.
*John Glenn resigned from the program in January 1964 to enter business (and later, politics). Another
Mercury astronaut, Scott Carpenter, would soon be devoting most of his time to the Navy's Project
Sealab, an experimental underwater habitat, although he would retain formal affiliation with the
astronaut program for another three and a half years.
ORIGINAL PAGE
62
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Selecting and Training the Crews
After a problem-filled 1963, Project Gemini looked toward better things in 1964.
The first flight test of the spacecraft and its Titan II launch vehicle went off on
April 11, raising hopes of a manned flight before year's end. 33 Two days later,
the Manned Spacecraft Center announced the names of the first crews for the
two-man earth-orbital missions. As might have been expected, the Commander
of the first Gemini mission was one of the Original Seven, Virgil I. ("Gus") Gris-
som, who had ridden the second suborbital Mercury flight in July 1961. Paired
with Grissom was one of the second astronaut group, John W. Young. Their
backup crew likewise had a representative from each of the first two astronaut
classes, Walter M. Schirra, Jr., pilot on Mercury-Atlas 8, and Thomas P. Stafford. 34
A week after the announcement, the four Gemini crewmen headed into a full
mission-specific training schedule. At the spacecraft builder's plant in St. Louis,
at MSC in Houston, and at the Cape in Florida they put in long hours learning
the design and function of the spacecraft systems, following the assembly and
testing of their spacecraft, attending briefings on program and mission objectives,
and practicing such tasks as getting out of a floating spacecraft. Simulators dupli-
cated as closely as possible most of the conditions of launch, orbital flight, and
63
Where No Man Has Gone Before
At the end of a 50-foot arm, the man-rated centrifuge at the Manned Spacecraft Center spins a
three-man gondola to simulate the g-forces during launch and re-entry.
**Of the Original Seven, Glenn had resigned, Carpenter was working in Project Sealab, and Slay-
ton was medically disqualified. At the press conference naming the Gemini 3 crews it was also
announced that Alan Shepard was suffering from a middle-ear inflammation that grounded him as
well. (Later that year Shepard took over from Slayton as chief of the Astronaut Office.) Only Cooper
remained unassigned at this time.
ORIGINAL PAGE
6,1 BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Selecting and Training the Crews
seemed clearly to be a factor in Slayton's choice of crews, but it was just as clearly
not the only factor. L. Gordon Cooper, Jr., pilot on the 34-hour, 22-orbit Mer-
cury 9 mission, was not assigned until the Gemini V crew was named in Febru-
ary 1965; his pilot was Charles ("Pete") Conrad, Jr., of the second group. Their
backups, both from the second group, were Neil A. Armstrong and Elliott M.
See, Jr. 37
After Grissom and Young completed Gemini 3, Slayton announced that their
backup crew, Schirra and Stafford, would be the prime crew for Gemini VI, backed
up by Grissom and Young. To trainees eagerly seeking some clue to their prospects
for flight assignment, this signaled that appointment to a backup crew was the
key to flying a mission. The system Slayton followed, as long as circumstances
permitted, was to promote each backup crew to prime crew of the next available
mission after their own prime crew had flown. Each flight had different objec-
tives, requiring different training, and the prime and backup crews had to train
as a team to perform most efficiently. Almost to a man, the astronauts professed
being in the dark as to exactly how Slayton chose crew members for their first
assignment, but that did not matter once they perceived that when they were
named to a backup crew they were, at last, in line for a flight assignment. 38
65
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
Any doubt that scientists were interested in space flight was dispelled by the
response: more than a thousand hopefuls sent in their applications. An ad hoc
committee of the Space Science Board (chaired in Hess's absence by Eugene Shoe-
maker) rigorously scrutinized about 400 of those who passed NASA's prelimi-
nary screening, finally sending only 16 names to NASA for final evaluation. 42
MSC had hoped for a larger group to choose from; Slayton's selection board had
much less information on the applicants' physical condition and psychological
makeup than they had for military applicants, and the choices were consequently
harder to make. 43The Space Science Board, however, was evidently determined
to pick only the most promising scientists. Shoemaker later recalled that the com-
mittee had been disappointed in the overall quality of the applications that came
in. Not many of the scientists who applied came up to the rather high standards
they set. 44 Whatever the reasons for this, NASA was able to pick only 6 scientist-
astronauts instead of 10 or more, as it had initially planned.
On June 27, 1965, NASA announced the names of its first scientist-astronaut
candidates: two physicians, Duane M. Graveline and Lt. Cmdr. Joseph P. Ker-
win, MC, USN, and four Ph.D. scientists, F. Curtis Michel, Edward G. Gibson,
Owen K. Garriott, and Harrison H. Schmitt (who was generally known by his
nickname, "Jack"). 4s Kerwin was a flight surgeon stationed at Cecil Naval Air
Station in Florida; Graveline, a former Air Force flight surgeon, was working in
the medical program at MSC. Gibson, a senior research scientist at the Applied
Research Laboratories of Philco's Aeronutronics Division in San Diego, Califor-
nia, and Garriott, associate professor of physics at Stanford University, were both
engineers engaged in research in solar and atmospheric physics. Michel was an
The first class of scientist-astronauts (1965). Left to right: Owen K. Garriott, Frank Curtis Michel,
Harrison H. (Jack) Schmitt, Duane E. Graveling Edward G. Gibson, and Joseph P. Kerwin.
ORIG!NAU PAGE 66
8! JSCK A,r,,',D WHITE PIHOTOQRAPH
i
Selecting and Training the Crews
From 1964 through 1966 George Mueller, chief of manned space flight programs,
worked hard to sell an ambitious post-Apollo program to his NASA superiors
and to Congress. His Apollo Applications Program (AAP), established in August
1965, contemplated 29 lunar and earth-orbital missions between 1968 and 1971.
Two-thirds of them would be manned flights, launched at the rate of eight per
year. A manned program of that magnitude seemed to have little chance of becom-
ing reality, but until circumstances forced him to back down from it, Mueller kept
the pressure on the field centers to plan for big things. 48
At Houston, Bob Gilruth and Deke Slayton--whatever their own views about
the probability that such an ambitious schedule could be realized--had to be pre-
pared to furnish crews for whatever emerged as the Apollo Applications Program.
If the projected AAP missions should actually materialize, many crews would
be needed in short order and training had to begin soon. While the recruitment
of scientist-astronauts was under way, Gilruth and Slayton urged that additional
pilot candidates be sought at the same time, but Mueller decided to wait until
the scientist-astronauts had been chosen. ° When only six trainees emerged from
that selection process, he agreed to go ahead. On September 10, 1965, Headquar-
ters announced it would accept applications for a new class of pilot-astronauts.
Qualifications would be the same as they had been for the third group: a bachelor's
degree in science or engineering plus 1,000 hours of jet flying time or qualifica-
tion as a test pilot. 5°
The announcement yielded 351 applicants--the largest number of pilots ever
to apply--of whom 159 met the basic requirements. Final screening during the
next four months produced the fifth class of astronaut candidates in April 1966:
19 pilots, 4 civilians and 15 military officers (see Appendix 6). Eleven of the fifth
group held advanced degrees, two of them doctorates, sl
67
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
The fifth group of astronauts, selected in 1967. Seated, left to right: Edward G. Givens, Jr., Edgar
D. Mitchell, Charles M. Duke, Jr., Don L. Lind, Fred W. Haise, Jr., Joe H. Engle, Vance D.
Brand, John S. Bull, and Bruce McCandless II. Standing, left to right: John L. Swigert, Jr., William
R. Pogue, Ronald E. Evans, Paul J. Weitz, James B. Irwin, Gerald P. Carr, Stuart A. Roosa,
Alfred M. Worden, Thomas K. Mattingly II, and Jack R. Lousma.
*Threeastronaut trainees had been killed in flying accidents in the previous two years. Ted Freeman's
T-38 hit a goose near MSC on Oct. 31, 1964, causing both engines to flame out; he ejected but was
too low for his parachute to open. Elliott See and Charles Bassett, prime crew for Gemini IX, crashed
on Feb. 28, 1966, after missing a landing approach at St. Louis Municipal Airport under marginal
weather conditions.
ORIGINAL PAGE
68 BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Selecting and Training the Crews
made in about six months.S2 By the time they came aboard, however, post-Apollo
manned space flight programs were in a precarious position and the future looked
much less bright (see Chapter 7). The chances seemed good that any scientist
who went to the moon would be one of the first five already in the program.
During 1965 and 1966 the Manned Spacecraft Center was busier than it had
ever been. Gemini flights were being launched from Cape Canaveral every other
month, on average. The Apollo command and service module was progressing,
not without difficulty, toward its first earth-orbital flight test. Mission planners
were hard at work on lunar-mission trajectories and contingency planning. Others
were studying photographs of the lunar surface from Ranger and Surveyor, look-
ing for suitable landing sites and scrutinizing the barren surface for possible unwel-
come surprises. Still to come were the extensive and detailed photographs from
Lunar Orbiter.
The Astronaut Office was as busy as the rest of the Center. All of the remain-
ing "Original Seven," plus the "Next Nine" and 10 of "The Fourteen" (third
group) were training for and flying the Gemini missions. By the end of 1966 crews
for the first four Apollo earth-orbital missions had been assigned and were' spend-
ing much of their time in design reviews and flight simulations. Russell Schweick-
art, one of the two scientists picked as a pilot, was serving as a kind of
ombudsman, mediating between the astronaut office and the experimenters who
had projects on Gemini. 53 His compatriot Walter Cunningham was sent to the
Falmouth conference in mid-1965 to explain to scientists some of the operational
factors that so strongly constrained a lunar landing mission. 54 Two of the first
five scientist-astronauts, Joe Kerwin and Curt Michel, did not start basic astronaut
training during their first year, and so were assigned to represent the Astronaut
Office in matters concerning space suits and Apollo Applications experiments,
respectively. The other three, Owen Garriott, Ed Gibson, and Jack Schmitt, drew
assignments to Apollo in-flight experiments when they returned from flight train-
ing in mid-year, as did Don Lind, the scientist who came in as a pilot with the
fourth group. 5s Before long, however, Schmitt was working with academic and
Geological Survey scientists to improve MSC's training course in field geology.S6
Schmitt was fortunate in having a scientific specialty that was widely accepted
as being important to Apollo. The other scientist-astronauts--except for Kerwin,
whose medical training could be applied to a number of space-related questions--
found themselves in an environment oriented almost exclusively to operational
and engineering concerns. Independent research was all but impossible; only Curt
Michel--whose academic home base was Rice University, less than an hour's drive
from MSC--made an attempt to sustain his previous research program. Owen
Garriott and Ed Gibson had to redirect their scientific interests into fields more
closely related to NASA's needs and plans, s7
Apart from the time they had to devote to mastering astronautic skills, the scien-
tists had to spend long hours on chores that sometimes seemed distinctly sub-
sidiary to the main objectives. Among the duties of the Astronaut Office were
69
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
The second class of scientists-astronauts, picked in 1967. Seated, left to right: Philip K. Chapman,
Robert A. R. Parker, William E. Thornton, and John A. LIeweIlyn. Standing, left to right: Joseph
P. Allen, Karl G. Henize, Anthony W. England, Donald L. HoImquest, Story Musgrave, William
B. Lenoir, and Brian T. O'Leary.
ORIGINAL PAGE
7O
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Selecting and Training the Crews
scientific proficiency shall be a prime requisite for at least one member of each
flight crew." Anything that seemed to increase their chances of flight assignment
was of vital interest to every person in the corps, the group had learned. (If Slay-
ton wanted someone on a crew who could speak Mandarin Chinese, one of the
astronauts told the study group, they would all be studying Mandarin Chinese.)
Therefore, if MSC made it clear that scientific proficiency was desirable for crew
selection, even the pilot-astronauts could develop a passion for science. 61
Perhaps the most difficult recommendation to implement was that the scientist-
astronauts be encouraged to keep up their research activity by affiliating with
an established research group. "The minimum amount of time required to main-
tain scientific proficiency," the group concluded, "is believed to be one day per
week for discussions, seminars, etc.," plus "one full week each month in which
the scientist-astronaut can become completely immersed in his research." The
group could not suggest how this could be squeezed into an already tight train-
ing schedule, but they noted that astronauts spent considerable time at seem-
ingly trivial tasks in engineering design that might be relegated to others.
Paradoxically, however, these time-consuming chores seemed an indispensable
part of the program, since the astronauts were the only competent group having
an overview of the whole operation, and were "the only single group that another
astronaut will trust. "'62
Stressing as it did the importance of research to a scientist, the study group's
report could have been read as calling for a division of the corps into a test-pilot
group and a scientist group. The scientist-astronauts' need to spend more than
one-third of their time in research was received with some skepticism by the pilots,
whose reaction was later summarized by one of them:
The issue did not become divisive because the scientist-astronauts themselves
accurately perceived the situation they were in and most of them did not try to
make the system fit their unique needs. They saw the utility of the maxim, "if
you want to get along, go along."
The study group's report was received politely but coolly at MSC.64 If Mercury
and Gemini had shown anything, it was that the unexpected may turn out to
be the norm, and no one knew how well a scientist, however skilled and intelli-
gent, would react to sudden operational emergencies. On the other hand,
appropriate reaction to such situations was believed to be almost instinctive to
a good test pilot. Slayton and Gilruth, pondering the problem of landing an exotic
spacecraft on a strange and possibly dangerous surface, naturally adopted the
view that piloting skills were essential to mission success. Slayton repeatedly
expressed this view in plain language: nobody would benefit from a mission that
left a dead geologist (and his colleague in the lunar module) on the moon 6s
--implying that just such a thing might happen if the pilot of the lunar landing
module could not cope quickly enough with a sudden emergency. So it was up
to the scientists to prove that they could become competent astronauts, which
71
WhereNoManHasGone Before
most of them did. None would ever command an Apollo mission; none would
ever pilot a lunar module to a moon landing or a command module through reen-
try; but they showed themselves able to tackle the training program and willing
to share the less pleasant but essential duties of an astronaut. Of the first six scien-
tists picked as astronauts, four eventually flew in space. Many of the others filled
essential roles in science planning and mission operations during the later Apollo
missions.
72
6
Picking a spot where a lunar module could land was a complex exercise requir-
ing tradeoffs among dozens of factors. Predominant among these were the topog-
raphy and texture of the lunar surface and the requirements of the lunar module's
guidance and navigation system. Other restrictions included the elevation of the
sun at the landing site; the temperature of the lunar surface; the radiation environ-
ment in space and on the moon; and the earth lighting conditions desired for
launch and recovery. _
The most restrictive mission rule, so far as landing sites for the earliest lunar
landing missions were concerned, was the requirement to place the spacecraft
73
Where No Man Has Gone Before
on a "free-return" trajectory--a flight path that allowed for failure of the service
module's main engine. If the service module engine should fail to put the space-
craft into lunar orbit, the joined CSM and LM would loop around the moon under
the influence of lunar gravity alone and head back to earth. This free-return trajec-
tory required the spacecraft to leave earth orbit on a path that would bring it to
the moon within five degrees of latitude of the lunar equator. As early as mid-1963
MSC's Space Environment Division selected four sites from a list compiled by var-
ious lunar scientists, balancing scientific interest against this mission rule. A few
months later five more sites were picked for preliminary trajectory studies. 4
The choice of lunar longitude for a landing site depended mainly on two con-
siderations. To land at a predetermined site it was essential to determine the posi-
tion and the flight path of the lunar landing craft as accurately as possible before
beginning the final descent to the surface. Navigational sightings taken from the
spacecraft on stars or on lunar surface landmarks provided the data from which
ground-based computers determined the spacecraft's orbit and calculated the
necessary course corrections. Accurate calculation of the orbit required the
astronauts to take sightings on five prominent lunar landmarks some distance
east of the landing site, and since the spacecraft went behind the moon on the
west and was out of radio and radar contact with earth until it emerged around
the eastern edge, those sightings could only be taken after earth contact was
reestablished. The position of the navigational landmarks had to be known with
an error of no more than 1,500 feet (450 meters). In mid-1963 this was not possi-
ble; at the eastern and western edges of the visible face, surface features might
actually be as much as 6,000 feet (1,800 meters) from where the best lunar maps
showed them. In light of these navigation requirements, early planning assumed
that a landing could be plotted no farther east than 40 degrees east longitude.
The "Apollo landing zone" thus defined extended to 40 degrees west longitude;
other operational considerations made a more westerly landing undesirable. 5
The second limitation on the longitude of the landing site was the elevation
of the sun at the time of landing, which was the major factor considered in choos-
ing the time of launch. To the pilot looking for a safe spot to land within the time
the lunar module could hover, it was vital that the sun be high enough in the
lunar sky to highlight the surface topography without casting long, confusing
shadows, but not so high that all surface detail was washed out. After landing,
the lunar explorers would also be hindered by a low or high sun. The moon has
no atmosphere to scatter light and therefore shadows are completely black; at
either low or high sun angles, visual observations can be difficult. Furthermore,
solar heating of the lunar surface varies with sun angle, complicating the prob-
lem of protecting the astronauts and the spacecraft against extreme temperatures.
Conditions would be best when the sun was 15 to 45 degrees above the horizon.
Mission planners could choose a launch time so that the lunar module would
land at a time when solar illumination was near optimum. Launch time was sub-
ject to the further constraint, however, that lunar missions had to leave the launch
pad well before last light in case an aborted launch required emergency recovery
operations. 6
Two potential hazards to the lunar mission were more difficult to take into
account: meteoroids and radiation. In 1963 no one knew how dangerous
meteoroids were. It seemed prudent to avoid the predictable (and dense) swarms
74
-T
U|
i
i
Mission and Science Planning: 1963-1966
that recur annually, but the earth-moon system constantly encounters a smaller
number of randomly distributed meteoroids. The last three test flights of the
Saturn I launch vehicle carried meteoroid-detecting satellites into earth orbit to
determine how serious this hazard might be. Radiation (subatomic particles,
x-rays, and gamma rays) was more worrisome. Of special concern were the high-
energy protons shot out from the sun during major solar flares, which could sub-
ject astronauts on the lunar surface to lethal doses of radiation. 7 Solar flares were
more troublesome because they are completely unpredictable. Protection was
extremely difficult and warning all but impossible: by the time a flare could be
detected on earth and its magnitude assessed, the most energetic (and danger-
ous) particles would already have reached the moon.
Within the zone defined by all these constraints--roughly 185 miles (300 kilo-
meters) wide, stretching 1,500 miles (2,400 kilometers) along the moon's equator--
geologic factors would determine the choice of a landing site. Surface topogra-
phy could not be known in any detail until Ranger and Surveyor provided infor-
mation; but from lunar maps available in 1963, several landing areas* about 400
square miles (900 square kilometers) in size could be picked out where slopes
apparently were not too great and craters not too numerous. Balancing the need
to pick landing areas near the center of the moon (where lunar maps were most
accurate) against the requirement to spread the areas as far as possible along the
equator (which allowed maximum flexibility in launch dates), MSC's Space
Environment Division found 10 landing areas that seemed promising enough to
warrant reconnoitering by unmanned spacecraft and close scrutiny by mission
planners. The areas were spotted in a zone extending from the southeastern edge
of Mare Tranquillitafis (not far from where Apollo 11 would eventually land) to
a point northeast of Flamsteed crater in Oceanus ProceUarum (some 375 miles
[600 kilometers] west of Apollo 12"s touchdown point). Even among these, how-
ever, none was completely satisfactory with respect to all the known constraints. 8
The effect of all these restrictions on the landing site was to reduce drastically
the number of consecutive days per month on which a lunar mission could be
launched. Considering only the two most important factors--sun angle and sur-
face temperature--a given site could be reached only if the spacecraft were
launched during a 2.3-day period each month. Experience to 1963 indicated that
launch operations stood a good chance of being interrupted and launches post-
poned because of systems problems, and no one was willing to count on launch-
ing an Apollo mission within 2.3 days. But if flight planners could be prepared
to land at more than one site for each launch--changing to a more westerly tar-
get if launch delays prevented reaching the first site--the number of consecutive
days on which a launch was possible could be substantially increased. A Bell-
comm study in early 1964 pointed out that choosing multiple sites for each launch
would make the program considerably more flexible, though it would require
certifying more sites through the Surveyor and Lunar Orbiter programs. That,
however, might cost no more than postponing a few launches by a month each. 9
*A landing area was a fairly large segment of the lunar surface which appeared sufficiently level
and smooth to permit landing; a landing site was an ellipse a few hundred meters in size within which
the lunar module would actually touch down. A site would be picked for exact targeting after the
hazards of the landing area had been assessed.
75
Where No Man Has Gone Before
The greatest uncertainty in the program at that time, pointed up by all these
early studies, was the physical nature of the moon's surface. Astronomers held
widely different views of what a lunar module would encounter when it touched
down. Gerald Kuiper of the University of Arizona, one of the principal investi-
gators in the Ranger project, was convinced that the surface was firm, though
it might be unconsolidated and might be covered by a thin layer of dust. Cornell
University astronomer Thomas Gold asserted, however, that the apparently
smooth areas on the moon were likely to be covered with a layer of fine dust
several meters thick, raising the prospect that the lunar module might sink out
of sight with only a short-lived dust cloud to mark its disappearance. TM There was
the further possibility that the surface might be so cluttered with boulders and
pitted with small craters that the lander would find no level spot large enough
to land--or if it tried to land, would turn over or come to rest tilted at an angle
that made return to orbit difficult.
NASA had been hoping that Ranger's television photographs would shed light
on these questions, but by the end of 1963 Ranger had experienced its fifth fail-
ure in as many attempts and was undergoing a critical reappraisal (see Chapter
2). 11 Spacecraft engineers at Houston's Manned Spacecraft Center, meanwhile,
in spite of their real need for this information in designing the lunar landing mod-
ule, had to go ahead without it. 12 Lunar Orbiter, still in the early stages, would
have to provide the information that mission planners needed for site selection.
The spacecraft builders could only hope that data from Surveyor, when they got
it, would not force them to revise their design too drastically.
76
MissionandSciencePlanning:1963-1966
Throughout 1965, site selection was one of Apollo's biggest concerns. Early in
the year the ill-starred Ranger project flew its second consecutive successful mis-
sion (in seven tries). Its photographs had enabled the Manned Spacecraft Center
to draw some generally encouraging conclusions about lunar topography, but
MSC's Space Environment Division concluded that Ranger photographs would
never enable them to certify lunar landing sites. They would, perhaps, allow
Apollo planners to rule out unsuitable areas, but picking a suitable landing site
by eliminating the unsuitable ones could take years. 16 Besides, Ranger provided
no information about the physical characteristics of the surface, which designers
of the lunar landing craft needed. _7 Surveyor was expected to soft-land on the
moon within a few months, and MSC was offering advice to Surveyor mission
planners at the Jet Propulsion Laboratory as to where the missions should land
to be of maximum use to Apollo. The Houston center was also working closely
with Langley's Lunar Orbiter program office in planning for optimum use of its
high-resolution cameras to locate sites for the lunar landing mission.
In efforts to satisfy the sometimes conflicting aims of lunar science and Apollo,
the Ranger project had been subjected to a great deal of pulling and hauling (see
Chapter 2). The result was that neither side was completely satisfied, and the
lunar scientists were particularly upset when Apollo preempted their experiments.
Intending to forestall similar problems with Surveyor and Lunar Orbiter, Homer
Newell established an ad hoc Surveyor/Orbiter Utilization Committee in the spring
of 1965, after the last Ranger mission (Ranger 9) successfully concluded that proj-
ect. Newell appointed his deputy, Edgar M. Cortright, chairman of the commit-
tee, whose other members were chosen from Headquarters and center project
offices.*_a
*Other members were: Everett E. Christensen, mission operations dir., OMSF; Victor C. Clarke,
Surveyor project office, JPL; Willis B. Foster, dir., Manned Space Science Div., OSSA; William A.
Lee, asst. mgr., Apollo spacecraft program office, MSC; Urner Liddell, chron., Planetology Subcom-
mittee of the Space Sciences Steering Committee, OSSA; Benjamin Milwitzky, Surveyor project dir.,
77
Where No Man Has Gone Before
OSSA; Oran W. Nicks, lunar and planetary programs dir., OSSA; Samuel C. Phillips, Apollo pro-
gram dir., OMSF; Lee R. Scherer, Lunar Orbiter project dir., OSSA; and William E. Stoney, Space
Environment Div., MSC; and Israel Taback, Lunar Orbiter project office, Langley Research Center.
*Other members were: Cortright, Lee, Stoney, and Christensen, all members of the Surveyor/Orbiter
Utilization Committee; Ernst Stuhlinger, Research Projects Office dir., MSFC; and John P. Claybourne,
Future Studies Office, Design Engineering Branch, KSC.
78
Mission and Science Planning: 1963-1966
Lunar Orbiter project officials set about making detailed plans for the first
mission that would satisfy Apollo's requirements. Surveyor managers, however,
were reluctant to comply with the committee's recommendations. They pointed
out that the ground rules required landing at a less-suitable site even though a
better one was available--a significant threat to mission success, JPL believed.
They would target the first Surveyor in compliance with the committee's ground
rules, but if the spacecraft had any trouble at an inferior site, JPL intended to
recommend strongly that the next mission be sent to a better one32
America's first unmanned lunar explorer,* Surveyor I, launched on May 30, 1966,
landed 63 hours later approximately 90 kilometers north of the crater Flamsteed
in Oceanus Procellarum, at the extreme western fringe of the Apollo landing
zone33 Its first television pictures were encouraging to Apollo engineers: the sur-
face was firm enough to support a lunar landing module and the surrounding
area was reasonably level. But beyond the immediate landing area the TV images
showed more than a few large boulders and craters. The pictures served to demol-
ish some hypotheses about the lunar surface, notably Gold's idea that the maria
were covered with deep layers of dust. The surface was composed of fine parti-
cles, firmly packed and cohesive. 24
Less than three months later, on August 10, Lunar Orbiter I roared off the pad
at Cape Canaveral; four days later the spacecraft was in orbit around the moon,
and by the end of the month it had photographed all nine of its assigned sites
in the Apollo landing zone. After completing its photography, Orbiter remained
in orbit, transmitting electronic data on gravity, meteoroids, and radiation around
the moon--another aspect of its service to Apollo and to lunar science. 2s
Malfunctions of the spacecraft and photographic system resulted in fewer good
photographs than project officials would have liked; but preliminary photographic
analysis began in late August and produced recommendations for the second Sur-
veyor and Lunar Orbiter missions by the end of September. On the basis of cra-
ter density and regional slopes, 10 of 23 areas selected for detailed study seemed
satisfactory; 8 potential sites were recommended for detailed analysis. 26 On Sep-
tember 29 the Surveyor/Orbiter Utilization Committee reviewed these results and
outlined the requirements for the second Orbiter mission.** Again Apollo sites
were stressed, particularly those types of terrain shown by Orbiter I to be the most
promising--landing areas smooth enough to land on, having little enough slope
in the approach path to avoid confusing the lunar module's landing radar sys-
tem. Lighting conditions for photography would be chosen so that slopes of 7
degrees, and surface protuberances 6 feet (2 meters) in diameter and 1.5 feet (0.5
meter) high, could be detected in an area 20 feet (7 meters) square. 27
Lunar Orbiter II, modified to correct the problems encountered by its predeces-
sor, was launched November 6, 1966, and its results far surpassed those of the
*But not the world's first; on Feb. 3, 1966, the Soviet Union, apparently intent on establishing space
"firsts," had logged another by landing Luna IX on the moon several hundred kilometers northwest
of Surveyor/'s landing site. Similarly the Russian Luna X became the first moon-orbiting satellite on
Apr. 3, 1966, four months before the U.S.'s Lunar Orh'ter I. Luna X did not relay photographs to earth,
however.
**A small thruster failed on Surveyor II (launched on Sept. 20, 1966) after its midcourse correction
maneuver, causing the spacecraft to spin at one revolution per second. All attempts to correct the
malfunction failed and the lander crashed 250-300 km southeast of crater Copernicus.
79
WhereNo ManHasGone Before
first mission. All of the 30 preplanned sites were photographed at medium and
high resolution, giving geologists and cartographers excellent material with which
to work. .28 The mapmakers believed that with more stereo photographs of the
quality returned by Lunar Orbiter II they could produce terrain maps with two-
to three-meter contours. MSC's Apollo project office representatives were pleased
with the second mission's results and believed that one more flight would satisfy
their requirements for the first one or two lunar landings. Apart from some addi-
tional site photography, Apollo wanted one or more Orbiter spacecraft to stay
in lunar orbit long enough to allow precision tracking by earth-based radar. All
navigational calculations for the lunar module were to be made by ground-based
computers using data from the Manned Space Flight Network, Apollo's commu-
nication and tracking system, and early certification of this _system was essential. 29
In mid-December 1966 the Apollo Site Selection Board met to review the status
of site selection. In general the process was going well. Geologic interpretation
of the Orbiter photographs had already yielded some general conclusions about
the nature of the lunar surface and where the best landing sites were likely to
be found. Cartographers could not accurately determine slopes in the landing
area without steroscopic photography, but MSC gave higher priority to finding
a landing site with a minimum of rocks and craters; the slope of the terrain lead-
ing to a suitable site could be evaluated some other way. No serious problems
in site selection were apparent, and the board could only await the results of Lunar
Orbiter III and more detailed analysis of the available data. 3°
As 1967 began Apollo planners did not want much more from the unmanned
lunar investigation projects. They would use whatever additional data became
available, but priorities were changing. Three more Lunar Orbiters and four
Surveyors would be sent to the moon during the next 13 months, but after the
third orbiter they would do more for lunar science generally than for Apollo
specifically. 31
MSC's original specifications for the lunar landing module included a general-
ized "scientific instrumentation system'" to provide for selenological research.
Specific experiments could not be listed in 1962, but investigations of the lunar
atmosphere, surface, and interior were contemplated. The contractor would
include weight, volume, and power allowances for the instruments in the mod-
ule design; specific instruments would be defined later. 32
After the lunar module contractor, Grumman Aircraft Engineering Corpora-
tion, was selected in later 1962, MSC forged ahead with spacecraft design. Defi-
nition of the lunar surface experiments, which was the responsibility of the Office
of Space Sciences and Applications, proceeded at a much more deliberate pace,
*A famous by-product of the Lunar Orbiter II mission resulted from the need to advance film peri-
odically even if no picture was taken. To avoid wasting that film, mission controllers were given a limited
choice of targets for these exposures. One was used to take an oblique picture of crater Copernicus
under almost ideal lighting conditions, showing hitherto invisible surface details. News media called
this "one of the greatest pictures of the century."
8O
!
ORIGINAL PAGE
BLACK AND Mi/HITE PHOTOGRAPH Mission and Science Planning: 1963-1966
Surveyor III bounced twice before finally landing, as this Apollo 12 photograph of its landing pad
shows. Imprints were as clear as they were when the unmanned spacecraft landed three years before.
The surface sampler, partially visible at upper left, was controlled from Earth. It scooped out several
trenches, seen just beyond the landing pad, and deposited a scoopful of lunar soil on the landing pad.
however (see Chapter 3). In early 1963 Houston expected that the first experi-
ments would be selected by the end of the year; 33 but months went by with little
progress. By September, spacecraft engineers urgently needed data on the
experiments--weight, volume, and power requirements--to feed into lunar mod-
ule design, but since nothing was available, MSC awarded a 10-month study con-
tract to Texas Instruments to investigate instrumentation requirements for manned
lunar exploration. 34 Headquarters was somewhat unhappy with this unilateral
action, but lunar module designers had to have the information and the scien-
tific community seemed to be in no hurry to supply it. 35 The study provided an
indication of the type of instrumentation likely to be useful, and in the next few
months the spacecraft office worked out preliminary weight and volume allot-
ments for the experiments: 250 pounds (113 kilograms) and 15 cubic feet (0.42
cubic meters) in the descent stage, which would be left on the moon; 80 pounds
(36 kilograms) and 3 cubic feet (0.085 cubic meters) in the ascent stage and in
the command module for a sample-return container and film. Requirements for
81
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
Technicians prepare a test version of the Apollo command and service module in the space environ-
men t simulation chamber at MSC. The lights mounted at left simulate solar irradiation. The chamber
walls can be cooled by liquid nitrogen to -193° C, simulating the radiation-absorbing void of space.
After the huge door is closed, the entire chamber, 55feet in diameter and 90feet high, can be pumped
down to less than one ten-millionth of atmospheric pressure.
82 ORIGINAL PAGE
BI._GK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
ORtGfNAL-PAGE
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH Mission and Science Planning: 1963-1966
the internal structure of the moon; an instrument to measure heat flow from the
moon's interior; radiation and meteoroid detectors; and a lunar atmospheric
analyzer. A 70-watt power module converted heat from a radioisotope fuel cap-
sule into electricity by means of thermocouples. The instruments, their power
supply, and their data-transmitting equipment were limited to 150 pounds (68
kilograms) and 12 cubic feet (0.34 cubic meters) and were to be housed in the
lunar module's descent stage. The specifications called for three units which could
function on the moon at the same time without interfering with each other. 39 The
program directive assigning management responsibility to MSC specified three
packages, one to be flown on each of the first three lunar landing missions, plus
a flight-qualified spare. The first was to be delivered by July 1, 1967. 40
Newell's office, meanwhile, had been evaluating proposals for the lunar sur-
face experiments, and on October 1 transmitted authority to Houston to begin
negotiations with principal investigators for the lunar gravimeter and the active
seismic experiment. '1 A third experiment, investigation of the lunar magnetic field,
was tentatively approved on December 15. 42 The science complement for the first
Two lunar surface experiments, the superthermal ion detector (standing on tripod) and the cold-
cathode ion gauge (attached by cable, left), measured components of the moon's extremely tenuous
atmosphere.
83
WhereNo ManHasGoneBefore
The "Swiss flag" (solar-wind collector) stands on the lunar surface outside the spacecraft Antares.
The aluminum foil collector trapped particles from the solar wind, which were then identified in the
laboratory of Dr. Johannes Geiss of the University of Berne, Switzerland. One of the simplest of
experiments, it was carried on all missions except Apollo 17. Note the almost feature-less lunar land-
scape at the Fra Mauro landing site.
*Passive lunar seismic experiment, Dr. Frank Press (M1T) and Dr. George Sutton (Lamont Geologi-
cal Observatory); lunar triaxis magnetometer, Dr. C. P. Sonett (NASA Ames Research Center) and
Jerry Modisette (MSC); medium energy solar wind experiment, Dr. C. W. Snyder and Dr. M. N.
Neugebauer 0PL); suprathermal ion detector, Dr. J. W. Freeman, Jr. (Rice Univ.) and Dr. F. Curtis
Michel (MSC scientist-astronaut); lunar heat flow measurements, Dr. Marcus G. Langseth (Lamont
Observatory) and Dr. Sydney Clark (Yale); low-energy solar wind, Dr. Brian J. O'Brien (Rice); and
active lunar seismic experiment, Dr. Robert L. Kovach (Stanford Univ.) and Dr. Joel S. Watkins 0dSGS).
84 ORIGINAL PAGE
:i
1
, i
Mission and Science Planning: 1963-1966
Mercury project engineers at MSC had reluctantly allowed a few scientific exer-
cises to ride their spacecraft, but this patched-on effort was of small importance.
To pave the way for worthwhile experiments in manned space flight, Homer
Newell persisted in urging scientists to devise experiments that would take advan-
tage of man's presence. By the time Gemini was fully operational in early 1965
a fair number of scientific exercises had been proposed and accepted for flight. 47
After Mercury, the Manned Spacecraft Center established an Experiments Coor-
dinating Office to ensure that science plans were compatible with the spacecraft
and the operational constraints of the mission. _ Within the Gemini Program Office
a Gemini Experiments Office supervised the science exercises undertaken in
Gemini.
As the Apollo science program evolved in 1964-65, the horizon of manned space
science expanded to include lunar surface experiments as well as in-flight (earth-
and lunar-orbital) science. In view of its new responsibility to oversee the develop-
ment and integration of the Apollo experiments as well as integrating the Gemini
science, the Houston center decided to centralize the management of all manned
space flight experiments in a single office. In June 1965 MSC Director Robert R.
Gilruth appointed Robert O. Piland to head a new Experiments Program Office
within the Engineering and Development Directorate. ° Piland, formerly a research
scientist at Langley, had served briefly on the staff of James R. Killian, President
Eisenhower's science advisor, before joining the Manned Spacecraft Center in
85
Where No Man Has Gone Before
1959. After contributing to the early planning and study efforts that led to the
Apollo spacecraft program, he was appointed deputy manager of MSC's Apollo
Spacecraft Program Office in 1962. His new office absorbed the staff and func-
tions of both the Gemini Experiments Office and the Experiments Coordination
Office and immediately took over work on the ALSEP contracts.
Piland's job was to keep track of the complex requirements of the Apollo space-
craft and mission plans and see that the experimenters understood those require-
ments and adhered to them. His responsibilities extended from the conception
of the experiment to the management and distribution of data. The Experiments
Program Office worked with spacecraft engineers, flight planners, scientific inves-
tigators, and contractors in developing, testing, and integrating the experiments
into the missions, s°
The in-flight experiments were an important part of Apollo lunar science, but
MSC's involvement with science was growing in other phases of the program
as well. During 1965 the Houston center was developing the concept of the lunar
receiving laboratory, which went into NASA's budget proposal for fiscal 1966
(see Chapter 4). When Apollo began to return samples of lunar material to the
earth, MSC's relations with the outside scientific community would expand con-
siderably. Those samples were of incalculable scientific value, and scientists would
assuredly demand a say in how they were handled from the time they were col-
lected on the moon to the time they were parceled out to investigators. Apollo
was about to create a relationship between MSC and the scientific world that was
new to both groups and would require careful handling.
There is not much room for doubt that MSC considered itself perfectly compe-
tent to manage the lunar samples with minimal help from the outside; the science
community could simply lay out its requirements and MSC, if it concurred, would
do the rest. Scientists, however, would never agree to stand in line at MSC's
dispensing window to receive their designated allotments of lunar material. The
deliberations of the various advisory groups and ad hoc committees convened
to define the lunar receiving laboratory make it plain that scientists saw the proper
staffing of the LRL as one of the most important questions of the entire project.
At the very least they would insist that a scientist of considerable repute be
appointed to head the laboratory and take charge of the sample analysis program,
with the advice and consent of the scientific community.
Besides the anticipated lunar science program, MSC had to recognize George
Mueller's increasing interest in a science-oriented post-Apollo program. Having
established an Apollo Applications Program (AAP) office in August 1965, Mueller
went to Congress the following spring to seek funding for it. 51 If he should get
what he was asking for, AAP would bring science to the forefront of manned
space flight; although MSC lacked the staff to support it (concurrently with its
Gemini and Apollo commitments) at the time, science clearly had to have a place
in Houston--otherwise MSC might find itself playing a support role to some other
center. At the end of March Faget announced the establishment of a Space Science
Office within his Engineering and Development Directorate, described as an
"interim arrangement pending development of a permanent scientific organiza-
tion." For this purpose MSC regrouped a number of scattered center activities
around Piland's Experiments Program Office and under his direction. While most
of those activities were conducted in support of manned space flight operations
86 _.
MissionandScience
Planning:1963-1966
and lunar exploration, the Space Science Office was also charged with develop-
ing, monitoring, and coordinating experiments for all manned space missions
involving science? 2
The following week Gilruth sent MSC's plan for a more extensive reorganiza-
tion to George Mueller. A new Space Medicine Directorate would consolidate
all center medical activities in a single organization. For science, a new Space
Science Division was to be established--not a science directorate on the same level
as Space Medicine or Engineering and Development, but an upgraded version
of the Space Science Office just established, still under Faget's jurisdiction. The
proposal more specifically included management of the lunar receiving labora-
tory, providing MSC's point of contact with the external scientific community,
and giving MSC scientists the opportunity to generate their own experiments.
Some 76 people from other offices would comprise the new division, and a scien-
tist would be recruited to head it as soon as possible. Agreeing with Newell's
view that the division should concentrate primarily on one scientific field, Gil-
ruth suggested that lunar and earth sciences would be its most appropriate dis-
ciplines, s3 For the next several months Headquarters and MSC discussed the
proposed reorganization and the question of a director for science at MSC. s4.
While those discussions were going on, Headquarters was working to clarify
agency-wide management responsibilities for future manned flight activities.
Apollo Applications, emerging as the most likely successor to Apollo, embraced
a much greater variety of scientific projects than Apollo and appeared to require
more interlocking of effort among the field centers (chiefly MSC and Marshall
Space Flight Center) as well as Headquarters program offices. Accordingly, on
July 26 Deputy Administrator Robert C. Seamans divided responsibility for
prospective programs among the various entities--in effect ratifying the arrange-
ment Homer Newell and George Mueller had been working under since 1963
(see Chapter 3). Mueller's Office of Manned Space Flight was to be responsible
for the conduct of Apollo and AAP missions, developing and funding the experi-
ments that were selected by Newell's Office of Space Science and Applications.
Seamans went one step further, assigning to each center primary responsibility
for specific areas: Marshall to develop the Apollo telescope mount (a major com-
ponent of Apollo Applications), Goddard to handle atmospheric science, meteorol-
ogy, and astronomical experiments, and MSC to manage the Apollo lunar surface
experiments package, lunar science, earth resources, and life-support systems.
Future assignments would depend on center capabilities and NASA's long-range
plans. 55
In November, "in response to the growing significance and responsibilities of
the Center in the area of science and applications," Houston informed Headquar-
ters that it proposed to create a Science and Applications Directorate, on the same
organizational level as those for Engineering and Development and Medical
Research and Operations. (At long last Homer Newell's view of the importance
of science at MSC prevailed.) It would subsume the functions of Space Science
Division and would collect all space- and lunar-science-related functions of the
center, along with the many people scattered throughout the center who were
then engaged in scientific work in support of Apollo. The directorate would be
responsible for planning and conducting all MSC programs in space science and
applications and would be the center's point of contact with the scientific world
87
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
By the time 1966 drew to a dose the Apollo spacecraft and Saturn launch vehicle
projects had been through some rough times. The lunar landing craft, under con-
tract to Grumman Aircraft Engineering Company of Bethpage, New York, was
slow to reach design maturity and Grumman had considerable difficulty with
the main propulsion engines, landing gear, and radar systems. Across the coun-
try in southern California, North American Aviation's Space & Information Divi-
sion had its own set of problems with the command and service module, s9
North American had other problems as well, notably with the S-II second stage
of the mammoth Saturn V launch vehicle. The S-II was similar to Saturn V's third
stage (the S-IVB) in that it used cryogenic propellants (liquid hydrogen and liq-
uid oxygen at extremely low temperatures), but it was much larger and presented
more difficult manufacturing problems. 60 Besides, North American lacked the
experience that the S-IVB stage contractor, Douglas Aircraft Company, could draw
on from its prior development of the smaller S-IV stage of Saturn I. In 1965 North
American's troubles in managing its two programs--especially the S-II--were the
most serious obstacle to achieving the end-of-the-decade goal for Apollo. During
1965 the company's handling of its Apollo and Saturn contracts drew extraordi-
nary attention from Headquarters and from Marshall Space Flight Center, cul-
minating in a top-to-bottom evaluation of NAA's program by teams of NASA
experts. In December Maj. Gen. Samuel C. Phillips, Apollo program manager
at Headquarters, sent a devastating critique of NAA's program management to
his bosses and to the company's executives. 61
The overall picture for manned space flight was not bleak, however. During
1965-66 the Gemini program had built a solid foundation for operations, sending
missions into earth orbit at an average of one every two months. Important ques-
tions about the human ability to function in zero gravity were settled. Rendezvous
was demonstrated in so many ways it seemed strange that anyone had ever
doubted it was feasible. Saturn and Apollo enjoyed some successes as well. Mar-
shall Space Flight Center proved out the Saturn I and IB launch vehicles--
important junior partners to Saturn V--and put up earth-orbiting satellites to dis-
pel worries about the hazard from micrometeoroids in space. By the end of 1965
all three stages of the Saturn V had been successfully (but separately) test-fired,
88
Mission and Science Planning: 1963-1966
and the Manned Spacecraft Center had proved that the Apollo launch escape
system worked, easing some concerns about aborts on the launch pad. 62
Since the status of science in the Apollo program had been nebulous in 1963,
the next three years saw substantial progress. Widespread debate over the goals
of manned space flight and the validity of the Apollo commitment during the
summer of 1963 had given the Office of Manned Space Flight the incentive to
accommodate science to some degree in its programs. The Office of Space Science
and Applications took the lead in creating an office to coordinate the efforts of
the two program offices. The major decisions concerning mission mode and space-
craft had been made when OMSF's new director, George Mueller, took over in
late 1963; he could therefore direct a good deal of his attention to other matters.
Mueller, unlike his predecessor, was not perceived as hostile to scientific investi-
gations in manned space flight, although it took some time for the scientists to
decide that he was basically supportive of their efforts. 63
Advice from the scientific community was brought to a clearer focus between
1962, when the Iowa summer study said little about manned lunar exploration,
and 1965, when the Woods Hole and Falmouth conferences defined the objec-
tives of lunar science in more specific terms. After the Woods Hole study posed
15 scientific questions about the moon that bounded Apollo science, study teams
defined the essential experimental measurements and the instruments with which
they would be made. Additional refinements to these preliminary definitions led
to specific studies for the lunar surface experiments package, which was put under
contract in 1966.
Houston's Manned Spacecraft Center was finally brought around to at least
an acceptance of science by the end of 1966. In the Gemini program it demon-
strated a willingness to incorporate scientific exercises into its operational mis-
sions and worked out a system for assessing the compatibility of experiments
with manned programs. Whether or not these exercises were scientifically impor-
tant, they brought the scientists and the flight planners together so that they might
better understand each other's problems. On its own initiative the Houston cen-
ter proposed and undertook to develop a laboratory in which to receive, catalog,
and conduct preliminary scientific examination of the returned lunar samples.
After getting its two spacecraft projects more or less in hand, MSC assumed
the responsibility for directing development of the lunar surface experiments and
then created a directorate in which (it might be hoped) the center could ulti-
mately develop its own science program. And finally it yielded to the clamor of
the scientific community in picking its first class of astronauts from the ranks of
promising young scientists. By the end of 1966, in fact, MSC was preparing to
select a second group.
On another front, MSC was cooperating with Headquarters in selecting the
sites where the lunar missions would land. MSC worked with the Apollo Site
Selection Board and Langley's Lunar Orbiter project, supplying its criteria for
landing sites and evaluating the information gleaned from Surveyor and Lunar
Orbiter. As 1966 ended, the list of candidate sites for the last Lunar Orbiter mis-
sions had been considerably narrowed.
At the beginning of 1967 those who wanted to see science become an integral
part of manned space flight could feel that some progress had been made in three
years. Spacecraft engineers and mission planners could feel that many of their
89
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
big problems were behind them. In spite of many problems with the command
module, the first manned earth-orbital mission was only weeks away from launch.
On August 26, 1966, spacecraft 012 arrived at Kennedy Space Center to begin
a first-article checkout that would last through the end of the year. 64
9O
7
Early in 1967 Project Apollo suffered its worst setback when all three members
of the first crew to fly in an Apollo spacecraft died in a fire. The tragedy forced
a reexamination of the project, especially NASA's supervision of its prime con-
tractors, and delayed the first lunar landing by some unknown length of time.
The fire had no direct effect on the lunar science program other than to pro-
vide vitally needed time to catch up to the launch schedule. The experiments pack-
age, the selection of landing sites, and the lunar-surface geology program all put
the time to good use.
On the afternoon of January 27, 1967, Virgil I. Grissom, Edward H. White II,
and Roger B. Chaffee, prime crew of Apollo mission AS-204,* were reclining in
spacecraft 012 atop their Saturn IB launch vehicle at Kennedy Space Center's
launch complex 34. Flight and launch crews were conducting a "plugs-out" simu-
lation to determine that the spacecraft would function properly on internal power.
The test had been frequently delayed by problems with communications and the
environmental-control system; these were exasperating but not abnormal and cer-
tainly not a portent of the day's climactic event. Just after 6:31 p.m. horrified
ground crews heard a cry of alarm over the communications circuits and saw a
bright glow through the spacecraft window. Seconds later the command module
ruptured, filling the "white room" at the end of the access arm on the service
structure with thick clouds of smoke. Technicians worked frantically to pry open
the hatch but were repeatedly driven back by the smoke and heat. By the time
they got the hatch open Grissom, White, and Chaffee were dead. A few minutes
later medical help arrived, only to find that nothing could be done.** Officials
quickly secured the launch pad and began the grim task of removing the bodies.
NASA Administrator ]ames Webb immediately appointed Floyd L. Thompson,
*Unofficially called "Apollo 1," the flight was more commonly referred to as "AS-204"--the fourth
flight of a Saturn IB vehicle (Saturn IB flights were numbered in the 200s, Saturn V missions in the
500s). When flights were resumed, mission numbers started with Apollo 4, for reasons that were
never completely clear.
**Postmortem examination disclosed that the crew had died of asphyxiation by toxic fumes produced
by incomplete combustion of the synthetic materials in the spacecraft. All had been burned, but not
severely enough to cause death.
91
Where No Man Has Gone Before
*Other members were astronaut Frank Borman, MSC; Maxime A. Paget, MSC; E. Barton Geer
Langley; Col. Charles E Strang, USAF; Robert W. Van Dolah, U.S. Bureau of Mines (replacing Franklin
A. Long of CorneU University, who had represented the President's Science Advisory Committee);
George C. White, Jr., NASA Headquarters; John J. Williams, Kennedy Space Center; and George T.
Malley, Langley, counsel. George W. Jeffs of North American Aviation was asked to serve as a
consultant.
**Grissom's Mercury capsule flooded and sank when its hatch accidentally blew off as he awaited
recovery from the second suborbital Mercury flight. On Mercury's second earth-orbital mission Scott
Carpenter overshot his landing area by nearly 300 kilometers, and for a while his fate was in ques-
tion. Gemini had produced two incidents: Gemini V/'s Titan vehicle shut down immediately after
ignition, leading to a few anxious minutes, and a malfunctioning thruster set the Gemini VIII space-
craft spinning wildly, requiring premature termination of the mission.
92
Setback
andRecovery:
1967
In early April the investigating board submitted its report concluding that the
precise point of origin of the fire could not be positively identified. Investigators
had found physical evidence of electric arcing from wires with damaged insula-
tion. Sometime during manufacture or testing, apparently, an unnoticed incidental
contact had scraped the insulation from a wire, thus providing the path for a
spark--exactly where, the investigators could not say, but the evidence pointed
to a spot near Grissom's couch where components of the environmental control
system had repeatedly been removed and replaced during testing. 6 The arc had
ignited flammable material and in the pure oxygen atmosphere* the resulting
fire had spread with astonishing rapidity.
Contributing to the disaster were an appalling number of factors that could only
be called oversights, to put the best possible face on it. The simulation had not
been considered hazardous because neither the launch vehicle nor the spacecraft
contained any fuel, nor were the Saturn's pyrotechnics installed; consequently
no emergency equipment or personnel were at the launch pad. Wiring carrying
electrical power was not properly protected against accidental impact. Far too
much flammable material--some 70 pounds (32 kilograms) of nylon netting, poly-
urethane foam, and Velcro fastening--had been haphazardly spread around the
command module, creating unobstructed paths for flames, No provision had been
made for the crew to get out of the spacecraft quickly in case of emergency. The
hatch could not be opened in less than 90 seconds. Neither the board's report
nor the congressional hearings that followed could explain why so many techni-
cal experts had failed to notice that spacecraft 012, as it sat on the launch pad
on January 27, was simply a bomb that needed only a trigger to set it off. Confi-
dent in Apollo's design approach, which emphasized eliminating the possibility
of ignition by electrical components, and unaware of the intensity and speed of
fires fed by pure oxygen, both NASA and contractor engineers had grossly
underestimated the consequences of a flaw in their hardware or procedures. Many
other problems had demanded attention throughout the fabrication of this proto-
type command module, and--perhaps lulled by success in past programs--
everyone had overlooked the hazards that were accumulating in the spacecraft.
In the months following NASA's investigation, responsibility for these condi-
tions was liberally distributed among contractors and NASA managers alike.
Charges of sloppy workmanship and poor quality control by the spacecraft
contractor--which NASA should have corrected--seemed justified. Critics asked
again whether the "end-of-the-decade" goal was, for no good reason, pushing
Apollo out of control and whether there really was a "space race" that justified
such haste. James Webb and George Mueller, who took most of the heat of Con-
gress's investigation, doggedly and successfully defended the program's objec-
tives as weIl as its schedule, aided by generally sympathetic congressional com-
mittees. 7
The Apollo project survived the fire shaken but undeterred. NASA continued
to aim for a lunar landing before 1970, but management (especially contractor
supervision) would be tightened, procedures (especially safety precautions) would
*During the simulation, as it would be at launch on a real mission, the command module atmosphere
was pure oxygen at 16.4 pounds per square inch (113 kilonewtons per square meter) pressure--10
percent above normal atmospheric pressure.
93
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
The Thompson board pointed out numerous deficiencies in the design of the
spacecraft and recommended changes in management and quality control
throughout the program. Even while the board was preparing its report NASA
was hard at work evaluating changes. Obviously the command and service mod-
ule needed the most attention, but the lunar module was equally rigorously
scrutinized, and no aspect of the Apollo program was spared detailed examina-
tion for hazards. 11
-How much the lunar landing would be set back no one knew.* Throughout
1966 the Office of Manned Space Flight had been working toward two unmanned
test flights of the Saturn V starting in 1967, to be followed by three manned flights
to check out the launch vehicle, both spacecraft, and the complex support
system for the lunar landing. NASA's public position was that "lunar flights,"
orbital or landing, would begin before the end of 1969. Planning schedules
showed several "simulated" lunar missions--which might orbit the moon but
not land--the first of which might be flown as early as October 1967 on AS-503
or as late as August 1968 on AS-506. The initial landing might be assigned to
AS-506, but the earliest mission unambiguously categorized in OMSF's master
schedules as a "lunar mission" and not a "simulation" was AS-507, scheduled
for November 1968.12
The fire wrecked that timetable, and for four months afterward all monthly
OMSF launch schedules were stamped "UNDER REVIEW." At the end of May
1967, a new master schedule showed only four Saturn V flights preceding the
first lunar landing: two unmanned, to check out the launch vehicle; one earth-
orbital flight to gain experience in simultaneous operation of the command and
service module and the lunar module; and one lunar mission simulation. The
Saturn V flights were interspersed among eight Saturn IB missions; as many of
these would be flown as necessary to discover and correct flaws in the spacecraft
and operations. The May schedule still showed the first landing in the last quar-
ter of 1968, but no one was authorized to mention any date more specific than
"before the end of 1968'" in public. 13
*Two years later Mueller told a congressional subcommittee that the fire had delayed the first manned
flight by 18 months, but in the interim progress was made in areas other than the command and
service module.
94
Setback and Recovery: 1967
In March 1966, when NASA contracted with the Bendix Corporation to build
the Apollo lunar surface experiments package (ALSEP), delivery of the first flight-
qualified set of instruments was scheduled for July 1967, seven months before
AS-504, the first Saturn V mission to which an experiment package was assigned. 14
It was an optimistic schedule, even though preliminary design work for several
of the experiments had already been funded by NASA grants9 s By late fall the
package was in schedule trouble. Two instruments were experiencing minor
difficulties, the central data-collecting station was in a critical state, and the mag-
netometer was having serious development problems. TM In late December 1966
Headquarters was considering shifting certain instruments from the second mis-
sion to the first on account of the lagging magnetometer. Scientists were particu-
larly anxious about this, because the data from the magnetometer were essential
to interpreting the results of two other experiments. Experimenters urged that
a search be started for a simpler magnetometer in case Ames's sophisticated instru-
ment could not be made ready in time. _7
Besides the experiments themselves, the radioisotope thermoelectric genera-
tor (RTG) required work. The RTG consisted of a large "fuel cask,'" packed with
plutonium-238, supplying heat to an array of thermocouples that produced elec-
tricity for the instruments. Project engineers were having difficulty assuring that
the radioactive fuel would not be dispersed into the atmosphere in case of an
abort during launch. TM At the critical design review the astronauts discovered
several hazards to the crew member who had to remove the hot (500 °C, 932 °F)
fuel capsule from its storage space in the LM and insert it into the thermocouple
assembly while setting up the instruments. Redesign of the package or revision
of procedures was necessary. _9
As the status of Apollo cleared in the months following the fire, a degree of
optimism returned to the experiments schedule. In July 1967 the first lunar
mission was AS-506, set for late November 1968, and the experiments for
the first four lunar missions were no longer lagging. 2° Even so, problems remained.
In late June 1967 Leonard Reiffel of Apollo Program Director Sam Phillips's
scientific staff wrote Phillips suggesting that "we do not schedule the ALSEP
for the first lunar landing." Reiffel cited the problems of the magnetometer, the
many unknowns that could affect the deployment and function of the experi-
ments, and the weight problems that were hindering production of the lunar mod-
ule. He offered his personal opinion that, except for the seismometer, the scientific
experiments would not yield fundamental information about the moon that would
be of immediate importance. All in all, Reiffel thought, the program might be
better served in the long run by waiting until the second mission to fly the full
complement of surface instruments: "An uncrowded time line on the lunar surface
for the first mission would seem to me to be more contributory to the advance of science
than trying to do so much on the first mission that we do nothing well [emphasis in
the original]. ''21
Reiffel's misgivings about the astronauts' work load and the time available for
surface activities were not off target. Early in development, Jack Schmitt, one of
the astronauts providing crew advice to the lunar surface experiments designers,
discovered an undesirable legacy from earlier conceptual work on the instruments:
95
Where No Man Has Gone Before
• . . In the early days, the crews.., were worried about having enough to
do on the moon .... In the early design stages they [the ALSEP designers]
took to heart the crew input to "give us something to do," and it was a mon-
ster .... The way they had that thing put together it was going to take for-
ever to deploy.
This design philosophy was intended to give substance to the argument that
men were essential in lunar exploration, but to Schmitt it was the wrong approach.
Precious time on the moon should not be wasted in the purely mechanical activity
of deploying the instrument package. He and other astronauts worked hard to
improve the design of the package so that deploying it did not take so much time,
but it was slow going. 22
Even before Reiffel's pessimistic evaluation of the science prospects for early
flight, Phillips had been worried about the progress of the first instrument pack-
age. In early June he appointed a review team to look into the development of
the magnetometer and another to examine the safety problems with the RTG. 23
The magnetometer investigation team found that the technically sophisticated
project had encountered severe schedule delays and cost overruns, but concluded
that Ames and its contractor had arrested the project's negative trends. Still, the
magnetometer clearly could not be ready for the first scheduled lunar landing.
A simpler instrument proposed by investigators at Goddard Space Flight Center
was briefly considered, but it could not meet the schedule either and was dropped.
At the end of August 1967, Phillips recommended to Deputy Administrator Robert
Seamans that the magnetometer be taken off the first ALSEP and replaced by
a laser reflector, a completely passive experiment which was under development•
The prospects seemed good that a complete ALSEP package as originally planned
could be flown on the second lunar landing mission. 24 Ames's magnetometer
remained in the schedule for the first landing throughout 1968, however. 2s
Without doubt the delay in the first lunar landing caused by the Apollo fire
relieved some of the pressure on the ALSEP experimenters and developers• For
all its human and economic cost, the 204 accident forced a pause that was put
to good use by those segments of the program (such as the science projects) that
were less vitally affected by the fire than the spacecraft. The command module
was suffering from many problems in early 1967, and it can be argued that sooner
or later something as serious as the fire would have halted progress. The tragedy
was that the price of straightening out the program was three lives.
During 1966, while the lunar landing program still seemed on track for successful
completion within the decade, the question of a manned program to follow
Apollo* took on considerable importance. Administrator James Webb was not
*At the time no milestone dearly marking the end of Apollo had been defined. It could be argued
that the first lunar landing would represent completion of Apollo and that subsequent missions would
be part of Apollo Applications. Most officials seemed to think of Apollo as comprising the first two
or three lunar landings and AAP as including all lunar exploration more extensive than those land-
ings could accomplish.
96
Setback and Recovery: 1967
the repetition of Apollo flights for more than two or three missions will be
unjustifiable in terms of anticipated scientific return without the modification
of the system to provide for additional mobility on the Moon's surface and
the capacity to remain on the surface for a longer period of time.
After a few initial flights, NASA should adapt the remaining spacecraft and
launch vehicles to those ends--for example, by converting the lunar module to
an unmanned supply vehicle that could be stocked with expendables, scientific
equipment, and mobility aids to support explorations of 7 to 14 days. Manned
lunar missions following the first few should be conducted at the rate of not more
than one or two per year, carefully coordinated with an expanded program of
unmanned exploration to reduce the overall cost of lunar scientific exploration
and to investigate areas that Apollo could not safely reach37
PSAC's report, published in February 1967, attracted little public notice in the
aftermath of the fire. Its recommendations on Apollo exploration, though brief,
were not overlooked by officials at the Manned Spacecraft Center, however. In
spite of its preoccupation with the first lunar landing, MSC turned attention to
the later lunar missions as soon as it could. 28 Shortly after taking over his duties
as Director of Science and Applications at MSC, Wilmot Hess sought the help
of lunar scientists in planning scientific exploration of the moon.
Following the pattern set by OSSA and the Space Science Board, Hess organized
a summer study in 1967 to discuss lunar exploration. On July 31 more than 150
scientists and NASA officials met on the campus of the University of California
at Santa Cruz to provide the expert advice NASA would need to conduct an effec-
tive lunar exploration program. The stated objectives of the conference were to
prepare detailed science plans, establish an order of priority for lunar investiga-
97
WhereNo ManHasGoneBefore
*The working groups and their chair persons were: Astronomy, L. W. Frederick, Univ. of Virginia;
Bioscience, Melvin B. Calvin, Univ. of California, Berkeley; Geochemistry, Paul W. Gast, Columbia
Univ.; Geodesy and Cartography, Charles Lundquist, Smithsonian Astrophysical Observatory; Geol-
ogy, Alfred H. Chidester, U.S. Geological Survey; Geophysics, Frank Press, Mass. Institute of Tech-
nology; Lunar Atmospheres, Francis Johnson, Southwest Center for Advanced Studies; Particles and
Fields, D. J. Williams, Goddard Space Flight Center.
**Afootnote to the title identified the whale as "Neobalaena shoemakerensis." At Falmouth Eugene
Shoemaker, impatient with the lack of progress toward defining Apollo's scientific goals, had com-
pared efforts "to make something happen, like getting some science on Apollo," to trying to push
a beached whale back into the ocean." If you push very hard you make a dent in the whale, but
as soon as you stop pushing, [the dent] comes right back out again," leaving the whale right where
it was. E. M. Shoemaker interview, Mar. 17, 1984. When the laughter had died down, an unidenti-
fied Headquarters participant topped the joke with the comment, "Gene, you ought to try pushing
that whale off the beach from the inside." H. H. Schmitt interview, May 30, 1984.
98
Setback
andRecovery: 1967
ples over a wider area and to explore peaks and valleys that a wheeled vehicle
could not reach. All the working groups agreed on the need for long unmanned
traverses on the lunar surface, for which a dual-mode "local scientific survey mod-
ule" was necessary. Besides carrying the lunar explorers from place to place, this
module would be capable of unmanned operation directed from earth, traveling
across the surface from one Apollo landing site to another. Along the way it would
deploy several small geophysical instruments and collect samples for return by
the next manned mission. An unmanned vehicle somewhat like this was being
considered, but the Santa Cruz conferees favored their own version, which was
more sophisticated. 31
To support longer stays on the moon, the scientists recommended that NASA
develop the capability to launch two Saturn Vs per mission: one to carry the
crew, the other, unmanned, to transport a modified lunar module carrying addi-
tional expendable supplies and scientific instruments.* To supplement the more
flexible manned missions they proposed, the working groups recommended that
a network of geophysical stations be established on the moon using improved
Surveyor spacecraft or similar instrumented modules. Other recommendations
for improving Apollo's scientific return included increasing the quantity of lunar
samples returned to 250 pounds (110 kilograms), modularizing the experiment
package so that instruments could be more easily interchanged to meet the scien-
tific requirements of each mission, and developing the capability to deploy
instrumented satellites in close orbit around the moon. 32
In spite of MSC's efforts to be responsive to experimenters' needs, the scien-
tists at Santa Cruz evidently felt that communication between investigators and
engineers still left much to be desired. They recommended that a project scien-
tist, preferably someone involved in the experiment, be assigned to each experi-
ment to make sure that scientists and engineers understood each others' needs
and limitations. 33
Turning to the question of astronaut participation in lunar exploration, the Santa
Cruz conference conceded the primacy of piloting skills in the choice of Apollo
crews, but strongly recommended that the second criterion for crew selection be
ability in field geology. On the later, more complicated scientific missions, the
conference considered that "'the knowledge and experience of an astronaut who is also
a professional field geologist is essential.'" As far as astronaut training was concerned,
the conferees insisted that "'in the interest of maintaining career proficiency, astronauts
should be provided time to engage in some form of research activity within their profes-
sional fields [emphasis in the original in both cases].' ,34 The latter point was par-
ticularly important. NASA was about to announce the names of a second group
of scientist-astronauts and the conference was sending a message to MSC that
this group should, from the start, be scientists first and pilots second.
Rounding out the summary recommendations of the conference, the working
groups outlined in some detail a sequence of missions to follow the first few Apollo
*A logistic support system based on the Saturn V had been in NASA's plans ever since the lunar-
orbit rendezvous decision in 1962. It was part of the price OMSF paid yon Braun for his support of
lunar-orbit rendezvous, and was to be designed and built by Marshall Space Flight Center, which
had no major development responsibilities after Saturn V. See Brooks, Grirnwood, and Swenson,
Chariots for Apollo, p. 81.
99
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
landings: (1) manned orbital flights around the moon to obtain better photographs
of proposed landing sites and study the surface with remote sensors, (2) single-
launch manned missions, and (3) dual-launch manned missions. Three explora-
tion missions were sketched out. One would send two men to the crater Coper-
nicus for three days, exploring and sampling the crater floor and its central peaks
with the lunar flying unit. The second, a six-day voyage to the Aristarchus region,
required a dual Saturn V launch carrying an unmanned lunar-traversing vehicle.
This mission would explore the "Cobra's Head," a curious crater lying at the
head of the sinuous rille known as Schroeter's Valley. Finally, plans were out-
lined for a seven-day mission to crater Alphonsus employing most of the explo-
ration aids recommended by the working groups. Scientific objectives were spelled
out in some detail for each site, and the conference report recommended that
all these mission proposals be given immediate detailed analysis to test their prac-
ticability. 3s
As important as its scientific recommendations was the mechanism the confer-
ence set up for effecting them. Near the end of the second week Hess established
a Group for Lunar Exploration Planning (GLEP)* to work continuously with
NASA mission planners to incorporate as many of the Santa Cruz recommenda-
tions as possible into the remaining Apollo and Apollo Applications missions. 3_
For the next few years GLEP and MSC planners would meet periodically to exam-
ine and refine mission plans.
Santa Cruz gave the Manned Spacecraft Center as much material for study as
it could have wanted, and Houston's planning groups began studying its recom-
mendations within weeks of its conclusion. Toward the end of September Elbert
King summarized the Santa Cruz proceedings for MSC's lunar missions plan-
ning board. The board's reaction to the conference's primary recommendations
was not especially sanguine. Neither the lunar flying unit--considered vital by
the scientists--nor the local science survey module was much more than a con-
cept at the time, and both would take considerable time to reach operational matu-
rity. Max Faget, MSC's director of Engineering and Development, agreed that
both vehicles were desirable but was not optimistic about either cost or sched-
ule. Since the Santa Cruz conferees had suggested that lunar exploration be
deferred until the flying unit was developed, the whole program could be held
up if it ran into difficulty. In the discussion it was pointed out that Marshall Space
Flight Center had studied similar mobility aids and was not convinced that a
remotely controlled surface vehicle was feasible. Marshall was currently explor-
ing a smaller lunar roving vehicle that could carry little more than the two
astronauts and some scientific equipment. The lunar missions planning board
did not settle the question of surface mobility at this meeting. Although it agreed
on the necessity to extend the range of the astronauts' exploration, the board
was not too keen on starting to work on either of the vehicles suggested at Santa
*Members were chairman Wilmot N. Hess, Maxime A. Faget, Harold Gartrell, Elbert A. King, Jr.,
Harrison H. Schmitt, and William T. Stoney, all of MSC; Richard J. Allenby, OSSA; James R. Arnold,
Univ. of California, San Diego; Melvin B. Calvin, Univ. of California, Berkeley; Philip E. Culbertson,
OMSF; Paul W. Gast, Columbia Univ.; Richard Jahns, Stanford Univ.; Francis Johnson, Southwest
Center for Advanced Studies; Charles Lundquist, Smithsonian Geophysical Observatory; FrankPress,
Mass. Institute of Technology; Nancy Roman, OSSA; Eugene M. Shoemaker, U.S. Geological Sur-
vey; and Donald J. Williams, Goddard Space Flight Center.
100
Setback and Recovery: 1967
Cruz. Faget guessed that the long-range vehicle could cost as much as $250 mil-
lion to develop. 37
On November 16 and 17 OSSA's Lunar and Planetary Missions Board, which
was responsible for advising NASA management on the overall balance between
lunar and planetary programs, met at Houston to review lunar exploration plans.
Hess presented the status of MSC's plan, the elements it should contain, and
how it was to evolve. Board members were clearly uneasy, for they asked Hess
to review the plan again before submitting it to Headquarters for approval. 38 Three
days after the Houston meeting, on request of the Lunar and Planetary Missions
Board, Associate Administrator* Homer Newell sent Robert Gilruth a motion
passed by the board to guide MSC's discussions with the Group for Lunar Explo-
ration Planning. While the board found most of the Santa Cruz report acceptable
in principle, it requested that the Group for Lunar Exploration Planning review
that report "in light of the severe fiscal constraints currently in effect." The board
suggested that to reduce the cost of lunar exploration, some of the manned land-
ings could be replaced by unmanned, automated, and mobile exploration sys-
tems launched by Saturn Vs, and asked GLEP to submit a few examples of
programs at different budget levels. 39
The "severe fiscal constraints" cited by the Lunar and Planetary Missions Board
had been building throughout 1967, and for the unmanned space programs, at
least a year before that. NASA's appropriations peaked in fiscal 1965 at $5.25 bil-
lion and declined by $75 million and then $207 million in the following two fiscal
years. In 1966 Lyndon Johnson had concentrated on establishing his Great Soci-
ety programs; in 1967 the American military presence in southeast Asia grew sub-
stantially. Apollo suffered little by comparison with some other programs, but
post-Apollo programs, including George Mueller's grandiose Apollo Applications
Program, had been postponed. 4° In the spring of 1967 NASA submitted a request
for fiscal 1968 of $5.1 billion, which Congress cut by $517 million. On signing
the space agency's authorization bill in August, the President indicated that he
would not oppose the reductions, noting that the federal deficit might run as high
as $29 billion instead of the $8.1 billion forecast early in the year. The country
faced hard choices, he said, and would have "to distinguish between the neces-
sary and the desirable."41
Three months later Administrator James Webb presented NASA's proposed
operating plan for fiscal 1968 to the Senate space committee. His figures showed
that Congress had cut only $50.5 million (2 percent) out of the $2,546.5 million
request for Apollo. Apollo Applications had been slashed by 31 percent, and
advanced mission studies had been completely eliminated. The Office of Space
*In August Newell had been appointed Associate Administrator, NASA's third-ranking officer,
succeeding Robert C. Seamans, Jr., who had moved up to the post of Deputy Administrator after
the death of Hugh L. Dryden in December 1965. John E. Naugle succeeded Newell as Associate
Administrator for Space Science and Applications.
101
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
Science and Applications had been hit relatively much harder. Congress had cut
$146.6 million (22 percent) out of its total request of $674.6 million for all space
science programs. OSSA's lunar and planetary missions were reduced by 12 per-
cent and Voyager, a major planetary program, was eliminated entirely. 42 Such
were the "severe fiscal constraints" that motivated the Lunar and Planetary Mis-
sions Board to ask for reexamination of MSC's lunar exploration plans.
The fscal crunch of 1967 was the beginning of a long period of comparative
austerity for the American space program. Domestic programs and the nation's
growing participation in the Vietnam war created severe pressure on all govern-
ment programs, and space was no exception. At first Apollo suffered less than
other space projects, but eventually it too would shrink as a result of changing
national priorities.
As long as Apollo was a goal yet to be attained, the nation and the Congress
seemed willing to support it at substantially the level NASA considered essen-
tial. Less exciting programs and less tangible space objectives fared less well when
the federal deficit grew. This trend in congressional support of space programs
from 1965 was not lost on NASA's managers, least of all on George Mueller. In
1963 he had begun looking for a viable post-Apollo program; since 1965 he had
worked for a specific (though ill-defined, in the opinion of some) program to use
the Apollo spacecraft and organization to produce useful results. His proposals,
deferred in fiscal 1966 and again in fiscal 1967, only achieved concrete status as
the Apollo Applications Program (AAP) in the fiscal 1968 budget--and then with
pitifully small financial support.
In early 1967, Apollo Applications still included (at least on paper) all manned
programs after the first few lunar landings--specifically, extended lunar explora-
tion using improved Apollo spacecraft. From mid-1966 onward, however,
Mueller's concept of Apollo Applications seemed to be narrowing. Congressional
committees had not warmed to his plans for a wide-ranging, multifunctional pro-
gram whose major goal seemed to be to use up the hardware already developed
and exercise the organization. Debate within his own manned space flight organi-
zation and discussions with aerospace executives led Mueller to the conclusion
that AAP should serve more specifically as a bridge to the next major manned
space program--whatever that might be. 4s
Thus as 1967 wore on and the consequences of the AS-204 fire were dealt with,
MueUer saw merit in separating lunar exploration from unrelated activities in AAP.
Lack of enthusiasm for AAP outside his own office--particularly at higher levels
of NASA management--undoubtedly contributed to this changing view. In May,
management discussions led to a number of decisions that subordinated AAP
to the main objectives of Apollo: the lunar landing had priority over AAP; no
hardware would be modified (a key feature of AAP) unless authorized by the
deputy administrator; and all AAP launch schedules and hardware assignments
would remain tentative until progress in Apollo could be assessed and AAP pay-
loads could be better defined. 44 Under these conditions, continued exploration
102
Setback
andRecovery:
1967
of the moon stood a better chance of support under the Apollo banner. Since
planning for manned lunar exploration was more or less independent of which
program office actually oversaw it, site selection, experiment development, and
mission planning continued without regard to organizational lines.
In December 1967 Mueller established an Apollo Lunar Exploration Office under
the Apollo Program Office in Headquarters. As director of the new office he named
Lee R. Scherer, a retired Navy captain who had directed the successful Lunar
Orbiter program (completed four months previously). Scherer's office would
assume responsibility at Headquarters for directing all activities connected with
lunar exploration. Two divisions, Flight Systems Development and Lunar Science,
would oversee spacecraft modifications and science plans, respectively. The Lunar
Science Division would look to the Office of Space Science and Applications for
all science planning.4S The major functions of the old Manned Space Science Divi-
sion were distributed between the Lunar Exploration Office and the Apollo Appli-
cations Program Office, and its director, Willis Foster, became assistant to the
associate administrator of OSSA in charge of manned space flight experiments.
At the end of 1966 construction of the Lunar Receiving Laboratory (LRL) at MSC
was well under way. On January 11, 1967, Gilruth advised Homer Newell that
the laboratory's design was essentially fixed and that any new requirements arising
out of proposals by scientific investigators could only be accommodated by design
changes, which would cost money and time. 46 Construction proceeded without
significant delay throughout the spring, and in mid-April program manager Joseph
V. Piland reported to Gilruth that he expected to close down his office by June
30 and turn the laboratory over to its operating staff. 47
The principal unsettled question in early 1967 was that of a laboratory staff.
For several months the LRL Working Group, appointed by the Planetology Sub-
committee of OSSA's Space Sciences Steering Committee, had insisted that the
laboratory must be a permanent scientific research organization headed by a
nationally respected scientist who would report to the director of MSC (see Chap-
ter 4). MSC's announcement creating the new Science and Applications Direc-
torate did not mention the Lunar Receiving Laboratory, confirming the "worst
fears" (as the group's chairman, Clark Goodman, put it) of the working group,
which was informed of the action only after the fact. Headquarters and MSC offi-
cials spent considerable time convincing Goodman that those fears were ground-
less: the laboratory would be a part of MSC's science directorate and MSC was
working closely with OSSA in selecting an outstanding scientist to direct it; the
director would be appointed only with the concurrence of the associate adminis-
trator for space science and applications; and he would be given a free hand in
revising the organization of the laboratory and selecting its staff. 48 Three days
after announcing the new science directorate, MSC issued an interim plan for
the management and operation of the Lunar Receiving Laboratory, placing it in
the Lunar and Earth Sciences Division, whose head would report to the Director
of Science and Applications. .9
103
WhereNoManHasGone Before
104
Setback and Recovery: 1967
a lunar sample analysis planning team* to assist him in formulating detailed guide-
lines for the selection and allocation of samples and the necessary scientific func-
tions in the receiving laboratory. A second group, the lunar sample preliminary
examination team,** would participate in the initial examination of samples in
the LRL. Besides investigators approved to perform experiments in the labora-
tory during quarantine, the latter group included a mineralogy-petrology team
who would help obtain information that would be used in allocating samples to
other investigators. These appointments did much to increase the confidence of
the scientists in MSC's plans for management of the samples. 55
The last gap in LRL management was closed with the appointment of a direc-
tor for the laboratory. On August 1, 1967, P. R. Bell, senior physicist at the Oak
Ridge National Laboratory, assumed duties as Chief of MSC's Lunar and Earth
Sciences Division and director of the LRL. Bell's career extended from pre-World
War II work with the National Defense Research Committee at the University
of Chicago through wartime research at MIT's Radiation Laboratory to postwar
work at Oak Ridge. An expert in instrumentation, he had conceived the vacuum
system that was being built by Union Carbide at Oak Ridge to be installed in the
receiving laboratory, s6
Complexities of Quarantine
Quarantine took up much of the time to the LRL during 1967. An Interagency
Committee on Back Contamination (ICBC), established in 1966 (see Chapter 4),
served as the policy-making board on questions of quarantine, t As the receiving
lab moved toward operational readiness, some possible complexities of operations
became apparent. Theoretically the approval of all the concerned regulatory
agencies would have to be secured before the samples could be released to lunar
scientists. In January 1967, Robert Gilruth sent his deputy, George Low, to Atlanta
to discuss matters with ICBC chairman David Sencer. Low and Sencer readily
*Members initially appointed were Wilmot N. Hess, MSC, chairman; Elbert A. King, MSC, secre-
tary; Edward Anders, Univ. of Chicago; James R. Arnold, Univ. of California, San Diego; P. R. Bell,
LRL manager, MSC; Clifford Frondel, Harvard Univ.; Paul W. Gast, Lamont Geol. Observatory,
Columbia Univ.; Harry H. Hess, Princeton Univ.; J. Hoover Mackin, Univ. of Texas; Eugene M. Shoe-
maker, U.S. Geological Survey; M. Gene Simmons, Mass. Inst. of Technology; Brian J. Skinner, Yale
Univ.; Wolf Vishniac, Univ. of Rochester; and Gerald J. Wasserburg, Calif. Inst. of Technology.
**Members initially appointed were Wilmot N. Hess, MSC, chairman; Klaus Biemann, Mass. Inst.
of Technology; Almo L. Burlingame, Univ. bf California, Berkeley; Edward C. T. Chao, U.S. Geolog-
ical Survey; Clifford Frondel, Harvard Univ.; Eibert A. King, MSC; J. Hoover Mackin, Univ. of Texas;
G. Davis O'Kelley, Oak Ridge National Laboratory; Oliver A. Schaeffer, State Univ. of New York,
Stony Brook; and M. Gene Simmons, Mass. Inst. of Technology.
"_Originalmembers of the ICBC in 1966 were David J. Sencer, USPHS, chairman; John R. Bagby, Jr.,
USPHS; Charles A. Berry, MSC;Aleck C. Bond, MSC;John Buckley, Dept. of Interior; Harold E Klein,
Ames Research Center; G. Briggs Phillips, USPHS; John E. Picketing, OMSF;Leonard Reiffel, OMSF;
Ernest Saulmon, Dept. of Agriculture; and Wolf Vishniac, Univ. of Rochester, National Academy of
Sciences representative. In January 1967 Robert O. Piland of MSC replaced Bond; later in the year
Wilmot N. Hess replaced Piland, James H. Turnock, Jr., OMSE replaced Reiffel, George L. Mehren,
Dept. of Agriculture, replaced Saulmon, and an OSSA member, Lawrence B. Hall, was added.
105
WhereNo ManHas Gone Before
agreed that a single official at MSC should be given the authority of the ICBC to
approve the quarantine protocol and to release the lunar samples when the
protocol had been satisfied. (NASA Headquarters had already indicated that
NASA's authority to release the samples could be delegated to Gilruth.) The ICBC
would develop quarantine procedures, its representative in Houston would cer-
tify to Gilruth that those procedures had been satisfied, and Gilruth would order
quarantine terminated, s7 If a long chain of approvals--from each of the regulatory
agencies through Headquarters to MSC--could be avoided, the academic investi-
gators could have their lunar material much sooner.
Once in the lunar receiving laboratory, crews and lunar samples were safely
sealed off from the earth, but between the command module floating on the Pacific
Ocean and the crew quarters in Houston was a gap in the containment of extrater-
restrial material. By late August 1966 it had been agreed that a "mobile quaran-
tine facility" would be used to transport the lunar explorers from the recovery
ship to the receiving lab. Essentially a travel trailer that could accommodate six
people for four days, the isolation van would be modified to prevent the escape
of infectious agents. It would be sealed aboard the recovery ship, carried from
the splashdown point to Hawaii, flown in a C-141 cargo aircraft to Ellington Air
Force Base near MSC, and hauled by truck to the LRL, where the astronauts would
enter quarantine through a plastic tunnel extending from the van to the LRL
door. ss
A similar method might be used aboard ship to transfer the astronauts from
the spacecraft to the mobile quarantine facility. If the command module was
assumed to be contaminated it should not be opened; hence the sealed space-
craft with its human contents should be hoisted onto the deck of the recovery
ship, where the astronauts could pass through a plastic tunnel from spacecraft
to isolation van. Landing operations managers were unwilling to risk this, how-
ever, because of the possibility of injuring the crewmen if the spacecraft were
dropped. Yet there seemed no feasible way to open the command module while
it floated on the ocean and still keep it isolated from the earth's biosphere. After
examining the spacecraft's environmental control system, the ICBC was satis-
fied that it would effectively filter out airborne bacteria during the long return
trip from the moon. s9 Thus only the astronauts--not the atmosphere of the com-
mand module--were likely to harbor biological contaminants, and some means
had to be devised to keep them from infecting the world on their short trip from
the spacecraft to the isolation van. The solution was to bag them in plastic: a "bio-
logical isolation garment," a zippered plastic coverall equipped with a respira-
tor. The recovery crew would toss these into the spacecraft; the astronauts would
don them before entering the recovery raft and remove them after they were sealed
in their temporary quarters aboard ship. 6°
Another key problem was the selection of biological tests--the "protocol"--
that would give maximum assurance that the samples harbored no dangerous
organisms while requiring minimum time and facilities in the receiving lab. Early
in 1966 MSC had contracted with Baylor College of Medicine in Houston to
develop the test protocol, which the ICBC reviewed at its December meeting. 61
The objective of the protocol was to permit a biomedical assessment of lunar mate-
rial so that samples could be released within 30 days of their arrival at the LRL,
106
ORIGINAL PAGE
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH Setback and Recovery: 1967
An Apollo mobile quarantine facility (MQF) on its pallet, in storage at MSC. The unit is a consid-
erably modified version of a commercial Airstream travel trailer. On the roof are two air-conditioning
units, front and back, and two filtered air inlets, center. The main door and viewing window are
in the rear {right). A side door (center) allowed transfer of rock boxes from the command module
through a plastic tunnel (not shown), after which they would be sterilized and passed out through
the transfer lock just forward of the side door. Auxiliary power units, visible on the front end of
the pallet, provided electricity during transfers from ship to shore and onto the transport aircraft;
at other times the unit took electricity from the recovery ship or the transport aircraft. The MQF was
35 feet long, 9 feet wide, 8 feet 7 inches high and weighed 18,700 pounds when fully stocked with
consumable supplies and support equipment.
107
Where No Man Has Gone Before
of lunar soil that was the nominal sample lay a range of possibilities in which
only grams or fractions of grams of material might be available. If the crew should
have to leave the moon with only a small sample, how could a satisfactory quaran-
tine examination be carried out and still leave material for other scientists to work
with? Vishniac took the position that if extraterrestrial organisms existed they
were bound to be introduced into the earth's biosphere eventually, no matter
how rigorous the precautions, if planetary exploration continued. Therefore the
Apollo quarantine protocol should search not for living organisms in general but
only for infectious organisms that constituted a clear danger to the earth. Thus
the quarantine protocol could be considerably simplified. 63Vishniac's suggestion
was privately welcomed at MSC, where some project managers felt that quaran-
tine procedures were on the verge of becoming unworkable."
Evidently other members of the committee were coming to a similar conclu-
sion, because at the next ICBC meeting they agreed to keep the quarantine pro-
tocol under continuing review. They also agreed that samples would be tested
on a few well understood living systems rather than a larger number of less com-
mon ones. Systems of greatest sensitivity would be selected so that results could
be quickly assessed, minimizing the amount of sample required and the time
needed to certify the lunar material as harmless. 6s
At its June meeting the ICBC reviewed the revised quarantine protocol and con-
sidered a statistical approach to determining the size of sample required to give
the desired reliability. It appeared that 1.2 kilograms (about 2.5 pounds) of mate-
rial would be needed to conduct an acceptable quaran_ne protocol. If, as the Santa
Cruz conference had recommended, no more than 5 percent of the total lunar
material were used for quarantine testing, 24 kilograms (53 pounds)--roughly the
nominal lunar sample--would be enough to provide a sample for quarantine test-
ing. The committee would continue to work toward a minimum test protocol in
case less than 24 kilograms were returned. 66
By the end of the summer the Interagency Committee had agreed on an out-
line of the procedures for releasing lunar material and astronauts from quaran-
tine. If, as expected, the biological tests showed no exotic organisms and the
astronauts developed no symptoms of infection within 21 days, the ICBC would
review the data and certify that the crewmen could be released. Any change in
the astronauts' general health would call for diagnosis. If the change was nonin-
fectious or could be attributed to familiar terrestrial organisms, quarantine could
be ended. But if no cause for the change was readily apparent, the question of
release would be passed to a NASA medical team. A similar plan was prescribed
for testing and releasing the lunar samples. If there were any doubt about living
organisms being in the lunar material, release might be conditional, requiring
sterilization or stipulation that the sample could be examined only behind a bio-
logical barrier. In all cases, doubtful results could lead to retention of the sam-
ples in the receiving laboratory until further testing satisfied all concerned agencies
that no hazard existed. 67
While the ICBC worked toward a final quarantine protocol, others were look-
ing ahead to premission testing of the receiving laboratory and its facilities. Early
in the summer George Mueller sketched out for MSC Director Robert Gilruth
a tentative timeline for LRL tests and simulations. According to Mueller's con-
cept, laboratory personnel could be trained in the operation of the equipment
108
Setback and Recovery: 1967
and conduct of the quarantine tests before the laboratory was actually occupied.
By the end of 1967 some partial simulations should be conducted to confirm the
suitability of the lab's systems and the ability of the technical support team to
handle the anticipated work load. In the following three months some actual
sample-handling simulations should be conducted. By rnid-1968, MueUer said,
a full-scale dress rehearsal of a mission should be conducted, from splashdown
through the end of quarantine. Samples and test subjects would be treated exactly
as they would be during an actual mission, with data being accumulated, han-
dled, and reduced in "real time," to iron out any deficiencies remaining in proce-
dures and equipment. 68 Houston estimated that preparation for an end-to-end
simulation of a lunar mission would require 11 months. 69
The six months after the Apollo fire were probably the busiest of the entire
moon-landing program. At the Manned Spacecraft Center and its spacecraft con-
tractor, North American Aviation, procedures were tightened up to give managers
a better grip on details of the program. Both MSC and NAA brought in new
managers for the spacecraft project. George Low, picked by James Webb to run
Houston's spacecraft program, appointed a tough configuration control board
at MSC which met every week to review proposed design changes. Every sys-
tem and subsystem in the command module was examined for hazards. New
materials and test procedures assured that the risk of fire was reduced to the abso-
lute minimum. T°
The fire bought time for the Saturn project as well. While the first and third
stages had few major problems, the second (S-I 0 stage--also a North American
project--had been having serious problems since 1965. S-II was the largest rocket
stage ever built to use liquid oxygen and liquid hydrogen, and its builders ran
into unique technological problems and needed all the help they could get to meet
launch schedules. At one point, in fact, S-II was the single most troublesome part
of the Saturn program. 71
The toil, tears, and sweat expended by NASA and contractors during the post-
fire months produced striking results before the year ended. On November 9,
1967, the first complete Saturn V to be flight-tested, AS-501, lifted off from the
brand new launch complex 39 at Kennedy Space Center, carrying a boilerplate
command and service module and a mock-up of the lunar module into earth orbit.
Apollo 4, as the flight was designated, was certainly the most complex mission
launched up to that time. Its long list of "firsts" included checking out all sys-
tems of the Saturn V, including the first in-orbit restarting of the S-IVB third stage.
As far as the spacecraft was concerned, Apollo 4 proved the soundness of the
command module's heat shield and redesigned hatch during simulated reentry
from a lunar mission. George Mueller's 1963 decision to test the Saturn V "all-
up" was apparently vindicated when AS-501 was officially evaluated as a suc-
cess in all respects. 72
With that success it was easy to feel that Apollo was "on its way to the moon,"
as Program Director Sam Phillips put it in a postlaunch press conference. Apollo
109
Where No Man Has Gone Before
4 was the first of six steps that MSC mission planners had set down as essential
precursors to the lunar landing. These flights, lettered "A" through "F," would
progressively test the systems of the command and service module and the lunar
module and verify flight operations procedures, first in earth orbit and then in
deep space (lunar orbit), before mission "G" landed on the moon. Four Saturn
Vs and two Saturn IBs (or three and three, depending on how the Saturn V and
the spacecraft systems performed) would be used for the prelanding missions.
This classification of missions, though unofficial, was the framework on which
subsequent planning was built73
The year also saw a considerable evolution of scientific activity at the Manned
Spacecraft Center. Much of the cause of scientists' complaints about the Hous-
ton center was removed by the creation of the Science and Applications Direc-
torate and the appointment of a research scientist of recognized stature as its head.
When that directorate became operational, Headquarters's Office of Space Science
and Applications delegated to MSC most of the responsibility for management
of the lunar samples, including direct contacts with the participating scientists.
The lunar receiving laboratory, although it was not accorded the bureaucratic stat-
ure at MSC that the lunar scientists had insisted on, was placed sufficiently high to
assure adequate autonomy, and its first manager was a research scientist who had
been a major contributor to the design of the LRL's sample-handling equipment.
NASA Administrator James Webb spent considerable time in 1967 exploring
a more prominent role in planetary science for the lunar receiving laboratory. In
view of the historic significance of the lunar samples and the possibility that probes
might eventually return samples from the planets, Webb wanted the LRL to
become the world's premier site for scientific research on the moon and the
planets. In discussions with the National Academy of Sciences during 1967, Webb
worked for an arrangement to bring this prospective "Lunar Science Institute"
under academic management, which would be essential if the institute was to
achieve the stature Webb wanted for it. By the end of the year NASA and the
Academy had defined the role of the institute and were working to form a con-
sortium of universities to manage it, but ideas had not yet crystallized and quite
a bit of negotiating was still to be done. TM
As 1968 began, Apollo program officials could look back on a year of accom-
plishment and ahead to more hard work. It would be a busy year at the Cape:
the official manned space flight schedule projected six developmental missions
for 1968. Three were Saturn I13missions, two of them unmanned tests of the lunar
module, and the third a manned test of the much-reworked command and ser-
vice module in earth orbit. Three Saturn V flights--two unmanned, verifying
spacecraft development, and one manned--would precede five manned Saturn
V missions in 1969. "The first lunar landing," the schedule stated for public con-
sumption, "'is possible in [the] last half of 1969. ''Ts Manned space flight opera-
tions were about to go into high gear.
When mission G was ready to fly, lunar scientists could expect the facilities
for handling its history-making cargo to be ready. During 1967 the lunar receiv-
ing laboratory had been completed and much of its specialized equipment
installed. Perhaps more important, MSC and the community of lunar investiga-
tors had set up the administrative mechanism by which the lunar material would
be parceled out for scientific examination. Within the constraints of quarantine
110
i.
Setback and Recovery: 1967
and of MSC's responsibility to safeguard and account for the samples, the scien-
tists, through their chosen representatives, would allot the lunar rocks and soil
to the approved investigators. As far as the official records reveal it, MSC and
the academic science community were developing a cooperative relationship along
lines that the scientists found acceptable, if not ideal.
111
!
8
Apollo took longer strides in 1968, perhaps, than in any previous year. In April,
fifteen months after the fire, a Saturn V carried an unmanned command module
into earth orbit to test launch vehicle and spacecraft systems and to simulate re-
entry from a lunar voyage. Only months before Apollo 7 tested the redesigned
command module with a crew in October, officials at the Manned Spacecraft Cen-
ter began to think about a much more ambitious flight. After selling their pro-
posal to Headquarters, they began making plans to send a crew to the vicinity
of the moon. For Christmas 1968 NASA gave the world a present to remember:
live television pictures and oral commentary from the crew of the Apollo 8 space-
craft in lunar orbit.
On the science side, progress was less spectacular. Technical problems with
the lunar surface experiments were largely overcome, but doubts about the
astronauts' ability to unload and deploy the instruments in the time available even°
tually caused program officials to substitute a smaller science package on the first
lunar mission. Several of the systems for handling lunar samples in the lunar
receiving laboratory caused major delays, but when the year ended the staff was
gearing up for a full-scale simulation.
Most of MSC's activity during 1967 and early 1968 was directed toward reducing
the fire hazard in the command module. The spacecraft hatch was redesigned
so that the crew could open it unaided in five seconds. Electrical systems and
the plumbing that carried oxygen and combustible coolants were thoroughly exam-
ined and modified. New materials to replace flammable nylon were investigated.
The advantages and disadvantages of atmospheres other than pure oxygen were
weighed. Repeated testing gathered data to support recommended changes. A
Senior Flammability Board, a Materials Selection Review Board, and a Crew Safety
Review Board were established to oversee specific parts of the process, and a tough
Configuration Control Board was set up to pass on all proposed changes in the
command module. The spacecraft builder, North American Aviation, was prod-
ded to supervise its subcontractors and vendors more closely to ensure on-time
delivery of critical subsystems. 1 The lunar landing module was less affected by
the fire, but it had its own problems. As had happened two years earlier, its weight
continued to creep upward, putting a squeeze on the scientific payload that could
be landed on the moon. Stress corrosion--cracks in aluminum structural
members--and fragile wiring caused delays and concern for reliability. Perhaps
the most serious problem was combustion instability in the lander's ascent engine,
which would blast the astronauts in the upper section back into lunar orbit after
they had completed their lunar exploration. These were worrisome problems at
this late stage, but concentrated effort by the lunar module contractor and two
engine contractors produced enough progress by mid-1968 to give NASA
managers reason for guarded optimism. 2
Late in January 1968 flight tests resumed when MSC put an unmanned lunar
lander through its paces in earth orbit. Designated Apollo 5 and launched on a
Saturn I-B, this flight verified operation of the lunar module's propulsion and
attitude-control systems and checked out the performance of the instrument unit
on the launch vehicle's uppermost stage, the S-IVB. The success of this mission
was more encouraging than the one that followed. On April 4 Apollo 6, the sec-
ond "all-up" unmanned test of the Saturn V, tested launch-vehicle systems and
the emergency detection system and allowed launch crews and vehicle engineers
to rehearse their tasks once more. Along for the ride, more or less, was a Block
I command module with some Block II* modifications; no mission objectives were
to be satisfied by this spacecraft except verification of its performance during reen-
try from a lunar mission. Apollo 6 was trouble from the start. The first-stage burn
produced intolerable "pogo" effects (longitudinal oscillations due to irregular fuel
feed), and a section of the adapter that mated the spacecraft to the booster blew
off during ascent. Two of the five engines on the second stage (S-H) shut down
prematurely. Perhaps the most troublesome fault was the failure of the third stage
(the S-IVB) to reignite in orbit--the maneuver that, on a lunar mission, would
send the Apollo craft on its way to the moon. Marshall Space Flight Center
immediately got to work on the problems; yet another unmanned Saturn V test
might be needed unless Marshall's engineers could correct them. 3
In spite of the difficulties with Saturn V and the lunar module, in mid-1968
it still seemed possible that manned flights could resume before the end of the
year. Command and service module number 101, delivered to the Cape at the
end of May, had fewer discrepancies on arrival than any previous spacecraft. It
would fly on Apollo 7, the first manned earth-orbital test of the second-generation
spacecraft, scheduled for the last quarter of the year. Since that mission would
use a Saturn I-B rather than a Saturn V and would not carry a lunar module,
its prospects seemed good.*
While spacecraft and operations engineers worked toward getting Apollo flying
again, their counterparts in the science programs were equally busy preparing
for the first lunar landing. Of all the science-related efforts, the lunar surface
experiments were in the best shape in early 1968. The lunar receiving laboratory
with its complex scientific equipment, and the elaborate procedures for back-
contamination control, had much farther to go before they would be ready to
handle their part of the program.
*The two versions of the command module were designed respectively for earth-orbit and lunar-
landing missions. They differed chiefly in onboard systems (guidance and navigation, docking, life-
support, etc.).
114
Final Preparations: 1968
During 1967 the Bendix Corporation and MSC ironed out the development prob-
lems of the Apollo lunar surface experiments package (ALSEP), and the project
was on schedule for the first lunar landing mission (see Chapter 6). But as the
year wore on, doubts about the ability of the astronauts to set up the instruments
in the time available,* expressed in July by a Headquarters official s (see Chapter
7), arose in other quarters as well. Planning for lunar surface operations called
for one period of activity in which the astronauts would collect a contingency
sample, inspect the lunar module, and familiarize themselves with the low-gravity
environment. During this excursion--whose length was limited by the capacity
of the portable life-support systems--they would scoop up 10 kilograms (22
pounds) of surface material and load it into the sample-return container. No one
was sure how much time these activities would require. MSC tended to be very
conservative in estimating how much work astronauts could do under lunar sur-
face conditions, and since it was certain that setting up the experiments would
take a good deal of time and effort, deployment was not scheduled during the
first extravehicular period. "For planning purposes," preliminary plans called
for a second moon walk during which the crew would unload, lay out, and con-
nect the science instruments. 6
As planning went on, however, and the limitations of time and life-support
systems became clearer, the flight of the planned group of instruments on the
first lunar landing mission became more doubtful. Simulations showed that a
suited astronaut had serious difficulty in unloading the package from the lunar
module. To complicate the situation further, weight was a growing problem with
the lunar module and difficulties were developing with the radioisotope ther-
moelectric generator that provided power for the experiments. By mid-1968 plan-
ners were already discussing the need to develop a smaller, less complex package
for that flight, so that some minimum scientific return would be realized. 7
MSC's normal conservatism in matters of crew safety and mission success grew
even stronger during the summer. The more engineers and mission planners
looked at alternatives the more attractive a simplified plan for lunar surface oper-
ations became. The first lunar landing would, after all, be the most hazardous
(potentially catastrophic) space mission yet, and it would be done with a space-
craft that had not been (and could not be) tested under conditions exactly duplicat-
ing the mission. Houston's concern had its effect in Washington. In June George
MueUer asked Gilruth to schedule a simulation of instrument deployment so that
he could make his own evaluation. 8 After this was completed in mid-August 1968,
Sam Phillips, Apollo program director at Headquarters, conferred with the chair-
man of the Science and Technology Advisory Committee** on proposed changes
in plans for the first lunar landing. When they reached agreement, Phillips noti-
*An additional question, raised by MSC's Flight Operations Directorate, was whether any lunar
module systems should be turned off during the lunar stay. FOD favored keeping critical systems
running so that the astronauts could depart immediately in case an emergency developed; this would
require additional consumables which would cut into LM weight margins. Minutes, Lunar Missions
Planning Board, May 19, 1967.
**Principal external advisory group to the Office of Manned Space Flight, established by George
Mueller in 1964.
115
WhereNoManHasGone Before
Commander Jim Lovell practices the "barbell carry," transporting a mockup of the lunar surface exper-
iments package in a walkthrough of the first traverse planned for Apollo 13. The black object on the
right with fins, is the radioisotope thermal generator (power unit).
fled committee members of the new plans. Instead of a 26-hour stay on the moon
and two-person excursions, he said, "it now seems prudent to limit the lunar
surface staytime to about 20 hours and the EVA [extravehicular activity] to a sin-
gle one-person excursion of 2 to 21/2 hours duration.'" This decision was based
on experience in Gemini, where MSC had been unpleasantly surprised by the
difficulty of working in null gravity. Whereas previous plans had called for the
astronauts to set up a high-gain (strongly directional) antenna for television trans-
mission, conduct preliminary geological exploration, collect samples, and emplace
the lunar surface experiments package, mission planners now proposed to cur-
tail the geological exploration, to depend on the 64-meter antenna at Goldstone,
California, to pick up TV signals from a less directional antenna that did not have
to be deployed by the astronauts, and to carry no scientific instruments at all.
Phillips regretfully acknowledged that much scientific information would be lost
but noted that subsequent missions would make up for it. Offsetting that loss
would be operational advantages that looked extremely attractive: an increase
in the safety margins for the lunar module's propulsion systems; maintenance
of the lunar module in a state of readiness for quick departure in an emergency;
and simplification of the training program, which was becoming undesirably
complex3
Phillips's action was welcomed by most of the MSC officials directly involved,
but not by Wilmot Hess, director of science and applications. Hess, who had been
fighting the battle for Apollo science on many fronts for the past two years, was
dismayed by Phillips's proposals. In a vigorous remonstrance he deplored the
ORIGINAL PAGE
116BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
ORIGINAL PAGE
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Final Preparations: 1968
Apollo 13 commander Jim Lovell (left) and lunar module pilot Fred Haise load up the tool carrier
in a training session at Kennedy Space Center.
severe loss to lunar science and the loss of credibility among the scientists that
MSC would suffer if the proposed changes were adopted:
What can I answer to the critics of the manned program?... People in NASA
and outside.., have repeatedly told me that no useful science had been done
on Gemini and that none would be done on Apollo. My answer has been that
it... would start with the lunar landings. This is not the case now. A person
who says now that the scientific program of Apollo could be carried out as
well using the Surveyor Block III spacecraft has a very good story. I don't know
how to answer him.
Hess strongly urged that the proposed single EVA be open-ended, lasting up
to three hours if all should go well, and carrying all the scientific instruments:
117
Where No Man Has Gone Before
experiments on the first landing and to make a firm announcement that the sec-
ond lunar landing would include a 35-hour stay, three EVAs, and the conduct
of the entire science program: collection of samples, deployment of the full pack-
age of surface experiments, and carrying out the field geology program. TM
118
Final Preparations: 1968
119
Where No Man Has Gone Before
A technician examines "Big Bertha," Apollo 14 lunar sample no. 14321 in the non-sterile nitrogen
atmosphere of a processing cabinet in the lunar receiving laboratory.
than 80 major and minor changes to the system and procedures before a full mis-
sion simulation could be conducted some time in early 1969. 26 MSC established
a configuration control board for the receiving laboratory to pass on proposed
changes and keep nonessential ones from proliferating37
By October 1968 sufficient progress had been made to conduct an operational
readiness inspection--a mandatory procedure for all MSC facilities. MSC Direc-
tor Robert R. Gilruth appointed a 10-person committee to review the facilities,
staffing, and operational plans38 After an initial meeting in early November and
a complete briefing two weeks later, committee members spent a month scrutiniz-
ing physical facilities, staffing and personnel training, and operational proce-
dures39 The committee's recommendations, submitted in mid-December, included
72 mandatory and 91 desirable changes necessary to render the laboratory accept-
able for operation. 3°
Preparations for a 30-day simulation of receiving laboratory operations,
scheduled for March and April, occupied most of the early months of 1969. In
the interim between the operational readiness inspection and the simulation,
laboratory staff and contractor employees worked to iron out the remaining
problems.
The receiving laboratory was only part of the scheme for preventing contami-
nation of the earth by alien organisms. Between the spacecraft floating on the
ORIGINAL PAGE
BLACK 120
AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Final Preparations: 1968
Sample
Processing Complex
Vacuum
Transfer Locks
Sketch of the layout of the vacuum processing complex in the lunar receiving laboratory. Phantom
units at left provided for expansion but were never actually built. Samples containers were passed
into the atmospheric decontamination system, through vacuum transfer locks, into the sample-
processing complex, where they were opened and their contents were examined and processed.
Pacific Ocean and the laboratory in Houston was a long chain of events that offered
several chances to contaminate the environment. Early in 1968, spurred by expres-
sions of concern by scientists outside the government, the Interagency Commit-
tee on Back Contamination (ICBC) revived the question of whether lunar con-
taminants could be completely prevented from escaping into the biosphere during
recovery operations, particularly between the floating command module and the
mobile quarantine facility aboard the recovery ship. For two years the committee
had been uneasy about this problem, and at its February meeting the chairman
opened the discussion once more. The committee asked MSC's landing and recov-
ery division to provide
Committee members also wanted details of MSC's contingency plans for bio-
logical containment in case the spacecraft came down outside the primary recov-
ery zone. 3_
These requests surprised Apollo officials at Houston, who thought those
questions had long been settled.Nonetheless, MSC engineers reviewed the sub-
jectagain at the June meeting of the ICBC, and the committee kept the contain-
121
Where No Man Has Gone Before
ment question on its agenda for further study. 32 At its October meeting the ICBC
reiterated its considered opinion that the recovery crew should attach some type
of biological filter to the spacecraft's post-landing ventilation valve, which circu-
lated air through the command module and exhausted it to the outside. When
this question had been raised two years before, MSC had demurred, warning
that an effective filter would reduce the efficiency of the ventilation system to
an unacceptable level and that attaching it to a floating spacecraft was too haz-
ardous to the recovery crew, especially in a rough sea. The committee insisted,
however, that development of a filter attachment with a supplemental fan should
be "energetically pursued to avoid what could be compromised and untoward
decisions."33
When these discussions came to the attention of MSC Director Robert R. Gilruth,
he asked for a detailed briefing on the situation and ordered another review of
the question. 34 Further discussions at MSC reaffirmed the center's basic position
that biological isolation garments for the crew (see Chapter 7) constituted the best
available containment in view of the difficulties presented by more secure meas-
ures. MSC officials did, however, propose to take more stringent precautions
against bringing lunar dust into the command module. 35 Preliminary discussions
of these procedures with an ad hoc committee of the ICBC produced tentative
agreement. 36
At the full committee meeting, however, agreement could not be reached. MSC
presented its plans for minimizing the transfer of lunar dust into the lunar mod-
ule and thence into the command module, which apparently mollified the ICBC
somewhat. But after reviewing the results of a simulation of Apollo 9, which had
included the use of the biological isolation garments and other phases of recov-
ery, the committee was convinced that recovery procedures allowed a breach of
containment that must be correctedY Dr. David Sencer, the ICBC chairman, then
wrote a strongly worded letter to Thomas O. Paine, newly appointed NASA
administrator,* expressing dismay over MSC's apparent failure to appreciate the
problem and make serious efforts to correct it. He pointed out that if recovery
procedures allowed lunar organisms to contaminate the earth, the rest of the
elaborate (and expensive) chain of quarantine was rendered useless and the space
agency would lay itself open to severe criticism by the public and the scientific
community. Sencer told Paine that the ICBC had considered recommending that
the first mission be delayed so the situation could be corrected, but had decided
instead to recommend that a filtration system for the command module be posi-
tively required on all future lunar missions--on the first, if possible, but only if
it would not delay the mission. The risk of contamination was acceptable only
if strict housekeeping procedures were enforced to minimize the amount of lunar
dust brought into the command module and if recovery teams were thoroughly
trained and required to observe contamination-control measures. 38
Sencer's letter produced immediate results. The questions were aired at a
Manned Space Flight Management Council meeting on April 9, after which Sam
Phillips directed Houston's spacecraft project manager, George Low, to begin
*Paine had been deputy administrator under James Webb since early 1968. When Webb retired
in October, Paine became acting administrator; he was appointed and confirmed as administrator
in March 1969.
122
i _ i"
J,
i!
Final Preparations: 1968
*The crew of Apollo 10, after testing the lunar module in lunar orbit, recommended against this proce-
dure. They believed it was unacceptably hazardous because in the cramped lunar module the body
movements involved could too easily result in contact with fragile areas, such as the windows. Their
recommendation was later accepted by the ICBC. Donald K. Slayton to Special Asst. to the Dir. and
Mgr., Apollo Spacecraft Program, "Suit Doffing in LM,'" June 2, 1969; Richard S. Johnston to Dir.,
Flight [Crew] Operations, same subj., June 11, 1969.
123
Where No Man Has Gone Before
The successful flight of Apollo 8 into lunar orbit during the Christmas season
of 1968 emphasized the fact that a lunar landing was fast approaching and that
preparations for back-contamination control were becoming critical. Headquar-
ters began to take a more active interest in the receiving laboratory and related
operations as 1969 began. Apollo program director Sam Phillips came to Hous-
ton in early February for a thorough review of containment from splashdown
to release from quarantine. 4s Ten days later George Mueller, whose Office of
Manned Space Flight had just been given full responsibility within NASA for
back-contamination control, brought a group of advisers from the regulatory agen-
cies to scrutinize Houston's preparations. 46 These advisers found the receiving
lab far from ready to handle a mission: equipment problems, a shortage of tech-
nicians, incompletely trained personnel, and deficient protocols for biological test-
ing all required work. 47
These and other deficiencies were expected to surface during a month-long dress
rehearsal of laboratory operations scheduled to start March 3. This exercise could
not exactly simulate every detail of operations because of equipment limitations,
but it would come as close as possible. During the second week a simulation of
recovery operations would be run in connection with the flight of Apollo 9, to
evaluate the transfer of astronauts from the recovery ship to the mobile quarantine
facility and then to the crew reception area of the lunar receiving laboratory. 4s
Expectations were borne out by the results of the simulation. Scores of faults,
most of them minor but some of them critical, emerged in both equipment and
procedures. 49 Among the more serious problems was contamination of the first
work station--the vacuum chamber in which the lunar sample containers were
opened. Somehow minute traces of organic matter had found their way into the
system, threatening to vitiate the search for indigenous organic material in the
samples. Worse yet, the level of contamination was not constant, so the investi-
gators could not correct their findings for it. When it appeared that the contami-
nation came from the vacuum pumping system, investigators began to consider
alternatives to opening the sample containers under vacuum to keep the lunar
material in pristine condition. The best choice seemed to be to fill the chamber
124
1
Final Preparations: 1968
with a gas (sterile nitrogen) that would not interfere with subsequent analyses. 5o
The receiving laboratory staff continued to work on the many details of labora-
tory operation throughout the spring. Progress continued toward certification of
the quarantine facilities and back-contamination procedures, sl By the time the
interagency committee met on June 5, MSC had completed action on most of the
outstanding questions and the committee granted certification of the lunar receiv-
ing laboratory as a biological containment facility. 52 The launch of Apollo 11 was
only five weeks away when another mission simulation got under way in the
laboratory, with only minor technical problems remaining to be worked out. 53
Considering the technical sophistication of the receiving laboratory and the rig-
orous procedures for handling the lunar samples, it is hardly surprising that prob-
lems persisted as long as they did. Management arrangements contributed as
well; the outside scientists who were intimately involved in examination and dis-
tribution of the samples could not spend full time at MSC, making continuity
of activity more difficult. Wilmot Hess was sensitive to the need for close cooper-
ation between MSC and the outside scientific community, and the relationships
established in the two years before the first landing went a long way toward
alleviating the problem.
Quarantine and back-contamination control added to the overall complexity.
Without a doubt, most engineers and lunar scientists at MSC took the back-
contamination problem much less seriously than did the interagency committee--
which, unfortunately for the engineers, had the authority to impose its require-
ments on the program. The reemergence in early 1969 of concern with back-
contamination during recovery operations can be attributed to the committee's
perception that MSC was not cooperating to solve the problem because the
engineers considered it unimportant.S4 In the end, the committee yielded at least
as much as the engineers on the question of biological containment, but it required
considerable effort and tactful interaction with the committee to produce that
result.
The start of operations in the receiving laboratory coincided with a period of
retrenchment in NASA, and technical difficulties were compounded by person-
nel problems. Rising budget deficits in the last two years of Lyndon Johnson's
administration had alarmed Congress and put a real squeeze on federal programs,
not excepting NASA's. Apollo suffered less than other programs, 55 but it was
not completely immune to economy measures. Ever since authorization hearings
began in early 1968 the field centers had been under pressure to reduce expendi-
tures and cut staff. 56 MSC's inability to add professional staff in the receiving
laboratory affected more than just the science. Four months before Apollo 11 flew,
the Office of Manned Space Flight's operations forecast for 1969 showed lunar
landing missions being launched at two- to three-month intervals after the first.
Gilruth took exception, however, advising Headquarters that, with its current
complement of professionals, the lunar receiving laboratory could support a lunar
mission only once every four months and that only if all went well during each
quarantine period. 57The laboratory had enough professional staff to operate only
two fully productive shifts a day; a third "holding shift" was manned principally
by technicians, who maintained the laboratory but did not continue processing
the samples. 58
125
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Landing site evaluation had begun as soon as photographs from the first Lunar
Orbiters became available (see Chapter 6). By March 1967 MSC's Lunar and Earth
Sciences Division had prepared a short list of candidate sites,* which it presented
to the Apollo Site Selection Board. Operational considerations predominated at
this stage of planning; the sites were all within the "'Apollo zone of interest"
(5 degrees north to 5 degrees south latitude, 45 degrees east to 45 degrees west
longitude) and appeared from the Orbiter photographs to be comparatively level
and smooth. MSC recommended that sites for the first landing be chosen from
that list by August 1. The board accepted that recommendation.61 For the rest of
the year the Apollo Site Selection Board worked steadily, with input from Bell-
NASA-S-67-6938
SET B MISSION I
APOLLO ZONE OF INTEREST
Eight lunar landing sites recommended by MSC in March 1967for further evaluation. Sites selected
from Lunar Orbiter photographs were designated primary (P) or secondary (S) according to apparent
merit; "II P-6" was the sixth primary site chosen from the Lunar Orbiter II photographs.
*"Landing sites," as somewhat loosely used in the following discussion, corresponds more nearly
to the "landing areas" previously mentioned (Chap. 6). However, within the larger areas studied,
MSC evaluators did examine several specific landing ellipses--"sites," in the sense that term was
used before.
ORIGINAL PAGE
126
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
ORIGINAL PAGE
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH Final Preparations: 1968
comm, the Jet Propulsion Laboratory, the U.S. Geological Survey, and the Group
for Lunar Exploration Planning, evaluating additional photographs from Lunar
Orbiters as they became available.* Meanwhile MSC continued to study the
operational constraints of its chosen sites; planners were mainly concerned with
slopes and irregularities in the terrain along the approaches to the sites, which
could interfere with the lunar module's landing radar. The data necessary to make
the final choice of sites (principally topographic maps) were slow in coming,
however, and MSC could not meet the August 1 date it had proposed. 62 Instead
the site selection board met at Houston on December 15 to decide on sites for the
first two missions and to lay out a schedule for future activities.
MSC presented the results of its studies on approach paths, which showed that
all the "Set B'" sites were acceptable. Simulations showed that the lunar mod-
ule's landing radar could guide the spacecraft to a landing at any of the eight
sites. A considerable part of the discussion dealt with the number of sites to be
retained in planning for each mission. At this stage no one could be sure that
every mission would be launched on time. If a technical malfunction caused a
countdown to be stopped, up to 66 hours' delay in launching might be neces-
Five lunar landing sites from set B (p. 126) recommended by MSC in December 1967for the first
landing mission.
*Lunar Orbiters III, /V, and V, launched on Feb. 4, May 4, and Aug. 1, 1967, all returned photo-
graphs used in Apollo landing site selection. Four more Surveyors were landed by early 1968 as well;
although they were mainly equipped for scientific studies, they also provided Apollo with useful
data on properties of lunar soil.
127
Where No Man Has Gone Before
sary, in which case a more westerly landing site would have to be substituted
for the original. This entailed complications in other aspects of mission
preparation--it required the astronauts to become familiar with three different
landing approaches and geologic areas, for example, and increased the require-
ments for maps and other data--but the alternative was to postpone the launch
for at least a month. 63
After summing up the detailed evaluations, John E. Eggleston, chief of MSC's
Lunar and Earth Sciences Division, recommended five of the best sites ("Set C")
for the first landing mission and another six for the second, which the board
approved. 64 Eggleston and Wilmot Hess, chief of MSC's Science and Applica-
tions Directorate, then directed the board's attention to the need to begin evalu-
ating sites for the third and subsequent missions. Landing areas topographically
different from those already chosen should be examined. Evaluation of highland
sites in or near the Apollo zone should be started. Board chairman Sam Phillips
agreed in principle that the third mission could be more ambitious, but he advised
planners to stay on the conservative side for the time being and look for science
targets in the areas covered by the Set B sites. A U.S. Geologic Survey represen-
tative suggested that in some cases shifting the landing point only a few kilome-
ters within a selected area would bring the astronaut-explorers within walking
distance of some scientifically interesting features. He also pointed out that if the
first landing was made in an eastern mare the second should be targeted to a
western one, since maria showed different characteristics in the two regions. 6s
From early 1968 onward the site selection teams would get only limited addi-
tional lunar photography, since after the fifth* no more Orbiters would be flown.
Orbiter photographic coverage, however, was not comprehensive; it did not cover
every interesting site with sufficient resolution to permit detailed evaluation. Until
the middle of 1967 the Office of Manned Space Flight was planning to fly an
advanced lunar mapping and survey system that would furnish more detailed
coverage of a greater portion of the lunar surface; but in August its potential value
to Apollo was judged to be marginal and its further development was canceled
to save money. _ The following March, however, Sam Phillips noted a continu-
ing need for lunar photography and asked MSC to consider how it might be
provided by astronauts in lunar orbit on scheduled Apollo flights. 67 Houston
enumerated several types of cameras and film that could be useful in site selec-
tion and in lunar cartography, and scientific interpretation as well. 68 Planning
was started for a considerable amount of lunar surface photography, including
candidate sites for future landings, to be conducted on every manned lunar
mission.
As 1967 ended, the short list of sites for the first manned lunar landing had
been approved and a longer list for the second mission had been tentatively
*Launched Aug. 1, 1967, Lunar Orbiter V completed its photographic mission on Aug. 18 and crashed
into the moon Jan 31, 1968.
128
ORIGINAL PAGE
BLACK AND WHITE PHOrOGRAPH Final Preparations: 1968
selected. The site selection board would continue to work with flight planners
and scientists to narrow down the choices. Meanwhile, as evidenced by the com-
ments of Eggleston and Hess at the December meeting of the site selection board,
attention was shifting to planning for the later missions.
As early as April 1967, the Manned Spacecraft Center's Science and Applica-
tions Directorate had put together a plan for lunar scientific exploration, to iden-
tify the scientific observations essential to basic understanding of the moon. As
guideIines, the review used the fifteen scientific questions about the moon for-
mulated by the Woods Hole summer study of 1965 (see Appendix 3). The plan
envisioned eight manned lunar missions, including one orbital mission which
would take photographs and gather data with remote sensors, arranged in a log-
ical geological sequence and spaced to allow scientists to digest the results of each
mission before executing the next. No more than three landings in the "Apollo
zone" were contemplated, and a highland area rather than a mare might be con-
sidered as early as the third landing. Both geological exploration by the astronauts
and emplacement of instruments for long-term data collection were contemplated.
The plan concluded that each mission should stay long enough to accomplish
the scientific tasks planned for it; there was no point in staying 14 days unless
the extra time could be put to good use. Short-range mobility aids for the
astronauts, such as a one-man flying vehicle, would be necessary for later
missions, but there was no real need for a vehicle that could cover hundreds of
kilometers .69
The MSC plan was partly an effort to focus local attention on hardware and
mission planning requirements for the later scientific flights, partly a contribu-
tion to higher-level agency planning. Throughout 1967 a joint study team from
SITE
IDENTIFICATION
NUMBER
l ABULFEDA
2 ALPHONSUS
3* APOLLO 2
4 APOLLO 3
5 APOLLO 4
6 ''_ APOLLO 5,
7"'" APOLLO 6R [PLA/ViSTEED p)
8' APOLLO 7
9 ARISTARCHUS PLATEAU
10' NORTHWEST OF CENSORINUS
f I" COPERNICUS PEAKS
12 COPERNICUS CD
13" DESCARTES
14 DIONYSIUS
15" FRA MAURO FM
16 GASSENDI _WEST_
17 OASSENDI (EAST _
18 GAUDIBERT A
19" HADLEY RILLE
20 HtPPARCHUS
21'" HYGINUS
22* LITTROW AREA
23" MARIUS HILLS
24 M_STtNG C ---
25 RIMA BODE II =
26 RIMA PRINZ I
27 SCH R(_TER'S VALLEY
28 SOUTH OF ALEXANDER
29 TOBIAS MAYER
30" NORTH OF TYCHO
31'* DAVY RILLE
32 *_ LALANDE
*PRIME SITE
• *ALTERNATE SITE
"" 'RECYCLE SITE
129
Where No Man Has Gone Before
the Offices of Manned Space Flight and Space Science and Applications in Head-
quarters had been working on the same question, in collaboration with Wilmot
Hess and the Group for Lunar Exploration Planning (formed after the 1967 Santa
Cruz conference; see Chapter 7). 70In February 1968 Headquarters issued its own
lunar exploration plan through the new Apollo Lunar Exploration Office. This
plan, more comprehensive than MSC's, outlined a strategy for lunar exploration
including and extending beyond currently planned Apollo missions.
Headquarters" strategy called for a combination of orbital and surface missions
to photograph and map structural features of interest and collect representative
samples, emplace a network of geophysical instruments for long-term monitor-
ing of the moon, and carry out long-range traverses to link local and regional
studies together. The lunar exploration program would be evolutionary, stress-
ing initial use of existing equipment, extending its useful life, and introducing
new developments as required. Desirable modifications included upgrading the
Saturn V to increase its lunar payload by 12 to 15 percent; extending power and
life-support systems on the lunar module to support astronauts for three days
on the moon; and reducing the lander's conservative propulsion allocations, as
experience warranted, to increase scientific payload. 71
The plan projected several new developments to extend the range of explora-
tion and increase the amount of useful work the astronauts could perform: one-
man flying units, a small roving vehicle, a local scientific survey module with
longer range that could be operated remotely, and a dual-launch system using
two Saturn Vs. The second (unmanned) booster of a dual-launch mission could
carry either a lunar payload module providing extra scientific equipment or an
extended lunar module with additional expendables for life support, to be landed
at the selected exploration site. The proposed schedule called for introducing the
extended lunar module, which could support three-day stays on the moon and
would carry short-range mobility aids, by mid-1971. Thereafter no more than two
missions per year should be flown, new capabilities being added as early as pos-
sible within budgetary limitations. Sites for nine missions of special scientific
interest requiring systematic increases in mission capability were described in an
appendix. ,72
Estimates of what such a program would cost were necessarily tentative, but
the report calculated upper and lower limits based on current assumptions about
production of Saturn Vs and spacecraft. Over the next eight fiscal years, new
payloads and additional spacecraft and launch vehicles would cost from $4.20
billion to $5.54 billion, depending on which Apollo mission made the first land-
ing. Funding was expected to peak in fiscal 1972 at $1 billion to $1.3 billion. 73
Lee Scherer, head of the Lunar Exploration Program Office, toured NASA instal-
lations in March to brief center officials of the plan. His first stop was in Hous-
ton, and afterwards MSC Director Robert Gilruth offered his center's comments
to George Mueller, calling the plan "thoughtfully developed, well integrated,
*The sites, identified by the names of nearby craters or other physical features, were: Censorinus,
Littrow, Abulfeda, Hyginus, Appenine front-Hadley Rille, Tycho, Schroeter's Valley, Marius Hills,
and Copernicus. Hadley Rille and a site near Littrow were visited by 3-day Apollo missions.
130
FinalPreparations: 1968
[and] unified." His sole reservation was that the funds provided for the next year
seemed inadequate to make a real start immediately:
I believe the FY 1969 budget requested should be increased to the amount that
can be spent wisely to initiate procurement activities to support the program.
Without additional monies early, the proposed flight dates will be very diffi-
cult to achieve. More serious, however, the impression may be created that
the program can wait another year to really get started. TM
A month later Gilruth again urged that Mueller start development for the
advanced Apollo missions. Reminding MueUer of the President's Science Advi-
sory Committee's public statement* that only two or three lunar landing missions
with the basic Apollo systems could be justified, Gilruth emphasized that
additional stay time, mobility, and scientific payload are considered essential
for later missions to produce adequate scientific payload to justify the mis-
sion .... In order to obtain the increased capabilities.., a small but signifi-
cant amount of funds must be committed in FY 1969.
Both the lunar flying unit and the extended lunar module could benefit from
additional funds in the current fiscal year. Acknowledging a general reluctance
in Headquarters to propose "new starts" (projects not already approved by Con-
gress for Apollo), Gilruth nonetheless urged Mueller to start on an unmanned
logistic support system.** Should development be postponed, he said,
it appears to us that the alternatives to significantly more money for lunar explo-
ration.., in FY 1969 will all be very embarrassing to NASA in 1971.
If the longer, more productive missions could not be conducted because the
systems had not yet been developed, the choices might all be unattractive: dual
missions of standard Apollo equipment at excessive expense, single Apollo mis-
sions of limited productivity--certain to draw criticism from the scientists--or inter-
vals of a year or more between launches, which would make it difficult to maintain
launch capability at the Cape. 7s
Mueller had presented the basic lunar exploration plan to the House Manned
Space Flight subcommittee earlier in February, but with no details of schedule
or budget. It had provoked little discussion. About a logistic support system, he
said only that it continued to be an objective and that studies would continue
to determine the best way to carry larger scientific payloads and support longer
stays on the lunar surface, r6
If anyone had reason to be pleased with the lunar exploration plan, the lunar
scientists did. To provide scientific advice to Scherer's planners, the Group for
Lunar Exploration Planning had met for two days in January 1968 to create a list
of recommendations based on the conclusions of the Santa Cruz conference the
*In its report, TheSpaceProgramin the Post-ApolloPeriod, published in February 1967; see Chapter 7.
*'In 1962 Joseph Shea, Deputy Director for Systems in the Office of Manned Space Flight, had
helped to secure Wernher von Braun's support for lunar orbit rendezvous by suggesting that Marshall
Space Flight Center develop a logistic support system and a lunar roving vehicle; see Courtney G.
Brooks, James M. Grimwood, and Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., Chariotsfor Apollo, NASA SP-4205 (Washing-
ton, 1979), pp. 80--81.
131
WhereNo ManHasGoneBefore
previous summer. The plan issued in February incorporated virtually every major
recommendation they made--the extended lunar module, the lunar flying unit,
and the logistic support system--and included the most favored science sitesd v
Extended lunar exploration would not be delayed by lack of cooperation at the
Manned Spacecraft Center. Gilruth's recorded reaction to the plan seems to show
that Houston was ready to participate fully in conducting it. But at Headquarters
George Mueller seemed less eager to move rapidly. Mueller had many other prob-
lems in 1968; the Saturn V had not yet been fully qualified, and both the com-
mand module and lunar module had problems yet to be solved. 78 Against that
background, Mueller was not in a hurry to seek approval of plans to modify the
lunar spacecraft before the principal objective had been achieved. At the same
time he was working hard to establish a post-ApoUo program that Congress would
support. 79
132
Final Preparations: 1968
It had to be done sooner or later, and as more than one official mentioned dur-
ing the planning discussions, it was essential to assuring a successful lunar land-
ing by the end of 1969. Yet the decision to send men to the moon on the Saturn
V's third flight seems almost breathtaking. The flight record of the big booster
at the time (two flights, one completely successful, the other plagued by mal-
functions) was enough to give managers pause; and the risks to be taken on a
lunar mission were far more serious than those of an earth-orbital mission. Still,
among NASA officials and Apollo contractor executives, no serious doubts were
raised about sending Apollo 8 to the moon at the end of 1968. 8s
The first men ever to see the moon at close range, Frank Borman, James A.
Lovell, Jr., and William A. Anders, left Launch Complex 39A at Kennedy Space
Center early in the morning of December 21, 1968, aboard Apollo command mod-
ule 103. Four days later they fired their main propulsion engine and the space-
craft became a captive of the moon's gravity, in an elliptical orbit which they later
changed to a near-circular orbit 60 nautical miles (111 kilometers) above the sur-
face. For the next 20 hours they took photographs, relayed their visual observa-
tions and descriptions of the topography back to Mission Control, and gave
viewers on Earth spectacular television views of the moon and of their home
planet. On Christmas day in the early morning, at the end of the 10th trip around
the moon, they fired the service module engine once more to return to Earth.
The success of this maneuver prompted Lovell to notify Houston, "Please be
informed there is a Santa Claus."a4 Had it failed, he and his crewmates would
have remained where they were, circling the moon until their oxygen ran out.
The space program was spared that grisly possibility, however, and the propul-
sion bum was so accurate that only one of three planned course-correction maneu-
vers had to be conducted on the way back--an adjustment of 4.8 feet per second
(1.5 meters per second). After an uneventful return trip, they splashed down
before dawn on December 27 in the Pacific Ocean, less than three miles (4.8 kilo-
meters) from the recovery ship. as
As the climax of nearly two years of painful recovery from the tragedy of AS-204,
Apollo 8 was a triumph the American space program badly needed. It not only
restored the prestige of NASA and boosted the morale of the entire Apollo work
force, it provided the confidence in spacecraft and ground-support systems that
no other, less daring, mission could have provided. About all that remained before
the first l_nding was to prove that the lunar module could carry out its part of
the mission; two flights in 1969 would test that last important link in the system.
Besides its operational tasks, Apollo 8 had some photographic assignments that
would give flight planners additional information about potential landing sites
and settle important questions about the use of landmarks to determine the
spacecraft's position. Overlapping vertical and oblique photographs were taken
to determine the elevation and geographical position of features on the far side,
information needed for accurate determination of the lunar module's position
before it descended for a landing (see Chapter 6). The crew was also given a list
of photographic targets of opportunity, selected from sites of scientific interest,
to supplement the imagery from Lunar Orbiter IV. Although the photographic
objectives were not completely fulfilled, the pictures returned by Apollo 8 added
considerably to the store of knowledge about lunar surface features. 86
133
WhereNo ManHas Gone Before
Equally valuable were the crew's visual observations of landmarks and poten-
tial landing sites. Their reports on the sharpness of landmarks, the ease of locat-
ing them, and the topographic details that could be seen from 60 nautical miles,
reduced many of the uncertainties about what a lunar landing crew might be able
to do by eye. Among other things, Borman's crew determined that lighting con-
straints (the allowable sun angle for optimum visibility) were on the conserva-
tive side; they found no difficulty in observing surface details at sun angles of
2 to 3 degrees, considerably less than the 6 degrees adopted as a lower limit. They
reported that the maps and photographs they carried, together with last-minute
instructions from the ground, were adequate for locating surface features. 87
The Apollo 8 crew was still debriefing when 1969 came around, the last year
of the decade set by John Kennedy for accomplishing the manned lunar landing
and return. Early projections of the 1969 launch schedule called for five missions,
spaced just over two months apart. 88 The progress made in 1968 suggested that
most preparations for the first landing could be made sometime during the year.
Of the major components of the Apollo system, only the lunar module remained
to be checked out.
For the most part, science had yielded to operations during the year. To pro-
vide some leeway for increases in the weight of the lunar module, and to avoid
overtaxing the astronauts on a mission that still contained many unknowns, the
lunar surface experiments had been simplified. The original "ALSEP" (Apollo
lunar surface experiments package) had been reduced to an "EASEP" (early
Apollo scientific experiments package). Enough suitable landing sites had been
picked to provide alternatives in case of launch delays, increasing the chances
of launching a mission during a given month's opportunity in spite of any tech-
nical problems that might halt the countdown before liftoff. But the sites were
chosen for maximum probability of successful landing, not for their immediate
scientific interest. Even so, no one would argue that whatever samples of lunar
material the first astronauts were able to return would not be of extraordina D'
interest to scientists.
But if science yielded to operational considerations, it received in return the
assurance that missions after the second--perhaps after the first--would include
as much science as the system could accommodate. The organizational mecha-
nism was in place and functioning to assure that mission plans encompassed scien-
tific objectives as far as possible. If the first landing attempt should be successful,
enough launch vehicles and spacecraft were in the pipeline to conduct nine more
landings. Project officials at the Manned Spacecraft Center were ready to extend
the duration of missions as much as the hardware would allow without major
redesign and were urging Headquarters to start work on mobility aids, to extend
the range an astronaut could cover on the moon. As soon as they had the opera-
tional experience to justify it, MSC managers were willing to do more than merely
land a human on the moon and return him safely to earth.
134
9
Crews for the early Apollo manned missions were named in 1966, but their
assignments were canceled after the spacecraft fire in January 1967. Mission-
specific training languished for a while, but in early May 1967 the crew of Apollo
7 was selected and began preparing for their earth-orbital mission. Deke Slay-
ton, director of flight crew operations at MSC, expedited training by assigning
a third group of astronauts (a support crew) to each flight (see Appendix 6). The
support crew assisted the prime and backup crews in training, doing a great deal
of necessary but time-consuming work: maintaining the flight data file (flight plan,
check lists, and mission ground rules); keeping the prime and backup crews
advised of all changes; helping training officers to work out procedures on the
simulators before the prime crews used them; and generally taking a load of details
off the prime and backup crews.1 Experience and seniority appeared to be the
major factors in Slayton's choice of crews. For the first three missions, prime and
backup crews were chosen from the first three groups of pilots selected; all com-
manders had flight experience in Gemini. Support crewmen were all from the
fourth group of pilots. 2 The scientist-astronauts, who ranked fourth in seniority
but last in experience, had varied assignments, participating in design reviews
and preflight tests and working on plans for Apollo Applications experiments;
geologist Jack Schmitt spent much of his time working on site selection. 3
George Mueller was making ambitious projections for the Apollo Applications
Program in 1966, and if they developed, more scientists would be needed for its
crews. In September 1966 the National Academy of Sciences and NASA
announced that applications for a second group of scientist-astronauts would be
accepted (see Chapter 5). Nearly a thousand hopefuls applied; the Academy's
selection committee forwarded 69 names to NASA in March 1967, and five months
later 11 new astronaut trainees, 9 Ph.D.s and 2 M.D.s, were named (see Appen-
dix 6). The group contained not a single qualified pilot; after six months of orien-
tation and basic "ground school" training at MSC, they would all be sent to Air
Force flight training. 4
Addition of this class of candidates brought the astronaut corps to a strength
of 56--more than Apollo seemed to need, since no more than 10 lunar missions
135
Where No Man Has Gone Before
were contemplated.* The qualifications of the new group--who were mostly phys-
icists, astronomers, or physicians, not earth scientists--suggests that MSC was
preparing for Apollo Applications missions rather than lunar exploration. When
they were chosen in mid-1967, however, even that prospect was growing dim
and would be dimmer yet by the time they had finished flight training. Head-
quarters program officials continued to talk of frequent Apollo Applications mis-
sions, s and Slayton had to be prepared to supply crews for whatever missions
should be assigned and to anticipate some degree of attrition. On the other hand,
if the program did not materialize as planned, the astronaut corps would be over-
staffed and many aspiring space explorers would have small chance of flying in
space. That could be an especially touchy point with scientists, who risked their
careers by enlisting as astronauts.** In interviews with the scientist applicants,
Slayton tried not to raise their expectations about the availability of flight assign-
ments, to the point of frankly admitting that the astronaut corps had no urgent
need for them at the moment. With that understanding, however, they were wel-
come in Houston, because the astronaut corps needed all kinds of talent to sup-
port MSC's missions. 6 Members of the new group soon dubbed themselves "The
Excess Eleven," or "XSXI."
Crews for both Apollo 9 and Apollo 10 were in training as 1969 began; on Janu-
ary 9 a third was named, for Apollo 11. Since November 1967 the prime crew
of Apollo 9-James A. McDivitt, David R. Scott, and Russell L. Schweickart--
had been following their spacecraft through assembly and rehearsing the com-
plex procedures of orbital rendezvous. Both McDivitt (who came in with the sec-
ond group of astronauts) and Scott were veterans, each having flown a Gemini
mission that had paved the way for rendezvous and docking operations.
Schweickart, like Scott, was a "Fourteen" (third group); he had not yet flown
a mission but had participated extensively in the development testing of the space
suit. The crew of Apollo 10, named on November 12, 1968, was the first in the
entire manned space flight program composed entirely of experienced astronauts:
Thomas P. Stafford, John W. Young, and Eugene A. Cernan. Stafford, the first
of his class to fly two orbital missions, and Young, who had also flown twice,
were from the second astronaut class; Cernan, from the third group, had a sin-
gle flight. They were also the first crew to be promoted as a unit, having served
as backup crew on Apollo 7. The crew for Apollo 11, also all veterans, consisted
*Given Slayton's system of promoting a backup crew to prime crew three missions later, and assum-
ing that no crewman would be assigned to more than one mission in any capacity, 10 lunar missions
would have required 55 astronauts (if support crews later became backup and prime crews). Slay-
ton's preference for flight experience in crew members, however, makes that assumption questiona-
ble; hence fewer astronauts could have filled the positions on prime, backup, and support crews.
On the 7 lunar landing missions flown, 39 astronauts filled 63 available crew positions.
**So did the pilot-astronauts, for that matter, but provision was made for them to keep their profes-
sional skills (flying) well honed as part of the program. The scientists enjoyed no such concession,
as was repeatedly pointed out by NASA's outside scientific consultants.
136
Primary Mission Accomplished: 1969
of Nell A. Armstrong from the second group and Edwin E. ("Buzz") Aldrin, Jr.,
and Michael Collins from the third. Armstrong and Aldrin had been on the backup
crew for Apollo 8; the third member of that crew, Fred W. Haise, was replaced
by Collins on the flight crew because Deke Slayton wanted an experienced pilot
in the command module for Apollo 11, which, if all went well, would most likely
be the first mission to attempt a lunar landing. 7
The success of Apollo 8 left only the qualification of the lunar module to be accom-
plished before a lunar landing could be attempted. In the alphabetical sequence
of missions adopted a year before (see Chapter 7), the next mission ("D") was
to fly both the command/service module and the lunar module, to check out all
LM systems and rendezvous techniques in earth orbit. This, according to 1967
plans, would be followed by missions "E" (combined CSM/LM operations in
high earth orbit, later discarded in favor of the "C-prime" mission, Apollo 8,
which did not carry a lunar module) and "F" (all operational procedures of a
landing mission except the actual landing). On the "F" mission the crew would
take the lunar module down to 50,000 feet (15,240 meters) above the moon, get
as good a look as possible at the proposed landing site for the first mission, and
return to lunar orbit for rendezvous with the command module, a
Mission "D'" (Apollo 9) would be the most complex yet flown, involving the
checkout of two spacecraft at the Cape and simultaneous operations with two
vehicles in orbit. An additional objective was operational checkout of the extra-
vehicular space suit and the portable life-support system that lunar explorers
would use on the moon's surface2
Apollo 9 was launched on March 3, 1969, for 10 busy days of operations. After
extracting their lunar module from the S-IVB stage, McDivitt and his crewmates
performed numerous tests of the engines on both modules, assessing the dynamic
behavior of the linked spacecraft as well as the performance of the propulsion
systems. On the third day they separated the vehicles and began independent
operations, testing the LM systems, and carrying out a complete docking maneu-
ver, all successfully. Schweickart's tests of the extravehicular space suit and life-
support system were equally gratifying. The most serious anomaly on the flight
was the appearance of motion sickness, which had also affected Apollo 8"s crew.
Schweickart vomited twice and Scott reported being on the verge of nausea for
considerable time after reaching orbit. Some tasks had to be cut short on this
account, but even so, all the primary mission objectives were satisfied. The Apollo
9 command module came down on March 13 within three miles (4.8 kilometers)
of the target point in the western Atlantic. x°
Two months later, launch operations crews at Kennedy Space Center were get-
ting ready for the final countdown for Saturn no. 505, the launch vehicle for Apollo
10. This mission was to "confirm all aspects of the lunar landing mission exactly
as it would be performed, except for the actual descent, landing, lunar stay, and
ascent from the lunar surface." Besides giving the entire mission support team
one more workout, it would also allow the manned space flight network to track
the spacecraft as it orbited the moon, to provide a more accurate description of
the irregular lunar gravitational field. .11 On May 18, the big booster sent CSM
*Analysis of irregularities in the orbits of Lunar Orbiter IV had revealed gravity anomalies attributed
to concentrations of mass ("mascons") at certain locations on the moon; they were sufficiently large
137
Where No Man Has Gone Before
to deflect the path of a lunar module. Results from Apollo 10 would be helpful in developing the
capability to land precisely at a targeted spot, which mission planners considered essential for the
later missions.
ORIGINAl: PAGE
138
BLACK AND MTH1TE PHOTOGRAPH
i
Primary Mission Accomplished: 1969
106 and lunar module LM-4, with Tom Stafford and his crew aboard, toward the
moon on a near-perfect trajectory--one designed to duplicate the path to be taken
by the first landing mission. Indicative of the pace of the program in early 1969,
even before Apollo 10 reached the moon, Cape crews trundled out Saturn 506,
the Apollo 11 launch vehicle, to Launch Complex 39A and began preparing it
for its epoch-making flight. 12
Stafford, Cernan, and Young carried out their pathfinding mission with remark-
ably few problems. On the fifth day the lunar module separated from the com-
mand module to photograph the approach path, verify the operation of the
landing radar, and survey the first landing site* from low altitude. They reported
that the landing radar worked as advertised and that the first astronauts to attempt
a lunar landing should have no problems finding a smooth level spot in the east-
ern end of the site; farther west, however, they might have to maneuver to find
a boulder- and crater-free area to touch down. That evaluation completed, Stafford
and Cernan took their lunar module back into orbit, checking out the abort gui-
dance system as they left low orbit. After rejoining John Young in the command
module they headed back to earth, splashing down on May 26 in the Pacific Ocean
some 400 miles (650 kilometers) east of Pago Pago. 13
As backup crew for Apollo 8 since late 1968, the prime crew of Apollo 11 had
already rehearsed many of the procedures for a lunar mission; but as the first
crew that would attempt a lunar landing, they had to prepare for much more.
From January 9, when they were named, until launch day their days were filled
with activity: briefings on all the spacecraft systems, fitting of spacesuits, lessons
in geology and astronavigation, rehearsal of procedures for rendezvous, practic-
ing unloading the lunar surface experiments, and whatever else the training
officers could squeeze into their schedule. For some time they had little access
to their primary training devices, the lunar module and command module simu-
lators. Until March, when Apollo 9 flew, they were third in line for those simula-
tors, and only after Apollo 10 was launched in May did they have first priority, s'
For Neil Armstrong and Buzz Aldrin and their counterparts in the backup crew,
practicing the lunar landing itself was among the most important parts of train-
ing. The lunar module pilots used a simulator built for the purpose by engineers
at Langley Research Center in Virginia. It consisted of a mockup of the lunar mod-
ule, suspended by cables from a long overhead trestle so that all but one-sixth
of its weight was neutralized. Since it did not provide complete freedom of move-
ment in all three directions, the Langley device was inferior as a lunar-module
simulator to the vehicle on which the mission commanders trained. 15 This free-
flying lunar landing training vehicle (LLTV), developed at the Flight Research
Center in California and built by Bell Aerosystems, was a skeleton framework
of tubing supporting a control station, fitted in the center with a downward-
thrusting jet engine to offset five-sixths of its weight and on the periphery of the
*Site IIP-6 (see Chapter 8), iust north of the equator in the southwestern part of Mare Tranquillitatis.
139
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Pete Conrad practices lunar landing in the lunar landing training vehicle (LLTV).
structure with a group of small thrusters to provide attitude and directional con-
trol. It was a skittish and somewhat unstable vehicle; on two occasions in 1968
pilots had to eject from it. 16 Nonetheless, it was the only device that could
accurately simulate the last few hundred feet of the lunar landing approach and
commanders of lunar landing missions and their backups were required to per-
form as many landings in the LLTV as time permitted. TM
The crews went through many rehearsals of the lunar surface activity--
deploying the experiments and collecting surface samples--during the last few
months of training, but they were given comparatively little refresher work in
field geology. The last formal geology briefings for the Apollo 11 crew came in
mid-April. 18As launch came closer, Armstrong became concerned about collect-
ing samples and making scientific observations. When he expressed his fear that
he might do something wrong, MSC geologist Elbert King emphasized that every-
thing he said and every specimen he collected would be valuable, simply because
he would be the first man ever to make scientific observations on the lunar sur-
ORIGINAL PAGE
140
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
ORIGINAL PAGE Primary Mission Accomplished: 1969
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
face. King's advice was not to worry about making mistakes. If he talked as much
as possible about what he saw and collected all the samples he could, no reasona-
ble scientist could fault his efforts39
By the time the Apollo 10 crew left on their mission and the crew of Apollo
11 could get first priority on the simulators, training had become the "pacing
item" in the launch schedule. 2° Throughout May and June the spacecraft and
its launch vehicle went through preflight preparations with no major problems,
141
Where No Man Has Gone Before
staying on schedule for a July 16 launch, while crews spent long hours in the
simulators. 21 When the White House proffered an invitation for the Apollo 10
and Apollo 11 crews to dine with the President, Deke Slayton was obliged to
notify Headquarters that taking one day out of the training regimen was likely to
cost a month's delay in launch. 22 On June 9 the photomosaics of their landing
site were delivered to the Cape so that Armstrong and Aldrin could practice the
approach to their touchdown point in the lunar module simulator23 Armstrong
completed his required flights in the lunar landing training vehicle on June 16. 24
The final days wound down without major interruption, however. The Lunar
Receiving Laboratory was certified by the Interagency Committee on Back Con-
tamination, two mobile quarantine facilities--including a spare, just in case--
were delivered to the recovery ship, and it appeared that humans would indeed
attempt a lunar landing as scheduled. 2s
At 9:32 a.m. Eastern daylight time on July 16, 1969, Apollo 11 left Launch Com-
plex 39A at Kennedy Space Center, bound for the moon. Four days later, at 4:18
p.m. EDT on July 20, Neil Armstrong skillfully set the lunar module Eagle down
in the Sea of Tranquility and reported, "Houston, Tranquility Base here. The Eagle
has landed."26 For the next 10 minutes Armstrong and Aldrin were occupied with
several post-landing procedures, reconfiguring switches and systems. Armstrong
found time to report to Mission Control what he had been too busy to tell them
"The Eagle has wings?" said Nell Armstrong as the lunar module Eagle pulled away from command
module Columbia, on its way to the first manned lunar landing. Armstrong turned Eagle around so
that Mike Collins in Columbia could examine it for possible problems. Three long probes signaled
contact with the lunar surface just before touchdown.
ORIGINAL PAGE
B__A_.K AND \kIHITE PHOTOGRAPIq 142
Primary Mission Accomplished: 1969
during the landing: that he had manually flown the lunar module over the rock-
strewn crater where the automatic landing system was taking it. Then he made
his first quick-look science report:
We'll get to the details of what's around here, but it looks like a collection
of just about every variety of shape, angularity, granularity, about every vari-
ety of rock you could find .... There doesn't appear to be too much of a general
color at all. However, it looks as though some of the rocks and boulders, of
which there are quite a few in the near area, it looks as though they're going
to have some interesting colors to them .... 27
After giving Houston as many clues as he could to the location of their module,
he added some more description:
The area out the left-hand window is a relatively level plain cratered with a
fairly large number of craters of the 5- to 50-foot variety, and some ridges--
small, 20, 30 feet high, I would guess, and literally thousands of little 1- and
2-foot craters around the area. We see some angular blocks out several hun-
dred feet in front of us that are probably 2 feet in size and have angular edges.
There is a hill in view, just about on the ground track ahead of us. Difficult
to estimate, but might be half a mile or a mile. 28
Armstrong and Aldrin then started preparing their spacecraft for takeoff, setting
up critical systems to be ready in case something happened and they had to leave
the lunar surface quickly. A short break in this activity gave Armstrong a chance
to pass along more information about the landing site:
• . . The local surface is very comparable to that we observed from orbit at this
sun angle, about 10 degrees sun angle, or that nature. It's pretty much with-
out color. It's... a very white, chalky gray, as you look into the zero-phase
line [directly toward the sun]; and it's considerably darker gray, more
like.., ashen gray as you look out 90 degrees to the sun. Some of the sur-
face rocks in close here that have been fractured or disturbed by the rocket
engine plume are coated with this light gray on the outside; but where they've
been broken, they display a dark, very dark gray interior; and it looks like
it could be country basalt. '9
Setting up the spacecraft systems took another hour and a half to complete; then
they were ready to get out and explore. The flight plan called for them to eat
and then rest for four hours, but Aldrin called Mission Control to recommend
starting their surface exploration in about three hours' time. Houston concurred. 3°
Although they had been awake almost 11 hours and had gone through some
stressful moments during the landing,* it seemed too much to expect the first
men on the moon to take a nap before they made history.
While Armstrong and Aldrin tended to their postlanding chores, Mike Collins,
orbiting 60 nautical miles (112 kilometers) overhead in the command module
Columbia, had little to do. Houston enlisted his aid in an attempt to locate Eagle,
*While Armstrong was maneuvering to avoid a boulder field, alarms sounded in the lunar module
indicating that the computer was overloaded. Mission Control quickly told the crew to proceed. Then,
as fuel was running low, a dust cloud obscured the surface and Armstrong had to touch down with-
out a good view of his landing spot.
143
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
giving him the best map coordinates they could derive from the sketchy infor-
mation available. With his navigational sextant Collins scanned several spots, with-
out success; Columbia passed over the landing site too rapidly to allow him to
search the area thoroughly and he never found the lunar module. 31 Determina-
tion of its exact location had to wait for postmission analysis of Armstrong's
descriptions of the area and examination of the spacecraft's landing trajectory.
Getting ready to leave the lunar module took longer than the crew had antici-
pated. It was after 9:30 p.m. in Houston, an hour and a half later than they had
hoped, when they opened the hatch. Armstrong carefully worked his way out
onto the "'porch," then climbed down the ladder, pausing on the lowest rung
to comment on the texture of the surface and the depth to which the footpads
had penetrated. At 9:56 p.m. he stepped onto the moon's surface, proclaiming,
"That's one small step for man, one giant leap for mankind"--inadvertently omit-
ting an "a" before "man" and slightly changing the meaning he intended to
convey. 32
Armstrong made a cursory inspection of the lunar module and reported his
reactions to the new environment. Aldrin then lowered a camera on the lunar
equipment carrier--a dothesline and pulley arrangement that seemed out of place
in the high-technology environment of Apollo--which Armstrong immediately
began using. Mission Control reminded him to scoop up the contingency sam-
ple, which he did. "I'll try to get a rock in here. Just a couple." He noted that
the collecting tool met resistance after penetrating a short distance into the sur-
face material. He then stowed the sample in a bag that he tucked into a pocket
of his suit. To the scientists on earth he remarked, "Be advised that a lot of the
rock samples out here, the hard rock samples, have what appear to be vesicles
in the surface. Also, I am looking at one now that appears to have some sort of
phenocryst."*33
Aldrin then joined Armstrong on the surface, and they spent the next several
minutes inspecting the landing craft and reporting on its condition, adjusting to
the low lunar gravity and trying various ways of getting around on the surface.
After a brief commemorative ceremony (reading the plaque attached to the lunar
module) and a short conversation with President Richard Nixon, they began
unloading and emplacing the scientific instruments and collecting samples. They
supplemented earth's limited television view of their activities with descriptions
of what they were seeing and doing. On a couple of occasions they acted like
field geologists. Aldrin reported that he saw a rock that sparkled "like some kind
of biotite," but he "would leave that to further analysis. "** After closely examin-
ing some rounded boulders near the spacecraft, Armstrong said they looked "like
basalt, and they have probably two percent white minerals in them .... And
*That is, the rocks had surface pits resembling those caused by the escape of gases from molten
material (which could indicate a volcanic origin), and one seemed to have a prominent embedded
crystal.
**Thiscomment drew criticism from some scientists on the ground that biotite (a mica-like mineral)
could not have formed on the moon. The criticism was unwarranted, because Aldrin had not said
that it was biotite, but that it looked like biotite he had seen on field trips; the criticism was mildly
detrimental, because it made the next crew more reluctant to use technical terminology, with which
some of the astronauts felt uncomfortable anyway, in describing what they saw. H. H. Schmitt inter-
view, May 30, 1984.
144
Primary Mission Accomplished: 1969
the thing that I reported as vesicular before, I don't believe that any
more .... they look like little impact craters where BB shot has hit the surface.' TM
The geologists in Houston watching this surface activity on television were quite
pleased with the astronauts' performance. At one point Armstrong disappeared
from the field of view of the TV camera, causing some momentary anxiety at his
apparent departure from the plan. It turned out that some unusual rocks had
attracted his attention and he had gone off a few meters to collect them. That
was exactly the kind of thing the geologists had hoped people on the moon would
do .35
By the time the crew had taken two core samples, again experiencing difficulty
in driving a sampling tool into the surface, and filled their sample return con-
tainers, Houston notified them that it was time to wind up their activity. Just
before midnight CapCom* Bruce McCandless told Aldrin to "head on up the
ladder," and at 12:11 a.m. Houston time both men and their samples were back
in the lunar module and the hatch Was sealed. 36 Humanity's first excursion on
the surface of another celestial body had lasted 2 hours, 31 minutes, and 40
seconds.
Back inside the lunar module, Armstrong and Aldrin removed their lunar sur-
face suits and portable life-support systems and used up their remaining film.
Houston passed up some more instructions in preparation for liftoff and tenta-
tively signed off for the night, but before long CapCom Owen Garriott, who had
relieved McCandless, came on the line with some questions from the scientists
about the nature of the surface and the problems in driving sampling tools into
the surface. Three hours after they returned to the lunar module, the lunar
explorers finally were able to turn in for a few hours of fitful sleepW
Next morning Armstrong, Aldrin, and Collins spent most of their time setting
up Eagle and Columbia for liftoff and rendezvous. Before the lunar module left
the moon, however, Armstrong gave Mission Control a detailed description of
the landing approach path and landing area, in the hope of helping scientists
locate their exact landing spot, and summarized the characteristics of the soil and
rocks around the area. 3s
Liftoff and rendezvous went smoothly. When the two spacecraft were locked
together Collins cracked Columbia "s oxygen supply valve and Aldrin opened the
lunar module's vent valve, to create a gas flow into the LM when the hatches
were opened--part of the procedure to minimize back-contamination--while
Aldrin and Armstrong vacuumed the lunar dust from their suits as best they could.
Their vacuum cleaner, a brush attached to the exhaust hose of the LM suit sys-
tem, was not very powerful and the tenacious dust came off only with difficulty.
There was not nearly as much loose dust in the lunar module as they had expected
when they returned from the surface; evidently it stuck tightly to whatever it
touched. 39 They passed the rock boxes and other items over to Collins and then
clambered into the command module, where they removed their suits and stowed
them in the bags provided. After jettisoning the lunar module and straightening
*The "Capsule Communicator'--a term left over from the Mercury days when spacecraft were
called "capsules"--normai]y was the only person who talked to crews in space over the radio circuit.
All CapComs were astronauts, most often astronauts who had not yet flown. Appendix 6 lists CapCom
assignments for all Apollo flights.
145
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Technicians unload the first box of lunar samples from Apollo 11 at the entrance to the lunar receiving
laboratory, July 25, 1969.
up the command module, the three astronauts settled in for an uneventful trip
back to earth. 4°
In the early morning hours of July 24, 8 days, 3 hours, 18 minutes, and 18 sec-
onds after leaving Kennedy Space Center, Columbia plopped down into the Pacific
Ocean about 200 nautical miles (515 kilometers) south of Johnston Island. Recov-
ery crews from the U.S.S. Hornet arrived quickly and tossed the biological isola-
tion garments into the spacecraft. After the cocooned astronauts emerged from
the spacecraft the swimmers swabbed the hatch down with Betadine (an organic
iodine solution); then astronauts and recovery personnel decontaminated each
other's protective garments with sodium hypochlorite solution. The biological
isolation garments were not uncomfortable in the recovery raft, but aboard the
helicopter they began accumulating heat. Both Collins and Armstrong felt that
they were approaching the limit of their tolerance by the time they reached the
ship. 41 An hour after splashdown they were inside the mobile quarantine facil-
ity. As soon as they had changed into clean flight suits, the astronauts went to
ORIGINAL PA_E
146 BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
I:
ORIGINAL PAGE
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH Primary Mission Accomplished: 1969
The Apollo 11 mobile quarantine facility is unloaded from its C-141 transport.
the large window at the rear end of the mobile quarantine facility to accept the
nation's congratulations from President Nixon, who had flown out to the Hornet
to meet them. 42
Meanwhile, recovery crews brought Columbia on board and connected it to the
astronauts' temporary home by means of a plastic tunnel. Through this, the film
magazines and sample return containers were taken into the quarantine trailer,
then passed out through a decontamination lock. Sample return container no.
2, holding the documented sample, was packed in a shipping container along
with film magazines and tape recorders and flown to Johnston Island, where it
was immediately loaded aboard a C-141 aircraft and dispatched to Ellington Air
Force Base near MSC. Six and a half hours later the other sample return con-
tainer was flown to Hickam Air Force Base, Hawaii, and thence to Houston. 43
The first sample container arrived in Houston late in the morning on July 25
and was delivered to the receiving laboratory shortly before noon. 44 The second
arrived from Hawaii that afternoon. 4s For the next few weeks the laboratory was
the center of more public attention, probably, than had been focused on any scien-
tific installation in this century. As they had done since the Ranger project and
would continue to do throughout the space science program, reporters pressed
the scientists for interpretations of their preliminary observations. Obviously any
scientific conclusions would have to await detailed study; nonetheless, the scien-
tists answered the journalists as best they could. One was reported to have charac-
147
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
ORIGINAL PAGE
BLACK AND WHITE
PHOTOGRAPH
The world's first lunar explorers debark from their recovery helicopter aboard the U.S.S. Hornet and
walk toward the mobile quarantine facility, encumbered by their biological isolation garments. These
were intended to protect the earth from any harmful microorganisms that the astronauts might have
picked up on the moon. They were abandoned on the next mission in favor of clean flight suits and
respirators.
terized the result as "'instant science,'" noting that "We have to look at the stuff
and then walk into a news conference, where we should be fairly conservative
148
ORIGINAL PAGE" Primary Mission Accomplished: 1969
BLACK AND WHI1-E P_nOrOGRAPH'
The contents of the second sample return container from Apollo 11.
and reserved.., and we talk off the top of our heads, and we're bound to goof
some. ',46
After initial inspection the sealed sample return container was transferred to
the vacuum laboratory and weighed (33 pounds, 6 ounces; 15.14 kilograms). Film
magazines were placed in an autoclave, to be exposed to a gaseous sterilant for
several hours before being sent to the photographic laboratory for processing. 47
Technicians in the vacuum laboratory then started the container through the
process of preliminary examination. Before admitting it to the vacuum system,
they passed it through a two-step sterilization, first with ultraviolet light, then
with peracetic acid (a liquid biocide), after which it was rinsed with sterile water
and dried under nitrogen. Next it was passed through a vacuum lock into the
main vacuum chamber. Opening the box was delayed for some hours when the
pressure in the vacuum system could not be stabilized. Operators suspected a
leak in one of the gloves through which the samples were handled, which was
torn in several places. 4s
By midafternoon the next day, however, the leak had not worsened and the
scientists decided to proceed. At 3:45 p.m. on July 26, as geologists crowded
around the observation port at the work station, the cover was removed from
the sample return container. ° The first glimpse of moon rocks was frustrating
because they were covered with fine dust that obscured their surface characteris-
tics. About all that visual observation revealed was that they were irregular in
shape and angular, with slightly rounded edges. 5°
In addition to the rocks and dust, the sample return container held a solar-wind
collector* and two core tubes, with which Aldrin had obtained subsurface sam-
r--"
*This was a sheet of aluminum foil that was set out at the start of the astronauts' lunar surface
activity to trap particles of the solar wind. Dr. Johannes Geiss of the University of Berne, Switzer-
land, devised the experiment, which went on every mission; crews called it "the Swiss flag" because
it was unfurled along with the Stars and Stripes.
149
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
ples. These had been least exposed to contaminants from earth and would pro-
vide the "bioprime'" sample, a 100-gram (3.5-ounce) portion of lunar soil that
would be tested for its effects on a variety of living organisms. Core tubes and
solar-wind collector were sealed in stainless-steel cans, sterilized, and transferred
out of the vacuum laboratory, sl
The following week more preliminary data trickled out of the receiving labora-
tory as two teams of scientists (the lunar sample preliminary examination team,
or "LSPET," and the lunar sample analysis planning team, or "LSAPT") got
down to work. These groups would examine, characterize, photograph, and cata-
log the specimens and allocate samples to the 142 principal investigators. Work-
ing two shifts a day for a while, they determined how the larger rocks would
be divided and which ones should be sectioned, basing their judgment on the
requirements of the investigators and the availability of the different types of sam-
pies. While many members of these teams were later involved in specific investi-
gations, their purpose at this stage was to match samples with research projects
to make most effective use of the samples. 52
On July 27 technicians removed a rock from the box for low-level radiation count-
ing, dislodging much of the dust from its surface. Geologists immediately classi-
fied the specimen as igneous (formed by melting). 53 It might be a fragment of
lava from a lunar volcanic flow or a rock produced by localized melting, such
as might result from a large meteorite crashing into the moon. Careful visual exam-
ination disclosed numerous small pits on the surface, as Armstrong had noted
during his excursion. The scientists tentatively identified three common minerals,
feldspar, pyroxene, and olivine, as the major constituents of the sample, s4
Spectrographic analysis of a pinch of lunar dust indicated that the surface mate-
rial from Tranquility Base was much like that analyzed two years earlier by Sur-
veyor V.* Noteworthy characteristics of the sample included an abnormally high
proportion of titanium and relatively small quantities of some volatile elements,
which would be depleted in materials aggregated at high temperatures.
Microscopic examination of the powdery material ("fines") showed that more
than half of it was composed of tiny particles of glass--shiny spheres, rare
dumbbell-shaped beads, and sharp, angular needles and fragments, s5
A few more tidbits emerged from the early work in the receiving laboratory,
among them the facts that the samples contained very little carbon (no more than
12 parts per million) and that some of the rocks had lain undisturbed on the lunar
surface for a million years or more. s6
Preliminary examination of samples and preparation of material for the inves-
tigators continued throughout August, aiming at distribution of experimental
material as soon as the quarantine protocols were completed. For the first few
days work in the laboratory went on as planned; some minor malfunctions in
the waste disposal system briefly threatened to break the biological containment
but were corrected without incident, s7 About the only potential equipment prob-
lem was the torn glove in the vacuum chamber. Since replacement was a time-
*The inactive Surveyor V sat some 25 kilometers (15.5 miles) north-northwest of Tranquility Base.
The last three Surveyors (V, VI, VII) carried instruments capable of identifying the major chemical
elements making up the surface material,; see Surveyor: Program Results, NASA SP-184 (Washington,
1969), pp. v-vi, 7, 271-350.
150
!_
• _
'_! II
Primary Mission Accomplished: 1969
After the President and other celebrities departed, the U.S.S. Hornet continued
steaming back to Hawaii, arriving at Pearl Harbor on the afternoon of July 26.
The mobile quarantine facility with its five passengers* was hoisted off the ship
onto a truck for transfer to Hickam Air Force Base a few miles away, pausing
briefly to acknowledge the greetings of the mayor and several thousand citizens
of Honolulu. At Hickam the trailer was loaded into a C-141 cargo aircraft, which
departed immediately for Houston. 61 Just after midnight the big plane touched
down at Ellington Air Force Base, where a large crowd awaited a glimpse of the
astronauts. Three hours later the crew and their companions entered their living
quarters at the lunar receiving laboratory, which would be their home for at least
the next three weeks. 62 On hand to greet them were the support personnel who
had entered the living quarters the week before: a dinical pathologist, five labora-
tory technicians, three stewards, photography specialist, Brown & Root-
Northrop's logistic operations officer, and a representative of MSC's public affairs
office. 63
After a day off to recuperate from the stresses of the preceding two weeks--
since July 16 they had been cooped up in very close quarters--the crew began
a week of intensive technical and medical debriefings. Periodic examinations and
blood tests monitored the physiological effects of their flight and recovery, while
the doctors kept a close watch for any signs of exotic infection. The living quarters
were equipped for routine clinical tests, or even minor surgery; but if a life-
threatening medical emergency arose, whether from recognizable or unfamiliar
causes, the victim would be transferred out to a hospital regardless of any con-
cern for back-contamination. _
Although all three astronauts were veterans of prior missions, none had ever
spent so much time in space, and post-mission activities had never been con-
ducted under strict confinement. Thus quarantine quickly became oppressive,
the more so because only meager provision had been made for recreation. An exer-
cise room was available, as well as a Ping-Pong table, and they could read or watch
television or talk by telephone to their families, but it was not like being at home.
At the conclusion of the technical debriefing sessions, less than a week after they
returned, they were called upon to comment on operations in the receiving labora-
*A physician, Dr. William R. Carpentier, and a technician, John Hirasaki, joined the crew in the
quarantine trailer aboard the recovery ship and remained in quarantine with them.
151
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
tory. Armstrong was noncommittal, saying that so far it had been going "about
as well as you can expect." Collins's less tolerant response was, "'I want out. "'65
Since no press conference with the astronauts was scheduled before quaran-
tine was lifted, reporters" only source of information was a daily briefing by John
McLeaish, the public affairs officer confined in the crew quarters. Once or twice
a day McLeaish briefed the press pool through a glass wall in the conference room
where the crew debriefings took place. Most of the time he had little to report:
everyone inside was healthy, the astronauts were busy with debriefings or writ-
ing their pilot's reports, and otherwise nothing much was going on. 66 And so
it remained for the duration of the three-week quarantine.
While the laboratory teams worked two shifts a day to prepare the samples
for outside researchers, project managers were considering how to deal with a
growing public curiosity about the first rocks returned from the moon. Even before
Apollo 11 left the launch pad, requests for lunar specimens for display had begun
to arrive at the Manned Spacecraft Center. When MSC scientists expressed con-
cern at what these requests might lead to, Apollo project manager George Low
asked Headquarters for help in developing a policy to deal with them. Low's prin-
cipal concern was that NASA "'would arouse the animosity of the scientists in
this program by wholesale or capricious distribution of valuable lunar material
for nonscientific purposes." Low considered it appropriate to prepare a few lunar
specimens for touring exhibits at major museums in the United States and abroad,
provided they were eventually returned to the lunar receiving laboratory for scien-
tific use. He also expected to be asked for samples to be presented to various
VIPs; this MSC was willing to do, provided the number and size of such samples
could be kept quite small. MSC scientists were alarmed, however, by a White
House proposal to present lunar samples to the heads of state of 120 countries. 67
Apollo program director Sam Phillips replied that his office was accountable
for the spacecraft and all hardware items that had gone to the moon; presumably
that responsibility extended to the lunar samples as well (although it appears that
this point had not been explicitly settled), and Phillips asked Houston for sug-
gestions as to procedures. Concerru_'ng the lending of samples to museums and
presentation of souvenirs to VIPs, however, he noted that "'The Administrator
will make the final determination of the overall allocation of lunar material for
scientific and other purposes. ''68 A mid-August general management review at
Headquarters reaffirmed this position, stating that the Public Affairs Office had
primary responsibility for arranging exhibition, presentation, or other uses of the
samples, and it was directed to develop plans for presentation, "if possible, of
small amounts of lunar material to Chiefs of State as desired by the President."
The Offices of Manned Space Flight and Space Science and Applications were
asked to indicate how much material, if any, and what kind (i.e., rocks or dust)
could be made available for such purposes. 69
When Headquarters called for that information, MSC's response reflected the
view of lunar scientists. They were not inclined to be liberal in giving away lunar
rocks, which they rightly regarded as a priceless scientific resource. Director Robert
R. Gilruth replied that he could make available 150 to 200 presentation samples,
152
i ,i
PrimaryMissionAccomplished:
1969
each consisting of 100 milligrams (less than the volume of an aspirin tablet) of
fines from the bulk or contingency samples. Concerning VIP souvenirs, Gilruth
said that "we could make available if required about 10 samples of 1 gm
each . . . to be given away if needed [emphasis in the original]," but the Center
would prefer not to part with samples that big. For museums, ten 50-gram
(1.75-ounce) rock specimens might be made available on loan, provided they could
be recalled on one month's notice by Houston's curator of lunar samples. 7°
Not surprisingly, public interest in the lunar samples was tremendous, and in
September the first of several displays of moon rocks was opened in the Smith-
sonian Institution in Washington. Thousands queued up to get a glimpse of a
moon rock; many found it disappointingly ordinary. 71 Presentation samples--
tiny portions of lunar dust, packaged in plastic vials and attractively mounted
in plaques--were prepared for the world's heads of state and presented by
astronauts or government officials on world tours. So far as can be determined,
no lunar rocks were cut and polished as paperweights for the desks of VIPs.
Premission plans called for the astronauts to be kept in isolation for 21 days
after their exposure to lunar material. If one of them had developed signs of infec-
tion by an exotic organism, or if some adverse effects had appeared in the living
systems being tested, their confinement could have been extended. Samples were
to be kept until results were in from all the biological protocols, which would
be completed within 50 to 80 days after the samples entered the receiving labora-
tory, depending on test results, n
From the medical standpoint the quarantine of the astronauts was absolutely
uneventful. Not the slightest sign of ill effects appeared in any of the astronauts,
the support personnel, or the technicians who were quarantined after two breaches
of containment in the vacuum laboratory.* So, after reviewing the results of ini-
tial biological testing and finding no evidence of infectious agents, the Interagency
Committee on Back Contamination agreed to release the astronauts and their com-
panions in confinement at 1 a.m. on August 11, one day earlier than originally
planned. The committee recommended, however, that they be kept under medical
surveillance until biological testing was complete and the samples were released, r3
The early morning hour for release was quite likely chosen in the hope of avoid-
ing a wild scramble with the news media at the door of the crew quarters. But
after a month of close confinement Armstrong, Aldrin, and Collins were not
inclined to stay an hour longer than necessary; so at 9 p.m. on August 10, after
the last medical examinations had been completed, they walked out of the living
quarters, made some brief remarks to the few reporters present, and were whisked
away to their homes. 74 After a press conference on the morning of the 12th, the
astronauts were scheduled to leave on a worldwide personal appearance tour.
*The first, a rupture of a glove in the vacuum system on Aug. 1 (see above), sent two technicians
into quarantine; on Aug. 5 a leak in an autoclave exposed four more to lunar materials. The most
direct exposure to lunar soil occurred on July 25 when a photo technician picked up a film magazine
that Buzz Aldrin had dropped on the lunar surface and found his hand covered with the tenacious
black dust. He was already in quarantine but had to decontaminate himself by showering for five
minutes. K. L. Suit, "Apollo 11 LRL Daffy Summary Report, 1200 July 25 to 1200 July 26."
153
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
With the return of the unique, expensive, and widely ballyhooed moon rocks,
NASA and its scientific advisory bodies anticipated some potential problems that
could embarrass both the space agency and the community of lunar scientists.
One was the theft or unauthorized use of the samples; another was an unseemly
scramble to publish results. To minimize the chances of such undesirable events,
the contracts covering the scientific investigation of lunar material stipulated that
the contracting institution would establish strict security and accounting proce-
dures for the samples, and that the investigator would reserve initial presenta-
tion of all results for a symposium to be held as soon as possible after each
mission. 81 Both provisions violated established scientific practice to some extent,
particularly the agreement to withhold publication; but in view of the unique sig-
nificance of the lunar samples and the benefits to be gained by discussion at a
lunar science symposium, scientists agreed to them.
Not surprisingly, since the samples were released before any of the samples
were publicly displayed, requests for permission to display the research samples
came in as soon as they were received. 82 These were considered case by case at
154
Primary Mission Accomplished: 1969
155
Where No Man Has Gone Before
the moon's interior was not like the earth's, ss The other instrument, the laser
retroreflector, was difficult to locate from earth because it was in strong sunlight,
which made detection of the reflected light pulse difficult. Only after lunar sun-
set would astronomers be able to use the instrument in the manner for which
it had been designed, s9
Sketchy as these results were, they clearly showed that Apollo would revolu-
tionize scientific thought about the moon and its relation to the earth. The detailed
studies would show how extensive this revolution might be (see Chapter 14). 9o
156
10
For a while during the summer of 1969, NASA basked in the afterglow of two
major successes. Within a few days of the return of the first men from the moon,
two unmanned spacecraft, Mariner 6 and 7, flew by Mars and transmitted
hundreds of closeup photographs--the first since Mariner 4 in 1965 and the most
detailed ever. 1 Some continuity in manned space flight was assured when several
years of difficult planning culminated in the decision--made while Apollo 11 was
on its way back to earth--on a configuration and mission plans for the first post-
Apollo project, Skylab. 2
Successes notwithstanding, the future of manned space flight was far from set-
tied. The Nixon administration, just eight months in office, had not adopted a
policy on space and was waiting for recommendations from a special Space Task
Group appointed in January 1969. Early indications were that the new adminis-
tration was more strongly committed to reductions in government spending than
to ambitious space programs. 3
The national enthusiasm generated by Apollo 11 was soon spent. In the words
of a journalist who had followed the program from its early days,
The people who in 1961 said, 'yessir, let's go to the moon and beat the Rus-
sians' had become a different people by 1969 .... There was the feeling: 'we
won the war, now bring the boys home.' . . . no one wanted a big space pro-
gram any more. .4
*"Bring the boys home" was a cry raised throughout the country as soon as World War II ended
in August 1945. As a result, the U.S. hastily--some thought unwisely--discharged millions of draftees
from the armed services and dismantled its military forces around the world.
157
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
first successful landing the interval between missions was extended to four
months: Apollo 12 was rescheduled for November 14 and Apollo 13 was targeted
for earliest launch readiness by March 9, 1970. 6
Pleased by the results of Apollo 11, scientists called for scientific goals to take
priority on subsequent missions. Those goals, stated by the Santa Cruz summer
study in 1967, included extending the Apollo landing zone to cover more of the
moon's surface, increasing the time the astronauts could remain on the lunar sur-
face, and providing mobility aids to enable the astronauts to cover more ground
in the time available (see Chapter 7 and Appendix 3). The scientists also noted
the desirability of gathering data from lunar orbit, either by deploying an indepen-
dent lunar satellite from the command and service module or by using sensors
mounted in the CSM. Four working groups had found good reasons to use the
moon-orbiting CSM for scientific purposes. .7
As soon as Apollo 11 was safely down in the Pacific, Mueller directed the
manned space flight centers to shift their efforts to lunar exploration. The manned
space flight organization had long agreed in a general way that the scientists'
goals were the primary justification for continuing the lunar landing program and
had, in fact, begun studying the changes implied in those goals as soon as the
Santa Cruz conference was over. Improved mobility was the most urgent need
for the scientific missions. The conferees at Santa Cruz had called for both a lunar
flying unit and a surface-traversing vehicle. Since both vehicles were likely to
require extensive development, the Manned Spacecraft Center's Lunar Explora-
tion Project Office had begun technical discussions with several contractors in
the fall of 1967. 8 After a year spent in defining requirements, MSC awarded two
seven-month preliminary definition contracts for a flying unit in January 1969.
Marshall Space Flight Center let study contracts in April for a dual-mode surface
vehicle, which could be remotely controlled from earth after the astronauts left
the moon. 9
Equally high on the priority list for exploration missions was extending the time
astronauts could stay on the moon. Grumman Aircraft Engineering Company,
the lunar module contractor, had made some preliminary studies on modifica-
tion of the lander for that purpose in 1967.10 Life-support systems and electrical
power were enough for only 36 hours on the surface; longer stays would require
hardware changes. Propulsion systems would have to be upgraded to carry the
scientific equipment and mobility module to be taken on exploration missions.
In March 1969, MSC directed Grumman to define the changes necessary to allow
*This option had been available since 1964, when engineers defining the Block II service module
had arranged its systems so that one sector was left empty to accommodate scientific instruments.
Courtney G. Brooks, James M. Grimwood, and Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., Chariots for Apollo: A History
of Manned Lunar Spacecraft,NASA SP-4205 (Washington, 1979), p. 140. The Santa Cruz planners had
envisioned one or two lunar-orbit missions devoted entirely to photography and remote sensing,
as then-current plans for Apollo Applications provided.
158
LunarExplorationBegins
thelunarmodule to stay three to six days on the moon, with their cost and sched-
ule impacts, u
Planning for lunar-orbital science began in May of 1968, when Wflmot Hess, act-
ing on a request from the Lunar Exploration Office in Headquarters, asked the
Apollo spacecraft program office to look into the question of placing a scientific
payload in the service module. 12 MSC commissioned North American Rockwell,
the spacecraft contractor, to study the effects on cost and schedule of adding scien-
tific instrumentation to the spacecraft as early as Apollo 14.13 As that study drew
toward a close without discovering any major difficulties, MSC established a panel
to review the operational implications of making scientific observations in lunar
orbit and to identify the scientific activities that could be conducted during a lunar
exploration mission. 14
By early 1969 MSC had concluded that a package could be developed in time
to fly on Apollo 14 in the last half of 1970 and had compiled a tentative list of
instruments for evaluation by the Space Science and Applications Steering Com-
mittee. Director Robert Gflruth sent Headquarters the center's procurement plan,
which provided for MSC to procure the instruments and deliver them as
government-furnished equipment to North American to be integrated into the
service module. Early approval and provision of the necessary funds by Head-
quarters were essential to meeting the projected schedule. TM
In early April the Office of Space Science and Applications approved a group
of experiments for the first phase of the lunar-orbit science project. 16 Apollo Pro-
gram Manager Sam Phillips wanted more specific information before granting
final approval and releasing funds, however, v The proposal was discussed in
detail by Mueller's Management Council on May 7, after which Mueller gave MSC
the authority to proceed--but on Apollo 16 rather than Apollo 14. Details of
integrating the experiments into the service module remained to be settled, as
did the exact mode of operation of each experiment, and this would take time. TM
On June 30 Headquarters sent Houston a list of lunar-orbital experiments for
Apollo 16 through 20, with authority to continue North American's integration
effort and begin procurement of experiments. Assignment of experiments to
specific flights could not yet be made, because the list was subject to revision
during the summer. Total cost of the project was not to exceed $55 million. 19
The manned space flight organization worked steadily from 1967 onward to
lay the foundations for scientific exploitation of the Apollo systems, but the effort
was often overshadowed by preparations for the first lunar landing. With NASA's
encouragement, the Santa Cruz conference that summer had called for a maxi-
mum effort. The scientists' recommendations had been carefully considered, and
by mid-1969 many of the most important ones were on their way to realization.
It seems clear that if manned space flight had enjoyed the assurance of a high
level of support, the lunar scientists would have gotten more. As it was, lunar
exploration had to proceed with little more than had been projected by mid-1969:
limited extension of the duration of exploration missions, a limited increase in
the range of operations on the lunar surface, and a few lunar-orbital sensors.
159
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Since its primary objective was to land on the moon and return, Apollo 11 had
been targeted for the least hazardous site. When the emphasis shifted to explo-
ration, however, scientific considerations carried much greater weight in the choice
of a landing site. t° Even so, every landing was as risky as the first, and ff MSC
vetoed a site or expressed strong reservations about its feasibility on operational
grounds, Headquarters and the Apollo Site Selection Board were reluctant to over-
ride the center's recommendations for the sake of enhanced scientific return. 21
During 1968 and early 1969 the Apollo Site Selection Board necessarily concen-
trated on choosing landing areas for the first two missions. Five prime candidates
had been chosen by December 1967, from which three--an eastern, a central, and
a western, to allow for possible delays in the launch--were picked for the first
landing (see Chapter 8). It was more or less taken for granted that if the first land-
ing mission should succeed, then the second would be sent to another of those
five sites, since much of the necessary planning would already have been done.
If the first mission landed in an eastern mare, the second would be sent to a west-
ern one, and vice versa.
The Board's advisory groups continued to evaluate Lunar Orbiter photographs
and by June of 1969 had produced a list of 22 sites for lunar exploration missions
(Table 1). These were chosen for their apparent value in contributing to answers
to one or more of the 15 questions in lunar exploration (Appendix 3). For most
of these sites, changes in operational philosophy would be required. Only one
site, not three, would be available at each launch opportunity; point landings
(within I kilometer, 0.62 miles) would be necessary, to place the landing module
as near the features of interest as possible; approach paths might be rough or un-
dulating rather than smooth; free-return trajectories could not be used; and the
high-resolution photography required to certify a site was generally not available. 22
With more than twice as many interesting locations to visit as there were mis-
sions planned, site selection would be a complex process at best. Scientists' priori-
ties might change as the results of early missions became known and as NASA
developed more precise landing techniques and extended the area where the
spacecraft could land. Reconciling the goals of science with the constraints of mis-
sion operations required an early start and continuing tradeoffs as the proj-
ect progressed.
At the June 3 meeting of the Apollo Site Selection Board, chairman Sam Phil-
lips, anticipating heavy work loads if the board was to accomplish its task within
tight schedules, requested that the board meet monthly if possible. He directed
Lee Scherer to prepare a thorough briefing on the scientific objectives of lunar
exploration and suggested that the Group for Lunar Exploration Planning pro-
pose a sequence of missions that would accomplish those objectives. Board mem-
bers agreed a that to make sensible choices between sites they needed a better
understanding of the rationale of lunar exploration and the operational improve-
ments being planned. 23
The meeting then turned to the question of a site for the second mission. Scien-
tists reiterated their preference for a western (younger) mare if the first mission
landed safely at an eastern (older) site. Two western sites were on the short list
160
ii
i:
Lunar Exploration Begins
*From minutes of the Apollo Site Selection Board meeting, June 3, 1969.
of preferred sites compiled in 1968: one just below the equator some 450 kilo-
meters (280 miles) south and slightly east of crater Kepler and the other about
250 kilometers (155 miles) northwest of the first. Benjamin Milwitzky of the Lunar
Exploration Office then suggested that Apollo 12 land near a Surveyor spacecraft.
As early as January 1969 Milwitzky, formerly the Headquarters program man-
ager for Surveyor, had suggested visiting a landed Surveyor and returning some
spacecraft parts and nearby surface samples to earth for study. This could yield
valuable engineering information on the effects of the space environment
on materials, besides allowing postmission verification of Surveyor's scien-
tific results. 24
MSC representatives then presented a rationale for considering two other west-
ern sites. Although these had been eliminated in selecting the final five sites, they
161
WhereNoManHas Gone Before
met MSC's criteria for operational suitability and offered certain advantages over
the first two. Both sites were near Surveyor spacecraft. 25 The Board reacted
unfavorably to these suggestions, pointing out that the site where Surveyor III
was located was in a younger mare that was not much different from those in
the eastern sites, whereas the scientists' first two choices were in typical older
regions. Examining the Surveyor would detract from the other objectives of the
mission. Furthermore, if returning Surveyor parts were set as a goal for the mis-
sion, failure to accomplish the necessary precision in landing could be interpreted
as failure--which would not, in fact, be the case. Chairman Sam Phillips was reluc-
tant to add any more sites to the list for the second mission. He did not favor
either of MSC's choices and instead directed Houston to examine two sites con-
sidered highly desirable by the scientists, Hipparchus and Fra Mauro, and report
on their suitability. 26
MSC analyzed the data available for these two sites and found them unaccept-
able for the second landing mission. Hipparchus had only about half as much
good landing area as the average Apollo 11 site and Fra Mauro was worse. Pho-
tographic coverage in both cases was marginal. Houston recommended that the
site selection board give no further consideration to these two locations, but that
it reexamine the Surveyor II! site, which met all the criteria for the first landing
and was in some respects better than the two western sites under consideration. 27
Phillips concurred and directed the Group for Lunar Exploration Planning to assess
the scientific merit of the site. 28
On June 17 the Site Selection Subgroup of the Group for Lunar Exploration
Planning met at Houston to try to reduce the complexity of lunar exploration plan-
ning. MSC's operations planners needed definite recommendations as to scien-
tific objectives and priorities rather than the unstructured group of sites currently
being considered. A short list of high-priority sites was desired, which would
not subsequently be changed except through formal change procedures. MSC
engineers briefed the subgroup on the increased capabilities that might be expected
for the exploration missions. After Apollo 11, four "H" missions were planned,
each of which would be able to carry a complete Apollo lunar surface experiments
package (ALSEP), could support two periods of surface activity by the astronauts,
and would be targeted for a smaller landing zone than the first mission.* On the
later "H" missions engineers expected to be able to land within a 1-kilometer
(0.62-mile) circle. After the "H" missions, six "J" missions would be flown. These
could land with considerably improved accuracy, stay on the surface for three
days and allow four excursions to the surface, and carry scientific equipment in
the service module for lunar-orbital experiments. Starting with the second or third
"J" mission, a powered surface vehicle would extend the astronauts' radius of
operations to about 5 kilometers (3 miles). 29
With these developments in mind, the subgroup reduced the list of candidate
sites to 10, ordering them in a sequence that would produce the best scientific
*The landing zone for Apollo 11 was about 19 kilometers long and 5 kilometers wide (12 by 3 miles)
as a result of uncertainties in the determination of the spacecraft's position and velocity in lunar orbit
before landing.
162
Lunar Exploration Begins
return, and added five more representing lunar features of scientific interest not
covered by the existing list. It recommended systematic photography from the
orbiting command and service module to provide the necessary planning data
for later missions. Finally, the subgroup recommended that Surveyor Ill be deleted
from further consideration for the second landing because its location was not
expected to yield data significantly different from the two eastern sites already
picked for Apollo 11. 3°
The Site Selection Board met again on July 10 for a briefing on the aims of lunar
exploration. Donald Wise of the Lunar Exploration Office discussed the types
of information the scientists hoped to get from the lunar exploration program:
the ages of lunar materials, their chemical composition, clues to the processes
that have created lunar landforms, the interior structure of the moon, and the
rate of flow of heat from its interior. Farouk EI-Baz of Bellcomm described the
general areas that should be sampled in the first phase (10 missions) of lunar explo-
ration: two types of mare material ("older" or "eastern" and "younger" or "west-
ern"); regional stratigraphic units such as deposits around mare basins; impact
craters in both maria and highlands; morphological manifestations of volcanic
activity in both maria and highlands; and areas that might give clues as to the
nature and extent of processes other than impact and volcanism which may have
acted on the lunar surface. He then enumerated the characteristics of each of the
10 landing sites proposed by the Group for Lunar Exploration Planning, relating
each to the scientific goals of the program and tying the sequence to expected
improvements in spacecraft capabilities and flight operations planning.
Chairman Phillips remarked that the list seemed well thought out and that a
short list of desirable science sites must soon be stabilized. After considerable
discussion, the Board approved the 10 candidate sites for planning purposes. Phil-
lips directed MSC to study these sites and report on their suitability.
Houston had already taken a quick look at the sites and determined that all
would require additional photographs before they could be certified under exist-
ing criteria. Photography from the Apollo 10 command module--conducted spe-
cifically to evaluate its usefulness for filling gaps in Lunar Orbiter coverage--had
proved adequate for site analysis, and MSC's data indicated that by proper choice
of sites for early missions, photographs of many of the later ones could be
obtained. According to MSC's studies, the Surveyor IlI site offered better oppor-
tunities for this "'bootstrap" photography than the other western locations on
the list. 31
Two months' work by the Apollo Site Selection Board did not finally deter-
mine where each Apollo exploration mission would go. It reduced the scope of
the debate somewhat, established the principle that changes were to be made
only for good scientific reasons, and provided the means for accommodating
changes as the program developed. The list of 10 sites approved in July provided
specific targets for mission planners; it would change as operational problems
arose and as improved equipment and techniques became available.
163
Where No Man Has Gone Before
On April 10, 1969, following the success of Apollo 9, MSC announced the names
of the crews for Apollo 12. The prime crew was commanded by Charles ("Pete")
Conrad, Jr., astronaut since 1962 and veteran of two missions, Gemini V and
Gemini XI. His lunar module pilot was Alan L. Bean, who joined the program
with the third group but had yet to fly a mission. Rounding out the crew as com-
mand module pilot was Richard F. Gordon, Jr., a member of the third class of
astronauts, who had flown with Conrad on Gemini XI. The three, all Navy avia-
tors, had trained together as backup crew on Apollo 9. Named to the backup
crew were commander David R. Scott, who had flown with Neil Armstrong on
the prematurely terminated Gemini VIII mission, and two astronauts from the
fourth group of pilots, lunar module pilot James B. Irwin and command module
pilot Alfred M. Worden. 32 Irwin's and Worden's only prior experience had been
on support crews, Irwin on Apollo 10 and Worden on Apollo 9. As support crew
for Apollo 12, Deke Slayton picked Gerald P. Carr and Paul J. Weitz, two pilots
from the fourth astronaut class, and Edward G. Gibson, the first scientist-astronaut
named to any Apollo crew position. 33 For Gibson and his colleagues this was
recognition of a sort. No one yet knew how support crews would fare in later
competition for prime crew slots*--so far, only one had gotten as far as a backup
crew--but his appointment was a sign that they had at least not been completely
forgotten.
In April 1969 no one could be certain that Apollo 11 would make the first lunar
landing, so training for Conrad, Bean, and Gordon was very much like that for
Armstrong, Aldrin, and Collins. Nominally both crews were preparing to land
at any of three sites; actually, their site-specific training concentrated on only one,
simply because there was not time to prepare adequately for three. 34 Apollo 11's
primary target was site 2, in the Sea of Tranquility; 12 focused on site 5, in Ocea-
nus Procellarum.
As was normal when two crews were in training simultaneously, the crew
assigned to the earlier mission had priority in use of the command module and
lunar module simulators until just before launch. Conrad and his group spent
their training time on other phases: briefings on systems, thermal-vacuum tests,
design reviews, geology classes and field trips, and the thousand and one other
details that went into preparation for a lunar mission. 35When Apollo 11 returned
successful in late July, the launch date for Apollo 12 was moved to November
and two months were gained for preparation.
Some of that preparation time would be needed, for after Apollo 11 the
objectives for Apollo 12 began to change. Shortly after the site selection board
*As it turned out, 8 of the first 13 astronauts named to support crews eventually made lunar flights.
164
Lunar Exploration Begins
had settled on its list of 10 landing sites for lunar exploration, Sam Phillips selected
the Surveyor III site as the target for the next mission. 36 Even though the scien-
tists had unanimously rejected its location as unsuitabIe, the inert Surveyor offered
some opportunities that could not be passed up. A demonstration of point land-
ing (i.e., within I kilometer [0.62 mile] of a preselected spot) needed to be made
as soon as feasible. For that purpose, something like a Surveyor was more appeal-
ing to mission planners than picking some specific crater. Scientists might have
good reasons for landing next to one crater rather than another, but to nonscien-
tists (including the public) all craters were pretty much alikeY Besides, valuable
engineering and scientific information could come out of examination of a space-
craft that had spent more than two years in the space environment,* as Milwitzky
had pointed out to the site selection board (see above). Houston had already deter-
mined that certain components could be removed from a Surveyor with no spe-
cial difficulty and was working with Hughes Aircraft Company, builder of the
Surveyors, on procedures the astronauts could use. 3a
As soon as that decision was made, changes in mission techniques became a
major effort for Apollo 12 planners. Howard W. Tindall, Jr., MSC's chief of Apollo
data priority coordination, wrote as the planning began, "'It is clear that lunar
point landing capability is absolutely necessary if we are to support the exploration pro-
gram the scientists want [emphasis added]. That is, mission success intrinsically
depends upon it."39 A preliminary look at the problems of accomplishing it, how-
ever, showed that it could not be done as early as Apollo 12. Too many proce-
dural changes were involved, and there was not enough time to incorporate them
and prove their suitability. Accordingly, mission planning teams at MSC set out
to refine existing techniques, in the hope that they could reduce the unavoidable
errors to the point of landing within a mile (1,600 meters) of a preselected spot. 4°
Trajectory planners first needed to know the precise location of Surveyor III,
which, they discovered, had been determined not long after the spacecraft had
touched downY*Geologists had located the spacecraft inside and just below the
eastern rim of a subdued crater about 200 meters (650 feet) across and 15 meters
(50 feet) deep, some 480 miles (775 kilometers) west-southwest of the moon's cen-
ter, at lunar latitude 2057 ' south, longitude 23020 ' west. 41
Given the precise location of their target, trajectory planners next went to work
improving mission techniques. The fundamental difficulty in making a precision
landing was determining the lunar module's orbital position and velocity in lunar
orbit (its "state vector") with sufficient accuracy. Earth-based radar acquired this
information and the communications network transmitted it to the lunar mod-
ule's primary guidance computer just before the landing craft began its powered
descent. No further change was made until the spacecraft reached low altitude
and the landing point was in sight. Then the mission commander could assume
manual control and adjust the landing point to avoid hazards, as Neil Armstrong
had done on Apollo 11, or land at a desired spot.
*Surveyor Ill landed on April 20, 1967, and transmitted 6,326 television pictures and large amounts
of scientific data for 14 days.
**Prominent features appearing in SurveyorIII'stelevision photographs had also been located in high-
resolution pictures of the same area taken by Lunar Orbiter III.
165
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
After the state vector was determined and before descent began, the spacecraft's
actual path could deviate from its predicted path for several reasons. Perturba-
tions caused by the irregular shape and gravity field of the moon, unwanted
changes in velocity during required spacecraft maneuvers, and the guidance sys-
tem's tendency to drift slightly from its inertial alignment, all contributed to inac-
curacy in the state vector. .42
A month of considering the sources of these errors and ways of minimizing
them boosted MSC's confidence considerably. Still, after a "three-day mission
techniques free-for-all" at the end of July, Tindall concluded that "if we land
within walking distance, it is my feeling we have to give most of the credit to
'lady luck."-43 Four weeks later, numerous productive suggestions had been
explored. Among the more significant changes were separating the lunar mod-
ule from the command module earlier in the mission and eliminating several atti-
tude changes normally made in the following two orbits. These changes gave
more accurate tracking of the LM, could significantly reduce unwanted velocity
changes, and might enable Mission Control's computers to measure drift in the
inertial navigation system and compensate for it. Another proposed refinement
was to give the spacecraft computer a revised landing point, based on radar track-
ing just before the lunar module started down, while the lander was making
its descent, thus taking out all the error accumulated to that point in one step. 44
All these changes got careful study in the next two months, with encouraging
results. Two weeks before launch Tindall was more sanguine. "For whatever it's
worth," he reported, "my feeling now is that as long as the systems work as
well as they have in the past, we have a pretty good chance of landing near the
Surveyor.'" Beyond that he would not make any predictions about the accuracy
of the landing. 45
On July 18, 1969, MSC issued the mission requirements document for Apollo
12, listing the primary purposes of the mission as investigating the lunar surface
environment, emplacing the first Apollo lunar surface experiments package
(ALSEP), obtaining samples from a second lunar mare, and enhancing the capa-
bility for manned lunar exploration. Major changes from Apollo 11 included the
possible use of a hybrid trajectory** rather than a free-return trajectory and
*These random (indeterminate) errors led engineers to use statistical methods in predicting landing
points. The most commonly used designation was the "3-sigma ellipse," centered on the desired
landing point, within which there was 99 percent confidence that the spacecraft would land. For Apollo
11 the 3-sigma ellipse was roughly 11.7 miles long by 3 miles wide (18.8 by 4.8 kilometers); for Apollo
12, planners were aiming for 2.6 by 1.6 miles (4.2 by 2.6 kilometers).
**Hybrid trajectories were fuel-saving flight paths which, unlike free-return trajectories, would not
return the spacecraft to earth if the service module's main propulsion system failed to put it into lunar
orbit. They were designed so that in case of such a failure the lunar module's descent engine could
correct the resulting flight path (which might put the spacecraft with its three occupants into solar
orbit) for return to earth.
166
Lunar Exploration Begins
167
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
and Charles M. Duke. For Apollo 14, Alan B. Shepard, Jr., was named com-
mander, Edgar D. Mitchell, lunar module pilot, and Stuart A. Roosa, command
module pilot, backed up by Eugene A. Cernan, Ronald E. Evans, and Joe H.
Engle. 5° Not one of the 13 scientist-astronauts was included.* Worse yet from
the scientists' point of view, seniority--which hitherto had seemed to be one of
Deke Slayton's primary criteria for crew appointments--appeared to count for
nothing when the first class of scientist-astronauts acquired it: of the 12 crew-
men named, only Lovell, Young, Shepard, and Cernan had been in the program
longer than they.**
This alone might not have been cause for alarm on the part of scientists had
it not been followed shortly by the resignation of several men occupying posi-
tions of some prominence in NASA's science program. At Headquarters, Dr.
Donald U. Wise, Lee Scherer's deputy in the Lunar Exploration Office, left to
take an academic appointment. Dr. Elbert A. King, Jr., a prime mover in estab-
lishing the lunar receiving laboratory at Houston and first curator of lunar sam-
pies, announced he would resign to become head of the geology department at
the University of Houston. The astronaut corps lost one of its scientist members
when F. Curtis Michel resigned to return to teaching and research at Rice Univer-
sity. Finally, Wilmot Hess, first director of Science and Applications at MSC, left
to become director of research at the Environmental Science Services Adminis-
tration laboratories at Boulder, Colorado.
Each man had his own reasons for leaving NASA, and their near-simultaneous
departure seems to have been only coincidental. (King, for example, had made
a commitment to the University of Houston more than a year earlier. 51) Still, all
but Hess--who dedined to discuss his resignation with the press--expressed some
dissatisfaction with the status of science in manned space flight programs. Michel's
main reason was to return to research, but he stated his disappointment that
NASA had shown "no serious intent to fly scientist-astronauts." King likewise
professed a desire to spend more time in research, which he found very difficult
to do in an administrative position, and warned that NASA had not yet convinced
the scientific community that it "will put together a program that will truly empha-
size science.'" Wise discussed his choice somewhat reluctantly, expressing con-
cern that criticism from the scientific community would intensify science's
problems: "With enough screams [from scientists]," he feared "we will fly only
five missions instead of ten--this would be the real tragedy." He too pointed
out (among other problems) "a lack of understanding of scientific goals at the
management level in NASA."52
Hess's resignation was perhaps the most serious of all in the eyes of outside
scientists, because he had been brought to MSC specifically to give the Houston
center some scientific respectability (see Chapter 6). He had, however, found
little support from center management and no understanding of the proper role
of science. His plans to establish a credible research program at MSC, which
*Mitchell held a Ph.D., but it was in engineering (astronautics and aeronautics), not one of the
natural sciences.
**However, three of the scientists had spent a year learning to fly, and all five had begun their
astronaut training after the next class of pilots, which included all the rest of the Apollo 13 and 14
crews, had been selected.
168
Lunar Exploration Begins
169
Where No Man Has Gone Before
seat of the manned space program. It is time now to make them the navigators.
The choice of missions . . . should be largely in their hands."58
Whether these editorials reflected a bias in favor of the intellectual elegance
of pure science or merely gross ignorance, they overlooked some basic facts about
Apollo's limited capabilities. Maximizing the yield of scientific data required
improving the techniques of manned space flight. Apollo 11 overshot its aiming
point by five miles (eight kilometers), and even the Washington Post would likely
have agreed that it made no sense to commit scientific missions if they could not
reach their targets. Nonetheless, progress toward scientific exploration was too
slow to suit some critics, and they evidently felt that their only recourse was to
take their case to the public.
The more subjective concerns of scientists were equally important but consider-
ably less easy to understand and more difficult still to implement. King's charge
that NASA management did not sufficiently understand or sympathize with scien-
tific objectives (whatever that meant) was seconded by others. Fred L. Whipple,
one of the country's foremost astronomers and a member of George Mueller's
Science and Technology Advisory Committee, put it to MueUer in early August
1969 in a letter calling attention to the lamentable situation at Houston. "I have
yet to talk to a scientist connected with the Apollo project," he wrote, "who feels
that he is really welcome there by the engineers. The atmosphere.., is not hos-
tile but it certainly is negative." In 26 years of working with engineers, Whipple
said, he had often had disagreements but had "never encountered the negative
type of attitude that persists at the MSC." He had personally heard an astronaut
say, in effect, that if only they could put all the scientists in a cage, then the
engineers and astronauts could get on with the program. Clearly this was not
a milieu in which a scientist could work effectively. 59
Later in the year, but in response to the same events, Alex J. Dessler, head
of the Space Physics and Astronomy department at Rice University, commented
on the discontent of the space scientists. In spite of the fact that American space
science was recognized as the most productive in the world, and space science
was relatively better supported than many other fields of science, the discontent
of space scientists was widespread and growing more intense. Dessler noted that
their attitude, though in some sense incongruous, was important, because Con-
gress was sure to listen if a number of prominent space scientists began to con-
demn the Apollo program. Scientists evidently felt that they had no effective
advocate at a high level in NASA--in contrast to the engineers, who were quite
well represented by George Mueller at the head of a program office. Even when
the scientists got what they wanted, Dessler said, they felt frustrated at "the
appearance of condescension on the part of the engineers.., the scientists some-
times feel they are being thrown a bone to shut them up. ''6°
Both Whipple and Dessler suggested similar solutions to the problem. Whipple
thought that much of the misunderstanding arose from NASA's desire to justify
Apollo on scientific grounds, something he believed could not be done. Manned
space flight, which he supported, had its own reasons for being, but they were
not necessarily scientific. He suggested that the only way MSC could gain the
support of scientists was to put a scientist of high repute, acceptable to both out-
side critics and the engineers and astronauts with whom he worked, in a posi-
tion "in which [he] has a major role in all of the decisions made with regard to
170
Lunar Exploration Begins
the operation of the Center." Dessler saw a need for a similar scientific heavy-
weight at Headquarters; scientists had had no such advocate since Hugh Dryden.*
For the manned space flight program to be acceptable to the scientific commu-
nity, apparently, scientists had to be in undisputed command.
This attitude was not new; even in the unmanned space science program, scien-
tists contended for influence in shaping NASA's programs and felt they did not
have enough. Homer Newell, as associate administrator for the Office of Space
Science and Applications from 1963 to 1967, had dealt with them time and again.
In retrospect he wrote, "Scientists are a contentious lot .... and the tremendous
opportunities of the space program inspired them to more intense dispute than
usual." Much of the tension in the space program, Newell said, "stemmed from
the scientists' presumption of special privilege, which at times Congress found
irritating."6_ That presumption, sometimes verging on arrogance, was unmistak-
able in the complaints aired during the summer of 1969, and, like Congress,
Apollo's engineers could hardly help finding it irritating. By their own lights,
the engineers were doing their best to facilitate scientific exploration of the moon
within the limitations of a very complex technology that offered many chances
for catastrophic failure. They were reluctant to take extreme risks--as by landing
at a site for which they had inadequate data simply because it looked more interest-
ing to the scientists.
The general malaise of the times may also have contributed to this somewhat
vague but strongly felt sense of impotence on the part of scientists. For the first
time in some years the value of pure research, long extolled by spokesmen for
science, was in question. The college generation of young Americans, including
many science students, grew concerned for the earth's environment. They often
indiscriminately attributed its deterioration to both inhumane science and mind-
less technology. They also disparaged the academics' devotion to research--most
particularly research subsidized by the military--as the major function of the
university, demanding more attention to teaching. A small group of radical stu-
dents forcibly brought these concerns to the attention of scientists late in 1969
at the national meeting of the American Association for the Advancement of
Science in Boston. The normally sedate proceedings were disrupted by hecklers,
organized demonstrations, and rump sessions, to the considerable distress of the
scientific community. 62
Whatever the origins of the space scientists" unhappiness, their public clamor
for more science on Apollo did not go unheeded. George Mueller wrote to MSC
Director Robert Gilruth in early September 1969, urging him to give this problem
his personal attention. After listing the steps already taken to support the science
program within a steadily declining personnel ceiling, Mueller cautioned that
*Hugh L. Dryden, director of the National Advisory Committee for Aeronautics (NACA) from 1947
to 1958, achieved his reputation through basic research in aerodynamics conducted at the National
Bureau of Standards. His election to the National Academy of Sciences in 1944 attested to his stature
among his peers. Although he was not active in research after taking over NACA, Dryden's skills
as a research administrator during difficult times earned widespread respect in the agency. He was
appointed deputy administrator of NASA in 1958, remaining in that post until his death in 1965.
Some pioneer space scientists remember him with something approaching hero worship.
171
Where No Man Has Gone Before
we will certainly detract measurably from the success of Apollo 11, and the
missions yet to be flown, unless we meet the challenge [of providing] the sup-
port required in the science area.
Noting that "some members of the scientific community are impatient and as
you know, are willing to air their views without necessarily relating those views
to what is practicable and possible," he stated that
Scientists had been reasonably well satisfied with the way the Apollo 11 samples
were processed, although there was considerable waste motion and some confu-
sion attributable to inexperience in the first real exercise of the lunar receiving
laboratory. The most serious complaint concerned the long delay in releasing sam-
ples to principal investigators. However, many deficiencies in equipment and
procedures had shown up during the first mission that required correction before
Jim Lovell (left) and Fred Haise work with the heat flow experiment during training at the Kennedy
Space Center.
ORIGINAL PAGE
172
RI2 ¢K AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPIq
Lunar Exploration Begins
ORIGINAL PAGE
BLACK AND WH1TE PHOTOGRAPH
Fred Haise, lunar module pilot on Apollo 13, practices using the lunar drill.
173
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Apollo 12, scheduled for mid-November. So, while completing their tasks fol-
lowing Apollo 11, scientists in the Lunar Receiving Laboratory were also prepar-
ing to incorporate necessary changes.
In early September the Lunar Sample Analysis Planning Team forwarded to
Anthony J. Calio, MSC's new Director of Science and Applications, a list of recom-
mended changes concerning matters such as weighing of samples, procedures
for transferring samples during quarantine, and photography. They also suggested
improving the display of information on sample history, status, and location, since
it had proved difficult during Apollo 11 to keep everyone informed of where the
individual samples were and what had been done to them. 64
Also in need of improvement was the vacuum system into which the returned
sample containers were first admitted to the laboratory. Problems had been fore-
seen in handling the samples under high vacuum, and indeed problems had devel-
oped during simulations and during the first mission (see Chapter 9). Members
of the analysis planning team now felt it was mandatory to open the lunar sam-
pie container in an atmosphere of dry nitrogen rather than in vacuum. If two
containers were returned, one could be opened in the vacuum system; but rather
than conduct the preliminary examination there, the contents should immedi-
ately be canned and stored under vacuum for the few investigators who required
vacuum-preserved specimens. The vacuum facility posed too many problems,
such as rupture of the gloves and contamination by organic materials from the
vacuum pumps, to allow continuation of its use for all the lunar samples. 65
Others who had been involved in handling the Apollo 11 samples offered
suggestions for reducing the number of people in the laboratory, separating the
functions of the preliminary examination team and the analysis planning team,
and eliminating the preparation of two samples for quarantine testing. All these
changes would speed up the release of samples to outside investigators. 66
A meeting in late September settled many of these questions, deciding that a
single "biopool" sample would be prepared for the biological tests rather than
the two that had been used on Apollo 11 and that the two sample return con-
tainers would be processed simultaneously: one in the vacuum system in the phys-
ical chemistry laboratory and the other under sterile nitrogen in the biological
preparation laboratory. Among other procedural changes adopted at this meet-
ing was a provision that the analysis planning team would begin work only after
the preliminary examination team had completed its tasks. 67
The Interagency Committee on Back Contamination continued to press for the
installation of a bacterial filter on the command module postlanding ventilation
system. MSC was unyielding although engineers continued to evaluate solutions
to the problem.68 Agreement was reached to discontinue using the biological iso-
lation garments, provided no crew member was ill on return. Recovery teams
would provide clean flight suits and respiratory masks for the astronauts to put
on before they left the command module. 69
For the crews, August, September, and October were packed with simulations,
briefings, and field trips. In mid-August they got their first briefing on the Sur-
veyor at the Jet Propulsion Laboratory. A month later they spent a day with the
geologists in the lunar receiving laboratory, examining the Apollo 11 rocks and
discussing plans for collecting samples. 70
174
LunarExploration Begins
Geologists had high hopes for the Apollo 12 crew. They had been the first to
go through a revised geology training program that stressed basic principles of
site exploration rather than minutiae such as identification of rocks. By the time
they were ready for launch, Pete Conrad and Alan Bean and their backups had
well over 200 hours of field work under their belts. Their last field trip, to the
volcanic fields of Hawaii, was extremely satisfying to their training officers. They
handled every problem put to them, their descriptions and photographs were
excellent, and their sampling of the terrain was first-rate. Everyone looked for-
ward to superior results from the first real lunar scientific expedition. 71
At Kennedy Space Center, preparations for the launch of Apollo 12 went
smoothly. The first complete lunar surface experiments package arrived at KSC
in late March. Spacecraft and Saturn V were mated on July 1, and the vehicle
was moved to launch complex 39A on September 8. A week before launch the
recovery quarantine equipment and mobile quarantine facility were ready for ship-
ment to the recovery ship, U.S.S. Hornet. From then on, the only hitch in launch
preparations occurred two days before launch, when discovery of faulty insula-
tion on a liquid hydrogen tank in the service module required exchanging the
tank for one on the Apollo 13 spacecraft. As launch day dawned, the only por-
tent of possible delay was a cold front approaching the Cape from the north. 72
175
iii _!
11
Lunar exploration began in earnest with the launch of the first "H" mission,
Apollo 12. Successful in all respects, Apollo 12 crowned the accomplishments
of 1969 by establishing the ability to put the lunar module down on the moon
within walking distance of a desired spot. That done, the next mission was
planned for a landing on the Fra Mauro Formation, the site highest on the scien-
tists' priority list. Apollo 13 was targeted to land there, but an equipment failure
forestalled a lunar landing and came close to costing three lives. Real-time improvi-
sation saved NASA from calamity and demonstrated the versatility of the Manned
Spacecraft Center's mission planning and mission control teams.* After a thor-
ough investigation that delayed subsequent missions by almost a year, Apollo
14 was assigned to land at the same site.
Not long after Apollo 12 returned, scientists gathered in Houston to present
the results of their investigations of the first lunar samples. In what was surely
one of the most exciting scientific conclaves of the century, practically all existing
theories of the moon's origin were thrown into doubt in one respect or another,
and scientists were more eager than ever for data. Shortly after that conference,
management at MSC sat down with lunar investigators and worked out ways
of increasing the amount and quality of the data to be returned by future Apollo
missions.
Their expectations, however, were soon reduced when the pressures of a tight-
ening federal budget forced cancellation of one of the planned Apollo missions.
Faced with drastic reductions in funding, NASA managers chose to allot more
of the available money to post-Apollo programs on which continuation of the
manned space flight program depended. Apollo 11 had ushered in an era of hard
choices, not expanding horizons.
The morning of November 14, 1969, was cold, cloudy, and wet at Kennedy
Space Center. Weather radar showed rain showers marking a cold front 80 miles
*See Appendix 8.
(130 kilometers) north of the Cape and moving south. With launch only hours
away, rain, broken low clouds, and overcast at 3,000 meters (9,800 feet) caused
launch officials to consider their options. Reports indicated no thunderstorms or
severe turbulence in the area, however, and conditions were better than the mini-
mums specified by launch rules. An hour and 22 minutes before liftoff, a pump
replenishing liquid oxygen in the launch vehide tanks failed. With success depend-
ing on a backup pump, launch director Walter Kapryan chose to proceed. 1 The
crew had trained intensively for the specific features of the planned landing site,
and if the day's launch window closed, that site would not be accessible for
another month.
Apollo 12 flew smoothly into a normal earth orbit, and after the inertial gui-
dance system was realigned and all systems checked out, Houston gave the sig-
nal to fire the S-IVB stage for translunar insertion. Three and a half hours into
the flight, command pilot Richard F. Gordon turned command module Yankee
Clipper around, extracted the lunar module Intrepid from its stowage site atop the
third stage, and Apollo 12 continued on its way to the moon. 4
The only midcourse correction maneuver of the outbound flight was performed
the next day, a 9.2-second burn that put the spacecraft on a fuel-saving hybrid
trajectory, s For the rest of the uneventful three-and-a-half-day trip to lunar orbit,
the crew spent their time housekeeping, tending to spacecraft systems, and
observing the earth and the moon. 6
Arriving at the moon 831/2 hours after liftoff, Conrad fired the main propulsion
engine for almost 6 minutes to go into an elliptical lunar orbit. Five hours later a
second burn put the spacecraft into a circular orbit at 60 nautical miles (111
kilometers) altitude, where Yankee Clipper would stay until it was time to return to
earth. The spacecraft passed over and photographed Apollo 13's landing area
in the Fra Mauro formation, and on the tenth revolution Conrad notified Cap-
corn Gerald Carr that "you can tell good Captain Shaky [Jim Lovell, commander
of Apollo 13] that he can relax. We've got his pictures. ''7
178
FirstPhase of Lunar Exploration Completed: 1969-1970
NORTH
Actual and projected ground tracks for the Apollo 12 landing. Numbered circles indicate successive
changes in the landing point designation made by Commander Conrad during the landing.
Six hours into the fourth day, Conrad and Bean prepared to enter and activate
the lunar module. Both were having trouble with their biomedical sensors; Con-
rad's were blistering his skin and Bean's were producing erratic signals. Both
men cleaned and reattached their electrodes, then finished donning their space
suits and began preparing Intrepid for departure. 8
For the next several hours Conrad and Bean in Intrepid and Gordon in Yankee
Clipper were busy setting up their guidance and navigation computers and
exchanging data with the ground. When all was ready, Gordon turned the space-
craft so that the long axis of the command and service module was perpendicu-
lar to the flight path with the lunar module outward from the moon, retracted
the docking latches, and fired his attitude-control thrusters to move Yankee Clip-
per away from Intrepid. 9 The landing craft was 5 miles (8 kilometers) north of its
intended ground track--largely as a result of an error in the landing site location
and the inability to adequately correct for the moon's irregular gravity field. This
and other errors would be removed by the instructions transmitted to the gui-
dance computer after the lunar module headed down for its landing. 1°
On the back side of the moon in the 13th revolution, the computer triggered
a 29-second firing of the descent engine, bringing the low point of Intrepid's orbit
to 8.1 nautical miles (15 kilometers). As the lander passed north of Mare Nec-
taris, Conrad turned it on its back with the descent engine pointed along the flight
path and switched the engine on to begin the final approach. Everything went
exactly as expected, and after two minutes Conrad commented that it "feels good
to be standing up in a g-field again." Three minutes later the module's attitude-
control thrusters began firing busily--more than Conrad thought they should--
but Houston assured him that all was well. 11
After seven minutes Intrepid nosed over into a near-upright position and for
the first time Conrad could see the lunar surface. The principal landmark iden-
tifying his landing point was a pattern of craters the astronauts called "Snow-
man"; Surveyor III lay halfway up the eastern wall of the crater that was the
Snowman's torso, and Intrepid was targeted for the center of the crater. As soon
as he could see out the window, Conrad cried delightedly, "Hey, there it is [Snow-
man]! There it is! Son of a gun! Right down the middle of the road!" Then, as
Bean called out altitude, velocity, and quantity of fuel remaining, Conrad maneu-
vered the craft with his hand controller to pick a smooth spot to land on. The
engine exhaust began kicking up dust about a hundred feet (30 meters) above
the surface and by the time Intrepid reached 50 feet (15 meters) the cloud obscured
the surface completely. At 1:54:36 a.m. EST on November 20, Pete Conrad made
a blind landing--exactly where, he could not tell, but certainly close to the intended
spot. TM
Conrad was naturally anxious to determine where he had set Intrepid down,
and while he and Bean went through the post-landing check list they occasion-
ally looked out the windows for landmarks that would allow Houston to pin-
point their location, but without success. After changing his mind a time or two,
Conrad finally concluded, "I'm not sure that I'm not sitting right smack on the
other side of the Surveyor crater, just a little bit past it." Two hours later, Dick
Gordon in Yankee Clipper confirmed Conrad's guess when he sighted both Intrepid
and Surveyor III through his sextant as he passed over the site. He told Houston
that the lunar module was "on the left shoulder of the Snowman .... about
a third of the way from the Surveyor crater to the head. 13 Postmission calcula-
APOLLO 12
EVA 2 TRAVERSE
Apollo 12"ssecond traverse, made by Pete Conrad and Alan Bean. "Head" crater was the head of the
"Snowman," the pattern of craters used by Conrad to locate his landing site.
180
FirstPhase of Lunar Exploration Completed: 1969-1970
tions placed Intrepid on the northwest rim of the Surveyor crater, 535 feet (163
meters) from the inert spacecraft. 14 Had there been windows in the back of the
lunar module_ Conrad could have spotted the Surveyor as soon as the dust settled.
After postlanding checks of systems, Conrad and Bean described what they
could see from their spacecraft. Intrepid had landed in undulating terrain pocked
with craters ranging from a few feet to .several hundred feet across, the larger
ones rimmed by large blocks of rock. Numerous boulders, up to 20 feet (6 meters)
in size, were scattered around the site, most of them angular rather than rounded,
many showing fillets of dust around the base. Immediately in front of the land-
ing craft Bean saw an area of "patterned ground"--parallel cracks in the surface
soil perhaps an eighth of an inch (3 millimeters) deep. From the lunar module
the crew could distinguish no color differences in the rocks or soil; everything
seemed the same bright white. TM
Five and a half hours after landing, Conrad squeezed out the hatch, then clam-
bered down the ladder to the bottom rung. As he stepped off onto the landing
Manned and unmanned lunar exploration meet: lunar module Intrepid, extreme upper left, rests on
the rim of the crater in which Surveyor III, right center, landed three years earlier. Apollo 12
astronauts Pete Conrad and Alan Bean took this picture toward the end of their second surface
traverse. They photographed the spacecraft and cut offseveral pieces of its hardware to return to earth
for study.
ORIGINAL PAC_E
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAI_
181
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Apollo 12 Commander Pete Con rad inspects the Surveyor III spacecraft. Two solar panels at the top of
the unmanned spacecraft provided electricity. Projecting in front of Conrad is the Surveyor's surface
sampler, extended on its lazy-tongs mechanism. Immediately to Conrad's right is the mirror for
Surveyor's television camera, which took hundreds of photographs of the surface. The lunar module
Intrepid, with its high-gain antenna deployed on the surface, is on the lip of the Surveyor crater,
upper right.
pad Conrad remarked, "Man, that [step] may have been a small one for Neff,
but that's a long one for me."* Looking around, he spotted the Surveyor half-
way up the opposite wall of the crater. One of the first things Conrad noticed
was that he was going to get extremely dirty: the surface dust was finer and deeper
than he had expected. TM
After Conrad had collected the contingency sample Bean joined him on the sur-
face, bringing the television camera with him. A few minutes later Houston
reported that the camera was not working. Cursory attempts at trouble-shooting
were fruitless, and television coverage for the mission--desirable but not
essential--had to be written off. *.17 The explorers pressed on with their other
*At 5 feet 6 inches (168 centimeters), Conrad was one of the shorter astronauts; Armstrong was
just under 6 feet (183 centimeters). The lowest rung of the ladder was about 2.5 feet (75 centimeters)
above the landing pad.
**Later examination determined that the image-tube target in the camera had been damaged by
exposure to intense light. Apparently Bean had inadvertently pointed the camera at the sun or a reflec-
tion off the lunar module while helping Conrad set up a directional antenna. MSC-01855, "Apollo
12 Mission Report," March 1970, p. 14-50.
ORIGIN. ,L PAGE
182 BLACK AND WHtlE PHO].,-OGRAP_
First Phase of Lunar Exploration Completed: 1969-1970
The primary objective of their first excursion was to deploy the scientific experi-
ments. Conrad and Bean unloaded the package easily, picked a spot 130 meters
(425 feet) northwest of the lander, and laid out the instruments without any seri-
ous difficulty. 19 On their way back to Intrepid they picked up more documented
samples and Bean took a soil sample with the core tube. After nearly four hours
on the surface, the astronauts returned to the lunar module, dusted each other
off as best they could without brush or vacuum cleaner, and climbed back inside.
After a brief evaluation of the day's work and some discussion of the next day's
plans, Houston signed off and the two astronauts strung up their hammocks and
turned in3 0
Overnight the geologists in Houston, working from several scenarios prepared
before the mission, formulated detailed plans for the geology exercise the
astronauts would carry out on their second outing. Next morning, when Bean
and Conrad were awake and ready to talk, CapCom Paul Weitz read through
the plans with them, discussing the scientists" recommendations for sampling
and photography, while the astronauts offered comments based on the previous
day's experience. Then they donned and checked over their space suits, recharged
with oxygen their portable life-support systems, vented the cabin, and set out
to collect samples. 21
During the next four hours Bean and Conrad covered something more than
one kilometer (3,300 feet), following a large-scale photographic map prepared for
the traverse and chatting constantly with each other and with Houston. 22 Scien-
tists in Houston followed their progress from their references to the maps they
carried. The extensive conversation was intended to substitute for a geologist's
field notes. 23 On the nearly featureless lunar surface, sampling proved somewhat
difficult; except for size, most of the rocks showed few distinguishing features.
Colors and textures were not always easy to determine, and when they were,
the astronauts tended to use nonscientific terms in describing them--probably
a symptom of their sensitivity to possible misuse of geological terminology. At
one point Conrad noted a rock containing a "'ginger-ale-bottle green" crystal
(which was probably olivine), and a few minutes later Bean spotted a rock he
said "looks almost like a granite," but immediately added, "of course it proba-
bly isn't, but it has the same sort of texture." Bean and Conrad documented their
samples carefully, photographing many of them and describing the location and
bag number for later reference. At "Head" crater, following instructions from
Houston, Conrad dislodged a medium-sized rock and allowed it to roll down the
slope to determine whether the seismometer some 70 meters (230 feet) away could
detect it (it did). Then it was on to "Bench" and "Sharp" craters, where they
sampled several large rocks on the surface that might be bedrock thrown out when
the craters were formed. 24
Two hours into the traverse the astronauts were on the edge of the Surveyor
crater. The slope of the crater wall was much less than it had appeared the day
before, when the low sun cast long, deceptive shadows. Pausing to reload a cam-
era and survey the situation, they decided it would be easier to walk across the
slope of the crater wall rather than come down from the rim. Approaching from
183
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
the side, they could take photographs of the landing-pad imprints and the trenches
dug by Surveyor's remotely controlled arm without disturbing the surface. These
would be compared with television pictures transmitted from the spacecraft
immediately after its landing. 2s
Examination of the Surveyor, the only human artifact ever encountered in lunar
exploration, was among the more interesting parts of the mission for Conrad and
Bean. What they noticed first was that much of its originally white surface had
turned brown--a change they attributed to a deposit of dust when they found
it could be wiped off. After photographing the surrounding surface and examin-
ing the spacecraft, they removed the Surveyor's television camera and cut off
pieces of electrical cable and structural tubing for study by scientists at the Jet
Propulsion Laboratory. They decided to remove the trenching scoop as well; then,
after collecting soil samples, they headed for another small crater to take a few
more samples on their way back to the lunar module. 26
One of several intriguing mounds in the Apollo 12 landing area in Oceanus Procellarum, reported but
not thoroughly investigated by astronauts Alan Bean and Pete Conrad.
ORIGINAL PAGE'
184BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPflr
First Phase of Lunar Exploration Completed: 1969-1970
Back in their spacecraft, Conrad and Bean had almost six hours before lifting
off to rendezvous with Yankee Clipper. After throwing out their portable life-
support systems they straightened up the cabin, stowing the rock boxes and
improvising stowage for the television camera, which Houston wanted to exam-
ine. They had carried in considerably more lunar dust than Armstrong and Aldrin
had reported; Conrad told Houston they looked like "a couple of bituminous
coal miners right at the moment, but we're happy. ''27
Despite the fact that they had trebled the existing record for lunar surface
activity, Bean and Conrad were not exhausted and had expended about 10 per-
cent less energy than anticipated. Both returned to the lunar module with almost
40 percent of their oxygen supply remaining on both excursions38 Bean suggested
to the medical officers that he would have enjoyed an occasional drink of water
while working on the surface; not that he felt dehydrated, but he would have
been more comfortable if he had been able to relieve the dryness in his mouth39
Intrepid's ascent stage lifted off the moon on time, and an hour and a half later
Conrad had Yankee Clipper in sight. Back in lunar orbit the dust the lunar explorers
had brought in with them began to float, thick enough to be visible in the cabin.
After the two spacecraft had docked they attempted to vacuum up the dust, with
little success, so they removed and packaged their suits in the lunar module, hop-
ing to minimize contamination of the command module. In spite of their efforts,
considerable dust dung to everything they brought back and remained suspended
An eclipse of the sun such as few have ever seen. On earth, a solar eclipse is produced by the moon; as
the Apollo 12 spacecraft moved into the earth's shadow on the return trip, the earth eclipsed the sun.
_° 3 185
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
in the atmosphere; the environmental control system seemed not to filter it out
as completely as had been expected. 3°
Intrepid, now a useless hulk, still had one more contribution to make to the
scientific objectives of the mission. For the benefit of seismologists wanting to
calibrate the instrument that Bean and Conrad had just left on the moon, Mis-
sion Control now burned the empty spacecraft's remaining fuel to take it out of
orbit. At a speed of 1.67 kilometers per second (3,735 miles per hour) the ascent
stage plowed into the moon 76 kilometers (47 miles) east-southeast of the instru-
ment package, producing a bizarre response: the seismometer recorded vibra-
tions that persisted almost undiminished for nearly an hour. It was so completely
unlike anything ever seen on earth that seismologists had no immediate expla-
nation. One scientist compared the result to striking a church bell and hearing
the reverberations for 30 minutes. 31
Yankee Clipper stayed in lunar orbit for 11 more revolutions, finishing up the
"bootstrap" photography and landmark tracking, looking at sites being consid-
ered for Apollo 14 and 15. Then the crew boosted their spacecraft out of lunar
orbit and settled in for the three-day voyage home. Now and then they chatted
with the duty CapCom about something that crossed their minds concerning their
exploration. Once in a while scientists wanted to debrief them concerning details
of their lunar surface activity. For most of the time, however, they relaxed. 32
At one point both Conrad and Bean passed along some reservations they had
about the field geology exercise. They had found the lunar surface a particularly
difficult one for classical field-geological techniques. Bean commented,
• . . we talked with [the geologists], before we went, about [the fact that] the
main objectives of the geology wasn't to go out and grab a few rocks and take
some pictures, but to try to understand the morphology and the stratigra-
phy.., of the vicinity you were in. Look around and try to use your head
along those lines. Well, I'll tell you, there [were] less than ten times I stood
in spots.., and said, "'Okay now, Bean .... is it possible to look out there
and try to determine.., which is first, which is second, and all that?"... That
whole area has been acted on by these meteoroids or something else so that
all these features that are normally neat clues to you on earth are not available
for observation.
Conrad concurred: "! think even a trained geologist would have trouble doing
a whole lot of field geology that way on the moon."33 Long afterward, Bean still
felt that astronauts could be most effective on the lunar surface by selecting and
documenting as many apparently different kinds of samples as possible rather
than attempting on-the-spot geologizing. 34 During a press conference on the last
day out, Conrad was asked whether he thought it would be desirable to have
a geologist as a member of the crew. He did indeed think so, but pointed out
that landing Intrepid had required all the piloting skill he had35--implicitly echo-
ing Deke Slayton's contention that landing on the moon was not yet a job for
a novice.
Early on the morning of November 24 Apollo 12 splashed down some 600 kilo-
meters (375 miles) east of Pago Pago, 3.5 kilometers (2 miles) from the recovery
ship U.S.S. Hornet. The landing was rough--apparently Yankee Clipper hit a ris-
ing wave as it swung on its parachutes--hard enough to dislodge a 16-ram movie
186
First Phase of Lunar Exploration Completed: 1969-1970
camera from its bracket and slam it into Alan Bean's forehead, momentarily stun-
ning him and opening a 1-inch (2.5-centimeter) cut, which Conrad bandaged. 36
The recovery swimmers soon arrived, tossed respirators and coveralls--replacing
the biological isolation garments that the Apollo 11 crew had found so
objectionable--into the command module, then assisted the astronauts into the
raft. Half an hour later recovery helicopters set the crew down aboard the Hornet
and they went straight to their mobile quarantine facility. Lunar sample containers
and film magazines were removed and flown to Pago Pago and thence to Hous-
ton. The astronauts had a longer journey: four days aboard ship to Hawaii, then
a nine-hour flight to Houston. On the morning of November 29, Conrad, Bean,
and Gordon entered the Lunar Receiving Laboratory for their 11-day stay in
quarantine. 37
That Apollo 12 was a success was apparent even on preliminary evaluation.
The procedural changes incorporated to improve landing accuracy had allowed
Conrad to put Intrepid down within sight of Surveyor III, exactly as intended. Lunar
exploration had been easy; neither Bean nor Conrad encountered any unexpected
difficulties and both had oxygen to spare when they returned. And while they
The last leg of a half-million-mile journey: in the early morning light of November 29, I969, the
Apollo 12 mobile quarantine facility is trucked through the main entrance to the Manned Spacecraft
Center on its way to the lunar receiving laboratory and quarantine.
ORIGINAl. PAGE
187 BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Where No Man Has Gone Before
had found it hard to apply their field-geology training on the unrevealing sur-
face of Oceanus Procellarum, they had collected nearly 75 pounds (34 kilograms)
of samples, most of them documented. The surface experiments they had set up
were returning streams of data, and scientists agreed the astronauts had done
a remarkable job. Communication between scientists in Houston and the
astronauts on the moon had been well handled by Mission Control. 3s If Apollo
12 was a reliable indicator, the scientific return from the remaining eight mis-
sions should be gratifying.
188
First Phase of Lunar Exploration Completed: 1969-1970
too much like Apollo 11's (see Chapter 10), but these analyses showed other-
wise. Chemically, the rocks from both sites were similar, containing the same
elements but in somewhat different proportions. Only two rocks from Apollo
12 were breccias, however, which predominated in the Apollo 11 samples. Many
of the igneous rocks returned by Apollo 12 were very coarse grained, suggesting
that they might have crystallized slowly, probably at considerable depth. While
the Apollo 11 samples had been notably rich in titanium, those from Apollo 12
were not. Both types were deficient in volatile elements. Olivine comprised only
about 10 percent of the first samples but was abundant in the second set. 46Petro-
logical examination indicated that the Apollo 12 rocks had crystallized at a high
temperature. 47 Preliminary potassium-argon dating suggested that the samples
from Oceanus Procellarum had solidified some 2.2 to 2.6 billion years ago, com-
pared to about 4 billion years for those from the Tranquility site. 48 Detailed results
from the work of principal investigators would not be available for some months,-
but these preliminary findings provoked considerable discussion at the first Lunar
Science Conference the following month.
Elsewhere in the Lunar Receiving Laboratory, the crew and their companions
in confinement had an uneventful three weeks. Debriefings by engineers and
scientists took up several hours a day for the first week; preparing the pilot's
report required much of the next, and they were grateful to have the uniterrupted
time to complete this chore. Visits by their families--through the glass wall in
the conference room--plus television and movies and the occasional game of pool
or Ping-Pong, provided some diversion. Conrad worked on assembling an FM
receiver kit but did not complete it. The scientists managed to get some samples
passed in to them in the crew reception area and were able to continue work on
the samples to a limited extent. They also got the chance to discuss the lunar
traverses with Conrad and Bean, using photographs as they became available. 49
Periodic medical evaluations showed no change in the condition of either the
crews or the quarantined scientists, and on December 10, 36 hours before the
quarantine officially ended, they were released, to be kept under medical sur-
veillance until biological tests on the samples showed them to be no threat to
life on earth. 5°
Throughout December those tests continued as the Apollo 12 samples were
exposed to dozens of plant and animal species. Meanwhile the examination and
characterization of the lunar rocks and soil continued, and the Lunar Sample Anal-
ysis Planning Team began the task of matching investigators' requirements with
the samples. Release of material to outside researchers was scheduled as soon
as the biological tests were completed, expected in early January 1970.
The decade of Apollo ended with investigators of the lunar samples preparing
to present their first findings to the scientific world. On January 5, 1970, several
hundred scientists, induding all 142 principal investigators for the Apollo 11 sam-
ples, met in Houston for the first of many annual Lunar Science Conferences.
For four days they discussed the chemistry, mineralogy, and petrology of the
189
Where No Man Has Gone Before
lunar samples, described the search for carbon compounds and evidence of liv-
ing material, the results of age determinations, and what had been learned from
the data returned from the surface instruments.
The flood of information presented at the conference precluded any large gener-
alizations. Some of the rocks brought back by Apollo 11 were basalts, formed
by melting, but the samples contained a high percentage of breccias. Most of the
rock fragments were similar to the larger rocks; a small number, however, were
entirely unlike the rest and may have come from the nearby lunar highlands.
The properties of most of the material were consistent with formation at high
temperature in the absence of oxygen or water. More than 20 minerals known
on earth had been identified, suggesting a similarity of origin for the two planets,
but at least three new ones unique to the moon had been discovered. The ages
of the lunar rocks and soil seemed to differ: the basalts from Tranquility Base
were found to be between 3 and 4 billion years old, while the soil contained par-
ticles believed to have been formed 4.6 billion years ago. 51 In light of the recently
determined age of the Apollo 12 samples, which were roughly a billion years youn-
ger, these numbers indicated that more than one cataclysmic event had shaped
the lunar surface.
Other studies showed that some lunar material dug up from below the surface
had once been on the surface, indicating that the lunar soil was undergoing con-
stant "'gardening.'" Studies of isotopes produced by cosmic-ray bombardment
indicated that some lunar rocks had been on or just below the surface for at least
10 million years. 52
The search for carbon compounds--possible relics of life forms in the moon
rocks--was inconclusive, in part because the methods of detection were extremely
sensitive. Carbon and some carbon compounds were detected, but no molecules
that could clearly be identified as derived from living organisms. The intensive
search for living organisms conducted in the Lunar Receiving Laboratory was
negative, as were efforts to identify fossil microorganisms, s3
On the whole the early work on the Apollo 11 samples was more intriguing
than revealing. A few scientists were willing, on the basis of the results presented
at the Houston conference, to discard one or more theories of lunar origin, but
most were not. One commented, "some still like the moon hot; some like it cold.'"
Many called attention to the limitations of the data and the futility of drawing
sweeping conclusions with information from such a small area. One of them put
it in perspective with the comment, "what I looked at was an area equal to the
size of three postage stamps and a thimbleful of material"; another remarked
facetiously, "'our results are based on the wanton destruction of two grams [about
the weight of a dime] of lunar material."54
After four days of discussion, a panel of prominent scientists attempted a sum-
mary at a news conference. Robert Jastrow, director of NASA's Goddard Insti-
tute for Space Studies, said that "old descriptions in terms of a hot or cold moon
are an oversimplification." To Edward Anders of the University of Chicago it was
clear that the moon "has been a geologically active body with several episodes
of melting and lava flows." For the last two or three billion years, however, it
has been almost dead. Jastrow and others doubted that the moon was thrown
off from the earth or that it was formed elsewhere and captured later. Gene Sire-
190
FirstPhaseof LunarExploration Completed: 1969-1970
mons, newly appointed chief scientist at MSC, summed up the state of lunar
science at the end of the conference. "There is a large amount of undigested data
and very little interpretation," he said. "You'll see in the next six months many
revisions of statements as to what it all means. "'55
The Lunar Sample Analysis Planning Team best characterized the significance
of the Tranquility samples:
The Apollo 11 samples were collected from a very tiny fraction of the moon's
surface. Nevertheless, they have given a vast new insight into the processes
that have shaped this surface and have established some significant limits on
the rates and mechanisms by which it evolved. The results reported do not
resolve the problem of the origin of the moon. However, the number of con-
straints that must be met by any theory have been greatly increased. For exam-
ple, if the moon formed from the earth, it can now be stated with some
confidence that this separation took place prior to 4.3 x 109 [4.3 billion] years
ago. Furthermore, such a hypothesis must now take account of certain defi-
nite differences in chemical composition [between the moon and the
earth] .... There is clear evidence.., that the surface of the moon is varia-
ble in both composition and age. It is therefore of great scientific importance to
obtain materials from a variety of terrains and sites [emphasis added]. _
After the conference ended on January 8 the scientists returned to their labs to
continue probing the lunar samples, while NASA focused on sampling the vari-
ety of terrains and sites they deemed so important. The next mission, Apollo 13,
was already targeted for the Fra Mauro Formation, 57 a geologic unit that covered
large portions of the lunar surface around Mare Imbrium. The landing site was
just north of the crater Fra Mauro, about 180 kilometers (112 miles) due east of
the spot where Pete Conrad had landed Intrepid.
Early in 1970 MSC set about to improve its relations with the lunar science com-
munity. As the first lunar science conference was meeting in Houston, Jim
McDivitt, manager of MSC's Apollo spacecraft program office, took note of scien-
tists' frequent complaints that MSC was unable or unwilling to accommodate
changes in the experiment program. "I would like to take steps to change this
impression and to attempt to generate a 'can-do' attitude toward science changes
consistent with operational and other constraints," McDivitt said. He intended
to establish a schedule for each mission, "to provide information to the science
world which will discipline their inputs to our schedule needs," and to establish
an Experiments Review Group, which was to consider new or late experiments
for the missions to recommend MSC policy on experiment changes. McDivitt him-
self would chair the group, which included Anthony J. Calio, director of science
and applications, Deke Slayton, director of flight crew operations, and Richard
S. Johnston, former special assistant to the center director now assigned to
McDivitt's office. 5s
The first lunar science conference apparently brought the question of MSC's
handling of science to a head, for Director Robert R. Gilruth moved to change
191
Where No Man Has Gone Before
his center's antiscientific image at the same time. On February 5, 1970, he and
11 of MSC's highest-ranking managers met with 9 prominent scientists involved
in the Apollo program to discuss issues between the two groups.* Several specific
problems were discussed and resolved. One major flaw the scientists found in
the conduct of Apollo science involved contact between astronauts, principal
investigators, and operations planners. Since there was not time to make non-
scientists astronauts over into scientists, the investigators insisted on giving
experimenters more time to discuss the objectives of the experiment with the
astronauts, thus improving the astronauts" understanding of what they could do
to enhance the results. Geologists had enjoyed an advantage in this respect, but
the experimenters pointed out that other disciplines were involved in lunar inves-
tigations and should get more attention in training. Another point involved com-
munication between scientists on the ground and astronauts on the moon; this
ought to be made easier, the scientists said, so that surprises could be dealt with
when encountered and procedures altered in real time if necessary. When it was
pointed out that this would require the principal investigators to learn how to
use the existing systems to best advantage, including participation in simulations,
the scientists agreed to take on that responsibility, s9
Finally, participants agreed to clarify relations between outside scientists and
MSC offices. In general experimenters should be more forthcoming with expla-
nations of the scientific rationale for experiments and MSC should simplify and
expedite reviews of proposed experiments and changes in existing plans. A general
improvement in communication between MSC, the scientists, and Headquarters
was necessary.60
Associate Administrator Homer E. Newell, who attended the meeting, later
commented approvingly to Gilruth that "the entire discussion was in a construc-
tive vein," and that "'some very complimentary remarks were made.., about
MSC's current approach to handling science." As associate administrator for
science and applications, Newell had for years tried to mediate between the scien-
tists and manned space flight officials, and he found the new attitudes gratifying
on both sides. 61
MSC immediately followed up on the February meeting by establishing a
Science Working Panel to be the single forum in which science requirements and
operational restrictions would be reconciled and adjusted. The working panel
would be advised by principal investigators and scientists representing the entire
spectrum of science. A science mission manager and a mission scientist (usually
*MSC was represented by Gilruth; Deputy Director Christopher C. Kraft, Jr.; George Abbey, tech-
nical assistant to Gilruth; Anthony J. Calio, director of Science and Applications; M. Gene Simmons,
chief scientist; Donald K. Slayton, director of Flight Crew Operations; Thomas P. Stafford, chief of
the Astronaut Office; Harrison H. Schmitt, astronaut; John Zarcaro, chief of the Lunar Missions Office;
Ted H. Foss, Geology and Geochemistry Branch; Glynn S. Lunney, Flight Control Division; and
Richard S. Johnston, Apollo Spacecraft Program Office. Scientists attending--most of them principal
investigators on Apollo--were James R. Arnold, Univ. of California at San Diego; Paul W. Gast, Colum-
bia Univ.; Marcus G. Langseth, Jr., Lamont-Doherty Geophysical Observatory; Frank Press, Mass.
Inst. of Technology; Robert Rex, Univ. of California at Riverside; Gordon A. Swann, U.S. Geological
Survey; Robert Walker, Washington Univ., St. Louis; and Gerald J. Wasserburg, Calif. Inst. of Tech-
nology. Homer E. Newell, NASA Associate Administrator, attended as an observer.
192
First Phase of Lunar Exploration Completed: 1969-1970
The last months of 1969 brought changes in several key offices in NASA Head-
quarters and the centers. Thomas O. Paine, who had succeeded James Webb as
NASA administrator less than a year earlier, called George M. Low to Headquar-
ters to become deputy administrator, the agency's second-ranking official.* After
guiding Apollo through its most difficult years and at long last establishing the
first post-Apollo project (Skylab), George Mueller announced his intent to resign
as Associate Administrator for Manned Space Flight at the end of the year. The
Air Force reassigned Lt. Gen. Sam Phillips, longtime manager of the Apollo Pro-
gram Office under Mueller, to command its Space and Missile Systems Organi-
zation. As Mueller's replacement Paine named Dale D. Myers, Apollo spacecraft
manager at North American Rockwell for many years; Phillips's place was filled
by Rocco A. Petrone, director of launch operations at Kennedy Space Center.
At Houston, Gilruth appointed Col. James A. McDivitt, command pilot on Gemini
W and commander of Apollo 9, to head the Apollo spacecraft project office and
Christopher C. Kraft, Jr., MSC's director of flight operations, to be deputy cen-
ter director. 65 MSC also had a new Director of Science and Applications, Anthony
J. Calio, who succeeded Wilmot Hess after Hess's resignation in the fall (see
Chapter 10).
New managers faced new problems in the year following Apollo 11's resound-
ing success. Public enthusiasm for lunar missions waned when, with Apollo 12,
they began to seem routine. Funding prospects were also bleak. Lyndon John-
son's last budget submittal (in January 1969) requested $3.878 billion for NASA, 66
nearly 25 percent lower than the budget for the peak year, fiscal 1965. When
Richard Nixon's first budget was submitted in April, that figure was reduced to
$3.833 billion. Paine put the best face he could on the situation; the reductions
would require "difficult program adjustments," but in the context of the adminis-
tration's determination to reduce government spending, "the nation can con-
tinue a scientifically effective program of manned lunar exploration" and the
capability to produce Saturn V boosters would not lapse beyond recovery. 67 When
the space agency's appropriation bill was signed in November, it provided only
$3.697 billion, and the adjustments became even more difficult. 68
*At the time Low, who took over as manager of MSC's Apollo spacecraft project office after the
AS-204 fire in April 1967, was serving as special assistant to MSC Director Robert R. Gilruth.
193
Where No Man Has Gone Before
*Chaired by Vice-President Spiro T. Agnew, the group included Robert C. Seamans, Secretary of
the Air Force and former deputy administrator of NASA; Thomas O. Paine, NASA Administrator;
and Lee A. Dubridge, Science Adviser to the President. Observers were U. Alexis Johnson, Under-
secretary of State for Political Affairs; Glenn T. Seaborg, chairman of the Atomic Energy Commis-
sion; and Robert P. Mayo, director of the Bureau of the Budget.
194
First Phase of Lunar Exploration Completed: 1969-1970
JamesLovell, Apollo 13 commander,practices moonwaIkingin a device that offsets 5/oof his weight.
ORIGINAL PAGE
195
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Where No Man Has Gone Before
announced that Apollo 20 had been canceled and the schedule for the seven
remaining flights would be stretched out into 1974. Four would be flown in
1970-1971 at intervals depending on the choice of sites. Lunar exploration would
then be interrupted while the three-mission Apollo Applications Program (a
rudimentary space station in earth orbit, soon to be renamed "Skylab") was con-
ducted. The last three missions to the moon would be flown in 1973 and 1974.
Low denied reports that NASA planned to cancel four Apollo flights, saying that
such action would "do away with most of our scientific return and waste the
investment we have made.'" Lunar scientists were reported to have been pleased
by Low's announcement; TM they had evidently feared that even more missions
would be deleted.
Ten days later, after preliminary discussions on the fiscal 1971 budget, adminis-
trator Thomas O. Paine revealed more changes in space exploration. Saturn V
launch vehicle production was to be suspended indefinitely after the fifteenth
booster was completed, leaving NASA with no means of putting really large pay-
loads into earth orbit or continuing lunar exploration. The last Saturn V was reas-
signed from Apollo 20 to Skylab. Unmanned explorations of Mercury and Mars
were reduced or deferred. Some 50,000 of the estimated 190,000 employees of
NASA and its contractors would have to be laid off, and many university scien-
tists would find their projects without funds. Though the new plans imposed
real austerity, Paine noted that they did provide for a start on the next project,
development of a reusable spacecraft to shuttle crews and payloads between earth
and a space station in earth orbit. _
Apollo still had supporters in Congress, however, and they tried their best to
add $130.5 million to the administration's budget for lunar exploration in fiscal
1971. But the Senate would not go along, and after a vigorous debate, the confer-
ence committee reported an authorization bill containing an increase of only $38
million for Apollo. 76 After the first two lunar landings, Congress and the nation
were ready to get on to other things--but nothing so expensive as a flight to Mars.
A congressional historian who served on the House space committee described
the dawn of the 1970s as "the worst of times for the space program," and then
summarized the budget debates:
By hindsight, it seems unlikely that even the strongest and most adept mobili-
zation of the supporters of more manned flights to the Moon could have suc-
cessfully overcome the adverse feeling in the country in the early 1970's.
Congress and the Nation could be persuaded to support Skylab, the Space
Shuttle, and a modest level of activity by NASA in many other areas.
But... Von Braun's dream of a manned flight to Mars was not in the cards
for the 20th century, at least."
Whether any Americans were going to Mars in this century or not, the crew
of Apollo 13-Jim Lovell, Ken Mattingly, and Fred Haise--were going to the moon,
and they were too busy preparing for that mission to worry about anything more
196
FirstPhaseofLunarExploration Completed: 1969-1970
l
--=
Apollo 13 astronauts James Lovell (left) and Fred Haise in training at Kennedy Space Center. This
photo gives an excellent view of the lunar module hatch (square opening above the ladder), through
which the suited astronauts had to crawl backwards, and the height of the ladder above the lunar
surface--which prompted Pete Conrad to remark on Apollo 12, "that may have been a small [step]for
Nell, but it was a big one for me."
ORIGINAL PAGE
197 BLACK AND _'H1TE PHOTOGRAPH
Where No Man Has Gone Before
spectacular. Their Saturn V was trundled out to launch complex 39A on Decem-
ber 15, 1969, anticipating launch on March 12, 1970. 78 On January 8, however,
Headquarters announced that Apollo 13 had been rescheduled for April 11 to
allow more detailed analysis of specific plans. 79
The target for Apollo 13 was a spot some 180 kilometers (112 miles) east of Apollo
12's landing site, just north of the crater Fra Mauro. The mission's primary task
was to sample the geologic unit called the Fra Mauro Formation, which covers
a large area around the Imbrium basin. The Fra Mauro Formation was generally
believed to consist of material ejected when Imbrium, one of the largest impact
basins on the moon, was formed. Scientists hoped that samples would allow them
to date the "'Imbrian event," which would establish the time relationships of
related and adjacent features. Finally, they expected that the Fra Mauro site would
provide samples that came from deep within the moon, excavated by the Imbrian
event. 8° The mission would also emplace a second set of lunar surface instru-
ments, differing from those flown on Apollo 12; a heat-flow experiment and a
charged-particle environment detector were substituted for the solar wind spec-
trometer, the magnetometer, and the suprathermal ion detector. A second cali-
bration of the lunar seismometers was to be accomplished by crashing the Saturn
V's third stage at a preselected location on the moon. 81
Preparations for the launch proceeded without major problems through Febru-
ary and March. Three days before launch, Jack Swigert took Ken Mattingly's place
as command module pilot, after the prime crew had been exposed to German
Apollo 13"s only contribution to lunar science: a seismometer in Mission Control recorded these
tracings after the Saturn S-IVB stage struck the moon.
ORIGINAL PAGE
198 BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
First Phase of Lunar Exploration Completed: 1969-1970
measles and Mattingly was found to have no immunity. Apollo 13 lifted off on
schedule at 2:13 p.m. Eastern Standard Time on April 11, and for two days oper-
ations were routine; Capcom remarked at one point that flight controllers were
bored to tears. A few hours later, however, an oxygen tank in the service mod-
ule ruptured, depriving the spacecraft of most of its electrical power and oxygen,
and the mission had to be aborted. Only a heroic effort of real-time improvisa-
tion by mission operations teams saved the crew. 8_
Almost lost in the drama of the mission was the one piece of scientific informa-
tion that Apollo 13 was able to provide. Shortly after command module pilot Jack
Swigert had extracted the lunar module from atop the S-IVB stage, ground con-
trollers fired the auxiliary propulsion system on the big rocket, putting it on a
course to crash into the moon. Three days later the 30,700-pound (13,925 kilo-
gram) hulk struck the lunar surface at 5,600 miles per hour (2.5 kilometers per
second) some 74 miles (119 kilometers) west-northwest of the Apollo 12 landing
site, releasing energy estimated as equivalent to the explosion of 7.7 tons (7,000
kilograms) of TNT. Half a minute later the passive seismometer left by Apollo
12 recorded the onset of vibrations that persisted for more than four hours.
Another instrument, the lunar ionosphere detector, sensed a gas cloud that arrived
a few seconds before the seismic signal and lasted for more than a minute. Seis-
mologists were baffled by the moon's response to shock, but welcomed the new
means of generating data. s3
In the year that it took to discover and correct the cause of the Apollo 13 fail-
ure, the scope of the remaining missions was altered. Apollo 14 would visit the
site intended for exploration by Apollo 13, but it would go there as the last of
the intermediate exploration missions. The flights that remained would stretch
the capabilities of the Apollo systems virtually to their limits, providing longer
visits to the lunar surface and increased mobility for the astronauts. Unfortunately
for lunar science, two missions were to be cut from an already minimal program.
199
ii
12
As budgets tightened and public support for lunar missions faltered in 1970,
NASA managers faced tough choices. On the one hand, the successful Apollo
exploration missions had given lunar scientists an appetite for more and more
samples--more, in fact, than even the six missions remaining on the schedule
were likely to provide. Against that stood the need to get moving on post-Apollo
programs, the first of which (Skylab) had reached a stage where it required sub-
stantial funds to stay on schedule. Given the unpalatable alternatives, NASA chose
to cut back on lunar exploration and apply the savings to its future. _
In February 1970 NASA took to Congress a budget proposal for fiscal 1971 for
$3.333 billion, down more than $500 million from the previous fiscal year. Adminis-
trator Thomas Paine listed for the House Committee on Science and Astronau-
tics the "hard choices" he had been forced to make to stay within that budget
while still making progress: suspending production of Saturn V launch vehicles
and spacecraft assigned to those vehicles, "mothballing" the Mississippi Test Facil-
ity and reducing the work force at the Michoud Assembly Facility where Saturn
Vs were assembled, closing the new Electronics Research Center at Cambridge,
Massachusetts, and canceling Apollo 20. 2 During the following summer it
appeared that Congress was in a mood to cut space funding even more. By July
rumors were circulating that more Apollo missions, perhaps as many as four,
were candidates for cancellation. 3 The first bill containing NASA's appropriation
(vetoed in August by President Nixon, who objected to the funds provided for
another agency) gave the space agency $3.269 billion--a figure that came out of
weeks of debate in House and Senate and conference committee and was clearly
all the space agency could expect. 4
On July 28, while Congress debated the funding issue, Tom Paine submitted
his resignation as NASA administrator, effective September 15, to President
Nixon. He planned to return to General Electric, the company he had left in early
1968 to become deputy administrator. Paine denied that NASA's immediate fund-
ing problems had influenced his decision, s Probably more decisive was the fact
that he saw no prospect of immediate change. From the start of his tenure as
201
PRECEDING PAGE BI.J_N',( NOT FILMED __tNTENTIONALLY RLANK
Where No Man Has Gone Before
administrator, Paine's ideas for the future of the space program were far more
ambitious than those of the President and the Bureau of the Budget.
On September 2 Paine called a press conference to announce NASA's interim
operating plan for fiscal 1971. Cutbacks and stretchouts in most major programs
were the order of the day, among them the cancellation of two more Apollo mis-
sions, 15 and 19. The remaining missions, redesignated Apollo 14-17,* would
be flown at six-month intervals in 1971 and 1972. After that would come the three
manned Skylab missions (which under earlier schedules had interrupted the
Apollo program for two years). Paine noted that he and his managers had made
this decision reluctantly and in spite of the conclusions of special reviews by the
Space Science Board of the National Academy of Sciences and the Lunar and
Planetary Missions Board, both of which had strongly recommended that all six
remaining missions be flown. Paine's main consideration had been "how best
to carry out Apollo to realize maximum benefits while preserving adequate
resources for the future post-Apollo space program. ,,6 For whatever consolation
scientists might get from it, one of the canceled missions (Apollo 15) was the last
of the limited exploration missions the three remaining after the cut would all
have considerably extended capability, including a surface roving vehicle. Left
unanswered was the question of what was to be done with the three Saturn V
boosters that no longer had missions to fly.7
Criticism of the decision to shorten Apollo was immediately forthcoming. A
New York Times editorialist called the decision "penny-wise, pound-foolish," not-
ing that the savings would amount to less than 2 percent of NASA's fiscal 1971
budget and less than 0.25 percent of the total investment in Apollo. "The budge-
tary myopia which forced this.., decision can only vindicate the critics who have
insisted that Apollo was motivated by purely prestige considerations, not scien-
tific goals," said the Times writer. While the Times had for years opposed Apollo's
high priority, "now that these huge sums have been spent the need is to obtain
the maximum yield, scientifically and otherwise, from that investment. "'8
This argument was typical of the reaction voiced by many after the cutback.
Particularly upset were lunar scientists. Astronomer Thomas Gold of Cornell
University likened the decision to "buying a Rolls Royce and then not using it
because you claim you can't afford the gas." The grand old man of lunar science,
Harold Urey, said the $40 million saved on operational costs was "'chicken feed'"
compared to the $25 billion already spent. 9 To the Washington Post he wrote,
It cost us... one half of one per cent of our gross production .... Now we
wish to finish a job which has been beautifully begun. And we get stingy.
Because of an additional cost of about 25 cents per year for each of us we drop
two flights to the moon recommended by scientific committees composed of
men who personally profit from the expenditure little or not at all. How fool-
ish and short-sighted from the view of history can we be? 10
*At the time, Apollo 14 had not yet flown. New mission numbers were 15, 16, and 17, with science
plans corresponding approximately to those of the old 16, 17, and 18.
202
Apollo Assumes Its Final Form: 1970-1971
None of the protesters, however, could offer a reasonable alternative to the cut-
backs. The New York Times editorial writer suggested that NASA seek participa-
tion, including financial contribution, by the Soviet Union or our European allies
in long-term lunar exploration--surely an unrealistic suggestion at best.
These complaints, well founded though they were, were far too late. By
mid-1970 NASA was operating on its lowest budget since fiscal 1965, under an
administration determined to reduce the federal deficit, while trying to get started
on a new generation of spacecraft and programs toward which administration
budget officers were less than enthusiastically committed. Complicating the prob-
lem of living within a restricted budget, NASA's record in holding program costs
to preprogram estimates was not good, a fact often brought up in congressional
budget hearings. (That had very nearly cost the agency the Mars landing project,
Viking, at the end of 1969. TM) Public and congressional support for purely scien-
tific missions, no matter how spectacular or important, had begun to erode before
Apollo 11. Whatever the fact may say about the nation's commitment to the space
program, NASA now lived or died by the perceptions of Congress and the
administration of the short-term value of its projects. Political pressure on the
space program was shifting in the direction of using space to solve earth's prob-
lems. 13
In mid-September 1970, 39 scientists who had long been associated with Apollo's
science program formally protested the cutbacks in a letter to the chairman of
the House Committee on Science and Astronautics, Representative George P.
Miller. They pointed out that the reduction in the number of missions might cause
the lunar science program to "fail in its chief purpose of reaching a new level
of understanding" of the origin of the earth and moon. As best they could tell,
the money saved in the "approved and scientifically most fruitful lunar program'"
was intended to support a post-Skylab manned earth-orbital project--"an as yet
unapproved program for whose scientific value there is no consensus, and whose
purpose is unclear" (i.e., the space shuttle). They concluded by expressing the
hope that the decision to cancel two Apollo missions was not yet final. 14
In reply, Miller called the scientists' attention to his committee's long record
of support for Apollo, pointing out that the committee had tried to get $220 mil-
lion more for lunar exploration into the authorization bills for fiscal 1970 and 1971.
"However, the [Nixon] Administration, in realigning national priorities, has
relegated the space program to a lesser role." Undoubtedly the two canceled
flights would have provided additional scientific information, Miller said, but that
had to be balanced against assuring the rational development of future space pro-
grams. In conclusion he mildly reproved the scientists: "Had your views on the
Apollo program been as forcefully expressed to NASA and the Congress a year
or more ago, this situation might have been prevented." But it was too late to
offer any serious hope of reinstating the two missions. TM
As the launch date for the next flight approached, lunar scientists faced hard
choices. Plans for Apollo 14 had reached the stage where no major changes were
possible• With three missions remaining instead of five, landing sites had to be
2O3
Where No Man Has Gone Before
chosen to give the best hope of answering the most important scientific ques-
tions. Experimenters and flight planners had to make the best possible use of
the extra payloads that the last three missions would be able to land on the moon.
The loss of the scientific information Apollo 13 would have returned from Fra
Mauro made it necessary to reevaluate objectives for later missions. At its meet-
ing in early March the Apollo site selection board had recommended Littrow (Fig-
ure 4, site 21) as the target for Apollo 14. TM After Apollo 13 the board's scientific
advisers almost unanimously agreed that the Fra Mauro site still rated the high
priority it had been given; they recommended sending Apollo 14 there instead
of Littrow, and the board agreed. 17 Since a number of changes in the service mod-
ule were expected as a result of the Apollo 13 investigation, Apollo 14 was resched-
uled for the third time in six months. Launch readiness was targeted for no earlier
that January 31, 1971. TM
In the nine months between the third and fourth lunar exploration missions,
the last of the year's budget shocks hit the Apollo program. With the loss of Apollo
Apollo 14 commander Alan Shepard practices towing the mobile equipment transporter while the
KC-135 airplane flies a parabolic path that reduces gravity to the level experienced on the moon. Lunar
module pilot Ed Mitchell follows the "rickshaw."
ORIGINAL PAGE
15 and 19, Apollo 14 became the last of the intermediate ("H"-type) missions.
Its basic objectives were the same as those of Apollo 13, but several changes were
made in details.
Apollo 13 had carried a surface science package consisting of a passive seis-
mometer, an atmospheric detector and a charged-particle detector, and a heat
flow instrument. Apollo 14's package left off the heat-flow experiment and added
three more: an active seismic experiment, a laser reflector like the one carried
on Apollo 11, and an ionosphere detector like the one carried on Apollo 12. The
active seismic experiment consisted of a set of detectors (geophones) to be laid
out on the surface and two devices for producing calibrated shocks. It would aid
The central processing station for the lunar surface experiments package on Apollo 14. The object
behind and to the left of the station is one component of the active seismic experiment, a mortar which
was intended to lob four explosive charges whose shocks would be recorded on the seismometer.
However, it was placed so close to the central station that experimenters feared that firing it would
cover the central station with dust, so the experiment was not performed.
ORIGINAL PAGE
205 8LACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Where No Man Has Gone Before
206
ORI(]IN/"_L PAGE Apollo Assumes Its Final Form: 1970-1971
Commander Alan Shepard walks toward the mobile equipment transporter (on which the camera was
mounted) while Ed Mitchell lays out the Apollo 14 lunar surface experiments. Note the checklist
attached to Shepard's left cuff.
After mission commander Alan Shepard and lunar module pilot Edgar Mitch-
ell had checked out Antares, command module pilot Stuart Roosa pulled Kitty
Hawk away and Antares began its descent to the surface. Last-minute course cor-
rections sent up from Houston were entered in the guidance computer and
Shepard piloted the spacecraft to a routine landing about 350 miles (563 kilometers)
west-southwest of the center of the moon's visible side. Antares was only 175 feet
(53 meters) from its targeted landing site. 29 Meanwhile Roosa had boosted Kitty
Hawk back up into a higher, circular orbit, where he had a number of tasks to
perform while his colleagues explored the Fra Mauro Formation.
The terrain on which Antares sat was gently undulating, with numerous craters
but comparatively few boulders. Mitchell commented that there was "more relief
[i.e., variations in elevation] than we anticipated from looking at the maps, 'm°
a characteristic that would cause them some difficulty later on. Having given Hous-
ton a description of what they could see, Shepard and Mitchell put on their space
suits and prepared for their first excursion.
Shepard's first words as he stepped on to the moon were inspired by his 9 years,
10 months, and 10 days of waiting from Mercury-Redstone 3, when he had been
the first American in space, to the day he stepped on the moon.* "'It's been a
*Shepard was the only one of the "Original Seven" astronauts to make that journey, only the sec-
ond to fly in the Apollo program.
207
Where No Man Has Gone Before
The lunar module Antares on the surface of the moon. The crewman to the right of the LM cannot be
identified. Note the rolling terrain, which often obscured landmarks and caused the Apollo 14
astronauts considerable difficulty in finding their way.
long way,'" he said, "but we're here."31 Mitchell joined Shepard on the lunar
surface and they unloaded the rickshaw and experiments and picked a spot some
500 feet (150 meters) west of Antares for the instruments. After laying out the
geophones for the active seismic experiment, Mitchell fired the explosive charges
in his hand-held "thumper" as they walked back to the lunar module. On the
way Shepard stopped to collect a comprehensive sample of rocks and fine sur-
face material from a representative area, found two "football-sized" rocks, and
collected some other surface samples. After more than four and a half hours they
were back in the lunar module. Houston then had half an hour's worth of ques-
tions from the scientists in the back room, and then it was time to turn in. 32
Shepard and Mitchell did most of the mission's geological field work on their
second traverse. Their biggest problem was in determining their location from
the landmarks shown on their map. More than once they changed their minds
about where they were. At the time and later, they attributed this to the rolling
terrain and the relation of their line of sight to the sun: craters might be visible
in one direction but not in another. Without familiar objects for reference, they
found it difficult to estimate distances. A prime objective was to sample the rim
of "Cone" crater, about a thousand meters (3,300 feet) from the spacecraft. By
the time they got there, however, they had spent considerable time and were
not positive that they were in the right place. As it turned out, they stopped just
a few meters short of the rim, but at the time they were not certain they were
ORIGINAL PAGE
208 BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
iill
! i _
Apollo Assumes Its Final Form: 1970-1971
on the slope of Cone, and Shepard was concerned with the tasks they had yet
to accomplish and the time available. 33 They turned back, completed the planned
traverse, and returned to Antares after another 4V2-hour excursion. They had col-
lected nearly a hundred pounds (45 kilograms) of samples and taken hundreds
of photographs documenting many of the rocks, boulders, and sampling sites,
including several panoramic views of the landing site. _ Before climbing back into
the lunar module, Shepard took out of his suit pocket "a little white pellet that's
familiar to millions of Americans"--a golf ball--and dropped it on the surface.
Then, using the handle for the contingency sample return container, to which
was attached "a genuine six-iron," he took a couple of one-handed swings. He
missed with the first, but connected with the second. The ball, he reported, sailed
for "miles and miles. ''aS
During the 331/2 hours Shepard and Mitchell were on the moon, Stuart Roosa
had several important tasks to perform in Kitty Hawk. Continuing what had begun
on Apollo 12, he photographed one of the remaining candidate landing areas (Des-
cartes) and made numerous observations of prominent lunar landmarks to pro-
vide data that would improve landing accuracy on subsequent missions. 36
Back in Antares, Shepard and Mitchell stowed their samples and discarded their
expendable equipment. Houston then passed up questions for half an hour con-
cerning details of their visual observations, which brought out some of the difficul-
ties they had experienced on the traverse. Geological features had been subtle,
occasionally they had had too little time to observe and comment on details, and
the rolling terrain had sometimes blocked their view of features only a few meters
away. 37
Liftoff from the moon came at 1:48 p.m. EST on February 6. Mission planners
had worked out a "direct" rendezvous scheme--that is, the ascent trajectory was
programmed to meet the command module at its highest point, with necessary
corrections being made during ascent--which they used for the first time. (On
previous missions several maneuvers had been necessary to adjust the LM's orbit
before bringing the spacecraft together.) Two and a half hours after liftoff, Antares
and Kitty Hawk docked; three hours later, having sent the lunar module crashing
to the lunar surface, Kitty Hawk headed home. 38
Along the way the crew performed some "'inflight demonstrations"--
experiments exploring some zero-g techniques that might offer useful applica-
tion of technology in space: electrophoresis (the migration of charged molecules
in solution under the influence of an applied voltage), transfer of liquids between
two containers, heat transfer, and casting of various materials from the molten
state. 39Results were promising enough to warrant further investigation on Skylab
and, later, on space shuttle missions. After finishing those demonstrations,
Shepard, Mitchell, and Roosa had little to do for the rest of the mission. Kitty
Hawk made a normal reentry and landed 0.6 miles (965 meters) from its targeted
point in the South Pacific near the aircraft carrier U.S.S. New Orleans in the early
morning light of February 9. Three days later the astronauts in their quarantine
trailer arrived at the lunar receiving laboratory at MSC, where they spent 15 days
in quarantine. 4°
Apollo 14 successfully concluded the intermediate stage of lunar exploration,
closing a period in which the progress made in mission planning and operations
exceeded expectations. Armstrong had overshot his target by five miles (eight
2O9
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Technicians examine Apollo 14 samples in the sterile nitrogen atmosphere of a processing cabinet
in MSC's lunar receiving laboratory. The cabinet is at atmospheric pressure. Earlier processing in
vacuum had to be abandoned, in part because the gloves through which technicians handled the sam-
ples could not stand up to the large pressure differential between the cabinet and the outside.
Antares for 331/2. Armstrong and Aldrin's 21/2 hours on the surface was more than
doubled by Conrad and Bean and extended nearly ninefold by Shepard and Mitch-
ell. Apollo 12 brought back 50 percent more lunar material than Apollo 11, and
Apollo 14 returned 25 percent more than that. About the only remaining improve-
ments to lunar exploration would come from the addition of extra supplies and
a powered vehicle to save time in exploring the lunar surface.
In the first half of 1969 the Office of Manned Space Flight (OMSF) had antici-
pated the requirements of the extended ("J") missions, Apollo 16-20, by order-
ing studies on modification of the lunar module and development of a powered
211
Where No Man Has Gone Before
lunar-surface vehicle (see Chapter 10). After studies by the lunar module con-
tractor, Grumman Aircraft Engineering Company, were reviewed by OMSF's
Management Council, MSC authorized Grumman on June 9 to proceed with
modifications on LM-10 and subsequent spacecraft. Changes to the landing mod-
ule would allow it to carry additional payload (the lunar roving vehicle) to the
lunar surface, return more lunar samples to earth, and provide consumables (oxy-
Apollo 14 explorers Ed Mitchell (left center) and Alan Shepard (righ t cen ter) examine and commen t on
some of the samples they collected. The specimen in front of Shepard was, at the time, the largest rock
brought back from the moon.
ORIGINAL PAGE'
212 BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPN
ORIGrNAL PAGE
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH Ap°ll° Assumes ItsFinalForm: 1970-1971
gen, water, and electrical power) to support the crew on the moon for periods
up to 78 hours. The first "extended" lunar module was to be delivered in time
for launch in April 1971. 41 Major changes included enlargement of the fuel and
oxidizer tanks on both ascent and descent stages, extension of the descent engine
nozzle to improve its efficiency, addition of batteries and solar cells to recharge
them, and rearrangement of stowage space. 42 At a critical design review in mid-
September, MSC cut out some of the changes to minimize cost increases, dis-
carding the solar cells and reducing the maximum duration of stays on the moon
to 54 hours. The extended LM would weigh 36,000 pounds (16,330 kilograms),
compared to 32,000 (14,515 kilograms) for earlier versions. 43
A large part of this extra payload was the lunar roving vehicle, which would
extend the astronauts' range on the moon. In May 1969 a surface-traversing vehide
was chosen rather than a flying unit as the most suitable means of carrying the
astronauts and their tools to sites of scientific interest, and Marshall Space Flight
Center was assigned responsibility for its development. 44 That fall, the Boeing
Company won the contract to develop the lunar roving vehicle (LRV or "rover").
The rover was to be a battery-powered vehicle weighing 400 pounds (181 kilo-
grams), capable of carrying a 970-pound (440-kilogram) load as far as 120 kilo-
meters (75 miles). 45Boeing's facility in Huntsville, Alabama, was to build the chas-
sis and assemble the complete vehicle from components manufactured by Boeing
in its Seattle plant and by AC-Delco Electronics. Development time was short:
the schedule called for delivery of the first of four vehicles by April 1, 1971, for
flight on Apollo 17, then scheduled for the following September. 46
213
WhereNo ManHasGoneBefore
In July 1969 the Apollo Site Selection Board had compiled a list of 10 landing
sites for Apollo 11-20, subject to further evaluation and revision in light of the
results of early landings (see Chapter 10 and Table 2). In August and September,
responding to a request from Headquarters and MSC program managers for
detailed science mission plans, members of the Group for Lunar Exploration Plan-
ning and its Site Selection Subgroup, working with MSC operations planners
and U.S. Geological Survey scientists, suggested some minor changes, based on
a reevaluation of geologic features at one of the sites and the expected availabil-
ity of good photography at another. These were endorsed by the Group for Lunar
Exploration Planning on August 23. 52
At the end of September, however, while many other complaints were being
registered concerning Apollo (see Chapter 10), some members of the Science and
Technology Advisory Panel and the lunar panel of the Lunar and Planetary Mis-
sions Board objected that their opinions were not receiving sufficient considera-
tion in site selection. Harold Urey complained that he did not know who was
making decisions regarding landing sites, nor what the reasons for choosing the
214
ApolloAssumesIts FinalForm:1970-1971
*Recommended by the Group for Lunar Exploration Planning; minutes of Apollo Site Selection Board Meeting,
July 10, 1969.
various sites were: the correspondence he received was unintelligible, full of unex-
plained acronyms and couched in unreadable bureaucratic jargon. He could not
take the time to attend meetings of the site selection subgroup to argue his case,
however, because of academic commitments, s3 Another meeting was held in mid-
October in the hope of considering the advice of the objectors, but they were
unable to attend. Gene Simmons, MSC's chief scientist, was annoyed and dis-
appointed. He wrote to the chairman of the Science and Technology Advisory
Committee,
To those of us who have been intimately involved with the scientific recom-
mendations on Apollo sites for some time, it was particularly disappointing
that only one of these "senior scientists" showed up in time for the meet-
ing .... The entire decisionmaking process of NASA on the landing sites for
the H and J series missions was postponed in order for these individuals to
meet with us and provide the kind of counsel that only they, presumably, could
give .... [Nonetheless,] we as a group felt that we should proceed with the
reexamination of the proposed landing sites, s4
215
WhereNoManHasGoneBefore
J-2 (17) Marius Hills Marius Hills Marius Hills Marius Hills
"Recommended by the Group for Lunar Exploration Planning, October 16-17, 1969.
**Hyginus Rille is the alternate site for the H-2 mission if operational constraints prevent landing at Fra Mauro
or Alphonsus.
to the last J mission, which would leave ample time to look for ways to overcome
the operational limitations. Houston's representative proposed yet another
sequence of missions (Table 4), which the board approved as a basis for continu-
ing evaluation. 56
Assignment of sites to specific missions was tentative at this stage of the proj-
ect because the necessary information was still sketchy. By the end of 1969, how-
216
Apollo Assumes Its Final Form: 1970-1971
*This was the result of the mission rule requiring daylight launches and of the annual variation
in the geometric relationships of the earth, sun, and moon.
217
Where No Man Has Gone Before
*Censorinus, Littrow, Alphonsus, Hyginus Rille, Rima Bode II, Hipparchus, M_sting C, Dionysius,
Sinus Medii, Hamsteed P, Gassendi, Copernicus, Descartes, and Marius Hills (see Table 1). At this
meeting, MSC ruled out Copernicus and Censorinus as unsuitable for landing because of rough ter-
rain. The subgroup dropped Gassendi, which appeared to present the same disadvantage.
**According to an MSC participant, consensus among the scientists at a site selection meeting was
nearly impossible to obtain. Each individual repeatedly voted for the site of his choice, and in the end,
NASA (i.e., MSC) had to made the decision. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots for Apollo,
p. 365.
218
Apollo Assumes Its Final Form: 1970-1971
16 between January and March 1972. The choice of a site for Apollo 17 was left
open; Marius Hills and Copernicus were the leading candidates, but others (e.g.,
Littrow) were still in the running, and a new site might be found in future orbital
photography. 62
The September meeting wrapped up the Apollo Site Selection Board's
unfinished business for the time being. After Apollo 14, scheduled for the fol-
lowing April, it would reconvene to examine the list of sites in light of the results
of that mission.
In the weeks following Apollo 11, when scientists and others found fault with
many aspects of the program, NASA was frequently castigated for its failure to
assign a scientist to a moon mission at the earliest possible date. When crews
were named for Apollo 13 and 14 in August 1969, the absence of a scientist-
astronaut on either crew was pointedly noticed by the press. 63 Scientists, eager
to have a scientist assigned to a crew, argued that one pilot in the lunar module
was enough: the second person was largely a bystander during the landing any-
way. But Deke Slayton, director of flight crew operations at MSC and the person
responsible for selecting crews, was adamant. At this point only one landing had
been made, and it had required almost instinctive action by the pilot in the last
seconds before touchdown. Slayton was not yet willing to entrust that responsi-
bility to a less experienced astronaut. Besides, he had to be prepared for the worst
case. "Both guys have to be able to fly it .... It would sure be a crime to have
one guy as a passenger and the commander break a leg and then you lose two
guys instead of one, plus the vehicle. "'64 Slayton had nothing but good things
to say about the scientist-astronauts and admitted that one of them, geologist
Harrison H. ("Jack") Schmitt, might be about ready for a flight, but he was not
going to be rushed. 65 By the end of the year, however, "reliable sources" were
saying that Schmitt would be named to the backup crew for Apollo 15. 66
On March 26, 1970, two weeks before Apollo 14 was launched, Slayton
announced the names of the crewmen selected for Apollo 15. As he had done
twice before, Slayton picked a backup crew from a prior mission*: commander
David R. Scott, command module pilot Alfred M. Worden, and lunar module
pilot James B. Irwin, all Air Force officers. As backup crew he named Richard
F. Gordon, who had piloted the command module on Apollo 12, commander;
Vance D. Brand, command module pilot; and Jack Schmitt, lunar module pilot.67
Three scientist-astronauts made up the support crew: astronomers Karl G. Henize
and Robert A. Parker and physicist Joseph P. Allen W. Schmitt's assignment sig-
naled MSC's intention to send a scientist to the moon before Apollo was finished:
*While it could not always be followed, Slayton's policy was to keep crews together. He normally
assigned backup crewmen to prime crews for the third mission following their backup assignment,
as was the case for Apollo 7 and Apollo 9. Neff Armstrong and Buzz Aldrin of Apollo 11 had both
been on the backup crew for Apollo 8; Mike Collins, initially on the prime crew for Apollo 8, had
to drop out when he developed a medical problem that required surgery. He returned to active sta-
tus and six months later was assigned to Apollo 11.
219
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
in the normal course of events he could expect to draw the assignment as lunar
module pilot on Apollo 18, which at the time was the next-to-last mission on the
schedule.
As the only geologist among the scientist-astronauts, Schmitt was the logical
choice to be the first scientist assigned to a lunar landing mission. Logic aside,
he had developed his flying skills assiduously and taken care to make himself
useful around the astronaut office. Having participated in the geology training
since joining the program, he had been instrumental in reorienting the course
to suit the rather specialized purposes of lunar exploration, bringing in outside
experts who emphasized the larger picture rather than the minute details of field
geology that could easily get in the way of astronauts interpreting what they could
see. He had spent many hours with the crews of Apollo 11, 12, 13, and 14, help-
ing them sharpen their observational and sampling skills. He had also made an
effort to get acquainted with the people in flight operations, learning as much
as he could about their problems and capabilities and helping to coordinate science
with flight operations. 68 As the one scientist-astronaut whose professional spe-
cialty was particularly suited to the objectives of Apollo, Schmitt was able to satisfy
his need to stay current in his profession while carrying out the duties demanded
of an astronaut. That, plus his general determination to do whatever seemed likely
to get him a crew assignment, kept him from getting on the wrong side of Slay-
ton and the test pilots.
Yet Schmitt's reservation on a moon-bound lunar module was by no means
confirmed. One mission already had been dropped, and additional cuts were a
strong possibility when Schmitt was named to a backup crew; when Apollo 15
and 19 were canceled in September 1970, it appeared that the backups for Apollo
14--Gene Cernan, Ron Evans, and Joe Engle, named in August 1969--would be
the prime crew of Apollo 17 and thus the last people to explore the moon.
The scientist-astronauts had kept out of the public discussions of whether pilots
or scientists should draw assignments to lunar missions. But in the year and a
half after the first lunar landing they grew increasingly restive and their discon-
tent became known within NASA. In January 1971, Associate Administrator
Homer Newell spent a day in Houston, privately hearing two or three scientists
at a time air their grievances. Practically all of them said, in effect, that they could
not keep up their scientific competence under the existing organization and leader-
ship of the Astronaut Office. Most of them expressed no animosity toward Deke
Slayton; they simply thought his criteria for crew selection were wrong. He gave
no consideration to the scientific activity that most of them had tried to work into
their schedules. Even among the pilots, proficiency in science seemed unimpor-
tant: one nonscientist who was regarded as the best geology student on his crew
was designated command module pilot and thus would never set foot on the
moon. They were almost all pessimistic about prospects for science on Skylab
and Shuttle unless something was done to change the way crews were selected.
220
Apollo Assumes Its Final Form: 1970-1971
Yet none of them felt that resigning in protest was a good way to change the
system, and none wanted to leave the astronaut corps. 69
Newell jotted down a few points after the meetings that he would later incor-
porate into a list of recommendations to Administrator James C. Fletcher: that
a change in the method of and responsibility for selecting crews should be con-
sidered; a geologist should be assigned to a lunar mission as soon as possible;
and if feasible, two scientists should be assigned to each Skylab mission. In addi-
tion the training program should be restructured to allow the scientist-astronauts
to give more attention to their scientific careers. 70
After reporting his findings to Fletcher--calling them tentative because he had
heard only one side of the question--Newell discussed the problem at some length
in the following weeks with Dale D. Myers, associate administrator for manned
space flight, and Robert R. Gilruth, director of MSC. Gilruth's (and Slayton's)
view that lunar missions required the skills of experienced test pilots prevailed.
Myers decided he could not "commit casually to the flight of scientist astronauts
on an Apollo mission": a failure on a lunar flight could mean the end of manned
space flight for a long time. On March 1 Myers advised the Chairman of the Space
Science Board, Charles H. Townes, of the conclusions he and Gilruth had reached:
This was the best Newell could get for the scientist-astronauts. He continued to
work to get two scientists on each Skylab mission, but without success. 72
So Schmitt's place on a lunar landing mission was assured, barring some highly
unlikely occurrence, but the announcement would be another six months in com-
ing. Meanwhile, a month after Alan Shepard and his crew returned from Apollo
14, Slayton named the crew for Apollo 16: commander John W. Young, com-
mand module pilot Ken Mattingly, and lunar module pilot Charles M. Duke, Jr.,
who had trained together for Apollo 13. Young had logged more time in space
than any other eligible astronaut,* having flown on Gemini III, Gemini X, and
Apollo 10. Mattingly had come within three days of flying on Apollo 13 but had
been taken off for medical reasons (see Chapter 11). Duke, a member of the third
class of astronauts chosen in 1966, had not yet had a flight assignment. Veterans
Fred Haise, Stuart Roosa, and Edgar Mitchell made up the backup crew. 73
*Jim Lovell, the record holder for time in space, was not eligible, having announced before the
launch of Apollo 13 that it would be his last flight.
221
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
*The unmanned lunar probe Luna 16 landed in Mare Fecunditatis (lunar latitude 0°41 ' south, lon-
gitude 56018 , east, approximately 100 kilometers [63 miles] west of crater Webb) on Sept. 20, 1970. An
electrically driven core drill penetrated some 35 centimeters (14 inches) into the lunar soil, collecting
about 100 grams (3.5 ounces) of sample, which was dumped into an upper stage of the spacecraft
and returned to earth four days later. NASA, Astronautics and Aeronautics, I970: Chronology on Science,
Technology, and Policy (NASA SP-4015), pp. 299, 316, 325, 349. Vinogradov's presentation at the con-
ference was one aspect of the cooperation in space exploration that was developing at the time, which
culminated in a joint American-Soviet manned mission in 1975. See Edward C. Ezell and Linda N.
Ezell, The Partnership: A History of the Apollo-Soyuz Test Project, NASA SP-4209 (Washington, 1978).
222
Apollo Assumes Its Final Form: 1970-1971
200-odd papers to the scientific literature on lunar science, it showed that future
missions might be expected to provide more scientific surprises. Future confer-
ences, however, would present new information in a growing context of facts
about the moon, established in the first two conferences and rapidly expanding
as investigators published their results elsewhere.*
Although the results of the second lunar science conference came too late to
influence the choice of a target for Apollo 14 (which was launched two weeks
later), they indicated that the Fra Mauro site selected for that mission was likely
to be a good choice. Its intrinsic interest as the first nonmare landing site was
heightened by the discovery of KREEP, for if that material were found in sub-
stantial quantity at Fra Mauro, the tenable hypotheses about the origin and early
history of the moon would be considerably restricted.
Astronauts and lunar scientists alike had chafed under the requirement to
quarantine spacecraft crews and lunar samples until it could be proved that no
infectious organisms had been brought back from the moon. Early in 1970 the
Interagency Committee on Back Contamination (ICBC) reviewed quarantine
requirements in light of the results from the first two Apollo missions. Consider-
ing the conditions that had been found to exist on the moon--and probably had
existed for billions of years--the requirement for quarantine now appeared super-
fluous. After lengthy discussion, the committee agreed to recommend to the
NASA administrator that crew quarantine be discontinued. They believed, how-
ever, that biological examination of the lunar samples should be continued and
that biological containment practices in the lunar receiving laboratory should con-
tinue, since among other things they assured the integrity of the samples. It was
agreed that the Space Science Board would be advised of this recommendation. 79
In February 1970 the Space Science Board discussed the matter and found no
reason to discontinue quarantine for Apollo 13, which was to fly in two months,
since it was targeted for a highland site that was different from the mare sites
sampled by Apollo 11 and 12. Nonetheless it agreed with the ICBC that crews
on future missions need not be quarantined unless anticipated differences in land-
ing sites seemed to require it. 8°
After the aborted flight of Apollo 13, the quarantine remained in force for 14,
since it was scheduled to take a deep lunar core sample, which might be differ-
ent from surface samples. 81 So Alan Shepard, Ed Mitchell, and Stuart Roosa spent
their time in the quarantine area of the Lunar Receiving Laboratory, the last lunar
explorers to do so. When no further evidence of exotic diseases or organic mate-
rial appeared, the requirement was finally revoked, although the ICBC would
continue to function through Apollo 17. 82
*The moratorium on publication before the conference, stipulated by NASA and agreed to by the
principal investigators of the Apollo 11 samples (see Chapter 9), was lifted after the first lunar science
conference. It had been imposed to avoid "a wild scramble for publication immediately after samples
became available." Philip H. Abelson, "The Moon Issue," Science 167 (1970): 447. There was evi-
dently a strong feeling that scientists were not immune to the temptation of the publicity that would
accrue to the first publication of the results of investigating a lunar sample.
223
13
When the spacecraft Kitty Hawk returned from Fra Mauro on February 9, 1971,
the preliminary stage of lunar exploration ended. Project Apollo, severely trun-
cated in the budget cuts of 1970, entered its last phase as NASA prepared to exploit
the potential of earth-orbital manned flight. Skylab, an earth-orbiting laboratory
scheduled for three long-duration missions between 1973 and 1974, would lay
the groundwork. Shuttle, the new reusable spacecraft that carried NASA's hopes
for a continuing manned program, had yet to receive the blessing of the Nixon
administration's budget officials and appeared to be facing stiff opposition in Con-
gress. After that, it would face a long period of development that seemed likely
to push the next set of manned missions into the late 1970s or early 1980s.
Apollo's mission planners, looking ahead to only three more lunar missions,
intended to make them as scientifically productive as the limitations of the sys-
tem allowed. Modifications to the lunar module were under way and the first
flight model of the lunar rover was undergoing tests. Landing sites for the next
two missions had been selected and a group of sensors for remote sensing of
the moon from lunar orbit was under development (see Chapter 12).
Apollo 15, the first of the "J" missions, was the most complex mission yet
attempted, one of which much was expected. Its landing site, 26 degrees north
of the lunar equator, was the first outside the original "Apollo zone." Commander
David R. Scott would bring the lunar module to the surface along a steeper
approach path (25 degrees) than had been used previously, coming in over the
Apennine front north of the 3,500-meter (11,500-foot) ridge of Hadley Delta. His
landing site was about 5 kilometers (3 miles) northwest of Hadley Delta, 11 kilo-
meters (7 miles) southwest of the foot of 5,500-meter (18,000-foot) Mount Had-
ley, and about a kilometer (half a mile) east of the edge of Hadley Rille. 1
Apollo 15 was the first mission to fly the extended lunar module with the
increased payload it could carry: expendable supplies sufficient to support the
astronauts for 67 hours, a complete lunar surface experiments package (see Appen-
dix 5), and the first lunar roving vehicle. Excursions were planned to the foot
of the Apennine Front and along Hadley Rille. In addition to the usual geological
investigations, the crew would take core samples to a depth of 2.5 meters (8 feet),
using an electrically powered drill. Temperature sensors inserted into the drill
This photo of the Apollo 15 command and service module, taken from lunar module Falcon while still
in lunar orbit, clearly shows the arrangement of the instruments in the scientific instrument module
(SIM) bay of the service module.
holes would enable scientists to record the rate at which heat flowed from the
moon's interior to the surface. 2
Starting with Apollo 15, the orbiting command and service module had a much
larger role to play in the lunar science program. While Scott and LM pilot James
Irwin were on the moon, command module pilot Alfred Worden's flight plan
called for him to operate a group of instruments carried in the scientific instru-
ment module (SIM) in the service module. Two cameras would collect high-quality
photographs of the lunar surface. A laser altimeter was provided to give a pre-
cise profile of' the lunar surface and to allow photogrammetrists to correct the
data from the cameras, from which accurate maps of the moon could be produced.
Besides cameras, the SIM bay housed instruments for remote sensing of the lunar
surface and a scientific subsatellite to be released in lunar orbit for long-term mea-
surement of particles and magnetic fields. On the trip back to earth Worden would
make the first extravehicular sortie in cislunar space to bring film from the cameras
back into the command module. 3
ORIGINAL PAGE
ii 'il
l
ORIGINAL PAGE Lunar Exploration Concluded
AND WHITE pHoTOGRAPH
BLACK
The lunar roving vehicle was among the more important new developments
for the extended Apollo missions, since it would allow the astronauts to sample
a much larger area around the landing site. When Boeing won the rover contract
in November 1969, it had little time to produce the novel vehicle: at the time the
schedule called for flight of the first rover on Apollo 16 in April 1971. 4Many details
of design were still to be settled, and much of 1970 was spent in ironing them out.
What evolved from the program was a unique four-wheeled vehicle remarka-
ble for its versatility and compactness. Smaller than a subcompact car, the rover
had a 2.3-meter (7.5-foot) wheelbase and measured 3.1 meters long, 1.8 meters
wide, and 1.14 meters high (10 x 6 x 3.75 feet). For its trip to the moon, all four
wheels folded inward and the rover folded double for stowage in the descent
stage of the lunar module. It was powered by two 36-volt silver-zinc batteries
with sufficient power for a range of 65 kilometers (40 miles) at speeds up to 17
kilometers per hour (11 miles per hour). If either battery failed the other could
227
ORIGINAL- PAGE:
Where No Man Has Gone Before BI._CK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Apollo 16 commander John Young practices unstowing the lunar roving vehicle from its storage space
in the lunar module.
carry the entire load. Four separate motors, one at each wheel, drove the vehi-
cle; any wheel could be cut out of the circuit and allowed to "free-wheel" if its
drive mechanism developed problems. Tires of spring-steel wire mesh carried
treads of titanium-alloy chevrons for traction; "bump stops" inside the wire mesh
prevented collapse of a tire in case of severe shock. Two collapsible seats were
mounted on the chassis, along with racks for equipment, tools, and sample bags.
All the rover's driving functions--forward and reverse speed, braking, and
steering--were controlled by a T-handle mounted between the seats. Besides four-
wheel drive, the rover featured redundant four-wheel steering. Either front or
rear wheels could be turned while the other pair was locked straight, or both
could be used simultaneously, allowing the rover to turn completely around within
its own length. It could clamber over obstacles 30 centimeters (1 foot) high, climb
and descend slopes of 25 degrees, and park on slopes as steep as 35 degrees.
The rover navigated by a dead-reckoning system. At the start of a traverse the
astronauts oriented the system's navigational gyroscope with reference to the sun.
During the trip, odometers recorded the distance traveled and the system con-
228
ORIGINAL PAGE
P_tACK AND \_H]TE PHOT_SRAPH Lunar Exploration Concluded
Driver's view of the control panel for the lunar roving vehicle. Power monitors and controls are in the
center; the steering control is the handle at the extreme right. The navigational system readout (upper
left) shows the current heading of the rover and the distance and bearing to the lunar module. The
speedometer is at the upper right.
tinuously computed and displayed the direction and distance to the lunar module.
Communications from the rover were relayed to earth through the lunar mod-
ule, but could be sent directly to earth when the lunar terrain blocked the line
of sight between the two vehicles. Mounted on the front of the rover were a tele-
vision camera and a high-gain antenna. At each stop the astronauts would acti-
vate the camera and orient its antenna toward earth. For the first time, scientists
229
Where No Man Has Gone Before BLACK AND '¢,/FII'FE PHOFOGRAPFI
at Mission Control would be able to look over the astronauts' shoulders during
surface exploration. Unlike the rover itself, the camera could be controlled from
earth, allowing scientists to direct the lunar activity, if necessary, on the basis
of what they could see. Alternatively, they could use the camera to survey the
area for interesting features while the astronauts carried out their preplanned
activities.
Fully equipped and ready for flight, the lunar rover weighed just over 200 kilo-
grams (440pounds) and could carry about 490 kilograrns(1,080 pounds), indud-
ing the astronauts, their life-support systems, their tools and equipment, and 27
kilograms (60 pounds) of lunar samples that could be brought back to the lunar
module on each trip. Models to be flown on missions were designed to support
this weight on the moon; in all prelaunch tests they had to be supported on spe-
cial racks, since if anyone inadvertently sat down on one it could coUapse, s
Apollo 17 astronauts Jack Schmitt (left) and Gene Cernan during the checkout of their lunar roving
vehicle. The roving vehicle used on the moon had to be supported on earth because it would not support
the astronauts" weight in normal gravity; note the wheels off the surface.
230
Lunar Exploration Concluded
Development of the rover was not without its problems. Although the project
got some schedule relief with the postponement of the first flight from April to
July 1971, at one point it was estimated to be two months behind schedule. 6 The
deficit was soon made up, however. The one-g training vehicle, a structurally
strengthened version equipped with conventional tires for use on earth, was deliv-
ered on November 18, 1970, and crews immediately began training with it. 7 The
first vehicle to be flown to the moon was delivered to Kennedy Space Center
the following March for prelaunch testing. Eight weeks later the rover was stowed
in the lunar module and both were loaded into the Saturn V stack. 8
In January 1971 Apollo 15's scientific instruments began arriving at Kennedy
Space Center, where they were subjected to two months of extensive preflight
testing. KSC engineers had more than a few problems with the instruments, as
they usually did when a new component was added to the spacecraft. Some
arrived late; principal investigators or contractor representatives often wanted
to make small changes or conduct last-minute tests. Mechanical problems com-
plicated the process as well. Two of the instruments had to be extended from
the service module on long booms to avoid interference from spacecraft systems.
The booms, designed for zero-g operation, would not support the instruments
in earth gravity, so on-the-spot fixes had to be improvised, with less than com-
pletely satisfactory results. But calibrations were finally completed and the SIM
was returned to North American's California plant for rework. When retesting
was completed in late April, the package was installed in the service module.
The lunar subsatellite arrived in May and after checkout was loaded into the space
craft on June 9. 9
Thunderstorms visited launch complex 39A during the month preceding Apollo
15's launch. Four lightning strikes damaged some ground support equipment
but the spacecraft and launch vehicle were undamaged. TM Otherwise the count-
down for Apollo 15 was, as launch director Walter Kapryan described it, "the
most nominal countdown that we have ever had. "'11 At 9:34 a.m. on July 26, just
187 milliseconds behind schedule, the Saturn V carrying command module
Endeavour* and its crew blasted off. Twelve minutes later Scott, Irwin, and Wor-
den were in orbit some 92 nautical miles above the earth, and after two revolu-
tions their S-IVB stage reignited to send them on their way to the plain at Hadley.
After extracting the lunar module Falcon (named for the Air Force Academy's
mascot by the all-Air-Force crew) from its stowage atop the S-IVB, they settled
down for an uneventful 3-day trip to the moon. Only two small midcourse
corrections were required along the way. 12
*Conscious of the importance of science on their mission, the crew named their spacecraft for the
ship commanded by Lieut. James Cook, who had sailed from England to Tahiti in 1768 to observe
the transit (passage between the earth and the sun) of the planet Venus in August 1769. Apollo Prime
Crew Press Conference, June 18, 1971, transcript.
231
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
Four hours before settling into lunar orbit, the crew jettisoned the cover of the
scientific instrument module in preparation for the lunar-orbital science to be con-
ducted later. Endeavour went smoothly into lunar orbit. Scott and Irwin entered
Falcon about 40 minutes early, checked out its systems, and had ample time to
eat lunch before beginning powered descent. After they undocked, Worden put
Endeavour into a circular orbit suitable for gathering scientific data. 13
Ten hours into their fourth day, Scott powered up Falcon for the approach to
Hadley. As had been the case throughout the mission so far, everything went
well during the landing approach. At about 9,000 feet (2,750 meters) above the
surface Scott noted the peak of Hadley Delta to his left; until he reached 5,000
feet (1,500 meters) the only other landmark he could spot was Hadley Rille. The
terrain was less sharply defined than he had expected from simulations. After
entering several redesignations of the landing site into his control computer, Scott
Astronaut Jim Irwin is aboard the lunar raver waiting for Apollo 15 commander Dave Scott to finish
photographing the landing site before departing on their first lunar traverse. The view is toward the
south. St. George crater, about 5 kilometers distant, appears immediately behind Irwin. Hadley Delta
rises behind the lunar module, which is visibly tilted because Scott landed on the rim of a shallow
crat_
ORIGINAL PAGE
BLACK AIYD WHITE ou_TT'r__u 232
Lunar Exploration Concluded
brought Falcon down through blinding dust and touched down at 6:16 p.m. East-
ern Daylight Time on July 29. Not sure of his exact location, Scott was sure he
was well within the boundaries of his designated landing zone. The lunar mod-
ule came to rest tilted back and to its left; two of its landing pads were just over
the edge of a small crater that Scott had not been able to see as he approached
the surface) 4
During the next 67 hours Scott and Irwin were to ride and walk over more of
the lunar surface than any of their predecessors. The first chore was a "standup
EVA,'" to survey the landing area for the benefit of the scientists in Houston.
Scott removed the upper hatch of the lunar module and stood on the engine cover,
describing what he could see and taking photographs that would allow construc-
tion of a panorama of the landing area. One remarkable photograph showed clear
evidence of stratigraphy in a prominent landmark ("Silver Spur") to the east of
Hadley Delta--a feature the explorers were unable to see later because of unfavora-
ble lighting. While Scott and Irwin carried out their assignments on the surface,
A1 Worden, orbiting above in Endeavour, had activated the scientific instruments
and cameras and was busy gathering data. On his 15th revolution he spotted
Falcon on the surface and relayed its position to Houston. TM
The next morning Scott and Irwin were up early and out on the surface. They
unloaded their roving vehicle without difficulty, climbed on and buckled their
seat belts, and set out on the first traverse. Scott soon discovered that the rover's
front wheels could not be steered. He could not correct the anomaly, but went
ahead, relying on the rear-wheel steering alone. TM
Their first goal was "Station 1," a spot on the rim of a medium-sized crater
("Elbow") located on the edge of Hadley Rille at the point where it makes a sharp
bend. On the way Scott had to get the feel of driving the rover, which he found
to be an excellent vehicle. Driving it on the moon, however, was not quite like
driving the 1-g trainer, and among other things he had to keep his eyes on the
surface ahead, especially when heading toward the sun, because surface features
were not always readily visible. The rover's maneuverability was good, but at 8 to
10 kilometers per hour (5 to 6 miles per hour) the ride was a bit bouncy. Driving
took all of Scott's attention, so Irwin provided most of the descriptions for
Houston's scientists. 17
Proceeding along the edge of Hadley Rille, the explorers had an excellent view
of the entire width of the canyon (about 1.5 kilometers or almost I mile) and down
its length to the sharp bend by "Elbow" crater. Landmarks along the route were
not always easy to identify, but their course was laid out by range and bearing
and they were never as uncertain about their position as Shepard and Mitchell
had been on Apollo 14. Less than half an hour after leaving the LM, and having
traveled something over 3 kilometers (about 2 miles) they reached their first stop,
dismounted, and turned on the television camera to give Houston a view of the
area. Using a telephoto lens, Scott photographed the far side of Hadley Rille where
layering was obvious in outcrops not far below the rim. Panoramic photography
and sample collection completed their work at Site 1) 8
Remounting their vehicle, Irwin and Scott drove around "Elbow" crater to Site
2, about 500 meters (1,600 feet) farther down at a point where ejecta from St.
George crater encroached on the edge of the rille. Here they began to encounter
233
Where No Man Has Gone Before
large blocks lying on the surface. One that excited Irwin particularly was a meter
or so (3 to 4 feet) across, its downslope edge buried in the loose soil and its upslope
edge free of the surface He photographed and sampled it; then once again they
took panoramic photographs and soil samples and drove a double core tube into
the edge of a crater. 19
With no more stops scheduled, Scott now turned the rover on to the heading
prescribed by his navigation system to return to the LM. On the way he cau-
tiously tried some maneuvers with the rover. Attempting a turn on a downslope,
he discovered that "you can't go fast downhill in this thing, because if you try
and turn with the front wheels locked up like that, they dig in and the rear end
breaks away, and around you go; and we just did a 180 [degree turn]-20 Near
Elbow crater Scott noted that there was a "neat place to go down into the rille,"
but Capcom reminded him that "we'd rather that you don't take that option."2_
Hadley Delta slopes upward and to the right in this photograph taken from the Apollo 15 lunar module
Falcon's upper hatch shortly after landing The feature in the background, 20 kilometers southeast of
the landing site, is "Silver Spur."
234
Lunar Exploration Concluded
Riding back toward Falcon, Scott and Irwin frequently saw features they would
have liked to stop and examine, but they had no time, so they briefly described
them to Houston and continued. 22 When they first caught sight of the LM they
estimated its bearing from the rover at 15 degrees, but the navigation system
showed 34, indicating some drift in the system. They reached the lunar module
2 hours and 15 minutes after they had left, parked the rover, and unloaded the
surface experiments package. Scott had picked a spot about 110 meters (360 feet)
west-northwest of the Falcon to deploy the instruments. Apollo 15's experiments
package included a new heat flow experiment, which required drilling two holes
in which temperature sensors would be placed. The experiments were deployed
without difficulty, but the second heat-flow drill hole caused problems when the
drill stuck and proved difficult to remove. By this time the astronauts were
approaching the limit of their life-support systems, so Mission Control directed
Scott to leave the drill in the hole and get on to other tasks. After deploying the
laser reflector and the solar-wind collector he and Irwin returned to Falcon and
closed the hatch. They had been out for six and a half hours and covered 10.3
kilometers (5.6 miles) on the lunar surface--more than twice as far as the Apollo
14 astronauts had traversed (on foot) during their entire mission. 23 A 40-minute
debriefing with Houston completed their first day of lunar exploration24
In the press briefing immediately following the first day's surface activity, flight
director Gerald Griffin expressed satisfaction with the astronauts' performance.
Apart from the failure of the rover's front-wheel steering, which had not signifi-
cantly impaired the planned activity, everything had gone well. Scott had shown
a somewhat higher metabolic rate than anticipated, resulting in faster consump-
tion of oxygen than had been allowed for. This was not a serious concern, but
it would have to be taken into account in planning the remaining excursions.
About the only changes anticipated for the next day's activity were to attempt
to solve the rover's steering problem and to try to extract the drill core for the
heat-flow experiment. 25 However, the science planning team still had to review
the day's results; plans for the second traverse could well be changed in light
of what had been accomplished.
Next morning, after Scott and Irwin had finished breakfast and attended to some
chores in the LM, Capcom Joe Allen briefed them on the upcoming day's work.
Science planners had decided to shorten the traverse somewhat to provide more
exploration with less travel time. A low-priority sampling stop had been tenta-
tively deleted and the route at the foot of Hadley Delta curtailed. The scientists
were giving the astronauts considerable freedom on this traverse, as Allen's
instructions showed:
We're going to depend very much on the observations from the two of you,
and it's going to be... your choice on exactly where you'd like to range and
where you'd like to carry out your major sampling tasks .... We're looking
now, primarily, for a wide variety of rock samples from the [Apennine] Front.
You've seen the breccias already. We think there may very well be some large
crystal[line] igneous [rocks], and we'd like samples of those and whatever vari-
ety of rocks which you're able to find for us--but primarily, a large number
of documented samples and fragment samples .... I'll [stop] now and ask
for any more questions. 26
235
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Scott replied, "No, no questions, Joe. You're really talking our language today.'27
During their extensive geological training, Scott had come to enjoy field geology
and considered himself a serious amateur? 8 and this was the kind of freedom he
wanted. It was the kind of exploration the geologists had wanted as well, and
although they would have preferred to have one of their own on the moon, appar-
ently they were confident enough of Scott's and Irwin's training to give them
a much freer hand than any previous team of lunar explorers.
Suited up and out on the surface, Scott and Irwin got aboard the rover and
belted in, pausing before they started to flip the circuit breaker for the front steering
open and then closed again. When Scott moved the hand controller the front
wheels moved. Nobody knew why, but he now had full four-wheel steering. 29
Then they set out, on a southerly heading, for the sloping terrain at the foot of
Hadley Delta. Roiling along at 8 to 9 kilometers per hour (5 to 6 miles per hour),
they described the craters and rocks along the route. In about 40 minutes they
were in the vicinity of "Spur'" crater, one of their sampling stops, and they parked
the rover to reconnoiter and collect specimens. 30 With continuous commentary
for Houston, the astronauts roamed the area for the next hour, taking pictures
and bagging samples. Then, as they examined a boulder that had attracted their
attention, Scott remarked, "'Guess what we just found." Then Irwin came over
for a look:
ORIGTNAL PAGE
236 BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
OR1G_NAL P,",,{IE
Lunar Exploration Concluded
BLACK AND WHITE pi--IOTOGRAPH
The "Genesis rock" as Apollo 15 commander Dave Scott spotted it in its "come-and-sample-me"
position atop a small mound of soil (upper center). Scott quickly identified it as anorthosite, a rock
many scientists believed made up the primitive lunar crust. The vertical-locating gnomon, with
attached color chart, is just to the right of the specimen.
237
Where No Man Has Gone Before
After a few more minutes of sampling and photographing the site, they climbed
back on the rover and started back to the lunar module. Since there was time
available, Houston directed them to stop at site 4 (the one that had been deleted
before the traverse started) where they took more samples. Then it was back to
Falcon to unload their cargo and return to the surface experiments site. Scott made
another attempt to remove the core drill he had left in the ground the day before,
but succeeded only when Irwin helped him pull it out. The second hole for the
heat-flow experiment was drilled and the temperature sensors were emplaced
in both holes. After performing a few more experiments in soil mechanics, Scott
and Irwin drove back to the lunar module, where they had one more task to per-
form: planting the American flag at the landing site. That done, they transferred
the samples to the LM, and closed the hatch, having completed the most produc-
tive lunar science traverse of the program so far. 33
Flight director Gerald Griffin expressed that evaluation more strongly at the
change-of-shift press briefing: in his opinion, "we probably have just witnessed
the greatest day of scientific exploration.., in the space program that we've ever
seen. ''34 Allowing for his understandable enthusiasm, Griffin's statement had
solid foundation in fact. Lunar missions had made advances in two years' time
that few would have expected. The equipment had functioned virtually without
flaw, with margins of expendables to spare. Scientists and network audiences
on earth had received live color television pictures far surpassing the crude black-
and-white images transmitted by Apollo 11. The astronauts had wasted no time,
they had provided excellent descriptions of what they could see, they had exer-
cised their judgment in collaboration with the ground-based scientists, and had
documented and collected more than 100 pounds (45 kilograms) of rocks, soil,
and core samples. Observers in Mission Control thought they could tell that Scott
and Irwin adapted to lunar gravity on the first traverse and as a result were more
sure-footed and confident on the second. 3s One more traverse remained, a trip
to the edge of Hadley Rille, but 15 would have been rated a success without it.
Capcom Joe Allen passed the word from scientists to the crew just after they
returned to the LM:
I'm told that we checked off the 100 percent science completion square some
time during EVA-1 or maybe even shortly into EVA-2. From here on out, it's
gravy all the way, and we're just going to play it cool, take it easy, and see
some interesting geology. It should be a most enjoyable day.
"Okay, Joe," Scott replied, "Thank you. We're looking forward to it. ''36
Their work was not the mission's only contribution to lunar science. While they
had been dashing around the surface, A1 Worden in Endeavour had been circling
the moon operating the cameras and instruments. In Endeavour's highly inclined
orbit he was able to see features that no previous observers had laid eyes on,
and he provided detailed descriptions each time he crossed the earth-facing side
of the moon. 37
Early the next morning Irwin and Scott left the lunar module on a west-
northwesterly heading to get a good look at Hadley Rille. After describing, pho-
tographing, and televising the features of the broad canyon, including evident
layering in the walls,they completed their third traverse in just under 5 hours. 38
238
ORIGINAL PAGE
Lunar Exploration Concluded
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Back at their base, they collected the solar-wind experiment, after which Irwin
produced a postal cover carrying a new stamp commemorating "a decade of
achievement" in space, and applied a first-day cancellation provided by the Postal
Service. 39 A few minutes later Scott stood before the rover's TV camera to con-
duct a scientific demonstration:
Scott then drove the rover about 300 feet (90 meters) away, where he parked
it with the television camera pointed at Falcon, aligned the antenna with earth,
and walked back to help Irwin load sample bags into the lunar module.
From St. George crater at the foot of Hadley Delta, this view looking north up Hadley RilIe shows the
floor of the gorge littered with rock fragments that have broken off the layers higher up the sides.
239
Where No Man Has Gone Before
For the next three hours the crew of the Falcon were occupied with stowing
equipment and sample containers and configuring the LM for takeoff. Then, while
the television camera watched, Falcon's ascent stage shot up from the surface in
a shower of fragments of insulation, visible for only a second or two. Flight con-
trollers had intended to follow Falcon with the camera, but decided against it when
problems developed in the camera's control system. 41The result contrasted sharp-
ly with the majestic rise of a Saturn V; with a "quick pop" and "a shower of
sparks [that] looked more like something left over from the Fourth of July,'" as
one columnist put it, Falcon quickly disappeared from the TV screen. 42
Falcon and Endeavour linked up an hour and 34 minutes later, and after jettison-
ing the lunar module the three astronauts settled in for two days of additional
lunar-orbital data-gathering. ° On their last orbit they released the scientific sub-
satellite, then headed for home. While the spacecraft was still nearly 200,000 miles
(320,000 kilometers) from earth, AI Worden carried out the last extravehicular
excursion of the mission, a 38-minute "space walk" to remove film cassettes from
the cameras in the scientific instrument module. 44 The long voyage home ended
on August 7, when Endeavour dropped into the Pacific Ocean about 320 miles
(515 kilometers) north of Hawaii. The landing was a little harder than normal
because one of the three parachutes failed to open fully, but no damage or injury
resulted. 45
It was clear even before Scott and his crew returned that Apollo 15 had sur-
passed all prior missions in both the quantity and variety of information it
returned. More than 350 individual soil and rock samples aggregating 77 kilo-
grams (170 pounds), ranging in size from 1 or 2 grams (0.03 to 0.06 ounce) to
more than 9.5 kilograms (21 pounds) and taken from two distinct selenological
regions (the mare plain and the foot of Hadley Delta), were the richest geological
haul of the program.46 The seismometer and the heat flow probes emplaced with
the surface experiments package were important in obtaining data on the moon's
interior, while the instruments A1 Worden had operated in lunar orbit gathered
information on the chemical composition of large areas on the front and back sides
of the moon.
If the scientists had been unhappy with MSC's cooperation in the early mis-
sions, they were overjoyed with the way Apollo 15 was conducted, and several
graciously congratulated MSC on it. Gerald Wasserburg of Caltech wrote to Robert
R. Gilruth to offer his congratulations "on one of the most brilliant missions in
space science ever flown." He particularly praised the fairness and wisdom of
the decisions made during the astronauts' explorations, even though he had not
always got what he wanted. 47 Larry A. Haskin, vice chairman of the lunar sam-
ple analysis planning team, told Gilruth that
Scott and Irwin had not been on the surface very long before.., we felt com-
fortable and confident that the scientific aspects of the mission were in com-
petent hands .... We always felt that the decisions made in real time.., were
24O
ORIGINAL- P AG'_'E'
BLACK Lunar Exploration Concluded
AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
fair with respect to priorities given to various activities and that the mission
was well balanced.
Haskin stressed that the inclusion of scientists in planning before the mission
and decision-making during the mission (through the science working group)
was a breakthrough in MSC's relations with the scientific community. 4e
Preliminary examination of the samples began as soon as the containers were
returned. Documentation of these samples was unusually complete, except for
some taken on the last traverse when time ran short. Taking advantage of the
fact that the astronauts were not quarantined after this mission, the preliminary
examination team asked Scott and Irwin to be present while the containers were
opened, to provide whatever information they could remember about some of
the less well-documented specimens while the circumstances were still fresh in
their minds. 49
The preliminary examination team concluded that three distinct types of struc-
tures had been sampled at Hadley: the Apennine Front, which had been produced
by collision of an asteroid-sized object with the moon; a series of horizontal lava
flows that filled part of the impact basin; and a ray of ejecta from a large young
crater produced after the basin was filled. Samples from the mountain front were
very diverse, including both breccias and igneous rocks. Those from the mare
plain, where Falcon landed, were of two basic types: basaltic rocks and glass-coated
breccias. The "Genesis Rock," so designated by the press, did turn out to be
Dave Scott and scientist-astronaut JoeAllen (rear) examine the "genesis rock" that Scott and Irwin
found on Apollo 15. The rock was almost pure anorthosite, possibly a remnant of the original lunar
crust. The gadget suspended above the rock displays identifying numbers when the sample is
photographed.
241
Where No Man Has Gone Before
As was his custom, Slayton waited until Apollo 15 had returned from its flight
to announce his choice of crewmen for the last lunar mission. On August 13,
1971, he named Eugene Cernan, Ronald Evans, and Jack Schmitt as the prime
crew for Apollo 17, backed up by Dave Scott, A1 Worden, and Jim Irwin, just
returned from Apollo 15. 53 The decision to put Schmitt on the crew instead of
Joe Engle--who had trained as lunar module pilot with Cernan and Evans on
the backup crew for Apollo 14--was, like all those before it, Slayton's, and no
one in the NASA organization put pressure on him to make it.* He noted later,
however, that "we might have gotten some [pressure], I suppose, if we hadn't
made the right decision down here. [But] there wasn't any doubt.., that we
*But see Chapter 12. Earlier in the year, Dale Myers, chief of manned space flight, and Robert
Gilruth, MSC director, had agreed to Schmitt's appointment to the Apollo 17 crew, subject to his
satisfactory completion of training, and Slayton was undoubtedly a party to that decision. The deci-
sion was evidently a well kept secret, however, for as late as August 3, Schmitt was quoted as admit-
ting that it seemed unlikely he would get the chance to explore the moon. Stuart Auerbach, "Apol|o
15 Leaves Moon Orbit At End of Historic Mission," Washington Post, Aug. 5, 1971.
242
ORIGINAL PAGE Lunar Exploration Concluded
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Apollo 16 commander John Young salutes the colors while leaping clear of the lunar surface.
were going to have to do that when they canceled [Apollo 15 and 19], and we
did it. ''56
Engle, who had been out of town during Apollo 15 on personal business, learned
that his plans had been changed on August 10, when he called in to the Astronaut
Office to see ff he had any messages. It was a tremendous disappointment; he
had made the hard decision to leave the X-15 program in 1966 because he thought
that going to the moon was the only way he could surpass his past accomplish-
ments. But, he said, "when something like this happens, you can do one of two
things. You can lay on the bed and cry about it .... or you can get behind the
mission and make it the best in the world." Engle's choice was to support the
mission. He would try to help Schmitt fit into the crew that he himself had trained
with for so long. After that, he hoped to test-fly the space shuttle. 57
At the customary news conference the week after the announcement, the first
question challenged Schmitt's assignment to the crew instead of Engle. Schmitt
said, "There's no question that Joe Engle is one of the most outstandingly quali-
fied test pilots in the business," but he was confident of his own abilities: "as
far as my qualifications to fly the spacecraft are concerned, I will attempt to com-
pete with anybody in the program." Cernan agreed: "Jack isn't sitting here as
part of this crew for any other reason than that he has rowed hard, he's earned
it, and he deserved it." He noted that Engle and Dick Gordon (command mod-
ule pilot on Apollo 12) had been assigned to the new space shuttle project and
commented (perhaps with a trace of envy), "Those guys moving into shuttle right
243
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
now are probably going to contribute.., a lot more than maybe even we can
contribute by a lunar mission."s8
On its final flight to explore the moon, then, Apollo would send a scientist--
the one astronaut indisputably qualified to make the observations scientists had
long wanted to make. It remained to be seen whether, under the constraints that
limited lunar exploration, he could apply his experience to enhance the quality
of the results.
Two landing sites had been seriously considered for Apollo 16, the crater
Alphonsus, 300 miles (480 kilometers) south of the moon's center, and the region
some 340 miles (550 kilometers) east-southeast of the moon's center, north of the
ancient crater Descartes. In both places geologists thought they would find high-
land material differing in composition from the Fra Mauro samples and the basalts
filling the maria. The wall of Alphonsus was, some argued, pre-Imbrian high-
lands material, while dark craters on its floor were thought to consist of relatively
young volcanic material that might have originated at great depths. North of Des-
cartes, two formations (Cayley and Descartes) were of major interest. Evidence
indicated that both were volcanic but of different types and ages. The area is the
highest topographic region in the highlands on the visible face of the moon,
indicating that the Descartes volcanics represent remobilized highlands. Analy-
sis of these materials was expected to clarify the basic processes that formed the
highlands. 59
Preliminary discussions among interested scientists considered both sites but
did not entirely agree on either. 6° Alphonsus remained a strong candidate, but
in view of the fact that it would be preferable to have more results from Apollo
14 and 15 before landing there, Descartes was preferred for Apollo 16. With one
more mission left, Alphonsus could still be visited. The Apollo Site Selection Board
approved Descartes as the landing site for Apollo 16 at its meeting on June 3,
1971. 61
Science plans for the Descartes mission were much the same as they had been
for Hadley Rille: to inspect, survey, and sample materials and surface features
in the landing area; emplace and activate the lunar surface experiments; and con-
duct photography and remote sensing of the moon from lunar orbit. The surface
package included two new instruments: a magnetometer and, in place of Apollo
15's suprathermal ion detector, an active seismometer that would be excited by
several explosive charges after the astronauts left. Another new experiment was
an automatic far-ultraviolet camera and spectrograph to photograph several
galaxies from the moon's surface. Its objective was to study the distribution of
interplanetary and intergalactic hydrogen. 62
Apollo 16 blasted off from Kennedy Space Center at 12:54 p.m. Eastern Stan-
dard Time on April 16, 1972. Command module Casper and lunar module Orion
arrived in lunar orbit three days later. All systems functioned well until Orion
separated from the command module; a malfunctioning component in the main
propulsion system caused Houston to delay the lunar module's descent for nearly
244
ORIGINAL PAGE Lunar Exploration Concluded
BLACK AND V,/f-41TE PHOTOGRAPH
Apollo 16 commander John Young, identified by the stripes on his legs, arms, and helmet, returns from
laying out the lunar surface experiments at the Descartes landing site. In the distance behind Young is
the lunar triaxis magnetometer; to his left is the radioisotope thermal generator (black), which powered
the experiments. Other apparatus on the surface is not identifiable.
six hours while it was checked out. When Mission Control was satisifed, Orion
fired its descent engine and landed easily on the plain at Descartes at 9:33 p.m.
EST on April 20. 63
In the next 71 hours mission commander John Young and lunar module pilot
Charles Duke laid out the surface instruments and conducted three traverses in
their lunar rover, covering in all some 27 kilometers (nearly 17 miles). While they
were busy on the surface, Ken Mattingly in Casper was occupied with operating
the instruments in the service module. The only serious mishap on the surface
occurred when Young tripped over the cable to the heat-flow sensors, pulling
it loose from the central station and incapacitating the experiment, a4
Young and Duke finished their exploration, loaded the 96 kilograms (210
pounds) of samples they had collected into Orion, and rejoined Mattingly in lunar
orbit on April 23. They released the moon-orbiting subsatellite, but because of
recurring problems with the service propulsion system, the spacecraft was not
in the optimum orbit for the satellite. As a result, the satellite crashed into the
moon after only five weeks. 6s During the four-day return flight they conducted
additional experiments with electrophoresis, a technique that offered advantages
for separating certain biological preparations that could not be efficiently done
in a gravity field. A normal landing in the Pacific, north of Christmas Island, com-
pleted the mission on April 27. 66
Even before the Apollo 16 rock samples had been returned to Houston it was
apparent that premission interpretations of the Descartes site had not been
245
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
Apollo 16 commander John Young collects a rake sample, screening out fragments smaller than about
1 centimeter.
ORIGINAL PAP_E
246 BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPh[
ORIGINALPAGE Lunar Exploration Concluded
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Following completion of Apollo 15, with 16 in the planning stages and only
one mission remaining after that, one scientist expected that the process of choos-
ing a site for the last flight would be "a dilly of an affair. ''72 Perhaps with that
thought in mind, Rocco Petrone, Apollo program director at NASA Headquarters,
started the procedure early, in October of 1971. After a site evaluation document
had been circulated among selected interested scientists for their critique and
response, an ad hoc site evaluation committee would meet no later than Decem-
ber 30 to consider site proposals and make recommendations to the Apollo Site
Selection Board in early 1972. 73
Actually, site selection for Apollo 17 was not as difficult as might have been
expected, considering that it was the last chance for many years to obtain mate-
rial and data from the moon. Preliminary review of possible sites produced a clear
consensus of objectives for Apollo 17: to investigate the pre-Imbrian highlands
Photograph of the Taurus-Littrow landing site for Apollo 17 taken by the metric camera on Apollo I5.
The landing site, marked with a white cross, lies between two massifs (north and south).
247
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
as far as possible from the Imbrium basin; to sample "young" volcanics; to obtain
photographic and remote-sensor coverage of areas not previously investigated;
and to provide the best coverage for the new traverse geophysics experiments
that were to go along. Application of all these considerations reduced the interest-
ing sites to three: Taurus-Littrow, a region on the southeastern rim of Mare Sereni-
tatis; Gassendi, a large crater on the northern rim of Mare Humorum; and (ranking
a distant third) Alphonsus, previously considered as an alternative to the Des-
cartes site. Of these three, the ad hoc site evaluation committee concluded that
Taurus-Littrow was the best. It was a two-objective site (highlands and young
volcanic material); it offered a reasonable contingency for a walking mission in
case the lunar rover should fail; and it would provide the greatest amount of new
information from the orbital sensors in the service module. TM
Operational considerations, taken up at the February meeting of the site selec-
tion board, gave no site a clear advantage. Problems existed at all three, although
Alphonsus, already well studied, was acceptable. At Gassendi there was a good
chance that the astronauts would not be able to get to their prime objective if
they had to land beyond the nominal 3-sigma ellipse. For Taurus-Littrow, detailed
studies at first indicated that under "worst-case" conditions the site was unsuita-
ble; the 3-sigma ellipse could not be fitted into it. When trajectory designers were
urged to reconsider their calculations in light of the results of Apollo 15, how-
ever, they produced some less conservative numbers and the site was accepta-
Geologist Jack Schmitt moves around a huge broken boulder at Taurus-Littrow (Apollo 17). He has
sampled the surface material where scoop marks are visible on the lower left front flank and is preparing
to take more samples. The boulder rolled down from the North Massif.
ORIGINAL PAGE
248 BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
Lunar Exploration Concluded
ble. With operational considerations out of the way, the board picked
Taurus-Littrow because of its greater scientific potential. 75
The Taurus-Littrow site was a flat-floored valley some 7 kilometers (4.3 miles)
wide, a dark, bay-like indentation in the broken mountain chain on the eastern
edge of Mare Serenitatis, at 20 degrees 10 minutes north latitude, 30 degrees 46
minutes east longitude. Bounded on three sides by high mountain massifs, the
valley contained numerous craters of possible volcanic origin, as A1 Worden had
noted from orbit on Apollo 15. 76
Premission data from the landing site indicated it to be geologically complex.
Rock types appeared to vary in age, composition, and probable origin, and the
mountains displayed structural features that might be correlated with several
major landforming events. The valley floor on which Apollo 17 was to land
appeared to be volcanic and thus might have originated deep within the moon.
A landslide intruded on one side of the valley floor, and boulder tracks down
the mountainsides added to scientists' interest in the site. 77
Until early 1971 Apollo 17 had been scheduled for June 1972; in February the
launch schedule was revised and both Apollo 16 and 17 were moved forward,
to March and December 1972, respectively. 78 The new launch date for Apollo 17
required one more launch constraint to be lifted, because Taurus-Littrow was not
accessible by translunar injection (departure of the spacecraft and S-IVB from the
earth parking orbit) over the Pacific Ocean. Early in the program Pacific injection
was adopted as the rule, since the alternative--injection over the Atlantic--
required a night launch at some times of the year. Although Atlantic injection
offered an economy in fuel and thus an increase in allowable payload, the poten-
tial problems incident to a night launch (see Chapter 6) tipped the scales. 79 By
the time the site selection board met in February 1972, however, "the bullet had
been bitten on night launches"8°; experience had made those problems much
less worrisome.
So it was that Apollo 17 was scheduled to leave the Cape at 9:38 p.m. EST on
December 6, 1972. 81 From August 8, when the launch vehicle was moved to the
pad, preparations went well. Some minor hardware problems cropped up but
were handled without delaying the schedule. Launch day was bright and warm;
the temperature was in the mid-80s at midafternoon. All looked well for the last
Apollo mission until 30 seconds before launch, when the automatic sequencer--
the oldest and most reliable piece of automation at the launch complex--shut the
system down. The first launch delay in the Apollo program caused by failure of
equipment amounted to 2 hours and 40 minutes while Cape and Marshall Space
Flight Center engineers worked around the malfunction. At 12:33 a.m. Eastern
Standard Time on December 7, command module America and lunar module
Challenger were off for Taurus-Littrow. 82 Flight controllers made up the lost time
during the translunar coast. 83
America and Challenger entered lunar orbit on schedule and all preparations for
landing went smoothly. After the two spacecraft separated, Cernan and Schmitt
took a spectacular photograph of their landing site. Three hours later Cernan
powered up Challenger for its descent. It touched down within 200 meters (650
feet) of its targeted landing point amid a field of craters at 3:15 p.m. EST on Decem-
ber 11. 84
249
Where No Man Has Gone Before
For the next 75 hours Cernan and Schmitt conducted the longest, and in many
ways the most productive, lunar exploration of the Apollo program. During three
trips from their base they laid out the surface experiments, drove the lunar rover
about 36 kilometers (22 miles) in all, ranging as far as 7.37 kilometers (4.5 miles)
from Challenger, and collected roughly 243 pounds (110 kilograms, of soil and rock
samples along with more than 2,000 documentation photographs. 85
Like their predecessors, Cernan and Schmitt were somewhat constrained by
the preplanned sequence of activity. Still, before they left the lunar module and
while unloading the Rover and the surface experiments, Schmitt found time to
give Houston's back-room scientists both large- and small-scale descriptions of
the landing area and the surface under his feet. _ Schmitt found the environment
in the landing area "superb" for observation: the lighting was excellent and the
rock surfaces generally clean, and he found little difficulty in distinguishing miner-
alogical and textural differences. For the most part he based his decisions on tak-
ing samples on visually detectable differences or similarities. 87
Besides collecting and documenting samples, on their traverses the explorers
laid out explosive charges for a seismic profiling experiment (the charges would
be set off after they left), took readings on a portable gravity meter at various
points along the route, and set up an instrument to measure electrical properties
of the lunar surface. At the site for the surface experiments package they drilled
two 2.54-meter (8.3-foot) holes for heat-flow sensors, took a deep core sample,
A view of the lunar orbital experiments in the scientific instrument module of the service module,
takenfrom lunar module Challenger beforeit dockedwith America on return from the lunar sutrace.
ORIGINAL PACE
250 BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
OR1GTN.&L- PA_E Lunar Exploration Concluded
BLACK
AND WkI!TE Pi-IOTOGRApH
Command module pilot Ron Evans outside the spacecraft America, recovering fiIm from the scientific
instrument module (SIM) bay of the service module. The cylindrical object with the handle, near his
knees, is a film cassette.
and set up the geophones (detectors) for the seismic profiling experiment, ss The
first excursion was largely taken up by these chores.
After an overnight rest and a discussion with Houston concerning plans for
sampling, Cernan and Schmitt set out on their second trip to collect specimens
from boulders along the lower slopes of the South Massif and to sample the lighter-
colored soil that overlay the western part of the valley. It was a long trip--an hour
by rover to the first major sampling stop--and would stretch their life-support
systems almost to the limit. The last couple of kilometers up the slope taxed the
rover, too, but it brought them to their objective in fine style. Schmitt took sam-
ples from three boulders which, as best he could tell, had come from layers visi-
ble farther up the South Massif. s9
251
Where No Man Has Gone Before
This is our commemoration that will be here until someone like us, until some
of you who are out there, who are the promise of the future, come back to
read it again and to further the exploration and the meaning of Apollo.
He then parked the rover at a spot where its television camera could watch their
takeoff, and Apollo's last two explorers finished their last tasks on the moon.
Cernan closed out the surface activity with the comment that "I believe history
will record that America's challenge of today has forged man's destiny of tomor-
row.'93 Then they packed up their samples, discarded the tools they would no
longer need, and climbed back into Challenger. 94
Next day, December 14, they blasted off to join America in lunar orbit. As tele-
vision audiences on earth watched, the rover TV camera, directed from Hous-
ton, followed their ascent stage until it was out of sight, then slowly scanned
the now-deserted lunar surface. 9s The awareness that no living person was around
made the scene all the more impressive. It was almost possible to hear the silence.
After hooking up with the moon-circling command module, Schmitt and Cer-
nan transferred their samples and data. America still had a day's work to do, com-
pleting the photographic and remote-sensing work that Ron Evans had been doing
while his crewmates were on the surface. Their work completed, the crew of
Apollo 17 left the moon with a blast from their service propulsion engine at 8:42
p.m. EST on December 16. A routine transearth coast brought them back to a
landing about 300 kilometers (200 miles) east of Pago Pago at 2:25 p.m. EST on
252
ORIGINAl_- PA_I=" Lunar Exploration Concluded
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
December 19, 1972. 96 Apollo's exploration of the moon, "one of the most ambi-
tious and successful endeavors of man, ''97 was over.
While scientists awaited the samples from Taurus-Littrow, editorial writers
offered varying evaluations of the lunar exploration project. Perhaps the bitterest
farewell to Apollo was expressed by William Hines, syndicated Chicago Sun-Times
columnist, who had opposed the project from the start: "And now, thank God,
the whole crazy business is over. ''98 The Christian Science Monitor cautioned that
"Such technological feats as going to the moon do not absolve people of respon-
sibilities on earth."" The New York Times decided that "Man's entire perspective
on the universe and on his place in it has been radically changed. Man evolved
on the earth, but he is no longer chained to it."1°° Time magazine noted that after
the magnificent effort to develop the machines and the techniques to go to the
moon, Americans lost the will and the vision to press on. Apollo's detractors,
said Time, were
prisoners of limited vision who cannot comprehend, or do not care, that Neil
Armstrong's step in the lunar dust will be well remembered when most of
today's burning issues have become mere footnotes to history. 1°1
Scientist-astronaut Jack Schmitt steps out of the command module America floating in the Pacific
Ocean. The large spherical bags are the uprighting system, which rights the command module if it
lands nose-down. A flotation collar has been attached by the frogmen of the recovery team.
253
14
At the start of 1973 scientists eagerly awaited the last samples from the moon.
Apollo was all but forgotten, however, at NASA's manned space flight centers,
which had already shifted gears and were preparing for the next manned projects.
In August 1972, when Apollo 17's Saturn V rolled out of the Vehicle Assembly
Building at Kennedy Space Center, two launch vehicles in adjacent bays were
being prepared for Skylab's first flight, nine months away. Barely a month after
Apollo 17 returned, Skylab program officials completed the design certification
review for modifications required at the launch complex. At Houston, Skylab
crews--officially named in January 1972--had been in training since late 1970.1
Crews for Apollo-Soyuz, the joint mission with the Soviet Union, scheduled for
mid-1975, were named in early February 1973, 2 the same week the first lunar sam-
ples from Apollo 17 were released. 3
The Manned Spacecraft Center now had nearly 380 kilograms (836 pounds) of
samples from the moon--all the lunar material the scientists could expect to get
for many years. Besides the samples, there was a mass of data from the lunar-
orbital experiments and a continuing flow of information from the lunar surface
experiments, most of which were still functioning (see Appendix 5). Scientists
now began to concern themselves with the preservation, description, and catalog-
ing of the samples and the provision of adequate support for a continuing pro-
gram of research. 4
Apollo 17 Samples
The Lunar Sample Analysis Planning Team met at MSC on January 29 to plan
for allocation of Apollo 17 samples. In keeping with the custom established on
the previous two missions, five key samples were released very early for
age-dating, including the orange soil that had so excited Jack Schmitt. During
February samples were sent to 116 of 185 principal investigators, even before the
preliminary examination was completed, so that some results could be reported
to the fourth Lunar Science Conference scheduled for March. 5
Schmitt's selection and documentation of samples taken from the large boul-
ders examined at Taurus-Littrow presented a new problem for the team. Con-
sidering that issuing samples to investigators working in isolation would waste
a unique opportunity to study the relationships between different rock types,
the team recommended that each boulder (or set of possibly related boulders)
255
IP_-,_'_._IN TEH TION ALI.F 8_1_
WhereNo ManHasGoneBefore
beexamined
by a small interdisciplinary group working in close collaboration.
After these groups had examined the samples and extracted as much informa-
tion as possible, the specimens would be cut up and distributed for study. 6
The fourth annual lunar science conference convened on March 5, 1973, with
more than 700 scientists in attendance. 7 NASA's Deputy Administrator, George
Low, opened the four-day meeting by reviewing the Apollo lunar exploration
program and the progress made in understanding of the moon in three and a
half years. He expressed NASA's gratification with the willingness of the scien-
tific community to participate effectively in analyzing the data and planning the
succeeding missions, citing the Group for Lunar Exploration Planning and the
Science Working Panels, the support provided during the missions by the scien-
tists in the back rooms, and the help others had given in training the crews and
selecting sites. Low told the group that NASA was "firmly committed" to con-
tinue support of lunar studies based on the Apollo samples. 8
Few results from Apollo 17 were presented at the conference, since so little time
had elapsed since the samples were released. One of the first studies had deter-
mined that the orange soil, which consisted mostly of tiny beads of brown to
reddish glass of a composition similar to lunar basalts, was probably of volcanic
origin. While it could also be explained as the product of a meteorite impact, the
soil was age-dated at 3.5 to 3.7 billion years, an age that could not be correlated
with any major basin-forming event and therefore with any major impact) Other
papers at the conference reported basic data on the nature, chemistry, and ages
of the Apollo 17 samples that had been released. 10
While analysis of lunar data continued unabated (the proceedings of the fourth
lunar science conference, like those of the three before it, filled three large volumes)
by early 1973 the major constraints to a model of lunar evolution were beginning
to be clear. Geological, geochemical, and geophysical evidence made it clear that
the moon is quite different from the earth in structure and composition and there-
fore probably in the process of its formation. 11 A coherent picture of the moon's
history gradually emerged over the next few years (see below).
This conference marked the end of Apollo's voyages, and perhaps that was
responsible for the "notable spirit of amity between lunar scientists and NASA's
engineer-managers" that some observers perceived at the meeting. In response
to George Low's acknowledgement of their contributions to Apollo and his pledge
of continuing support for lunar studies, the conferees adopted a motion that
acknowledged some "awkward moments" over the years but praised the space
agency for its overall execution of a project that had "already revolutionized ideas
of the solar system's evolution." In a less formal but probably more meaningful
gesture, a small group of the scientists who had been most intimately involved
in planning the Apollo missions dug into their own pockets to honor selected
NASA managers and engineers at a private banquet. One anonymous scientist
said it was their way of saying thanks to "'some of the higher people who played
256
ORIGINAL PAGE Project Apollo: The Conclusion
BLACK AND WHITE PHOTOGRAPH
ball and to some of the lower echelon people--beautiful guys who would come
along at the right time, stand up to their bosses, and help us get an experiment
on board."12 It was a considerable change from the prevailing attitude only three
and a half years before (see Chapter 10), but much else had changed in those
years as well.
In 1974, following the fifth lunar science conference, Robert Jastrow* attempted
a brief synthesis of what science had learned from the Apollo studies for the New
York Times. After outlining the gross features of the moon's evolution, he
The Earth-facing side of the moon, showing the locations of the six Apollo landing sites.
*Jastrow, the first director of the Theoretical Division in the Office of Space Sciences (see Chapter
2), later headed NASA's Goddard Institute of Space Studies in New York City.
257
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
acknowledged that "Apollo has left at least one great cosmological question unan-
swered: Where did the moon come from?" For years before Apollo 11 landed,
Jastrow said,
scientists argued the merits of various theories with great intensity, but the
battle ended in a stalemate. Each theory suffered from at least one major defect.
Everyone expected that the lunar landings would promptly settle the debate.
It seemed obvious that as soon as we found out what the moon was made
of, we would be able to tell where it came from: it would have either the same
or different chemistry from that of the earth.
These hopes were not realized. Analysis of the moon rocks has shown
that.., the moon did not come from the earth. But it didn't suggest any alter-
natives.
The origin of the moon remains as much a mystery as it was before
Apollo .... 13
But if the moon's origin remained mysterious, the early stages in its evolution
became clearer as the results of Apollo science accumulated.
Arriving at a model of lunar evolution was not easy, since so many different
and often unrelated scientific disciplines contributed essential information.
Interpretation of the data from geological studies concerning volcanic activity,
for example, had to be consistent with the seismic scientists' findings about the
moon's internal structure. Heat flow measurements had to be interpreted in light
of the geochemical abundances of radioactive elements. Gerald J. Wasserburg,
professor of geology and geophysics at Caltech, who participated in the lunar
studies from the beginning, commented that this required most investigators to
change their approach to science. For the most part, Wasserburg said, they had
come to the first lunar science conference as specialists, "without any concep-
tion of the relationship of their particular observations to the global problems of
a planet." As the work proceeded, however, "specialists began to recognize the
interrelationships between their own work and studies done by other individuals
in completely different fields. So a broader, truer planetary science [began] to
emerge."14
Before Apollo 11, considerable information about the moon had been available--
principally its physical characteristics, but including some basic chemical facts
as well. is For many years it had been known that the moon was only 60 percent
as dense as the earth (3.3 grams per cubic centimeter as against 5.5 for the earth)
and that its rotational properties were almost identical with those of a homogene-
ous sphere. In the 1960s, space probes yielded more information. Surveyors V,
V/, and V/I carried instruments that measured the proportions of key chemical
elements in the lunar surface. They showed that the maria were different from
the highlands and that the moon was chemically different from both the earth
and the (presumed) primordial material of the solar system. The terrestrial mate-
rial most closely resembling the maria was basalt, an igneous rock, indicating the
maria had been flooded with molten rock that had later solidified. Geochemists
deduced from its density that the lunar basalt could not represent the average
composition of the entire moon, which allowed the inference that the moon was
not homogeneous.
258
J_
i] i'"
i
Project Apollo: The Conclusion
Later, the Lunar Orbiters returned photographs that showed the moon's hid-
den side to be topographically quite different from the visible side. Besides provid-
ing information essential to the selection of Apollo landing sites, Orbiter
photographs contained a wealth of geological clues. They convinced geologists
that at least some of the moon's surface features had been produced by volcanic
activity. Analysis of the spacecrafts' orbits provided evidence for anomalous con-
centrations of mass ("mascons") under some of the maria, suggesting that the
lunar crust was thicker and more rigid than was previously supposed. Had the
crust been more plastic, the mascons would have settled deeper into it over geo-
logic time, eliminating the gravitational anomalies that affected Lunar Orbiter V.
Thus the outer layer of the moon had been cold and rigid for a very long period,
yet lava flows large enough to fill the basins had occurred as well. This too implied
a nonuniform structure for the moon and probably a complex evolutionary history.
To this sketchy body of knowledge about the moon Apollo contributed an over-
whelming flood of new information, out of which scientists began to contruct
new models, some to be discarded quickly, others to be modified and retained.
The geophysical data may have been the easiest to integrate into a coherent pic-
ture. Apollo's four seismometers detected infrequent, weak tremors originating
within the moon, at depths of 800 to 1,100 kilometers (500 to 700 miles), much
deeper than those on earth. Forty-three moonquake zones were identified, each
showing periodic activity correlated with lunar tides. Artificial seismic events
(impacts of LM ascent stages and spent S-IVB stages)--plus the fortuitous colli-
sions of a large (1,100 kilograms, 2,400 pounds) meteorite with the
moon16--produced signals that suggested a crust about 60 kilometers (37 miles)
thick, overlying a different homogeneous layer extending down to about 1,000
kilometers (625 miles). Deeper still a partially molten core may exist, which, assum-
ing it to be a silicate rock, would be at a temperature of about 1,500 ° (2,700°F).
Results from the laser altimeters carried on Apollo 15 and 16 confirmed that
the moon's center of mass does not coincide with its geometrical center. Some
scientists suggested this was due to the presence of the low-lying maria on the
near side. Others suggested that the crust on the far side was thicker than that
on the near side, which would make the absence of maria on the far side easier
to explain: a thicker crust could have prevented the extrusion of molten material
except in the very deepest craters, such as Tsiolkovsky. 17
Geological and geochemical data were harder to interpret; only the broadest
general conclusions could be stated after Apollo 17. The returned samples showed
that the moon was chemically different from the earth, containing a smaller
proportion of volatile elements (those that are driven off at low to moderate tem-
peratures) and more radioactive elements than the cosmic average. Geochemical
evidence indicated that three types of rocks predominate on the lunar surface:
basalts rich in iron covering the maria; plagioclase or aluminum-rich anorthosites
characteristic of the highlands; and uranium- and thorium-rich basalts that also
contain high proportions of potassium, rare-earth elements, and phosphorus
("KREEP'" basalts). Some scientists felt, however, that these could not represent
the structure and texture of the primordial lunar rocks; it seemed likely that those
characteristics had been virtually obliterated in the massive bombardment that
the moon has obviously undergone. TM
259
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
260
Project Apollo: The Conclusion
quent years, those on other celestial bodies, e.g., Mercury, Mars, and the satel-
lites of Jupiter and Saturn) has stimulated interest in the mechanics of crater
formation, leading to laboratory studies using high-velocity particles. Finally, the
impact theory of the moon's origin has recently been revived, with modifications.
Collision of an object the size of Mars with earth has been computer modeled
and found to be not unattractive. Newer thinking about the origin of the moon
considers that more than one process may have contributed significantly, that
is, collision followed by accretion of additional material by both bodies. As yet,
the available evidence does not permit a clear-cut choice among the various postu-
lates. 2o
So far as the Apollo results have shown, the moon's surface has undergone
no large-scale changes for something like 3 billion years. Continuous slow ero-
sion of large features by the impacts of small meteoroids has added to the dust
layer on its surface, now and then a substantial meteoroid has produced another
crater, and occasionally a boulder, dislodged by an internal tremor or an external
shock, has rolled down a slope, leaving its track in the dust. Today the moon
looks very much as it looked to the first humans, and it must have changed very
little since the age of the dinosaurs.
261
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Most of the issues over which NASA and the external science community wran-
gled grew out of the necessity to define, virtually from scratch, the scientific con-
tent of lunar exploration. One lunar scientist pinpointed the difficulty in
midprogram:
"In 1976 one more Luna (Luna 24) returned a much larger sample from the southern edge of Mare
Crisium in the moon's northeastern quadrant. Astronautics and Aeronautics, 1976, A Chronology, NASA
SP-4021 (Washington, 1984) pp. 182-83.
262
Project Apollo: The Conclusion
of the mission wlere] for some time lost in the management and excitement of the larger
enterprise both by NASA and an insufficiently involved and unprepared scientific com-
munity [emphasis added]37
When lunar landing became the Apollo objective in May 1961, the United
States had only 15 minutes of manned flight experience in space and a tenta-
tive plan for a spacecraft that might be able to circumnavigate the moon. No
rocket launch vehicle was available for a lunar voyage and no route (mode)
agreed on for placing any kind of spacecraft safely on the lunar surface and
getting it back to earth. Nor was there agreement within NASA itself on how
it should be done38
Acutely aware that NASA's total manned space flight experience was limited
to one ballistic flight and that he was being asked to commit men to a 14-day
trip to the moon and back, [MSC Director] Robert Gilruth said he was simply
aghast. 29
It can hardly be doubted that Gilruth's reaction was shared by his line engineers
at the Manned Spacecraft Center--and by managers in the Office of Manned Space
Flight as well. The 8- or 9-year time limit given them by Kennedy* would have
daunted even the most optimistic engineer who was familiar with the state of
the art in aerospace engineering and the complexities of a moon landing. Charged
with that responsibility, they had to put first things first, and their single-minded
concentration on essentials left science with a low priority. No evidence has been
found that Bob Gilruth and his engineers actively opposed the incorporation of
science into Apollo. They knew that it would have been absurd to land men on
the moon if they did not at least leave their spacecraft to explore the surface--
and, if possible, collect samples and emplace scientific instruments.
Still, the feeling developed among some scientists that MSC was obstructive
toward science, and as much as anything else, the Houston center's narrow focus
on nonscientific aspects of the program was responsible. Homer Newell, associ-
ate administrator for space science, knew well that MSC could be difficult to deal
with, but he could at least perceive a reason for it:
*The phrase, "before this decade is out," was deliberately chosen by the President to allow for
some flexibility of interpretation. It could without serious equivocation be construed as meaning either
1969 or 1970. See Theodore C. Sorenson, Kennedy (New York: Harper & Row, 1965), p. 525.
263
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
National Academy of Sciences and its Space Science Board over the question of
who should decide the content of the space programs. The executive director of
the Space Science Board went so far as to urge that NASA rely exclusively on
the outside scientific community for its science program, which would effectively
have reduced NASA's role to providing launch vehicles and operational support
for science (besides, of course, financing the experimenters). Newell later recalled
that gradually a working arrangement evolved putting NASA "in the driver's
seat, [with] the scientific community serving as navigator, so to speak .... with
a mixture of tension and cooperation that is best described as a love-hate rela-
tionship.-31
Science would eventually become the navigator for lunar exploration as well,
but only after the primary objective had been attained. During the early years
the Manned Spacecraft Center at least made some significant gestures toward
eventual accommodation of science, establishing an office to coordinate experi-
ments, providing space in the lunar module to carry scientific equipment, 32 and
starting to train astronauts in the principles of field geology. It was less concerned
with developing a full program of lunar exploration. MSC, in fact, could do little
in that regard, because strategic planning for lunar exploration was the responsi-
bility of the Office of Space Sciences and Applications (OSSA) at Headquarters.
For a considerable time following the establishment of Apollo, no organized
lunar and planetary science lobby existed. So in formulating a program of lunar
science, OSSA first sought statements of broad objectives from ad hoc groups,
such as the Sonett committee, which established the basic criteria for science on
the Apollo missions in 1962 and the training required for astronauts to execute
the science program (see Chapter 2). Considered and endorsed in principle at
the 1962 Summer Study at the State University of Iowa, these criteria were then
used by discipline-oriented planning teams to define specific scientific investiga-
tions. By mid-1964 these teams had listed the experiments expected to be the most
productive--some to be conducted on the moon, some to be done on returned
samples, and some to be carried out by instruments left on the lunar surface (see
Chapter 3).
In 1965, the Summer Study at Woods Hole, Massachusetts, sharpened the focus
by formulating 15 key questions about the moon that lunar science studies should
be designed to answer. Following the Woods Hole sessions, a study group met
at nearby Falmouth to make the first attempt to explicitly define an evolutionary
program of lunar science for the next 10 to 15 years (see Chapter 3 and Appendix
3). The Falmouth report became the basis for much of the planning that followed. 33
Thus while the Manned Spacecraft Center was working toward its primary aim
of landing people on the moon, OSSA was preparing the ground for the scien-
tific work to be done when they got there. In 1966, after years of encouragement
from Headquarters, MSC established a Science and Applications Directorate,
which assumed much of the responsibility for Apollo science and, more impor-
tant to the science community, put a research scientist into the management struc-
ture at MSC (see Chapter 6). The new office had no significant effect on Apollo
plans immediately, but its influence was to become stronger as the project went on.
One of the first actions taken by Wilmot N. Hess, MSC's first Director of Science
and Applications, was to convoke a summer study to translate the plans devised
at Falmouth into scientific requirements for Apollo exploration: mission duration,
264
Project Apollo: The Conclusion
lunar surface mobility, and scientific use of the command module in lunar orbit.
Participants did their job well: in the preface to their report Homer Newell noted
that "the plans are optimistic and exceed the capability of the agency to execute.' ,34
Even so, the most important recommendations that came out of the 1967 study
at Santa Cruz (see Appendix 3) were carried out on the Apollo missions as soon
as the required engineering and operational changes could be incorporated into
the system.
Few questions were as important in the ultimate success of Apollo as making
certain that the external science community had a voice in the planning of the
missions. In the summer of 1967 Wilmot Hess created three science teams that
would operate throughout the duration of the project: the Group for Lunar Explo-
ration Planning (superseded in 1970 by the Science Working Panel), the Lunar
Sample Analysis Planning Team and the Lunar Sample Preliminary Examina-
tion Team. The specific responsibilities of these groups were probably not more
significant than their role in promoting cooperation between MSC and the science
community. Establishment of the two teams concerned with lunar samples placed
responsibility for sample distribution in the hands of scientists; the Group for
Lunar Exploration Planning was intended to reassure scientists that their con-
cerns were at least being considered in developing plans for later missions.
Yet when the first lunar landing mission succeeded in bringing back nearly 50
pounds (21 kilograms) of lunar samples for study, some scientists once more went
public with the complaints that NASA was "not responsive to the needs of
science" (see Chapter 10). It is not easy to determine exactly what was meant
by this charge, expressed as it was in such general terms. Nor is it easy to grant
it much validity, considering that NASA began, immediately after Apollo 11, to
incorporate some of the high-priority improvements in the Apollo system sug-
gested by the Santa Cruz conference--the lunar roving vehicle, the extended lunar
module, and modifications of mission plans to accommodate larger payloads--
all of which would improve the scientific return. Trajectory designers at MSC
set out to improve the landing accuracy of the second mission, explicitly if not
solely for the benefit of science. What more NASA could have done for science
in Apollo, short of turningthe program over to scientists, is difficult to imagine.
The complaining scientists overlooked or ignored the fact that manned space
flight officials could not be certain that the first attempt at a lunar landing would
succeed. (Michael Collins, command module pilot on Apollo 11, confessed that
on launch day he would not have given better than even odds that the whole
complex mission would be carried out without a failure. 3s) That being true, it was
not prudent to begin modifying the spacecraft before the first landing was accom-
plished.* If Neil Arni_.trong had been forced to abort his landing, George Mueller,
*MSC's refusal to anticipate scientific requirements and modify the spacecraft to accommodate them
was one of the scientists' most serious complaints. The head of the Experimental Planetology Branch,
Solar System Exploration Division, at Johnson Space Center pointed out in criticizing the draft of
this book that "It require[d] at least a year of lead time for even the simplest of new ideas to be
introduced into a program as complicated as Apollo. Therefore, waiting until after the first one or
two successful landings to begin accommodating the scientists' wishes was guaranteed to delay any
implementation for a long time." He also cited Gilruth's waiting until early 1970 to work out MSC's
differences with the scientific community as a similar source of irritation for scientists. Wm. C. Phin-
265
Where No Man Has Gone Before
chief of manned space flight, was prepared to send missions to the moon at the
shortest intervals launch teams could manage until someone landed on the moon
and returned safely to earth before the decade of the 1960s was out. As soon as
that was done, Mueller urged MSC Director Bob Gilruth to do his best to accom-
modate science. Gilruth's response, following the first lunar science conference
in January 1970, was to bring his principal lieutenants and a group of leading
scientists to the table to work out their major differences, with the result that
scientists' input to the later missions was effective and satisfying to the scientists
(see Chapter 11).
An issue that sharply divided the scientists and manned space flight officials
from first to last was the question of whether a scientist should go to the moon.
Even before they knew what the lunar surface was like, scientists took it for
granted that only one of their fraternity could properly conduct a scientific sur-
vey while on the moon. Analogously, Deke Slayton, Director of Flight Crew Oper-
ations at MSC and the man most responsible for assigning crews to missions,
was confident that only an experienced test pilot thoroughly familiar with space-
craft systems could be depended upon to react correctly in whatever emergency
might develop during a landing. The scientists seem to have felt that piloting
a spacecraft was a skill much like driving a car and could be learned by any
reasonably intelligent person in a comparatively short time. 36 Slayton considered
it easier to teach an astronaut a few basic scientific tasks than to make a pilot
out of a scientist37--hence if either skill took precedence, it should be piloting.
Both were right and both were wrong. If lunar explorers had only a little time
on the moon, science would be best served if one of the crew was a scientist of
considerable experience who could make the most of what little he could see and
do. On the other hand, an emergency in a lunar mission might leave no time
for conscious thought. The ability to take the proper action instinctively would
be expected of an experienced test pilot but might be difficult to instill into a per-
son having little experience of acting decisively in emergencies.
As long as spacecraft were regarded as experimental rather than operational,
Slayton's view--shared by Bob Gilruth--prevailed, modified by the addition of
some basic instruction in geology to the astronaut training program. Eventually
MSC yielded on the point of accepting scientists for astronaut training, but did
so with the stipulation that they must also qualify as jet pilots, if necessary by
taking flying training before starting in the astronaut program.
ney to William Waldrip, "Review of Apollo History," Mar. 31, 1987. The point is certainly valid,
but it presumes, as scientists typically did, that science should have taken precedence as early as
Apollo 12. The present author does not agree. The last 21/2 years before Apollo 11 were spent recover-
ing from the AS-204 fire, which totally occupied spacecraft engineers and program managers. Prob-
lems with the lunar module lingered through 1968. To have begun modifying the untried lunar module
to suit the purposes of science a year or more before the first lunar flight would have been to invite
trouble.
266
Project Apollo: The Conclusion
We got excellent sampling, we got excellent photography .... but until Apollo
17 we did not get very much good, solid descriptive work, with one exception--
that exception being Neil Armstrong .... He was probably the best observer
we sent to the moon, in spite of very limited training; he just had a knack for it. _
*Apollo 13 was indeed an emergency, but the responsibility for saving the mission was in the hands
of experts on the ground. The success of the rescue did not depend on the crew's ability to act swiftly
in a critical situation.
267
Where No Man Has Gone Before
*Carbon compounds, for example--possible relics of extinct life or precursors of life on the moon--
could be detected if present to the extent of a few parts per billion.
268
Project Apollo: The Conclusion
held firm, on the grounds that crew safety would be imperiled. The committee
settled for biological isolation garments and application of a biocide to the
spacecraft.
In the event, the precautions proved unnecessary and quarantine was aban-
doned after the third lunar landing. Apart from the expense, quarantine was irk-
some to engineers and scientists alike, for it impeded postflight debriefings and
delayed the release of samples to principal investigators. In any case, quarantine
was not intended to be absolute: the second guideline governing procedures
stated, "the preservation of human life should take precedence over the main-
tenance of quarantine." If a command module had begun to sink during recov-
ery operations, or if a major fire had broken out in the crew quarters of the
receiving laboratory, or if a quarantined astronaut had suffered a medical emer-
gency that could not be handled within the LRL, quarantine would have been
broken. 41
The results of biological and chemical examination of the returned lunar sam-
ples indicated that life never has existed on the moon--or at least that it left no
traces at the sites examined. As did the data returned from Mars by the Viking
landers a few years later, the Apollo results showed that the only conclusion that
can be reached at present concerning the existence of life elsewhere in our solar
system is, "not proven."
A decade and a half after Eugene Cernan left the last human footprint on the
moon, the value and the wisdom of the Apollo project can still be debated. As
an engineering accomplishment it is unparalleled in history. As a scientific proj-
ect it enabled researchers on earth to study documented specimens from another
body in the solar system, perhaps the only such specimens that will be available
in this century. As an exercise in the management of an unprecedentedly large
and complex effort it stands alone in human experience.
Yet all these achievements can be read two ways. Magnificent as they were,
the launch vehicles that carried men to the moon turned out to be too expensive
for other missions. The choice of lunar-orbit rendezvous as the mission mode--
largely dictated by the end-of-the-decade challenge--produced two spacecraft
ideally adapted to their function but without sufficient margin for growth to
advance the exploration of the moon as far as scientists wanted. Apollo's scien-
tific results were of vital interest to only a very small fraction of the scientific com-
munity and did not authoritatively answer the questions scientists hoped they
would answer before the first landing. (As one critic caustically commented, the
scientists were able to obtain "a neater fix, so to speak, on the number of angels
who can dance on the point of a pin. "''_) The methods devised for managing
Apollo were impressive; yet the question remains,
Has the whole operation represented but another highly successful one-shot
exercise in crisis management, or has it represented incorporation into American
society of a new way to organize, systematically and purposefully, the develop-
ment and use of scientific and technological resources to the furtherance of
national goals? 43
269
Where No Man Has Gone Before
James Webb, under whose direction NASA developed those methods, believed
them to be the lasting contribution of Apollo, but in the 18 years since the first
lunar landing they have not been applied to any undertaking of comparable size.
It was unfortunate, in a sense, for the United States's space program that
Kennedy's challenge called for NASA to proceed directly to the most difficult
goal that seemed achievable in 1961, for it doomed whatever followed to be an
anticlimax:
The first Apollo landing was, in one sense, a triumph that failed, not because the achieve-
ment was anything short of magnificent but because of misdirected expectations and
a general misinterpretation of its real meaning. The public was encouraged to view
it only as the grand climax of the space program, a geopolitical horse race and extrater-
restrial entertainment--not as a dramatic means to the greater end of developing a far-
ranging spacefaring capability [italics in the original]. _
Americans had plenty to occupy their attention in 1969--civil rights, the plight
of the poor, an increasingly unpopular war in southeast Asia, rising federal
deficits, and growing concern for the preservation of a livable environment--and
plenty of advocates for every cause clamoring for action. If the nation had not
set its space goals as high as possible at the outset, the concerns of the late 1960s
could easily have stopped a more measured approach well short of the moon.
Future generations may look back on Apollo as a costly technological stunt or
the portent of man's destiny in the universe. Scientists studying the origin and
evolution of the solar system may devise other means of acquiring data from the
moon and the planets, but they will surely be thankful for the samples gathered
by the twelve men who made the first lunar voyages.
270
SOURCE NOTES
CHAPTER 1
1. U.S., Congress, House, Toward the Endless Frontier: History of the Committee on Science and Technol-
ogy, 1959-1979 (Washington: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1980), p. 269. This history was
written by Ken Hechler, a Ph.D. historian and author of books on political and military history,
who served on the House Committee on Science and Technology for 18 years beginning in 1959.
2. Homer E. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere: Early Years of Space Science, NASA SP-4211 (Washing-
ton, 1980), pp. 87-99. NeweU joined NASA in 1958 as director of the space science program, became
Associate Administrator for Space Science (later Space Science and Applications) in 1961 and
Associate Administrator in 1967. He retired in 1973 and died in 1984. See also Arnold S. Levine,
Managing NASA in the Apollo Era, NASA SP-4102 (Washington, 1982), pp. 9-17, and Robert L.
Rosholt, An Administrative History of NASA, 1958-1963, NASA SP-4101 (Washington, 1966), pp.
37-47.
3. Rosholt, Administrative History, pp. 45-47. For a history of JPL's Ranger project, see R. Cargill
Hall, Lunar Impact: A History of Project Ranger, NASA SP-4210 (Washington, 1977).
4. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere, pp. 104-105.
5. Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., James M. Grimwood, and Charles C. Alexander, This New Ocean: A His-
tory of Project Mercury, NASA SP-4201 (Washington, 1966), pp. 55-65. The NACA-NASA research
in high-speed flight is treated in Richard Hallion's On the Frontier: A History of the Dryden Flight
Research Facility, NASA SP-4303 (washington, 1984).
6. Swenson, Grimwood, and Alexander, This New Ocean, p. 73.
7. Ibid., pp. 99-102.
8. Courtney G. Brooks, James M. Grimwood, and Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., Chariots for Apollo: A His-
tory of Manned Lunar Spacecraft, NASA SP-4205 (Washington, 1979), pp. 4, 52-53.
9. Roger E. Bilstein, Stages to Saturn: A Technological History of the Apollo/Saturn Launch Vehicles, NASA
SP-4206 (Washington, 1980), pp. 26-42.
10. Documents on International Aspects of the Exploration and Use of Outer Space, 1954-I962, staff report
prepared for the Senate Committee on Aeronautical and Space Sciences (Washington, 1963), p. 188;
the quote is from Eisenhower's annual budget message to Congress, Jan. 18, 1961.
11. "Report to the President-Elect of the Ad Hoc Committee on Space," Jerome B. Weisner, chmn.,
(classified version), Jan. 12, 1961, p. 10.
12. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 7-17.
13. John M. Logsdon, The Decision to Go to the Moon: Project Apollo and the National Interest (Cambridge,
Mass.: MIT Press, 1970), pp. 108-I09, 112-115.
14. President's Science Advisory Committee, Introduction to Outer Space (Washington, 1968), p. 6.
15. James R. Killian, address to the M.I.T. Club of New York, Dec. 13, 1960; quoted in Logsdon,
Decision, p. 20.
16. Space Science Board of the National Academy of Sciences-National Research Council, "Man's
Role in the National Space Program," reprinted in Senate, Committee on Aeronautical and Space
Sciences, National Space Goals for the Post-Apollo Period, 89th Cong., 1st sess. (henceforth 89fl),
1965, pp. 242-43.
17. Logsdon, Decision, p. 86.
18. James E. Webb and Robert S. McNamara, memo to the President, "Recommendations for our
National Space Program: Changes, Policies, Goals," May 8, 1961.
19. Logsdon, Decision, pp. 127-28.
20. Ibid., p. 129.
21. Ibid.
271
Where No Man Has Gone Before
272
ii
Source Notes
CHAPTER 2
1. R. Cargill Hall, Lunar Impact: A History of Project Ranger, NASA SP-4210 (Washington 1977), pp.
15-16.
2. Stephen G. Brush, "Nickel for Your Thoughts: Urey and the Origin of the Moon," Science 217
(1982):891-98.
3. Senate Committee on Aeronautical and Space Sciences, Scientists" Testimony on Space Goals, Hear-
ings, 88/1, June 10, 1963, pp. 51, 52-53.
4. Homer E. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere: Early Years of Space Science, NASA SP-4211 (Washing-
ton, 1980), pp. 212-13.
5. Hall, Lunar Impact, p. 15.
6. Ibid., pp. 5, 17; Clayton R. Koppes, JPL and the American Space Program: A History of the Jet Propul-
sion Laboratory (New Haven and London: Yale University Press, 1982), pp. 99-100.
7. Hall, Lunar Impact, pp. 18, 20-24.
8. Ibid., p. 38.
9. NASA, Fifth Semiannual Report to Congress, October 1, 1960, Through June 30, 1961 (Washington,
1962), pp. 49-50.
10. For a discussion of some of the problems faced by the engineers in ensuring reliability, see Loyd
S. Swenson, Jr., James M. Grimwood, and Charles C. Alexander, This New Ocean: A History of
Project Mercury, NASA SP-4201 (washington, 1966), pp. 167-213.
11. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere, p. 163.
12. Scientists" Testimony on Space Goals, pp. 110, 244; Newell, "The Mission of Man in Space," address
to Symposium on Protection Against Radiation Hazards in Space, Gatlinburg, Tenn., Nov. 5,
1962, text.
13. R. L. F. Boyd, "In Space: Instruments or Man?" International Science and Technology, May 1965,
pp. 64-75. Boyd, a British astronomer with substantial experience in unmanned space science
projects, presents the archetypal sky scientist's view--supremely confident of the potential of
computerized systems and condescendingly contemptuous of the capability of man.
14. Hall, Lunar Impact, p. 114.
15. Ibid., pp. 289-96.
16. Swenson, Grimwood, and Alexander, This New Ocean, pp. 414-15.
17. Joseph F. Shea to Dir., Aerospace Medicine and Dir., Spacecraft & Flight Missions, "Selection
and Training of Apollo Crew Members," Mar. 29, 1962.
18. Courtney G. Brooks, James M. Grimwood, and Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., Chariots for Apollo: A His-
tory of Manned Lunar Spacecraft, NASA SP-4205 (Washington, 1979), chap. 3.
19. Ivan D. Ertel and Mary Louise Morse, The Apollo Spacecraft: A Chronology, vol. I, NASA SP-4009
(Washington, 1969), p. 108.
20. "Draft Statement on Scientific Training of the Astronaut for Consideration of the Lunar Explora-
tion Committee," signed by G. McDonald, M. Ewing, T. Gold, E. Stuhlinger, H. Hess, H. Brown,
and R. Jastrow (members or consultants of the Lunar Sciences Subcommittee of the Space Sciences
Steering Committee), no date [ca. Sept. 1961].
21. House Committee on Science and Astronautics, Subcommittee on Space Sciences and Applica-
tions, 1963 NASA Authorization, Hearings on H.R. 10100, 87/2, pt. 4, pp. 1783-88, 1879-80, 1928-31.
22. Hall, Lunar Impact, p. 157.
23. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere, chap. 12, discusses the relations of OSS to the external scientific
community, including the scientists' insistence on noninterference. For additional examples, see
Daniel S. Greenberg, The Politics of Pure Science (New York: The New American Library, 1967),
pp. 85, 112, 114, 132, 135, 137.
24. Hall, Lunar Impact, p. 162.
25. OMSF, "Requirements for Data in Support of Project Apollo," issue no. 1, June 15, 1962.
26. Hall, Lunar Impact, p. 162; Koppes, JPL and the American Space Program, p. 116.
27. Shea, "Selection and Training of Apollo Crew Members," Mar. 29, 1962; W. A. Lee to Dr. J.
F. Shea, "Ad Hoc Working Group on Apollo Scientific Experiments and Training (sic)," Apr.
13, 1962.
273
Where No Man Has Gone Before
28. L. D. Jaffe, "Minutes: Ad Hoc Working Group on Apollo Scientific Experiments and Training,
27 March 1962," Mar. 30, 1962.
29. Jaffe, "'Minutes: Ad Hoc Working Group on Apollo Scientific Experiments and Training, 17 April
1962," Apr. 20, 1962, with attachment: Lee, "Guidelines from the Office of Manned Space Hight."
30. Lee, "Guidelines From the Office of Manned Space Hight."
31. Jaffe, "Minutes: Ad Hoc Working Group on Apollo Scientific Experiments and Training, 23 April
1962," no date.
32. Ibid.
33. Homer E. Newell and D. Brainerd Holmes, memo for the Assoc. Adm., "Establishment of a Joint
OSS/OMSF Working Group," Oct. 22, 1962.
34. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere, p. 401.
35. NASA Hq., News Release 62-251, "Unit to Coordinate Manned and Unmanned Space Hight,"
Nov. 27, 1962.
36. Hall, Lunar Impact, p. 79.
37. Shoemaker interview, Houston, Mar. 17, 1984.
38. Shoemaker interview; Shoemaker, "Report for week of November 12/" Dec. 13, 1962.
39. Lee to Shea, "OSS Participation in Apollo," Sept. 22, 1962.
40. Swenson, Grimwood, and Alexander, This New Ocean, pp. 414, 419, 443-44; W. David Compton
and Charles D. Benson, Living and Working in Space: A History of Skylab, NASA SP-4208 (Washington,
1983), pp. 59-60.
41. Shoemaker to Dir., Lunar and Planetary Programs and Dir., Systems Studies, "Report for Week of
November 12," "Report for Week of November 19," and "Report for Week of November 26," all
dated Dec. 13, 1962.
42. Shoemaker to Dir., Office of Space Sciences, "Recommended Structure for Manned Space Science
Planning Group," Dec. 13, 1962; Shoemaker to Dir., OMSF and Dir., OSS, "Panel Chairmen
and Members Recommended for the Manned Space Science Planning Group," Dec. 26, 1962.
43. Shoemaker to Din, Office of Space Sciences, "Recommended Structure .... " Dec. 13, 1962;
Shoemaker interview; Shoemaker, "Report for Week of November 19," Dec. 13, 1962.
44. Newell to Robert Gilruth, Feb. 15, 1963; Newell, "Memorandum to A/Mr. Webb," Mar. 26, 1963.
45. Shoemaker interview.
46. NeweU, Beyond the Atmosphere, p. 292; Nolan to Gilruth, Apr. 24, 1963.
47. "Memorandum of Agreement between Office of Manned Space Hight [and] Office of Space
Sciences, Scientific Interfaces," no date; signed by E. M. Cortright July 25, 1963, and J. F. Shea
July 26, 1963.
48. NASA Release 63-242, "NASA Office of Space Science and Applications Organization Detailed,"
Nov. 18, 1963; Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere, p. 284.
49. Robert L. Rosholt, An Administrative History of NASA, 1958-1963, NASA SP-4101 (Washington,
1966), pp. 289-302; Arnold S. Levine, Managing NASA in the Apollo Era, NASA SP-4102 (washing-
ton, 1982), pp. 5-6, 38-46.
50. Levine, Managing NASA, p. 19.
51. House Committee on Science and Astronautics, 1965 NASA Authorization, Hearings on H.R. 9641,
88/2, pt. 1, pp. 113-14.
52. Levine, Managing NASA, p. 119.
53. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 128-31; "Apollo Schedule and Cost Evaluation,"
presentation to George E. Mueller, Sept. 28, 1963, copy in JSC History Office files, box 063-65.
54. NASA Management Instruction 9000.002, "Establishment of a Manned Space Flight Experiments
Board," Jan. 14, 1964; Compton and Benson, Living and Working in Space, pp. 61-62.
55. Willis B. Foster to Chief, Lunar & Planetary Branch [OSSA], "Establishment of Manned Space
Flight Experiments Board," Jan. 9, 1964.
56. Barton C. Hacker and James M. Grimwood, On the Shoulders of Titans: A History of Project Gemini,
NASA SP-4203 (washington, 1977). Gemini is, to some degree, the forgotten manned space flight
program, yet it was essential in determining that men could survive for as long as two weeks
in zero gravity with no serious aftereffects, in proving the techniques of orbital rendezvous and
controlled earth landing, and in developing the fuel cell as a power source, besides providing
many hours of operational experience for mission control.
57. President's Science Advisory Committee, report by the Space Science and Space Vehicle Panels
(Donald F. Hornig, chmn.), "Objectives and Means in Lunar Surface Exploration," Oct. 15, 1963.
274
Source Notes
CHAPTER 3
1. See Harold C. Urey, "The Contending Moons," Astronautics & Aeronautics, vol. 7, no. 1 (Jan.
1969), pp. 37-41, reproduced in "Lunar Science Prior to Apollo 11," Robert Jastrow, Vivien Gor-
nitz, Paul W. Gast, and Robert A. Phinney, eds. (NASA Goddard Space Flight Center Institute
for Space Studies, 1969), pp. I-1 to I-6. This collection, a summary of discussions at a conference
on problems in lunar science held in New York on June 5, 1969, contains papers and excerpts
from books by the leading researchers in lunar science. Although it includes some results from
Ranger and Surveyor that are not pertinent to the present discussion, this volume is a good single
source of pre-ApoUo information on the moon.
2. Eugene M. Shoemaker, "Exploration of the Moon's Surface," American Scientist 50 (1962):99-129.
3. Urey, "The Contending Moons"; Harold C. Urey and G. J. F. MacDonald, "Origin and History
of the Moon," in "Lunar Science Prior to Apollo 11/' pp. 1-14 to 1-135.
4. Urey, "The Contending Moons."
5. "Principal Issues in Lunar Exploration," in "Lunar Science Prior to Apollo 11," pp. 1-19.
6. Ibid., p. 4.
7. "Draft report of the Ad Hoc Working Group on Apollo Experiments and Training on the Scien-
tific Aspects of the Apollo Program," Charles P. Sonett, chmn., July 6, 1962.
8. L. D. Jaffe, "Minutes: Ad Hoc Working Group on Apollo Scientific Experiments and Training,
23 April 1962," no date.
9. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 61-67, 83-86.
10. Robert C. Seamans, Jr., to Homer E. Newell, July 25, 1962.
11. Homer E. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere: Early Years of Space Science, NASA SP-4211 (Washing-
ton, 1980), pp. 207-208.
12. Ibid.
13. National Academy of Sciences-National Research Council, A Review of Space Research, report of
the summer study conducted under the auspices of the Space Science Board at the State Univer-
sity of Iowa, June 17-Aug. 10, 1962, NAS-NRC Publication 1079 (Washington, 1962), pp. 11-4
to 11-5, 4 to 10.
14. Ibid., pp. 11-15 to 11-16.
15. NeweU, Beyond the Atmosphere, p. 209.
16. Verne C. Fryklund, Jr., to Ernst Stuhlinger and Hans Hueter, MSFC, "Scientific Guidelines for
LLS and LLV Studies," July 3, 1963; Fryklund to Dir., MSC, "Scientific Guidelines for the Apollo
Project," Oct. 8, 1963.
17. Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., James M. Grimwood, and Charles C. Alexander, This New Ocean: A His-
tory of Project Mercury, NASA SP-4201 (Washington, 1966), pp. 414-15, 418, 443-45.
18. For a discussion of the integration of experiments with the Mercury flights, see Lewis R. Fisher,
William O. Armstrong, and Carlos S. Warren, "Special Inflight Experiments," in Mercury Project
Summary Including Results of the Fourth Manned Orbital Flight, May 15 and 16, 1963, NASA SP-45
(Washington, 1963), pp. 213-19.
19. The author found this impression to be rarely if ever documented but pervasive among space
scientists and others interviewed. It seemed to be most persistent in the minds of scientists who
were not associated with the manned programs over long periods of time; those who worked
closely with MSC engineers in developing the Apollo science program came to feel otherwise,
for the most part. See author's interviews with P. E. Purser, Mar. 10, 1983, E. M. Shoemaker,
Mar. 17, 1984, and H. H. Schmitt, May 30, 1984, and Loyd S. Swenson's interviews with A. J.
Dessler, May 16, 1971, and E. H. King, Jr., May 27, 1971, tapes in JSC History Office files. Those
who understood the engineers' problems and accepted the manned lunar landing program as
the driving force of the entire space program tended to be more sympathetic. Scientist-astronaut
H. H. Schmitt felt the scientists' expectations of the engineers were unreasonable: "look what
they [the engineers] were trying to do, for crying out loud: they were trying to land on the
moon! . . . [As late as 1968] there was not an engineer.., who could prove that the lunar mod-
ule was going to be able to fly to the moon [land and return]." (Schmitt interview.) During Mer-
cury, the many foreseeable (and unforeseeable but expected) problems of developing spacecraft
275
Where No Man Has Gone Before
and operations caused engineers to be intolerant of any exercise not essential to the lunar land-
ing that might in any way imperil the crew or the engineering and operational objectives of a flight.
20. Shoemaker interview.
21. Newell to Gilruth, Feb. 15, 1963; Wendell W. Mendell, interview with Swenson, Feb. 11, 1971,
transcript in JSC History Office files; Newell to AIMr. Webb, Mar. 16, 1963.
22. King interview; Gilruth to Thomas B. Nolan, Mar. 29, 1963.
23. MSC Circular 19, "Establishment of the Mercury Scientific Experiments Panel," Apr. 18, 1962;
MSC gen. mgt. inst. 2-3-1, "Manned Spacecraft Center In-Flight Scientific Experiments Coordi-
nation Panel," Oct. 15, 1962; MSC tech. mgt. inst. 37-1-1, "In-Flight Experimental Programs,'"
July I8, 1963; William O. Armstrong, interview with James M. Grimwood and Ivan D. Ertel, Jan.
24, 1967, transcript in JSC History Office files.
24. Fryklund to SD/Deputy Director, "Memo from J. M. Eggleston About a Facility at MSC to House
the Space Environment Division," July 24, 1963; Newell to MlAssoc. Adm., "Facility at Manned
Spacecraft Center for the Space Environment Division," July 31, 1963.
25. Newell to Gilruth, "Manned Space Science Division Supporting Research and Technology Tasks,"
Nov. 21, 1963; Fryklund, "'Discussions at Manned Spacecraft Center on September 19, 1963,"
memo for record, Sept. 27, 1963; Fryklund to Dr. Robert Voas, Oct. 11, 1963; Paul R. Brockman
to SM/Acting Director, "Manned Space Science Project Management," Nov. 8, 1963; Brockman
to SP/Gutheim, "Weekly report," Nov. 22, 1962; Willis B. Foster to Assoc. Adm. for MSF, "Apollo
Scientific Guidelines," Dec. 19, 1963; Brockman to Gutheim, "Weekly Report," Dec. 6, 1963.
26. Foster to Richard Mize, "Weekly Report for Week of December 16," Dec. 20, 1963.
27. Foster to Mize, "Weekly Activities Report," Jan. 10, 1964; "Minutes: Manned Space Science Work-
ing Group of the Space Sciences Steering Committee," Jan. 30, 1964; Foster to SSIDir. of Sciences,
"Weekly Activities Report," Feb. 12, 1964.
28. Fryklund to Members, Manned Space Science Working Group, Space Science Steering Commit-
tee, "First Group of Suggested Apollo Investigations and Investigators," Feb. 3, 1964; Fryklund
to chmn., Space Sciences Steering Committee, "Preliminary definition of Apollo investigations,"
Feb. 13, 1964.
29. Fryklund to John M. Eggleston, "Integrated Apollo Science Program," Mar. 25, 1964; Fryklund
to Assoc. Aclm., SSA, "Integration of Apollo Science Program," Mar. 26, 1964; "Minutes, Manned
Space Science Working Group of the Space Sciences Steering Committee, 26 March 1984," Apr.
9, 1964.
30. E. L. Durst to Chief, Flight Operations Div., "Project Apollo, Operational Ground Rules for the
Lunar Landing Mission," Oct. 23, 1963; MSC, "The Development of an Apollo Lunar Landing
Mission Reference Trajectory," Internal Note 64-OM-12, May 1964.
31. MSC, "Contributions of MSC Personnel to the Manned Lunar Exploration Symposium, June 15
and 16, 1964," no date; D. A. Beattie, E. M. Davin, and P. D. Lowman to Dir., Manned Space
Science Div. and Chief, Lunar and Planetary Science Branch, "Supplemental Recommendations
and Comments on 'Apollo Scientific Investigations,'" July 6, 1964; Fryklund to Dir., MSC, "Action
Items and Positive Results from the Apollo Science Meeting," July 6, 1964.
32. Davin to multiple addressees, "Request for comments on the attached lunar surface science pro-
grams definition document for the approved Apollo missions, no date [Dec. 1964].
33. OSSA, "Apollo Lunar Science Program: Report of Planning Teams," part I, Summary (Dec. 1964),
pp. 4-9.
34. Ibid., part II, Appendix.
35. Eggleston to Staff, "Establishment of interim coordinators for scientific equipment," Jan. 14, 1965.
36. Foster to multiple addressees, "Report of Program Plans and Status," Feb. 1, 1965.
37. Foster to Assoc. Adm., MSF, "Matters to discuss with Joe Shea in regard to science experiments,"
Apr. 1, 1965.
38. Maxime A. Faget to Foster, "Grants or contracts to potential principal investigators for lunar sur-
face experiments," May 11, 1965, with encl., "Chronology [of background information]."
39. Richard J. Allenby to Mueller and NeweU, "Minutes of Newell-Mueller Meeting of 23 February
1965," Apr. 19, 1965, with end., "Memorandum of Agreement between Office of Manned Space
Flight [and] Office of Space Science and Applications, Scientific Interfaces."
40. B. A. Linn to the record, "MSF Procurement Plan for Lunar Surface Experiments Package,'" June
3, 1965; Mueller to MSC, attn. Dave Lang, "Request for Approval of Procurement Plan for Lunar
Surface Experiments Package," June 7, 1965.
276
Source Notes
41. NASA release 65-260, "Three Firms Selected to Design Apollo Lunar Surface Package," Aug.
4, 1965.
42. National Academy of Sciences-National Research Council, Space Research: Directions for the Future,
report of a study by the Space Science Board, Woods Hole, Mass., 1965, NAS-NRC Publication
1402 (Washington, 1966), p. iii.
43. Ibid.
44. Ibid., pp. 623-26.
45. Ibid., pp. 628-29.
46. Ibid., pp. 5-34.
47. Ibid., pp. 486-93.
48. Ibid., p. 21.
49. NASA 1965 Summer Conference on Lunar Exploration and Science, Falmouth, Massachusetts, July 19-3I,
1965, NASA SP-88 (Washington, 1965), pp. 1, 7-19.
50. Ibid., pp. 59-393, 407-17.
51. Neal J. Smith to Allenby, 11 Aug. 1965.
52. NASA 1965 Summer Conference, pp. 7-12, 16-19.
53. Shoemaker interview.
54. Harold C. Urey to Newell, June 19, 1961.
55. Shoemaker, "Exploration of the Moon's Surface," American Scientist 50 (1962): 121.
56. Ted H. Skopinski to Chief, Systems Integration Div., "Selection of Lunar Landing Site for the
Early Apollo Lunar Missions," Mar. 21, 1962.
57. Bruce K. Byers, Destination Moon: A History of the Lunar Orh'ter Program, NASA TM X-3487 (Washing-
ton, 1977), pp. 9-15.
58. Ibid., pp. 19-47, 67-69, 75-78, 227.
59. Gilruth to Mueller, Aug. 5, 1965.
60. T. H. Thompson to G. E. Mueller and Gen. S. C. Phillips, Dec. 23, 1964.
61. Mueller to multiple addressees, "Establishment of Apollo Site Selection Board," July 1, 1965.
CHAPTER 4
277
Where No Man Has Gone Before
12. Hess to Newell, with encl., "Report ofAd Hoc Committee on Lunar Sample Handling Facility,"
Feb. 2, 1965.
13. Ibid.
14. McLane to Chief, Facilities Div., "FY 67 C of F Program," with end., "Lunar Sample Receiving
Laboratory Project Description and Project Justification," Jan. 20, 1965.
15. Foster to Faget, "Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory," Feb. 24, 1965.
16. Faget to Foster, "MSC Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory,'" Mar. 22, 1965.
17. Q. G. Robb to Chief, Test Facilities Branch, "Background Material on the Lunar Sample Facil-
ity," Apr. 6, 1965.
18. Hess to NeweU, Feb. 2, 1965.
19. See the testimony of Dr. Colin S. Pittendrigh in Senate Committee on Aeronautical and Space
Sciences, Scientists" Testimony on Space Goals, 88/1, June 10-11, 1963, pp. 73-80. Pittendrigh cited
the same estimate of the probability of life in the universe as that given by Su-Shu Huang ("Occur-
rence of Life in the Universe," American Scientist 47 (1959): 397-403), who estimated that one bil-
lion billion (10 TM) planets in the observable universe might be sites for the evolution of life. See
also the report of the biology working group in A Review of Space Research, pp. 9-1 to 9-4, 9-6.
For a discussion of the arguments concerning life in the solar system, see Edward Clinton Ezell
and IAnda Neumann Ezell, On Mars: Exploration of the Red Planet, 1958-1978, NASA SP-4212
(Washington, 1984), pp. 51-66; see also their bibliography, p. 482, and survey of preliminary results
of the life-detecting experiments on the Viking Ianding missions, pp. 400-414.
20. Minutes, meeting of the Exobiology Committee of the Space Science Board, Feb. 20, 1960, cited
in Space Science Board, "Conference on Potential Hazards of Back Contamination from the Planets,
July 29-30, 1964" (advance copy), no date [Aug. 1964].
21. A Review of Space Research, p. 9-13.
22. Homer E. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere: Early Years of Space Science, NASA SP-4211 (Washing-
ton, 1980), pp. 274-75.
23. Ibid.
24. Space Science Board, "Conference on Potential Hazards of Back Contamination.'"
25. Eggleston to multiple addressees, "Sterilization precautions and quarantine of astronauts and
equipment following Apollo missions," Feb. 5, 1965.
26. Orr E. Reynolds to Assoc. Adm. for Space Science and Applications, "Responsibility for Space
Quarantine," July 2, 1965.
27. Eggleston to multiple addressees, "Sterilization precautions .... " Feb. 5, 1965; Eggleston to mul-
tiple addressees, "Recommendations on NASA Position on Sterilization and Quarantine of Apollo
Astronauts and Equipment," Feb. 19, 1965.
28. Reynolds to Assoc. Adm. for SSA, "Status of the Public Health Service-National Aeronautics
and Space Administration negotiations on back contamination," May 10, 1965.
29. W. E. Stoney, Jr., to Chief, Engineering Div., "Support Information for FY 67 C of F Project--
Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory "' July 30, 1965; Hall to Ed Chao, "Engineering Study and
Preliminary Engineering Report for Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory," July 1, 1965.
30. Reynolds to the record, "Surmnary of meeting between representatives of the National Aeronautics
and Space Administration and the Public Health Service, July 31, 1%5," Aug. 17, 1965.
31. W. W. Kemmerer, Jr., and E. A. King, Jr., to Faget, "Proposed MSC Quarantine Policy for the
Apollo Program," with end., "Proposed Quarantine Policy for Apollo Program," Sept. 25, 1965.
32. Elbert A. King, Jr., interview with Loyd S. Swenson, May 27, 1971, tape in JSC History Office
files; Kemmerer and King to the record, "Summary of a meeting between representatives of the
National Aeronautics and Space Administration, Public Health Service and the Department of
Agriculture, MSC, Houston, Texas, September 27, 1965," Sept. 30, 1965.
33. Lawrence B. Hall to Deputy Adm., "Informal Conference on Back Contamination Problems,'"
Oct. 15, 1965.
34. Owen E. Maynard to PS Branches, "Earth contamination from lunar surface organisms," Oct.
29, 1965.
35. King interview.
36. Hugh L. Dryden to William H. Stewart, Nov. 15, 1966.
37. Stewart to Webb, Dec. 22, 1966.
38. Deputy Dir., Space Medicine (OMSF), TWX to McLane, Nov. 22, 1965; McLane to A. C. Bond,
"Hqs. Request for Quarantine Fac[ility]. Study," Nov. 22, 1965.
278
Source Notes
39. Faget to Col. Jack BoUerud, "Study of Existing Personnel Quarantine Facilities," with end., "Apollo
Personnel Quarantine Facilities Review," Dec. 8, 1965.
40. W. David Compton and Charles D. Benson, Living and Working in Space: A History of Skylab, NASA
SP-4208 (Washington, 1983), pp. 40, 99-100.
41. House Committee on Science and Astronautics, 1967 NASA Authorization, Hearings on H.R. 12718,
8912, pt. 1, Mar. 10, 1966, p. 6.
42. Ibid., p. 36.
43. Idem, 1967 NASA Authorization, Hearings before the Subcommittee on Manned Space Flight on
H. R. 12718, 89/2, pt. 2, Mar. 1, 1966, p. 465.
44. Ibid., pp. 417-21.
45. Ibid., p. 476.
46. Ibid., pp. 477-79.
47. Arthur Hill, "Lab Delay May Slow Mission To the Moon," Houston Chronicle, Mar. 10, 1966.
48. Robert F. Freitag to George M. Low, Mar. 14, 1966.
49. MSC, "Site Investigation Study, Lunar Receiving Laboratory," draft report, Mar. 24, 1966, unpagi-
nated. The final version was distributed on Apr. 7.
50. Ibid.
51. Paul E. Purser to Gilruth and Low, Mar. 29, 1966; Purser to Freitag, "Supplementary Informa-
tion on the Lunar Receiving Laboratory," Mar. 30, 1966.
52. House, 1967 NASA Authorization, pt. 2, Mar. 31, 1966, pp. 1207-59.
53. Charles Culhane, "Panel for Restoring Funds for Moon Lab," Houston Post, Apr. 1, 1966.
54. House Committee on Science and Astronautics, Authorizing Appropriations to the National Aeronautics
and Space Administration, House Rept. 1441, 89/2, Apr. 20, 1966, pp. 121-24.
55. "$4.9-Billion Is Voted For NASA By House," New York Times, May 5, 1966.
56. House Committee on Appropriations, Independent Offices Appropriation Bill, 1967, House Rept. 1477,
89/2, May 5, 1966, pp. 13-14.
57. Senate Committee on Aeronautical and Space Sciences, NASA Authorization for Fiscal Year 1967,
Senate Rept. 1184, 89/2, May 23, 1966, pp. 81-83.
58. NASA Off. of Legislative Affairs,, "Legislative Activity Report," vol. V., no. 141, Aug. 24, 1966.
59. Jane Van Nimmen and Leonard C. Bruno, with Robert L. Rosholt, NASA Historical Data Book,
1958-1968, vol. h NASA Resources, NASA SP-4012 (Washington, 1976), p. 117.
60. Leo T. Zbanek to Chief, Facilities Div., "Lunar Sample Handling Facility," Mar. 5, 1965; Faget
to Foster, "'MSC Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory," Mar. 22, 1965; OSSA Ad Hoc Committee
on the Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory, "Concepts, Functional Requirements, Specifications
and Recommended Plan of Operation for the Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory," Mar. 15, 1965;
McLane to J. G. Griffith, "Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory," Apr. 8, 1965; Gilruth to Chief,
Engineering Div., "Formation of a Technical Working Committee for the Design of a Lunar Sam-
ple Receiving Laboratory and Designation as Consultants to Assist in the Selection of an Architect-
Engineer Firm," June 14, 1965; Foster to Faget, "Membership of the Headquarters Advisory Com-
mittee on Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory," July 14, 1965; Foster to Dir., Facilities Program-
ming and Construction, "Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory," Aug. 19, 1965; Foster to George
M. Low, "Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory," Aug. 25, 1965; OSSA Standing Committee on
LSRL, "Review of the Preliminary Engineering Report (PER) of the Lunar Sample Receiving Labora-
tory (LSRL)," Nov. 10, 1965; Low to Foster through Dr. George E. Mueller, "Manned Space Science
Standing Committee for the Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory," Dec. 9, 1965.
61. House, 1967 NASA Authorization, pt. 2, Mar. 1, 1966, p. 472.
62. Dave W. Lang to George J. Vecchietfi, "Schedule of Procurement Actions--Lunar Receiving Labora-
tory," Apr. 30, 1966.
63. MSC Announcement 66-57, "Establishment of a Lunar Receiving Laboratory Policy Board and
a Lunar Receiving Laboratory Program Office," May 9,1966
64. D. D. Wyatt, "Lunar Receiving Facility, memo for record, Manned Spacecraft Center,'" June 14,
1965.
65. Mueller to MSC, TWX, subj.: "Lunar Receiving Laboratory," July 28, 1966.
66. NASA Releases 66-200, Aug. 1, 1966, and 66-222, Aug. 19, 1966.
67. Space Science Board, "Report of Ad Hoc Committee on Lunar Sample Handling Facility," Feb.
2, 1965.
68. King interview.
279
Where No Man Has Gone Before
69. OSSA Ad Hoc Committee on the Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory, "'Concepts... for the
Lunar Sample Receiving Laboratory," Mar. 15, 1965, p. 80.
70. McLane to Mgr., Systems Tests and Evaluation, "Staffing for the Lunar Sample Receiving Labora-
tory," Sept. 2, 1965.
71. Urner Liddell to Chmn., Space Science Steering Committee, "Recommendations of Planetology
Subcommittee, Meeting 3-66, February 23-25, 1966,'" no date.
72. "Summary Minutes, Lunar Receiving Laboratory Working Group of the Planetology Subcom-
mittee, Space Sciences Steering Committee (Meeting No. 1-66)/' May 5, 1966.
73. McLane to Dir., Engineering and Development, "Estimate of scientist staffing requirements for
the Lunar Receiving Laboratory," May 25, 1966.
74. House Committee on Science and Astronautics, 1968 NASA Authorization, hearings before the
Subcommittee on Manned Space Flight, 90/1, pt. 2, p. 599.
75. "Summary Minutes, Lunar Receiving Laboratory Working Group of the Planetology Subcom-
mittee, Space Sciences Steering Committee (Meeting No. 1-67)," July 11, 1966.
76. Joseph R. Crump to Purser, with encl., "Concerning a Contract for Lunar Receiving Laboratory,"
July 27, 1966.
77. Draft memo, Gilruth to Mueller, "Procurement Plan for Operational Support Services Contract
for the Manned Spacecraft Center Lunar Receiving Laboratory," with encl., procurement pIan,
no date [c. Sept. 5, 1966].
78. Gilruth to Lt. Gen. Frank A. Bogart, Oct. 12, 1966.
79. J. E. Riley to Mr. Cariski, "MSC Procurement Plan for Operational Support of Lunar Receiving
Laboratory," Oct. 18, 1966; Bogart to Mr. Webb, "Meeting with Dr. Seitz on the Lunar Receiv-
ing Laboratory," Nov. 7,1966; Purser, "'Lunar Receiving Laboratory Operations Planning,'" memo
for the record, Nov. 7, 1966; Robert O. Piland to Deputy Dir., "Lunar Receiving Laboratory,"
Nov. 8, 1966; Wesley L. Hjornevik, TWX to Bogart, Dec. 15, 1966; Francis B. Smith to Webb and
Seamans, "December 1966 meeting to discuss plans for the Lunar Receiving Laboratory," Dec.
19, 1966.
80. Smith to Webb and Seamans, "December 1966 meeting .... "' Dec. 19, 1966.
81. Willis M. Shapley to Mueller and Newell, "Lunar Receiving Laboratory,'" Dec. 21, 1966.
82. "Summary Minutes, Lunar Receiving Laboratory Working Group of the Planetology Subcom-
mittee, Space ,Science Steering Committee (Meeting No. 2-67)/' Sept. 26-27, 1966; Lunar Receiving
Laboratory Working Group to Newell through Planetology Subcommittee, Sept. 29, 1966; Bogart
to Low, Sept. 22, 1966; "Minutes, Interagency Committee on Back Contamination," Oct. 3, 1966;
David J. Sencer to Seamans, Nov. 14, 1966; G. Briggs Phillips to Bogart, with end., "Status Report
on the Lunar Receiving Laboratory," Dec. 13, 1966; Melvin Calvin to Newell, Dec. 29, 1966; Richard
J. Allenby to Assoc. Adm. for Space Science and Applications, "Lunar Receiving Laboratory Prob-
lems," Dec. 29, 1966.
83. Hjornevik to Bogart, TWX, Dec. 15, 1966; MSC Announcement 67-7, "Organization and Person-
nel Assignments for the Science and Applications Directorate," Jan. 10, 1967.
84. Low to Bogart, Jan. 13, 1967, with encls.: Gilruth to Chief, Procurement and Contracts Div., "Justifi-
cation (under NPC 401) for nonpersonal service contract for operation of the Manned Spacecraft
Center Lunar Receiving Laboratory," Jan. 13, 1967; Piland to Chief, Procurement and Contracts
Div., "Justification for noncompetitive procurement for operational support of the Lunar Receiv-
ing Laboratory," Jan. 13, 1967.
CHAPTER 5
1. MSC's philosophy of astronaut selection and training was well summarized in a memo by
Christopher C. Kraft, Jr., of MSC's Flight Operations Division in late 1962. Commenting on an
article in a national magazine, wherein it was speculated that future astronauts might be com-
puter experts rather than test pilots, Kraft wrote, "It is our feeling that you must use people who
are adapted to taking action should emergencies develop and who are well trained in this cate-
gory. We feel that you can then take this type of individual.., and give him the necessary training
28O
Source Notes
in the other fields such as navigation and guidance, geology, etc. The primary need is for spacecraft
control, at least in the programs presently planned (Gemini and Apollo), and these people can be trained
to accomplish the explorations presently envisioned [emphasis added]. When you get to the point of
conducting experiments in space, such as you would do in the Space Station .... we would prob-
ably use engineers and scientists who were experts in a given field. However, the people respon-
sible for control of the vehicle ferrying these types of experts to and from the Space Station, and
the people on board the Space Station responsible for emergency action will probably still be
in the same category as test pilots." C. C. Kraft, Jr., to A. M. Chop, "Article on Astronaut Selec-
tion in November 7 issue of Time Magazine," Nov. 8, 1962. This basic philosophy has been fol-
lowed for 20 years, right down to the operational flights of the Shuttle orbiter.
2. Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., James M. Grimwood, and Charles C. Alexander, This New Ocean: A His-
tory of Project Mercury, NASA SP-4201 (Washington, 1966), p. 174.
3. Ibid., pp. 131, 160-63.
4. Ibid., p. 174.
5. Ibid., p. 235; John H. Glenn, Jr., interview with Robert B. Merrifield, Mar. 15, 1968, transcript
in JSC History Office files. For a colorful account of the beginning of the manned space flight
program, including the choice of test pilots as the Original Seven astronauts and their experiences
through the Mercury program, see Tom Wolfe, The Right Stuff (New York: Farrar, Straus and
Giroux, 1979). Wolfe's literary style is objectionable to many, but his treatment of Mercury is
(to the present author's knowledge) well researched and is considered by many Mercury par-
ticipants to accurately convey the spirit of the early days of manned space flight.
6. Swenson, Grimwood, and Alexander, This New Ocean, pp. 235-37.
7. National Academy of Sciences-National Research Council, A Review of Space Research, report of
the summer study conducted under the auspices of the Space Science Board, NAS-NRC Publi-
cation 1079 (Washington, 1962), p. 1-22.
8. Ibid., pp. 11-1 to 11-16.
9. Ibid., pp. 11-8 to 11-12.
10. Ibid., pp. 11-17 to 11-19.
11. Swenson, Grimwood, and Alexander, This New Ocean, pp. 440-42.
12. Ibid., pp. 177, 442.
13. Donald K. Slayton interview, Oct. 15, 1984. Slayton's comments on this case: "There were two
situations where we had a strong input from Headquarters. One was on Apollo 13, where for
some reason George Mueller didn't like the crew I had assigned to fly 13 and insisted on turning
them around .... We wound up switching the 13 and 14 crews around .... The other
thing .... on 13, Mattingly had that medical problem [exposure to rubella] .... "Alan Shepard
was commander of the crew that flew Apollo 14, so the original assignment would have given
him command of Apollo 13. At the time those two crews were publicly named (August 1969)
Shepard had been back on flight duty less than six months after spending almost five years off
the active list for medical reasons.
14. Slayton interview by Robert B. Merrifield, Oct. 17, 1967, transcript in JSC History Office files;
MSC Space News Roundup, Sept. 19, 1962; MSC Announcements 190, Apr. 29, 1963, and 268, Nov.
5, 1963.
15. Alan L. Bean interview, Apr. 10, 1984.
16. Barton C. Hacker and James M. Grimwood, On the Shoulders of Titans: A History of Project Gemini,
NASA SP-4203 (Washington, 1977), pp. 49-73.
17. House Committee on Science and Technology, Astronauts and Cosmonauts: Biographical and Statistical
Data [Revised May 31, 1978], report prepared by the Congressional Research Service, Library of
Congress, July 1978, pp. 6-7; idem, Astronautical and Aeronautical Events of 1962, report prepared
by the NASA Historical Staff, June 12, 1963, p. 56.
18. Astronautical and Aeronautical Events of 1962, pp. 146, 191.
19. SIayton interview, Oct. 17, 1967.
20. Ibid.; MSC, "Flight Crew Training Report No. 1," Oct. 20, 1962.
21. MSC, "Flight Crew Training Reports," nos. 1-16, Oct. 15, 1962, to Feb. 9, 1963; no. 16 includes
a summary of topics covered in the basic science course.
22. MSC, "Apollo Spacecraft Project Status Report No. I for Period Ending September 31, 1962/' p. 48.
23. NASA, Astronautics and Aeronautics, Chronology on Science, Technology, and Policy, 1963, NASA
SP-4004, (Washington, 1964) p. 197.
281
Where No Man Has Gone Before
24. MSC Release 63-102, June 18, 1963; Slayton interview, Oct. 17, 1967; Astronauts and Cosmonauts,
p. 7.
25. House Subcommittee on Manned Space Flight of the Committee on Science and Astronautics,
1964 NASA Authorization, hearings on H.R. 5466, 88/1, pt. 2(a), p. 235, Mar. 7, 1963.
26. Astronautics and Aeronautics, 1963, pp. 322, 392.
27. Astronauts and Cosmonauts, p. 7.
28. Astronautics and Aeronautics, 1963, p. 495.
29. Hacker and Grimwood, On the Shoulders of Titans, p. 191.
30. MSC, Flight Crew Training Reports nos. 66-83, Feb. 3-June 1, 1964.
31. Elbert A. King, Jr., interview by Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., May 27, 1971, tape in JSC History Office files.
32. Ibid.; interviews, Alan L. Bean, Apr. 10, 1984, and Eugene A. Cernan, Apr. 6, 1984; Michael
Collins, Carrying the Fire: An Astronaut's Journeys (New York: Farrar, Straus and Giroux, 1974),
pp. 72-75.
33. Hacker and Grimwood, On the Shoulders of Titans, pp. 194-200.
34. Ibid., 219.
35. Ibid., 220-24; Donald K. Slayton, Warren J. North, and C. H. Woodling, "Flight Crew Proce-
dures and Training," in Gemini Midprogram Conference Including Experimental Results, NASA SP-121
(Washington, 1966) , pp. 201-11.
36. Hacker and Grimwood, On the Shoulders of Titans, pp. 239-40.
37. Ibid., 255.
38. All the astronauts this author has interviewed have stated that they never understood exactly
what determined their first assignment to a crew; see author's interviews with Alan L. Bean,
Harrison H. Schmitt, Eugene A. Cernan, and Joseph P. Kerwin, Jr., transcripts in JSC History
Office files; with Paul J. Weitz, transcript in Skylab files, Fondren Library, Rice Univ.; also Col-
lins, Carrying the Fire, p. 141, and Slayton interview, Oct. 15, 1984. A special scientific committee
convened at OSSA's request by Rice University to recommend ways to provide more opportuni-
ties for scientific training of astronauts noted that criteria for crew selection were a mystery to
the astronauts; see n. 61, below.
39. See W. David Compton and Charles D. Benson, Living and Working in Space: A History of Skylab,
NASA SP-4208 (Washington, 1983) pp. 12-14, 19-20; also House, Subcommittee on Manned Space
Flight of the Committee on Science and Astronautics, I965 NASA Authorization, hearings on H.R.
9641, 88/2, pt. 2, pp. 446-48, 587-609, and Arnold S. Levine, Managing NASA in the Apollo Era,
NASA SP-4102 (Washington, 1982), pp. 239-47.
40. Homer E. Newell to W. N. Hess, Apr. 16, 1964.
41. "NASA to Select Scientist-Astronauts for Future Missions," NASA Release 64-248, Oct. 19, 1964.
42. Homer E. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere: Early Years of Space Science, NASA SP-4211 (Washing-
ton, 1980), p. 209.
43. Slayton interview, Oct. 15, 1984.
44. Eugene M. Shoemaker interview, Mar. 17, 1984. According to Jack Schmitt, who worked with
Shoemaker before and after he was selected as an astronaut, the committee set the standards
too high. He recalled telling Shoemaker that they should have picked more scientists, "because
we need[ed] more visibility down here." Shoemaker argued that the Academy did not want to
risk choosing people who would not work out as astronauts, so the committee applied very strict
standards. H. H. Schmitt interview, July 6, 1984.
45. MSC News Release 65-63, June 29, 1965.
46. "NASA Picks 6 Scientist-Astronauts To Make Field Trips to the Moon, Washington Post, June
27, 1965.
47. Associated Press, "Dr. Graveline Quits Project as Astronaut," Chicago Tribune, Aug. 19, 1965.
Graveline's wife sued him for divorce shortly after he was selected. While no documentation
has been found to confirm it, the general impression among the astronauts was that divorce was
considered incompatible with the established image of the astronaut, apart from the fact that
involvement in a divorce case might create psychological problems that would impair the trainee's
(or pilot's) efficiency.
48. Compton and Benson, Living and Working in Space, pp. 40-56, 83-86.
49. George E. Mueller to Robert R. Gilruth, Jan. 25, 1964.
50. "NASA To Select Additional Pilot-Astronauts," NASA Release 65-288, Sept. 10, 1965; "U.S.
Seeking Astronauts for Apollo," Baltimore Sun, Sept. 11, 1965.
282
Source Notes
51. "Nineteen Pilots Join United States Astronaut Team," NASA Release 66-77, Apr. 4, 1966; "19
Chosen as Spacemen, Some for Moon Missions," Washington Post, Apr. 5, 1966.
52. "Scientists Invited to Become Astronauts, Do Research in Space," NASA Release 66-255, Sept.
26, 1966.
53. Russell L. Schweickart, interview with Peter Vorzimmer, May 1, 1967, transcript in JSC History
Office files.
54. NASA 1965 Summer Conference on Lunar Exploration and Science, NASA SP-88 (Washington, 1965),
pp. 407-17.
55. Alan B. Shepard, Jr., to multiple addressees, "Astronaut Technical Assignments,'" Jan. 6, 1967.
56. Harrison H. Schmitt interview, May 30, 1984.
57. Slayton interview, Oct. 15, 1984.
58. Ibid.; Bean interview.
59. Joseph P. Kerwin, Jr., interview, Mar. 29, 1985.
60. Bean interview; Cernan interview.
61. "Space Science Training for Astronauts Involved in NASA Manned Space Flight Missions," report
under contract NSR 44-006-031, Nov. 1965, p. 4.
62. Ibid., pp. 2-4.
63. Cernan interview.
64. Gilruth to Dr. A. J. DessIer, Dec. 22, 1965.
65. Slayton interview, Oct. 15, 1984. When the debate over sending a scientist to the moon intensi-
fied in 1969, several wire-service stories quoted Slayton to this effect; see Paul Recer (Associated
Press), "They Feud Over Moon Flights," Miami Herald, Oct. 12, 1969. Gilruth's position was
expressed in a letter to George Mueller, Sept. 2, 1969, responding to Mueller's concern that the
science community was growing restive because no scientist-astronauts were assigned to Apollo
missions.
CHAPTER 6
283
Where No Man Has Gone Before
mean that a lunar module could sink out of sight. The pictures returned by Ranger 7 (July 1964)
gave Gold no reason to change his thinking; see R. Cargill Hall, Lunar Impact: A History of Project
Ranger, NASA SP-4210 (Washington, 1977), p. 285; also Gold, "Ranger Moon Pictures; Implica-
tions," Science 145 (1964):1046-48. Most Ranger scientists agreed that the TV pictures from Ranger
7 gave no basis for drawing conclusions about the load-bearing characteristics of the surface. They
did give some useful information about the distribution and size of craters and the slopes of lunar
terrain on a smaller scale than had been possible. Gold remarked after the conclusion of Ranger
that its pictures were like mirrors: "everyone sees his own theories reflected in them." Hall, Lunar
Impact, p. 309. For a bibliography of studies on the lunar surface up to the first successful Ranger
mission, see J.W. Salisbury, ed., Bibliography of Lunar and Planetary Research -- 1960-I964,
AFCRL-66-52, U.S. Air Force Office of Aerospace Research, Cambridge Research Laboratories,
Jan. 1966.
11. Hall, Lunar Impact, pp. 156-82.
12. Courtney G. Brooks, James M. Grimwood, and Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., Chariots for Apollo: A His-
tory of Manned Lunar Spacecraft, NASA SP-4205 (Washington, 1979), pp. 150-54.
13. National Academy of Sciences-National Research Council, A Review of Space Research, report of
the summer study conducted under the auspices of the Space Science Board at the State Univer-
sity of Iowa, June 17-Aug. 10, 1962, NAS-NRC Publication 1079 (Washington, 1962); idem, Space
Research: Directions for the Future, report of a study by the Space Science Board, Woods Hole,
Mass., 1965, NAS-NRC Publication 1402 (Washington, 1966).
14. NASA 1965 Summer Conference on Lunar Exploration and Science, Falmouth, Massachusetts, July 19-31,
1965, NASA SP-88 (Washington, 1965), passim.
15. House, Subcommittee on Manned Space Flight of the Committee on Science and Astronautics,
1966 NASA Authorization, hearings on H.R. 3730, 89/1, pt. 2, pp. 278-85.
16. John M. Eggleston to Dr. W.A. Lee, "Target Selection for Future Ranger Flights," Feb. 4, 1965.
17. C.J. Byrne, "Ranger VII Photo Analysis--Preliminary Measurements of Apollo Landing Hazards,"
Bellcomm, Inc., Tech. Memo. TM-65-1012-2, Mar. 17, 1965.
18. Newel] to multiple addressees, "Establishment of Ad Hoc Surveyor/Orbiter Utilization Commit-
tee," June 22, 1965.
19. George E. Mueller to multiple addressees, "Establishment of Apollo Site Selection Board," Manage-
ment Instruction (NMI) 1152.20, Aug. 6, 1965.
20. John P. Mayer to Chief, Mission Planning and Analysis Div., MSC, "Lunar landing site selec-
tion," Oct. 6, 1964; Robert R. Gilruth to Mueller, "Establishment of Apollo Site Selection Board,"
July 29, 1965; Gilruth to Newell, "Members of Ad Hoc Surveyor/Orbiter Utilization Committee,"
July 29, 1965.
21. OSSA, "Ad Hoc Surveyor/Orbiter Utilization Committee, Minutes First Meeting, Washington,
D.C., August 20, 1965," Sept. 16, 1965; I.M. Ross (Bellcomm, Inc.) to Maj. Gen. S.C. Phillips,
"'MSF Position for SurveyorlOrbiter Utilization Committee Meeting August 20, 1965," Aug. 20,
1965. For a more detailed description of Lunar Orbiter mission planning, especially in support
of Apollo, see Bruce K. Byers, Destination Moon: A History of the Lunar Orln'ter Program, NASA
TM X-3487 (Washington, 1977), pp. 177-99, 248-53, 261; Orbiter's contributions to Apollo site
selection are summarized on pp. 308-14. No useful single source for Surveyor mission planning
and its relation to Apollo is available; the project's results (almost entirely scientific) are summa-
rized in Surveyor Program Results, NASA SP-184 (Washington, 1969).
22. Willis E. Foster, "Draft Minutes of Second Meeting of Ad Hoc Surveyor/Orbiter Utilization Com-
mittee," Oct. 1, 1965, with encl., ltr., R.J. Parks to Benjamin Milwitzky, subj.: Surveyor Mission
A Landing Site Selection, Sept. 28, 1965.
23. Albert Sehlstedt, Jr., "Surveyor Makes Soft Landing On Moon," Baltimore Sun, June 2, 1966.
24. William Hines, "Man Could Explore the Moon on Foot," Washington Evening Star, June 17, 1966;
Evert Clark, "Surveyor Found 'Gritty" Moon That Can Support a Spacecraft," New York Times,
June 17, 1966.
25. Byers, Destination Moon, pp. 228-45.
26. Lunar Orbiter Photo Data Screening Group, "Preliminary Terrain Evaluation and Apollo Land-
ing Site Analysis Based on Lunar Orbiter I Photography," Langley Working Paper LWP-323, Nov.
1966.
27. Foster, "Minutes of the Surveyor/Orbiter Utilization Committee, Washington, D.C., September
29, 1966"; Byers, Destination Moon, p. 251.
284
SourceNotes
28. Byers, Destination Moon, p. 258. See L.J. Kosofsky and Farouk E1-Baz, The Moon as Viewed by Lunar
Orbiter, NASA SP-200 (Washington, 1970), for an annotated collection of many of the best photo-
graphs from the Lunar Orbiter missions, along with brief descriptions of the spacecraft and its
systems and a complete listing of the sites photographed on each of the five missions. The detail
in these photographs, even in halftone reproduction, must be seen to be believed. Much of the
geologic interpretation of the moon has been accomplished using Lunar Orbiter photographs and
the information they contain is far from exhausted, according to Eugene Shoemaker (interview,
Mar. 17, 1984).
29. Foster, "Minutes of the Surveyor/Orbiter Utilization Committee, Washington, D.C., January 5,
1967."
30. S.C. Phillips to multiple addressees, "Minutes of the Apollo Site Selection Board Meeting, Decem-
ber 15, 1966," Mar. 3, 1967.
31. John M. Eggleston to Dir., MSC, "Utilization of Orbiter and Surveyor in Support of Apollo and
Apollo Applications Program Objectives," Jan. 18, 1967; Byers, Destination Moon, pp. 312-26,
329-30.
32. MSC, "Project Apollo Lunar Excursion Module Development Statement of Work," July 24, 1962,
pp. 2, A-107-109.
33. MSC, "Project Apollo Quarterly Status Report No. 3 for Period Ending March 31, 1963," p. 30.
34. MSC, "Project Apollo Quarterly Status Report No. 6 for Period Ending December 31, 1963," p. 34;
contract NAS9-2115, "Survey of Lunar Surface Measurements, Experiments, and Geologic
Studies," Sept. 30, 1963.
35. John M. Eggleston to Wayne Young (JSC), letter with comments on draft of Apollo explorations
history, Sept. 12, 1984.
36. MSC, "Project Apollo Quarterly Status Report No. 8 for Period Ending June 30, 1964," p. 47.
37. Mueller to MSC, "Request for Approval of Procurement Plan for Lunar Surface Experiments Pack-
age,'" June 7, 1965.
38. "Three Firms Selected to Design Apollo Lunar Surface Package," Hqs. Release 65-260, Aug. 4, 1965.
39. MSC, "Lunar Surface Experiments Package Request for Proposal," May 27, 1965, pp. b-1 to b-29.
40. S.C. Phillips to multiple addressees, Apollo Program Directive No. 3, subj.: Management Assign-
ment for the Lunar Surface Experiments Package (LSEP) Project, M-D 8030.003, June 15, 1965.
41. NewelI to Dir., MSC, "Selection of Scientific Investigations for Early Apollo Lunar Landing Mis-
sions," Oct. 1, 1965.
42. Newell to Dir., MSC, "Selection of Apollo Lunar Science Magnetic Field Investigations," Dec.
15, 1965.
43. William J. O'Donnell to Ames Res. Ctr., MSC, and JPL, TWX, "'Moon Surface Experiments Cho-
sen for Apollo," (NASA Hqs. Release 66-17), Jan. 27, 1966.
44. Newell to Dir., MSC, "Authorization to Procure Space Science and Applications Investigations
for Apollo Lunar Missions," Feb. 14, 1966.
45. "Bendix Named to Manufacture Lunar Package," NASA Hqs. release 66-63, Mar. 17, 1966.
46. A.P. Fontaine (Bendix Corp.) to Gilruth, Feb. 18, 1966.
47. Barton C. Hacker and James M. Grimwood, On The Shoulders of Titans: A History of Project Gemini,
NASA SP-4203 (Washington, 1977), pp. 229-31; see Gemini Midprogram Conference Including
Experimental Results, NASA SP-121 (Washington, 1966), pp. 305-436, and Gemini Summary Con-
ference, NASA SP-138 (washington, 1967), pp. 221-317, for summaries of the Gemini experiments
program and its results.
48. See W. David Compton and Charles D. Benson, Living and Working in Space: A History of Skylab,
NASA SP-4208 (Washington, 1983), pp. 59-63, for pre-Apollo experience with scientific
experiments.
49. MSC Announcement 65-81, "Designation of Manager, Experiments, in E&D, and Establishment
of the Experiments Program Office," June 21, 1965.
50. Ibid.
51. Compton and Benson, Living and Working in Space, pp. 40-52.
52. Maxime A. Faget to multiple addressees, "Establishment of a Space Science Office within E&D,'"
Mar. 31, 1966.
53. Gilruth to Mueller, "Change in the basic MSC organization," Apr. 4, 1966.
54. D.M. Allison, "Summary Minutes: Planetology Subcommittee of the Space Science Steering Com-
mittee (Meeting No. 1-67), 26, 27, 28 July 1966," no date.
f . G. / 285
Where No Man Has Gone Before
55. Robert C. Seamans to Hqs. Assoc. Administrators, "Management Responsibilities for Future
Manned Flight Activities," July 26, 1966; see also Compton and Benson, Living and Working in
Space, pp. 48-52.
56. George M. Low to multiple addressees, "Pending MSC Organizational Change, Nov. 17, 1966.
57. Mueller to Gilruth, Jan. 17, 1967, with encls., MSC Organization Chart approved by Webb and
functional statement for MSC Director of Science and Applications.
58. MSC Announcement 67-27, "Director, Science and Applications Directorate," Feb. 17, 1967.
59. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 131-201.
60. Roger E. Bilstein, Stages to Saturn: A Technological History of the ApolloSaturn Launch Vehicles, NASA
SP-4206 (Washington, 1980), pp. 209-32.
61. Ibid., pp. 225-32; Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 194-96; Maj. Gen. Samuel C.
Phillips to J. Leland Atwood, NAA, Dec. 19, 1965, with encls.
62. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 183-85, 208.
63. Eugene M. Shoemaker interview, Mar. 17, 1984.
64. Charles D. Benson and William Barnaby Faherty, Moonport: A History of Apollo Launch Facilities
and Operations, NASA SP-4204 (Washington, 1978), pp. 384-87.
CHAPTER 7
1. Courtney G. Brooks, James M. Grimwood, and Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., Chariots for Apollo: A His-
tory of Manned Lunar Spacecraft, NASA SP-4205 (Washington, 1979), pp. 214-17; Charles D. Ben-
son and William Barnaby Faherty, Moonport: A History of Apollo Launch Facilities and Operations,
NASA SP-4204 (washington, 1978), pp. 390-94.
2. One author has characterized the media coverage of the early period as based on the unspoken
view (based on several widely publicized failures) that "our boys always botch it and our rockets
always blow up," and suggests that journalists uncritically emphasized the risks of manned space
flight. Tom Wolfe, The Right Stuff (New York: Farrar, Straus and Giroux, 1979). Wolfe's
conclusion--supported by the (admittedly subjective) recollections of the present author, who
watched many of the launches, from Mercury through Apollo, on television--gains credibility
after viewing a television documentary entitled "Spaceflight," broadcast on the Public Broad-
casting System in May 1985. In an interview on that program Walter Cronkite, who was a prin-
cipal figure in the Columbia Broadcasting System's coverage of manned space flight, recalled
that the history of failure in rocket tests up to 1961 heightened his perception of the danger to
the astronaut. The astronauts did not share this apprehension; their day-to-day participation in
hardware development gave them an informed estimate of the danger they faced.
3. "Entire Crew of Mission Set for Feb. 21 Is Lost; Grissom, White, Chaffee," Washington Post, Jan.
18, 1967.
4. "Is Moon TraveI Worth the Cost?" Chicago Tribune, Jan. 29, 1967; "The Space 'Success Sched-
ule,' "Philadelphia Inquirer, Jan. 30, 1967; "A Time for Deliberation," Washington Evening Star,
Feb. 1, 1967; "'Haste in Space," Wall Street Journal, Feb. 20, 1967; "The Legacy of Counterfeit
Crisis," ibid., Apr. 13, 1967; Jerry E. Bishop, "Moon Race: Can't Machines Do It?" ibid., Apr.
16, 1967.
286
Source Notes
D. Benson, Living and Working in Space; A History of Skylab, NASA SP-4208 (Washington, 1983),
p.84-91.
10. House, Investigation, pp. 10-11; J.V. Reistrup, "Webb Defends Judgment on Apollo," Washington
Post, Apr. 11, 1967. Considerable misunderstanding was generated when members of the
committees demanded to see the "Phillips Report," which both NASA officials and North American
executives professed not to recognize by that name. The members of Congress were referring
to a hard-hitting critique of NAA's management, which Gen. Sam Phillips had submitted to NAS_
and to the contractor in late 1965 (see Chap. 6), but because it took the form of notes enclosed
with a letter it was not called a "report." When the document was finally identified, however,
Webb, Mueller, and Phillips provoked charges of a cover-up by refusing to furnish it to the com-
mittees on the grounds that public disclosure could undermine NASA-contractor relations; Wil-
liam Hines, "Ryan Says NASA Knew of Apollo 'Incompetence,' "Washington Evening Star, Apr.
26, 1967; Thomas O'Toole, "NASA Accused of Covering Up Troubles," Washington Post, May
11, 1967. On this point S. Rept. 956 (see note 6, above) stresses the effect of NASA officials' behavior
on the legislators' confidence in the agency; see "Additional Views of Mr. Brooke and Mr. Percy,"
pp. 12-14, and "Additional Views of Mr. Mondale," pp. 15-16. For more extensive discussion
of the fire and its aftermath, see Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots; Benson and Faherty,
Moonport; and the records of the Senate and House committee investigations cited earlier.
As the investigations proceeded, the press raised allegations of questionable political deals that
gave North American the contract for the command and service module; see Harry Schwartz,
"'Unanswered Questions on the Apollo Tragedy," New York Times, Apr. 15, 1967; William Hines,
"Apollo: A Shining Vision in Trouble," Washington Star, May 21, 1967. These allegations were
never put in the committee records and remained unsubstantiated. Three years later, however,
they were revived in Journey to Tranquility (Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday and Co., 1970), by three
English journalists, Hugo Young, Bryan Silcock, and Peter Dunn.
11. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 225-32; Benson and Faherty, Moonport,
pp. 401-402.
12. OMSF, "Manned Space Hight Schedules, vol. I, Level 1 Schedules and Resources Summary,"
Dec. 1966; House Subcommittee on Manned Space Hight of the Committee on Science and
Astronautics, 1967 NASA Authorization, hearings on H.R. 12718, 89/2, pt. 2, pp. 72-76.
13. OMSF, "Manned Space Hight Schedules, vol. I, Level 1 Schedules and Resources Summary,"
May 1967.
14. Ibid., February 1966.
15. John T. Holloway to Dir., MSC, "Development of Experiments for the Apollo Lunar Surface Experi-
ments Package (ALSEP)," Apr. 14, 1966.
16. OMSF, "Manned Space Flight Schedules, vol. I, Level 1 Schedules and Resources Summary,"
Nov. 1966.
17. William T. O'Bryant to MSC, attn. Robert O. Pfland, "Guidelines for Possible Substitution of
Other Instruments for the Lunar Surface Magnetometer in ALSEP," Dec. 23, 1966.; D.K. Slay-
ton to Mgr., Experiments Program Off., "Possible Replacement of the Lunar Surface Magnetom-
eter on ALSEP," Dec. 22, 1966.
18. Anon., "ALSEP OSSA Review, October 3, 1966."
19. Slayton to Director, Engineering and Development, "Comments on the ALSEP Delta Prelimi-
nary Design Review," Dec. 15, 1966.
20. OMSF, "Manned Space Flight Schedules, vol. I, Level 1 Schedules and Resources Summary,"
July 1967, pp. 49, 33.
21. Leonard Reiffel to Gen. S.C. Phillips, "Flight Schedule for ALSEP and Related Matters," June
20, 1967.
22. Harrison H. Schmitt interview, May 30, 1984.
23. Phillips to Administrator, "Lunar Surface Magnetometer," June 6, 1967; Piland to Mgr., Apollo
Spacecraft Program Office, "ALSEP Program Review with General Phillips, June 1, 1967," June
7, 1967.
24. Phillips to Dep. Adm.,"Lunar Surface Magnetometer," July 5, 1967, with encl., preliminary report
of review team; Phillips to Dep. Adm., same subj., Aug. 30, 1967; John F. Parsons (Ames Res.
Ctr.) to NASA Hqs., attn. Dr. James H. Turnock, "Lunar Surface Magnetometer Program," Aug.
31, 1967.
287
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
25. OMSF, "'Manned Space Flight Schedules, vol. I, Level I Schedules and Resources Summary,"
monthly issues, Jan. 9 through Oct. 8, 1968.
26. Arnold S. Levine, Managing NASA in theApollo Era, NASA SP-4102 (Washington, 1982), pp. 239-53;
Compton and Benson, Living and Working in Space, pp. 40-44, 46-48, 79-82.
27. President's Science Advisory Committee, The Space Program in the Post-Apollo Period (The White
House, February 1967), pp. 13-16.
28. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 362-63.
29. 1967 Summer Study of Lunar Science and Exploration, NASA SP-157 (Washington, 1%7), pp. 3-6.
30. Anon., "'Falmouth plus two years or how much nearer is the whale to the water?" no date [c.
Aug. 1966].
31. 1967 Summer Study of Lunar Science and Exploration, pp. 9-11.
32. Ibid., pp. 12-13.
33. Ibid., pp. 18-19.
34. Ibid., p. 19.
35. Ibid., pp. 19-29.
36. Ibid., p. 4.
37. Minutes of the Lunar Mission Planning Board, Sept. 28, 1967.
38. Robert R. Gilruth, TWX to Hqs., subj. "OSSA Activities--Weekly Report,'" Nov. 30, 1967.
39. Homer E. Newell to Gilruth, Nov. 20, 1967.
40. Compton and Benson, Living and Working in Space, pp. 83-102.
41. Weekly Compilation of Presidential Documents, vol. 3, no. 34, p. 1193.
42. Senate, Committee on Aeronautical and Space Sciences, NASA's Proposed Operating Plan for Fis-
cal Year 1968, hearing, 90/1, Nov. 8, 1967. For the tribulations and demise of Voyager, see Edward
Clinton Ezell and Linda Neuman Ezell, On Mars: Exploration of the Red Planet 1958-1978, NASA
SP-4212 (Washington, 1984), pp. 85-119; for a general discussion of NASA's budget process and
the "phasing down of the space program" in the middle to late 1960s, see Arnold S. Levine,
Managing NASA in the Apollo Era, NASA SP-4102 (Washington, 1982), pp. 179-209.
43. Compton and Benson, Living and Working in Space, chapters 3 and 5, deal with AAP's fluctuating
plans and fortunes during the period before Apollo 11.
44. Robert C. Seamans, Jr., memorandum for the record, subj.: "Apollo Program Decisions--Manned
Apollo Flights and Apollo Applications Program Plans," May 17, 1967.
45. "Unified Lunar Exploration Office," NASA Release 68-5, Jan. 4, 1968; Philip E. Culbertson to
Wilmot N. Hess, Jan. 3, 1968.
46. Gilruth to Newell, "Principal Investigator requirements for the Lunar Receiving Laboratory (LRL),"
Jan. 11, 1967.
47. Joseph V. Piland, "Lunar Receiving Laboratory Bi-weekly Status Reports," Jan. 9, Jan. 23, Feb.
6, Feb. 20, Mar. 6, Mar. 20, Apr. 3, Apr. 17, 1967; Piland to Dir., MSC, "Phase-out of Lunar
Receiving Laboratory Program Office," Apr. 14, 1967.
48. Clark Goodman to members of LRL Working Group, "Science and Applications Directorate at
MSC," no date [c. Jan. 14, 1967].
49. MSC Announcements no. 67-7, "Organization and Personnel Assignments for the Science and
Applications Directorate," Jan. 10, 1967, and 67-4, "Interim Plan for the Management and Oper-
ation of the Lunar Receiving Laboratory," Jan. 13, 1967.
50. Melvin Calvin to Newell, Dec. 29, 1966; Paul E. Purser to Deputy Dir., MSC, "Planetary Biology
Subcommittee Meeting at MSC on January 10-11, 1967," Jan. 17, 1967.
51. George M. Low, "Resume of Meeting of January 16, 1967, at the Communicable Disease Center,
Atlanta, Georgia," Jan. 16, 1967.
52. "First Lunar Samples Set for Experiment by 110 Scientists," Hqs. Release 67-55, Mar. 16, 1967.
53. Low to John E. Naugle, Mar. 9, 1967; Newell to MSC, "Lunar Sample Analysis Planning,'" June
16, 1967.
54. Gilruth to John E. Naugle, "Lunar Sample Analysis Planning," Nov. 15, 1967.
55. Ibid.
56. MSC Announcement 67-140, "Designation of Chief, Lunar and Earth Sciences Division," Oct.
11, 1967.
57. Low to Earle Young, "Various documents concerning back-contamination and lunar sample
release," Jan. 23, 1967.
288
SourceNotes
58. Robert L. Tweedie, memo for record, "NASA/DOD Interface Conference, Recovery Quarantine
Equipment," Aug. 25, 1966; James C. McLane, Jr., to C.R. Haines, "Lunar Receiving Laboratory
(LRL) functional interfaces with the Apollo Command Module and returned astronauts," Aug.
24, 1966.
59. John E. Picketing, "Minutes, Interagency Committee on Back Contamination," Oct. 3, 1966.
60. Collection of related documents, "Interagency Committee on Back Contamination," no date
[approx. Aug. 1966], box 076-12, JSC History Office files.
61. Aleck C. Bond to record, "Interagency Committee Meeting, October 3, 1966," Oct. 6, 1966.
62. W.W. Kemmerer, "Lunar Receiving Laboratory Sample Protocol Briefing December 16, 1966,"
Dec. 16, 1966; Minutes, Interagency Committee on Back Contamination, Dec. 16, 1966.
63. Wolf Vishniac to Dr. Harry S. Lipscomb (Baylor Coll. of Med.), Feb. 2, 1967.
64. Bond to Deputy Dir., MSC, "Biological protocol for LRL," Feb. 9. 1967.
65. Pickering, "Minutes, Interagency Committee on Back Contamination,'" Mar. 2, 1967.
66. Pickering, "Minutes, Interagency Committee on Back Contamination," June 7, 1967.
67. Interagency Committee on Back Contamination. "Quarantine Schemes for Manned Lunar Mis-
sions," no date [Aug. 1967].
68. George E. Mueller to Gilruth, June 2, 1967.
69. Joseph V. Piland to Dir., Science and Applications, "'Simulated handling of astronauts and returned
equipment for Apollo missions," Aug. 9, 1967.
70. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 228-35.
71. Bilstein, Stages to Saturn, pp. 211-33.
72. Ibid., pp. 355-60; Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 232-34; Benson and Faherty,
Moonport, pp. 403-29; MSC, "Apollo 4 Mission Report," MSC-PA-R-68-1, Jan., 1968, pp. 1-1
through 1-4; MSFC, "Saturn V AS-501 Flight Evaluation," MPR-SAT-FE-68-1, Jan. 15, 1968, pp.
xxxviii-xlii.
73. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 234-35.
74. James E. Webb to Frank B. Smith, Jan. 7, 1967; Webb to Frederick Seitz, NAS, Feb. 2, 1967; Philip
H. Whitbeck to Deputy Dir., Administration, MSC, "Operation of the Lunar Receiving Labora-
tory," Feb. 14, 1967, with encl., "Report on meeting with Mr. Webb on organizational location
and operation of the lunar receiving laboratory"; Newell, draft memo to Seamans, "Manned
Spacecraft Center Science and Applications Directorate and the National Lunar Research Labora-
tory," Mar. 2, 1967; Smith, "Comments Made at MSC at 3116/67 Meeting with Dr. Seitz, George
Low, et al., Relative to Management of the LRL," Mar. 27, 1967; anon., viewgraph for presenta-
tions on functions of Center for Lunar and Earth Sciences, Dec. 20, 1967, JSC History Office files,
box 076-41.
75. OMSF, "Manned Space Flight Schedules, vol. I, Level 1 Schedules and Resources Summary,"
Jan. 9, 1968, pp. ii, 27-29.
CHAPTER 8
1. Courtney G. Brooks, James M. Grimwood, and Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., Chariots for Apollo: A His-
tory of Manned Lunar Spacecraft, NASA SP-4205 (Washington, 1979), pp. 228-29, 237-41.
2. Ibid., pp. 244-47.
3. Ibid., pp. 241-53; Roger E. Bilstein, Stages to Saturn: A Technological History of the ApolloSaturn
Launch Vehicles, NASA SP-4206 (Washington, 1980), pp. 360-63.
4. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, p. 253.
5. Leonard Reiffel to Gen. S. C. Phillips, "Flight Schedule for ALSEP and Related Matters," June
10, 1967.
6. Donald K. Slayton to Dir., Science and Applications (MSCO, "Apollo Lunar Surface Operations
Planning," Feb. 28, 1968.
289
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
7. Vet R. Wilmarth, "Summary Minutes, Planetology Subcommittee of the Space Science and Appli-
cations Steering Committee (Meeting No. 3-FY68), May 15, 16, 17, 1968"; Edward M. Davin to
Mgr., Apollo Surface Expts. Program, "Contingency Science Payloads," July 3, 1968; Richard
J. Green to MSC, attn. : John W. Small, "Science Payload Options, July 3, 1968.
8. George E. Mueller to Robert R. Gilruth, June 5, 1968; Gilruth to Mueller, June 27, 1968.
9. Phillips to Dr. Charles H. Townes, Aug. 31, 1968, with encl., letter to members of OMSF Science
and Technology Advisory Committee, same date.
10. George M. Low to G. W. S. Abbey, "Lunar Mission Planning," Sept. 3, 1968; Wilmot N. Hess
to Mgr., Apollo Spacecraft Program (MSC), "Changes in Mission G Plans," Sept. 4, 1968.
11 Hess to Dir. (MSC), "Contingency Apollo Science Program,'" Sept. 30, 1968, with encl., "Con-
tingency Apollo Science Program Implementation Plan" (preliminary), Sept. 27, 1968; idem, "Plans
for Alternate Science Program on First Apollo Lunar Landing," Oct. 4, 1968.
12. Mueller, TWX to MSC attn.: Robert R. Gilruth, Nov. 5, 1968.
13. A. E. Morse, Jr., to Mgr., Apollo program, "KSC support for the LM-5 Early Apollo Scientific
Experiment Payload (EASEP)," Nov. 12, 1968; Phillips to Gilruth, Nov. 15, 1968.
14. Phillips to Gilruth, Nov. 15, 1968.
15. Phillips, TWX to MSC attn.: G. M. Low, W. N. Hess, "Experiment Assignments to Lunar Mis-
sions," Dec. 5, 1968.
16. Wilmarth, "Summary Minutes."
17. Gilruth to Hqs., attn.: E. Taylor, TWX, "OSSA Activities--Weekly Report," Oct. 24, 1968.
18. MSC, "Lunar Receiving Laboratory Briefing," transcript of presentation, June 29, 1967; MSC,
"Annual Report for Calendar Year 1967, The Directorate of Medical Research and Operations,
Manned Spacecraft Center," n.d. [Dec. 1967].
19. Edgar M. Cortright to Gilruth, Mar. 27, 1968; Hess to Dir., Medical Research & Operations, "Initi-
ation of monthly review meetings on LRL," Mar. 29, 1968.
20. Hess to multiple addressees, "Preliminary Examination Team Simulation Tests and Full Scale
LRL Simulation," Aug. 20, 1968.
21. Gilruth to Charles W. Mathews, May 17, 1968; Minutes, Monthly LRL Reviews, June 10, July
1, Aug. 12, 1968.
22. MSC, "Minutes of Monthly LRL Review," Sept. 16, 1968; John E. Pickering, "Trip Report [to
LRL monthly manager's review]," Sept. 18, 1968.
23. P. R. Bell to Martin Favero, June 18, 1968; "[Minutes,] Lunar Science Analysis Planning Team,
July 26 [1968]"; Hess to multiple addressees, "Preliminary Examination Team Simulation Tests
and Full Scale LRL Simulation," Aug. 20, 1968.
24. Gilruth to Edward H. Levi (Univ. of Chicago), Feb. 25, 1969.
25. Bell to Members of Preliminary Examination Team, "The Preliminary Examination Team simula-
tion and training session, October 22 through November 1, 1968," Oct. 16, 1968.
26. Test dir., vacuum laboratory, "Report on PET Simulation, October 25-30, 1968," Oct. 31, 1968;
Bell to Dir., Science and Applications, "LRL Equipment and System Problems, Nov. 7, 1968.
27. Hess to L. R. Scherer, "Changes in the Lunar Receiving Laboratory," Dec. 6, 1968; Hess to LRL
Staff, "Configuration Control Board (CCB),'" Dec. 6, 1968.
28. Gilruth to multiple addressees, "Operational Readiness Inspection of the Lunar Receiving Labora-
tory," Oct. 21, 1968.
29. Peter J. Armitage to multiple addressees: "Minutes of the First ORI Committee Meeting for the
Lunar Receiving Laboratory," Nov. 5, 1968; "Minutes of the Second ORI Committee Meeting
for the Lunar Receiving Laboratory," Nov. 22, 1968; "Minutes of the Third ORI Committee Meeting
for the Lunar Receiving Laboratory," Dec. 4, 1968; "Minutes of the Fourth ORI Committee Meeting
for the Lunar Receiving Laboratory," Dec. 4, 1968; "Status of the Operational Readiness Inspec-
tion on the Lunar Receiving Laboratory and the Recovery Quarantine Equipment," Dec. 19, 1968;
"Minutes of the Fifth ORI Committee Meeting for the Lunar Receiving Laboratory," Dec. 23, 1968.
30. Armitage, "Final Report, Operational Readiness Inspection of the Lunar Receiving Laboratory
and Recovery Quarantine Equipment," May 7, 1969.
31. John E. Picketing, "Minutes, Interagency Committee on Back Contamination, 8-9 Feb. 1968."
32. Idem, "Minutes, Interagency Committee on Back Contamination, 11 June 1968."
33. Idem, "Minutes, Interagency Committee on Back Contamination, 17-18 Oct. 1968."
34. Richard S. Johnston to C. C. Kraft, M. A. Faget, and C. A. Berry, "Apollo Back Contamination,"
Nov. 8, 1968.
290
SourceNotes
35. Johnston to multiple addressees, "Back-Contamination program review," Jan. 16, 1969; "ICBC
Meeting at MSC on March 28 and 19," Mar. 18, 1969.
36. Gilruth to Maj. Gen. J. W. Humphreys, Jr., Mar. 19, 1969.
37. Pickering, "Minutes, Interagency Committee on Back Contamination, 28-29 March 1969."
38. David J. Sencer to Thomas O. Paine, Apr. 7, 1969.
39. S. C. Phillips, TWX to MSC, attn.: G. M. Low, "Biological containment on 'G' mission prior
to entry into MQF,'" Apr. 10, 1969.
40. Ibid.; Low to multiple addressees, "Apollo Back Contamination Action Items," Apr. 14, 1969;
Low to Phillips, "Apollo Back Confamination Action Status," Apr. 15, 1969.
41. Low to Phillips, "Transmittal of Summary Report and Actions from Back Contamination LDX
Conference Held April 21, 1969," Apr. 24, 1969, with encl., Low to Multiple Addressees, "Back
Contamination LDX Conference held April 21, 1969, Between MSCINASA Headquarters; minutes
and action items," Apr. 24, 1969.
42. MSC Announcement 69-60, "Lunar Receiving Laboratory Operations," May 1, 1969.
43. Johnston, draft of MSC position paper on Apollo back contamination program, Apr. 25, 1969.
44. Picketing, "'Minutes, Interagency Committee on Back Contamination, 2 May 1969."
45. Phillips to Gilruth, "Lunar Receiving Laboratory Readiness Review," Jan. 16, 1969; Gilruth to
Phillips, Jan. 29, 1969, with tentative agenda for proposed review.
46. Mueller to Gilruth, Jan. 13, 1969; Gilruth to Mueller, Feb. 8, 1969.
47. A. B. Park to Pickering, Mar. 7, 1969, with end., "Report by U.S. Department of Agriculture
Team on Lunar Receiving Laboratory Evaluation for Quarantine Requirements," n.d.; Howard
H. Eckels to Picketing, Mar. 11, 1969, with encl., "Department of Interior Observations on the
Lunar Receiving Laboratory Procedures Relative to Invertebrate and Fish Species, February 12,
13, and 14, 1969"; idem, Feb. 27, 1969, with encl., Kenneth E. Wolf to Eckles, "Technical Review
of Lunar Receiving Laboratory," Feb. 25, 1969; Picketing to Dir., Apollo Program, "LRL Bioprotocol
Readiness Review and Certification Procedures," Feb. 24, 1969.
48. MSC, "Lunar Receiving Laboratory Simulation Plan, March 3--April 16, 1969," n.d., pp. 1-2.
49. Rudy Trabanino to LTD's [Laboratory Test Directors], "Debriefing of Laboratory Personnel," Mar.
16, 1969; D. White to LTD's, "Critique of 3-13 March Simulation in Vacuum Laboratory--Shift
I," Mar. 16, 1969; T. McPherson to LTD's, "Vacuum Laboratory Critique--Second Shift," Mar.
16, 1969; Trabanino to LTD's, "Critical Vacuum Laboratory Problems," Mar. 21, 1969; O. A.
Schaeffer and J. G. Funkhauser to Bryan Erb, "Leak Checking of RCL Containers with Gas Analysis
System," Mar. 24, 1969; Bell to Deputy Mgr., LRL, "Problems Identified in February and March
LRL simulations," Mar. 27, 1969; H. C. Sweet and Charles H. Walkinsbau, Jr., "Summary of
Simulation of Botanical Protocol--March 1969," n.d. [Mar. 1969]; "Minutes, Interagency Com-
mittee on Back Contamination, 28-29 March 1969--Manned Spacecraft Center--Houston, Texas,"
Mar. 29, 1969; Trabanino, "'Critical Vacuum Laboratory Problems," Apr. 3, 1969.
50. Hess to Bell, "Organic Contamination of F201," Apr. 8, 1969.
51. Johnston to multiple addressees, "Action items from Interagency Committee on Back Contami-
nation (ICBC) Meeting," May 5, 1969; Gilruth to multiple addressees, "Establishment of Apollo
Back Contamination Control Panel," May 8, 1969; Johnston to Chief, Crew Systems Div., and
ChieL Flight Crew Support Div., "Lunar Module Back Contamination Simulation, May 12, 1969;
Johnston to Col. John E. Picketing, May 14, 1969; Johnston to multiple addressees, "Action Items
from Interagency Committee on Back Contamination (ICBCO Meeting, May 2, 1969," May 15,
1969; idem, "ICBC Telephone Conference Summary and Action Items," May 21, 1969; MSC,
"Back Contamination Mission Rules (Recovery to Receiving Lab)," MSC 00005, May 21, 1969;
Low to multiple addressees, "Back Contamination Procedures, May 20, 1969; Robert E. Smylie
to Mgr., Apollo Spacecraft Program, "Back Contamination Procedures," May 22, 1969; Johnston
to multiple addressees, "Apollo Back Contamination Simulation Meeting Summary," May 23,
1969; idem, "Back Contamination Action Items," May 28, 1969.
52. Mueller to Administrator, "Manned Space Hight Weekly Report," June 9, 1969.
53. Johnston to multiple addressees, "Apollo Back Contamination Simulation Meeting Summary,
May 23, 1969.
54. Sencer to Paine, Apr. 7, 1969.
55. W. David Compton and Charles D. Benson, Living and Working in Space: A History of Skylab, NASA
SP-4208 (Washington, 1983) , pp. 99-102.
291
Where No Man Has Gone Before
56. Hess to MSC Dir., "Summary OSSA Senior Council Meeting," Apr. 30, 1968; Hess to John E.
Naugle, "Staffing of the LRL,'" June 6,1968; Naugle to Hess, same sub., July 9, 1968; M. L. Raines
to Assoc. Dir., "Systems and Support Contractor Reduction," July 12, 1968; MSC, "Minutes
of Monthly LRL Review, September 16, 1968"; Earle B. Young to LRL ORI Committee, "Pro-
posed LRL Staffing," Nov. 26, 1968; P.R. Bell to Dir., Science and Applications, "Staffing Plan
for the Lunar and Receiving Laboratory," Jan. 17, 1969; Wesley L. Hjornevik to Lt. Gen. Frank
A. Bogart, "'Lunar Receiving Laboratory Staffing, Jan. 27, 1969; MSC, "LRL Staffing Plan Sta-
tus, April 8, 1969, Science & Applications Directorate and Medical Research & Operations Direc-
torate.'"
57. John D. Stevenson, TWX to multiple addressees, "MSF mission operations forecast for January
1969," Jan. 3, 1969; Gilruth to Stevenson, "Ability to support launch schedule for CY 1969/'
Mar. 4, 1969.
58. Bell to Dir., Science and Applications, "Staffing plan for the Lunar and Receiving Laboratory,"
Jan. 17, 1969.
59. W. W. Kemmerer, Jr., to all LRL personnel, "Initiation of mission operating conditions for the
Sample Laboratory secondary biological barrier," June 3, 1969.
60. Johnston to all NASA LRL personnel, "Lunar Receiving Laboratory Apollo 11 Task Group," June
4, 1969.
61. MSC, "Lunar Landing Site Selection Briefing, Compilation of Presentation Material," Mar. 8,
1967; John E. Eggleston to Dir., Science and Applications, "Trip report--Apollo Site Selection
Board Meeting; Surveyor/Orbiter UtiliTation Committee Meeting," Apr. 3, 1967; Owen E. May-
nard to Mgr., Apollo Spacecraft Program Office, "Trip report--Apollo Site Selection Board and
Surveyor/Orbiter Utilization Committee Meetings," Apr. 20, 1967.
62. Low to Hqs., attn. Dr. James A. Turnock, "Selection of Lunar Landing Sites for First Lunar Landing
Mission," Sept. 3, 1967.
63. Phillips to multiple addressees, "Minutes of the Apollo Site Selection Board meeting of Decem-
ber 15, 1967," Jan. 29, 1968; MSC, "Apollo Site Selection Board Briefing, Compilation of Presen-
tation Material," Dec. 15, 1967.
64. Ibid.
65. Ibid.
66. Compton and Benson, Living and Working in Space, p. 87; Robert C. Seamans, Jr., to Mueller, "Ter-
mination of the Lunar Mapping and Survey System," July 25, 1967; U.S., Congress, House, Sub-
committee on Manned Space Flight of the Committee on Science and Astronautics, 1968 NASA
Authorization, Hearings on H.R. 4450, H.R. 6470, 90/1, pt. 2, pp. 127-28, 568-69; idem, 1969 NASA
Authorization, Hearings on H.R. 15086, 90/2, pt. 2, p. 64.
67. Phillips to Gilruth, "Lunar Photography from the CSM," Mar. 29, 1968.
68. John R. Brinkmann to Chief, Syst. Eng. Div., "Lunar photography from the CSM," May 13, 1968;
Warren J. North to Chief, Syst. Eng. Div., same subj., May 15, 1968.
69. MSC, "MSC Lunar Scientific Exploration Plan," Apr. 14, 1967.
70. Hess to multiple addressees, "Pre-GLEP meeting January 10 in Washington, D.C.," Jan. 3, 1968.
71. NASA Hqs., "The Plan for Lunar Exploration," Feb. 1968.
72. Ibid.
73. Ibid.
74. Gilruth to Mueller, Mar. 4, 1968.
75. Gilruth to Mueller, Apr. 1, 1968.
76. House, Subcommittee on Manned Space Flight of the Committee on Science and Astronautics,
1969 NASA, Authorization, Hearings on H.R. 15086, 90/2, pt. 2, pp. 26-35. The same plan was
presented by John E. Naugle to the subcommittee on science and applications, also without
stimulating discussion; see idem, Subcommittee on Space Science and Applications of the Com-
mittee on Science and Astronautics, 1969 NASA Authorization, Hearings on H.R. 15086, 90/2, pt.
3, pp. 146-58.
77. Andre J. Meyer, Jr., "Minutes of the Lunar Mission Planning Board," Feb. 13, 1968.
78. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 237-53.
79. Compton and Benson, Living and Working in Space, pp. 99-104.
80. Phillips, "Minutes of the Apollo Site Selection Board Meeting of March 26, 1968," May 6, 1968.
81. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 265-72.
82. Ibid., pp. 256-60, 272-74.
292
il
Source Notes
83. Ibid.
84. Ibid., pp. 274-84.
85. MSC PA-R-69-1, "Apollo 8 Mission Report," Feb. 1969, p. 3-2.
86. Ibid., pp. 4-1 to 4-9.
87. Ibid., pp. 4-8 to 4-9, 7-19 to 7-20.
88. John D. Stevenson, TWX, "MSF Mission Operations Forecast for January 1969," Jan. 3, 1969.
CHAPTER 9
1. Courtney G. Brooks, James M. Grimwood, and Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., Chariots for Apollo: A His-
tory of Manned Lunar Spacecraft, NASA SP-4205 (Washington, 1979), p. 261.
2. Ibid., pp. 261-62.
3. Interview with Joseph P. Kerwin, Jr., Mar. 29, 1985; interview with John R. Sevier, Apr. 24, 1986.
4. NASA Release 67-211, Aug. 4, 1967.
5. W. David Compton and Charles D. Benson, Living and Working in Space: A History of SkyIab, NASA
SP-4208 (Washington, 1983), pp. 84-86.
6. Interview with Donald K. Slayton, Oct. 15, 1984.
7. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 373-77.
8. Ibid., pp. 234-35.
9. Ibid., pp. 290-91.
10. Ibid., pp. 292-99; "Apollo 9 Mission Report," MSC PA-R-69-2, May 1969, pp. 1-1 to 1-2.
11. "Apollo 10 Mission Report," MSC-00126, Aug. 1969, p. 3-1.
12. Charles D. Benson and William Barnaby Faherty, Moonport: A History of Apollo Launch Facilities
and Operations, NASA SP-4204 (Washington, 1978), p. 474.
13. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 303-12.
14. Ibid., pp. 318-26; MSC, "Apollo 11 Crew Training Summaries (Jan. 31-July 15, 1969),'" folder
in box 081-13, JSC History Office Apollo files.
15. Brooks, Grimwood, and Swenson, Chariots, pp. 322-25; Langley Research Center, "Lunar Landing
Research Facility and Landing Loads Track," presentation at Field Inspection of Advanced Research
and Technology, Hampton, Va., May 18-22, 1964, copy in box 081-45, JSC History Office Apollo
files; George E. Mueller to Robert R. Gilruth, Feb. 19, 1969; Gilruth to MueUer, Apr. 1, 1969.
16. Bell Aerosystems Co. release, Jan. 20, 1967, in box 081-45, JSC History Office Apollo files; several
good photographs of the LLTV in flight are found in "Series of Lunar Landings Simulated,"
Aviation Week & Space Technology, June 30, 1969. See also David F. Gebhard, "Factors in the Choice
of LEM Piloting and Testing Techniques," SAE Preprint 866F, April 1964; Gene J. Matringa, Donald
L. Mallick, and Emil E. Kleuver, "An Assessment of Ground and Flight Simulators for the Exami-
nation of Manned Lunar Landing," AIAA Paper 67-238, presented at AIAA Flight Test, Simula-
tion and Support Conference, Cocoa Beach, Fla., Feb. 6-8, 1967; and James P. Bigham, Jr., "The
lunar landing training vehicle," Simulation, July 1970, pp. 17-18, copies in box 081-46, JSC His-
tory Office Apollo files; Richard H. Holzapfel, TWX to NASA, attn.: B. P. Helgeson, May 7, 1968;
T. O. Paine to LLRV-1 Review Board, "Investigation and Review of Crash of Lunar Landing Train-
ing Vehicle #1," Dec. 11, 1968; idem, "Investigation and Review of Crash of Lunar Landing
Research Vehicle #1," Dec. 31, 1968.
17. Bigham, "The Lunar Landing Training Vehicle."
18. "Apollo 11 Crew Training Summary."
19. Elbert A. King, Jr., interview with Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., May 17, 1971, tape in JSC History Office
Apollo files.
20. Mueller to Administrator, "Manned Space Flight Report--May 26, 1969.'"
21. Idem, Manned Space Flight Reports: May 26, June 2, 9, 16, 23, 30, 1969; "'Apollo 11 Crew Train-
ing Summary"; Slayton, Flight Crew Operations Directorate Weekly Activity Reports: May 30,
June 6, 13, 20, July 3, 11, 18, 1969.
22. Julian Scheer to Slayton, June 3, 1969; Slayton to Scheer, "Attendance of Apollo 10 and 11 crews
at White House dinner," June 9, 1969.
293
Where No Man Has Gone Before
294
I_ i ""
Source Notes
64. Idem, "Status Report, John McLeaish Comments on Crew, 7128/69, CDT 08:05 AM," July 28,
1969; Richard S. Johnston, Lawrence F. Dietlein, M.D., and Charles A. Berry, M.D., eds., Bio-
medical Results of Apollo, NASA SP-368 (Washington, 1975), p. 418. If indeed there was a serious
risk of contaminating the earth with alien organisms, the decision to breach quarantine in the
event of a life-threatening emergency would have meant taking that risk rather than sacrificing
an astronaut. No one seems to have contested that decision; perhaps this indicates the real per-
ception of risk from "moon bugs."
65. MSC, "Lunar Receiving Laboratory, MSC Building 37, Facility Description,'" September 1968,
pp. 8-19; "Apollo 11 Technical Crew Debriefing," vol. II, p. 26-4.
66. MSC Public Affairs Office, Crew Status Reports, July 28-Aug. 10, 1969.
67. George M. Low to NASA Hqs., attn.: Lt. Gen. S. C. Phillips, "Special Lunar Samples for Museum
Display or Presentation to VIPs," July 7, 1969.
68. Phillips to Low, "Lunar Sample Accounting," Aug. 5, 1969.
69. Willis H. Shapley to multiple addressees, "Lunar Sample Material," Aug. 19, 1969. It was reported
that Nixon offered the President of Indonesia and other chiefs of state "a piece of the moon as
a souvenir"; New York Times, July 28, 1969, cited in Astronautics and Aeronautics, 1969: Chronology
on Science, Technology, and Policy, NASA SP-4014 (Washington, 1970), p. 249.
70. Phillips, TWX to Low, Aug. 15, 1969; Robert R. Gilruth to Rocco A. Petrone, "Non-Scientific
Use of Lunar Samples," Sept. 5, 1969.
Forwarding the latter memo to George Low, Wilmot Hess (whose deputy, Anthony Calio, had
drafted it for Gilruth's signature) stressed his own distaste for the plan to present large samples
to VIPs--a distaste that was shared by the lunar scientists. Elbert King, who had been appointed
first curator of lunar samples, did everything he could to prevent distribution of any lunar sam-
ples as souvenirs. When he first heard of the plan to present souvenirs to VIPs, his impression
was that "they were talking about big polished pieces of rock for paperweights .... Here was
priceless scientific material that was going to be cut up as political trophies." The White House
proposal was even more offensive to King, and when a Washington paper called him to ask for
his reaction, he commented that it would be unthinkable--a reaction which, he recalled later,
"caused much unhappiness within the center, because here was someone [at MSC] disagreeing
with the President, and that's very poor form." Elbert A. King, Jr., interview with L. S. Swen-
son, Jr., May 27, 1971, tape in JSC History Office files; Marti Mueller, "Trouble at NASA: Space
Scientists Resign," Science 165 (1969): 776-79.
Nixon had already drawn considerable adverse criticism from some newspapers, which accused
him of trying to turn Apollo to his own political advantage in spite of his negligible record of
supporting the space program. His telephone call to the astronauts on the moon, the addition
of his signature to those of the astronauts on the commemorative plaque on the lunar module
Eagle, and his visit to the Hornet (on his way to a tour of Asia), were all cited as attempts to get
unmerited credit for the Apollo accomplishment. See the editorial in the Washington Post, "Our
Mark on the Moon," July 3, 1969; Herblock's cartoon "Lunar Hitchhiker," Washington Post, July
6, 1969; "Plaque Pique," Washington Evening Star, July 9, 1969; Marianne Means, "President
Nixon and the Astronauts," Los Angeles Herald-Examiner, July 13, 1969; "Hate the President,"
Richmond (Va.) News Leader, July 15, 1969; William Hines, "Nixon Skims Off the Cream," Washing-
ton Sunday Star, July 27, 1969.
71. "8,200 View Moon Rock,'" Washington Evening Star, Sept. 18, 1969, " 'It looks like any rock,' ""
Washington Daily News, Sept. 18, 1969.
72. Johnston et al., Biomedical Results of Apollo, p. 419.
73. "Minutes, Interagency Committee on Back Contamination," Aug. 10, 1969.
74. Don Kirkman, "Germ-Free Apollos Sent Home," Washington Daily News, Aug. 11, 1969; Albert
Sehlstedt, Jr., "Astronauts Brace For Celebrations," Baltimore Sun, Aug. 12, 1969.
75. "Apollo 11 LTD Daily Summary Report, 1200 July 26 to 1200 July 27"; Wilmot N. Hess, "LRL
Summary Report No. 7/' July 31, 1969.
76. A summary of the investigations is found in Johnston et al., Biomedical Results of Apollo, pp. 425-34.
77. MSC, "Sample Information Summary #5 Final," Aug. 27, 1969, p. 13; see also LRL Summary
Reports for Aug. 1 through Aug. 31.
78. J. W. Humphreys, Jr., to Dir., MSC, "Release of all lunar material and lunar exposed material
in Building 37, Manned Spacecraft Center, Houston, Texas," Sept. 11, 1969.
295
Where No Man Has Gone Before
79. Rocco A. Petrone, TWX to Gilruth, "Approval of MSC proposed allocation of Apollo 11 lunar
sample material for distribution to approved principal investigators for scientific analysis," Sept.
9, 1969; Petxone, TWX to Gilruth, "Release of lunar samples," Sept. 12, 1969; NASA Hqs., "Moon
Surface Samples Distributed," Release No. 69-130, Sept. 12, 1969.
80. Richard A. Wright, "Lunar and Earth Sciences weekly activity report," Oct. 17, 1969.
81. Paine to Gilruth, Sept. 8, 1969. Some investigators did not conform to the ban. In November,
a scientist at the U.S. Geological Survey wrote indignantly to MSC's director of science and appli-
cations, enclosing clippings that indicated some findings had been released prematurely and outside
of normal scientific channels. According to one, Harold Urey had stated in a talk in San Diego
that the Apollo 11 samples had been found to be 4.6 billion years old, which supported his the-
ory of the moon's origin. G. Brent Dalrymple to Anthony J. Callo, Nov. 13, 1969, with encl.,
copy of article, "Moon Rocks" Age Is Now Firmly Fixed," San Francisco Chronicle, Nov. 8, 1969.
82. E. F. Bartell (Cornell Univ.), TWX to Space Sciences Procurement Branch MSC, Sept. 16, 1969.
83. William L. Green, TWX to MSC, attn. Brian Duff, Oct. 3, 1969.
84. Donald U. Wise, TWX to MSC, attn. Dr. W. Hess, Aug. 11, 1969.
85. Philip H. Abelson, "The Moon Issue," Science 167 (1969):447.
86. The Lunar Sample Preliminary Examination Team, "Preliminary Examination of Lunar Samples
from Apollo 11," Science 165 (1969):1211-27.
87. Ibid., p. 1226.
88. Cohn, "Seismometer on Moon Registers Disturbance," Washington Post, July 23, 1969, "Moon
Tremor Recorded by Apollo Device," ibid., July 24, 1969.
89. Idem, "Moon Tremor Recorded."
90. Idem, "Old Moon Game Taunts Players.'"
91. Mueller, "Manned Space Flight Weekly Report-July 28, 1969.'"
CHAPTER 10
1. Stuart Auerbach, "Mariner 6 Relays 33 Pictures of Mars," Washington Post, July 30, 1969; idem,
"Mariner 7 Photographs Mysterious Mars Canals," ibid., Aug. 5, 1969; Edward Clinton Ezell
and Linda Neuman Ezell, On Mars: Exploration of the Red Planet 1958-1978, NASA SP-4212 (Washing-
ton, 1984), pp. 74-80, 175-80.
2. W. David Compton and Charles D. Benson, Living and Working in Space: A History of Skylab, NASA
SP-4208 (Washington, 1983), pp. 104-11.
3. Ibid., pp. 115-18; Homer E. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere: Early Years of Space Science, NASA
SP-4211 (Washington, 1980), pp. 286-89.
4. John Noble Wilford, "A Spacefaring People: Keynote Address," in A Spacefaring People: Perspec-
tives on Early Spaceflight, Alex Roland, ed., NASA SP-4405 (Washington, 1985), p. 72. Wilford,
a veteran reporter and one of the best on space, covered the space program for the New York
Times for many years. He was the keynote speaker at this conference on manned space flight
history at Yale University, Feb. 6-7, 1981. Wilford asserted (p. 71) as one of the major themes
of space history that "The first Apollo landing was, in one sense, a triumph that failed, not because
the achievement was anything short of magnificent but because of misdirected ex _ectations and a general
misperception of its real meaning. The public was encouraged to view it only as the grand climax of the
space program, a geopolitical horse race and extraterrestrial entertainment--not as a dramatic means to the
greater end of developing a far-ranging spacefaring capability. This led to the space program's post-Apollo
slump [emphasis in the original]."
5. John D. Stevenson, TWX to MSF centers and support elements, "MSF Mission Operations Fore-
cast for June 1969," June 5, 1969; Courtney G. Brooks, James M. Grimwood, and Loyd S. Swen-
son, Jr., Chariots for Apollo: A History of Manned Lunar Spacecraft, NASA SP-4205 (washington,
1979), p. 285; Mueller, "Manned Space Flight Weekly Report--July 1, 1969."
6. Stevenson to multiple addressees, TWX, "MSF mission operations forecast for August 1969,"
July 27, 1969; MueUer, "Manned Space Flight Weekly Report--July 29, 1969."
296
Source Notes
7. 1967 Summer Study of Lunar Science and Exploration, NASA SP-157 (Washington, 1967), pp. 163-73,
229-33, 324, 358-59.
8. Andre J. Meyer, handwritten notebooks UI-VI (late 1967 to early 1969), in JSC History Office files.
Besides being involved in other advanced project planning, Meyer headed the Apollo Explora-
tions Project Office at MSC.
9. Mueller, "Manned Space Flight Weekly Report--January 6, 1969, .... Manned Space Flight Weekly
Report--April 21, 1969."
10. Wflmot N. Hess to AA/Director, "Summary OSSA Senior Council Meeting," Apr. 30, 1968; John
D. Hodge to PA/Office of Program Manager, MSC, "Lunar Exploration Support," June 4, 1968,
with encl., "ELM [extended lunar module]--Development."
11. MSC, draft statement of work, "LM Modification Study for Extended Lunar Staytime," rev. 28,
Feb. 1%9; Mueller, "Manned Space Flight Weekly Report--March 4, 1%9."
12. Lee R. Scherer to MSC, attn. Wilmot N. Hess, "Subsatellite on Apollo Lunar Missions," May
3, 1968; Hess to Mgr., Apollo Spacecraft Program Off., "CSM Lunar Orbiting Science Study,"
May 10, 1968.
13. J. J. Eslinger to Apollo CSM Engineering Supervision, North American Rockwell Corp., Project
Memorandum #3, "Apollo Scientific Experiments Program (ASEP)," Feb. 27, 1969.
14. MSC, "Weekly Activities Report, Science and Applications Directorate, January 20--27, 1969."
15. Robert R. Gilruth to Mueller, "Lunar Exploration CSM Orbital Science, Phase I," Mar. 27, 1969.
16. John A. Naugle to Gilruth, TWX, Apr. 4, 1969.
17. S. C. Phillips to Gilruth, TWX, subj.: CSM Phase I Orbital Science, Apr. 21, 1969.
18. William E. Stoney, Jr., to MSC, attn.: J. P. Loftus, "CSM Orbital Science Missions," May 15, 1%9.
19. Phillips to MSC, attn.: R. Gilruth, TWX, subj.: Authority to proceed with SM orbital experiments
for Apollo 16 through 20, June 27, 1969.
20. J. O. Cappelari, Jr., ed., "Where on the Moon? An Apollo Systems Engineering Problem," The
Bell System Technical Journal 51 (I972): 976-84.
21. John R. Sevier interview, Apr. 24, 1986.
22. MA/Apollo Program Dir. to multiple addressees, "Minutes of the Apollo Site Selection Board
Meeting of June 3, 1%9."
23. Ibid.
24. Ibid.; Benjamin Milwitzky to Dir., Apollo Lunar Exploration Office, "Biasing Apollo Missions
to Land Near Surveyor Spacecraft on the Moon," Jan. 10, 1%9.
25. Minutes of the Apollo Site Selection Board Meeting, June 3, 1969; Owen E. Maynard to Mgr.,
Apollo Spacecraft Program, "Apollo Site Selection Board trip report-June 3, 1%9," with end.,
"Lunar Landing Site Recommendations for Apollo 12 as Presented to Apollo Site Selection Board
June 3, 1969," June 10, 1%9.
26. Minutes of the Apollo Site Selection Board Meeting, June 3, 1969.
27. George M. Low to NASA Hqs., attn.: S. C. Phillips, TWX, "Lunar Landing Sites for H-1 Mis-
sion," June 12, 1%9.
28. Phillips to MSC, attn.: G. Low, TWX, "Lunar Landing Sites for H-1 Mission," June 16, 1969.
29. N.W. Hinners to Captain L. R. Scherer, "Second Mission Landing Sites," June 18, 1%9; Hin-
nets to Group for Lunar Exploration Planning and Site Selection Subgroup, "Fourth GLEP Site
Selection Subgroup Meeting--June 17, 1%9," June 23, 1%9; Hinners to file, "GLEP Site Selec-
tion Subgroup, Fourth Meeting, June 17, 1969," Aug. 4, 1969.
30. Hinners, "Fourth GLEP Site Selection Subgroup Meeting--June 17, 1%9.
31. Minutes of the Apollo Site Selection Board Meeting, July 10, 1969.
32. NASA Release 69-53, Apr. 10, 1%9; "Crew to Make 2d Landing On Moon Set,'" Washington Post,
Apr. 11, 1969.
33. Ivan D. Ertel and Roland W. Newkirk, with Courtney G. Brooks, The Apollo Spacecraft: A Chronol-
ogy, vol. W, NASA SP-4009 (Washington, 1978), pp. 408-9.
34. Sevier interview.
35. "Apollo 12 Crew Training Summaries (Mar. 28-Nov. 14, 1%9)/' folder in box 081-14, JSC His-
tory Office files.
36. MSC News Release, "Apollo 12 Landing Sites," July 25, 1%9; John G. Zarcaro to multiple addres-
sees, "Apollo 12 Mission H1 planning,"July 28, 1%9.
37. Sevier interview.
297
Where No Man Has Gone Before
38. B. E. Oldfield (Hughes Aircraft Co.) to John Hodge, July 10, 1969; Hodge to mgr., Apollo space-
craft program, "Science and Technological Items Available Upon Landing at a Surveyor Site,"
July 31, 1969.
39. Howard W. Tindall, Jr., "A Lengthy Status Report on Lunar Point Landing Including Some
Remarks about CSM DOI [Descent Orbit Insertion]," Aug. 29, 1969. Tindall's clear and breezy
style in writing memos ("Tindallgrams,'" as they came to be called), usually prefaced with an
attention-grabbing title, gained him a well-deserted local reputation. He had the gift, rare among
engineers and still rarer among managers, of compacting large amounts of information into a
few clear and understandable paragraphs, leavened with considerable humor.
40. Tindall, "How to Land Next to a Surveyor--a Short Novel for Do-lt-Yourselfers," Aug. 1, 1969.
41. Surveyor IIh A Preliminary Report, NASA SP-146 (Washington, 1967), pp. 12-16; Walter Sullivan,
"Surveyor Tracked Down By a Photographic Sleuth," New York Times, Nov. 19, 1969.
42. John P. Mayer, "The Search for Surveyor III," MSC Internal Note 69-FM-329, Jan. 16, 1970. Its
language shows that the report was written before the launch of Apollo 12, although it is dated
two months later.
43. Tindall, "How to Land next to a Surveyor," Aug. 1, 1969.
44. Tindall, "'A Lengthy Status Report," Aug. 29, 1969.
45. Tindall to multiple addressees, "Apollo 12 Descent--Final Comments," Nov. 4, 1969.
46. MSC, "Mission Requirements, SA-507/CSM-108/LM-6, H-1 Type Mission, Lunar Landing,'" MSC
SPD9-R-051, July 18, 1969, pp. 2-1 to 2-3.
47. MSC, Apollo 12 Mission Reviews, Aug. 15 and Oct. 2, 1969.
48. Andre J. Meyer to PA/Mgr., Apollo Spacecraft Program, "Surveyor 3 Activities on Apollo 12 Mis-
sion," Aug. 28, 1969.
49. Hinners to L. R. Scherer, "Second Mission Landing Sites," June 18, 1969; James H. Sasser to
multiple addressees, "Highlights of GLEP Site Selection Subgroup Meeting in the Mapping
Sciences Laboratory on June 17, 1969," June 22, 1969.
50. Thomas O'Toole, "Veteran Astronauts Lovell, Shepard to Lead "70 Moon Flights,'" Washington
Post, Aug. 7, 1969. A month earlier a Houston paper had run an unconfirmed story that Shepard,
Roosa, and Mitchell would be the crew for Apollo 13, with Lovell, Mattingly, and Haise man-
ning 14 (Arthur Hill, "Alan Shepard Will Command 3rd Moon Team," Houston Chronicle, July
3, 1969). This may have been the cause for George Mueller's overriding Slayton's choice for these
crews--the only instance in which Headquarters reversed Slayton's selections (see note 13,
Chap. 5). Shepard had been off the active list until May 1969, serving meanwhile as head of the
Astronaut Office ("Mercury's Shepard rejoins flight group,'" MSC Roundup, May 16, 1969). The
report that he had been named to the first mission scheduled after he returned to active status
would have considerably upset the scientist astronauts. In the course of an interview unrelated
to this book, one of them commented off the record to the present author, "the test pilots ran
the astronaut office and flew their friends.'" True or not, such a perception would have been
hard to refute after this crew selection.
51. Marti Mueller, "Trouble at NASA: Space Scientists Resign," Science 165 (1969):776-79.
52. Ibid.
53. Wilmot N. Hess, interview with Robert Merrifield, Nov. 7, 1968, transcript in JSC History Office
files; John Noble Wilford, "Moon Scientists Seek Place in the Sun," New York Times, Aug. 10,
1969; Gilruth to Mueller, Sept. 2, 1969.
54. Eugene Shoemaker, "Space--Where Now, and Why?" Engineering and Science 33(1) (1969): 9-12.
55. "Geologist to Quit Apollo Project; Weak Scientific Effort Charged," New York Times (UPI), Oct.
9, 1969.
56. Harold Urey, who during this period continually criticized NASA's choice of lunar landing sites,
wrote off geologists as "mostly . . . a second-rate lot .... [Geology] is descriptive, and very often
[geologists] do not learn more than the most elementary things about chemistry and physics."
Urey to Mueller, Oct. 7, 1969. Of Shoemaker, Urey said, "Gene is one of the few capable people
who has had a prominent part in advising NASA, though he has had a very rigid geological point-
of-view .... I do not agree with him in some ways, but his general criticism of the lack of good
scientific advice is correct.'" Urey to Paine, Oct. 9, 1969. Urey and Shoemaker had both worked
on Project Ranger.
Shoemaker's criticism deeply affronted some in NASA, who felt it could only do the program
harm; see Homer E. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere: Early Days of Space Science, NASA SP-4211
298
SourceNotes
(Washington, 1980), pp. 292-93. To this day Shoemaker insists that his intent was grossly mis-
understood: "What I was trying to do," he told the author, "was to get people to focus on some-
thing they were losing on this thing, but I never got the point across.'" He and a few others thought
the point was, "'let's make the astronaut himself an instrument of scientific discovery," which
could not be done by slavishly following preplanned operations. "The sample scientists didn't
give a damn, frankly, whether the astronauts discovered something or not; they were going to
discover something with the samples that came back, you see. * * * As far as I'm concerned,
the kinds of things you could discover, by human observer, under the constraints of
Apollo .... [have not] been touched. If you could get me a spacecraft tomorrow, I've got the
whole program.., in my head .... and it's still there [on the moon]. All you need to get me
is a hand lens and a shovel .... There's three and a half billion years of history in three meters
[10 feet] of dirt.., on the lunar surface, and . . . we haven't even touched it yet." Shoemaker
interview, Mar. 17, 1984. Since Shoemaker did not make this point central to his public remarks,
it is not surprising that his former colleagues in NASA were affronted.
57. "Scientists vs. NASA," unsigned editorial in the New York Times, Aug. 12, 1969.
58. "Before We Start to Mars," unsigned editorial in the Washington Post, Aug. 8, 1969.
59. Fred L. Whipple to George E. Mueller, Aug. 1, 1969.
60. Alex J. Dessler, "Discontent of Space-Science Community," Oct. 30, 1969, paper written for
unknown purpose, copy in box 075-36, JSC History Office files.
61. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere, pp. 213, 221-22. The fact was that no eminent research scientist
was willing to give up research for a career (or even a year's tenure) as a research administrator;
yet Whipple, Dessler, and other scientists continued to urge NASA to find such a person to man-
age the science programs. See Newell, chap. 12 ("Who Decides?"). A similar problem arose in
the life sciences program; see John A. Pitts, The Human Factor: Biomedicine in the Manned Space
Program to 1980, NASA SP-4213 (Washington, 1985), passim.
62. John Lannan, "Money, Space, Environment Dominate Scientists' Parley," Washington Evening
Star, Dec. 27, 1969; "Scientists Hit Threat to Cut 4 Apollo Flights," Boston Sunday Globe, Dec.
28, 1969; "Technology Misused, Radicals Charge," Washington Post, Dec. 29, 1969. An expres-
sion of the plight of science in 1969 and the evil effects of military-sponsored research is found
in "Support of Science on the University's Own Terms," by Gerard Piel (publisher of Scientific
American), Science 166 (1969): 1101.
63. Mueller to Gilruth, Sept. 3, 1969.
64. James R. Arnold to A. J. Calio, "Apollo 12 Recommendations," Sept. 5, 1969; Arnold to Calio,
"Display of Sample Information in the LRL," Sept. 6, 1969.
65. Paul W. Gast to Calio, "Dry Nz Facility as a primary ALSRC Receiving and Handling System,"
Sept. 8, 1969; LSAPT to W. N. Hess, "Minutes of LSAPT dated March 13, 1969," Mar. 21, 1969;
Gast to LRL Management and Mission Review Board, no subject, Aug. 8, 1969.
66. E. C. T. Chao and R. L. Smith to Hess, "Recommendations and Suggestions for Preliminary Exami-
nation of Apollo 12 Returned Lunar Samples," Sept. 8, 1969.
67. R. S. Johnston to P. R. Bell and W. W. Kemmerer, Jr., "Apollo 12 Sterile Nitrogen Processing,"
Sept. 22, 1969.
68. Johnston to NASA Hqs., attn.: Maj. Gen. J. W. Humphreys, "Apollo 12 Back Contamination
Program Plan," Oct. 7, 1969; Johnston to Mgr., Command and Service Modules, Apollo Space-
craft Program, "Requirement for Installation of a Postlanding Vent Valve Back Contamination
Filter on CM's 108 and Subsequent," Sept. 18, 1969.
69. Johnston to the record, "Apollo 12 Back Contamination Program," Sept. 17, 1969.
70. Apollo 12 Crew Training Summaries, Aug. 15, Sept. 15, Nov. 14, 1969, folder in box 081-14,JSC
History Office.
71. Harrison H. Schmitt interview, May 30, 1984.
72. Manned Space Flight Weekly Reports, Apr. 1, July 1, Sept. 15, Nov. 10, 1969; Charles D. Benson
and William Barnaby Faherty, Moonport: A History of Apollo Launch Facilities and Operations, NASA
SP-4204 (Washington, 1978), pp. 480-81.
299
Where No Man Has Gone Before
CHAPTER 11
1. Charles D. Benson and William Barnaby Faherty, Moonport: A History of Apollo Launch Facilities
and Operations, NASA SF-204 (Washington, 1978), pp. 481-82.
2. Ibid.
3. MSC, "Apollo 12 Technical Air-to-Ground Voice Transcription," prepared for Data Logistics Office,
Test Div., Apollo Spacecraft Program Office, Nov. 1969 (cited hereinafter as "12 Air-to-Ground"),
p. 17; MSC, "Apollo 12 Mission Report," MSC-01855, March 1970, pp. 14-2 to 14-4.
Postflight analysis of available data supported the first tentative conclusion. Electric-field mea-
surements at the launch site indicated that the clouds were charged, but not enough to produce
lightning. The passage of a conductor (such as the launch vehicle) is known to produce lightning
under such conditions. Witnesses disagreed on the question of lightning strikes, but photographs
showed two bolts from cloud to ground 36.5 seconds after launch, neither of which produced
damage. The second discharge, 52 seconds after launch, was probably between clouds. See
MSC-01540, "Analysis of Apollo 12 Lightning Incident," Feb. 1970. Damage to the launch vehi-
cle was negligible (several telemetry sensors on the service module were knocked out), but launch
rules were subsequently tightened to forbid launch under weather conditions favorable to light-
ning strikes.
4. 12 Air-to-Ground, p. 24.
5. Apollo 12 Mission Report, p. 5-4.
6. Ibid., p. 5-5.
7. 12 Air-to-Ground, p. 292.
8. Ibid., pp. 281-92.
9. Ibid., pp. 292-322.
10. Apollo 12 Mission Report, pp. 5-7 to 5-8.
11. 12 Air-to-Ground, pp. 335-45; Apollo 12 Mission Report, p. 5-9.
12. 12 Air-to-Ground, pp. 346-68; Apollo 12 Mission Report, p. 6-3.
13. 12 Air-to-Ground, pp. 348-68.
14. Apollo 12 Mission Report, pp. 4-25 to 4-27.
15. 12 Air-to-Ground, pp. 370-73.
16. Ibid., pp. 406-11.
17. Ibid., pp. 418-26; Apollo 12 Mission Report, p. 14-50.
18. 12 Air-to-Ground, pp. 429-60.
19. Apollo 12 Mission Report, p. 3-26; 12 Air-to-Ground, pp. 438-73.
20. 12 Air-to-Ground, pp. 473-521. Neil Armstrong and Buzz Aldrin had difficulty finding a way
to sleep comfortably in the cramped LM. Hammocks were added on Apollo 12 and Bean and Conrad
found them quite comfortable in lunar gravity.
21. 12 Air-to-Ground, pp. 553-89.
22. Ibid., pp. 597-716.
23. The Lunar and Planetary Missions Board recommended in early 1968 that astronauts should talk
as much as possible ("almost incessant talking," as the Board put it) while on the lunar surface,
describing what they were doing, what they could see and how they interpreted it, and what
they intended to do next and why, to provide a complete record of their surface activity. Homer
E. Newell to Robert R. Gilruth, Feb. 5, 1968. MSC agreed in principle only, suggesting that the
astronauts observe the tried and proven rules of aircraft communications, transmitting only neces-
sary information while at the same time making an effort to provide "a running commentary
of significant events and actions so preplanned that normal communications discipline is not vio-
lated but yet is complete enough to assure a maximum of scientific return from the exercise."
That kind of commentary would be "comparable to the usual field notes of the practicing geolo-
gist on a field trip." Gilruth to Newell, Feb. 20, 1968; W. N. Hess to Special Asst. to the Dir.,
"Astronaut Activity on Lunar Surface," Feb. 19, 1968.
3OO
Source Notes
301
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
51. Victor Cohn, "Same Chemical Origin Seen for Earth, Moon," Washington Post, Jan. 7, 1970; "Sum-
mary of Apollo 11 Lunar Science Conference" (prepared by the Lunar Sample Preliminary Exami-
nation Team), Science 167 (1970): 449-51. The entire January 30 issue of Science was given over
to the papers resulting from studies on the Apollo 11 samples (see Chap. 9), requiring some extraor-
dinary effort in reviewing and editing. Manuscripts were received the first week in January, refereed
and revised during the next two weeks, and the issue was printed three weeks later. See Philip
H. Abelson, "The Moon Issue," ibid., p. 447, and "Acknowledgements," ibid., p 781. Revised
and expanded versions of the papers presented at the conference were published in Proceedings
of the Apollo 11 Lunar Science Conference (3 vols.), A. A. Levinson, ed. (New York and London:
Pergamon Press, 1970).
52. '"Summary of Apollo 11 Lunar Science Conference"; Wilford, "Lunar Churning Surmised From
Samples of Rock," New York Times, Jan. 7, 1970.
53."Summary of Apollo 11 Lunar Science Conference."
54. James C. Tanner, "Moon Rocks' Age Put at 4.6 Billion Years, Much Older Than Any Found on
the Earth," Wall Street Journal, Jan. 6, 1970.
55. Wilford, "Apollo Conference Ends With a Wealth of Data but an Unclear Picture of Lunar Ori-
gin," New York Times, Jan. 9, 1970; Tanner, "Moon Scientists End Their Session Today, But Many
Questions Remain Unanswered," Wail Street Journal, Jan. 8, 1970.
56. "Summary of Apollo 11 Lunar Science Conference."
57. George E. Mueller to Administrator, "Manned Space Flight Weekly Report," Dec. 15, 1969.
58. James A. McDivitt to multiple addressees, "Apollo Experiments Review Group," Jan. 6, 1970.
59. Homer E. Newell, "Conference Report, February 5, 1970, Lunar Science Institute, Houston, Texas,
Subject: Critique of Apollo Lunar Missions and the Maximization of Scientific Returns for the
Remaining Apollo Flights," Feb. 6, 1970.
60. Ibid.
61. Newell to Gilruth, Feb. 6, 1970.
62. Calio to PA/Mgr., Apollo Spacecraft Program, "Lunar Surface Science Requirements," Mar. 27,
1970; Calio to multiple addressees, "Science Mission Manager and Mission Scientist Assignments
for Apollo 13 and 14," Apr. 6, 1970; Calio to TJ/James H. Sasser [and others], "Science Working
Panel," June 4, 1970.
63. Eugene F. Kranz to TM/Acting Mgr., Lunar Missions Office, "Science Briefings for Flight Crews,"
Apr. 23, 1970.
64. NeweU, Beyond the Atmosphere: Early Years of Space Science, NASA SP-4211 (Washington, 1980),
p. 293.
65. National Archives and Records Service, Weekly Compilation of Presidential Documents, Nov. 17, 1969,
p. 1597; NASA Releases 69-151, Nov. 10, 1969, and 70-4, Jan. 8, 1970; NASA Announcement,
Aug. 31, 1969; MSC Releases 69-66, Sept. 25, 1969, and 69-70, Nov. 26, 1969; Thomas O'Toole,
"Petrone, Launch Director at Cape, Promoted to Head Apollo Project," Washington Post, Aug.
23, 1969; "Mueller Leaves NASA Dec. 10; Paine Lauds His Apollo Role," ibid., Nov. 11, 1969.
66. NASA Release, Jan. 15, 1969.
67. Presidential Documents, Mar. 21, 1969; NASA Budget Briefing, Apr. 15, 1969, transcript.
68. Presidential Documents, Dec. 1, 1969.
69. Space Task Group, The Post-Apollo Space Program: Directions for the Future, report to the President,
Sept. 15, 1969.
70. "Nixon Backs Mars Flight but Rejects All-Out Drive," New York Times, Sept. 16, 1969.
71. "Before We Start to Mars," unsigned editorial in the Washington Post, Aug. 8, 1969.
72. Victor K. McElheny, "NASA Adviser: Sending Men to Mars 'Utmost Folly'," Boston Globe, Dec.
19, 1969; Cohn, "Cut in Space Program Urged," Washington Post, Dec. 29, 1969.
73. U.S., Congress, House, Toward the Endless Frontier: History of the Committee on Science and Technol-
ogy, 1959-79 [by Ken Hechler] (Washington: U.S. Govt. Printing Office, 1980), p. 269.
74. "Apollo Missions Extended to '74,'" New York Times, Jan. 5, 1970; "Experts Hail Schedule for
Moon Trips," Washington Post, Jan. 6, 1970. Rumors that four Apollo missions might be canceled
circulated in late 1969; see O'Toole, "Nixon to Give Space Goals; Modest Program Expected,"
Washington Post, Dec. 22, 1969; "Scientists hit threat to cut 4 Apollo flights," Boston Sunday Globe,
Dec. 28, 1969. For the effects of budget cuts on Skylab, see W. David Compton and Charles D.
Benson, Living and Working in Space: A History of Skylab, NASA SP-4208 (Washington, 1983),
Chap. 4.
302
Source Notes
75. Richard D. Lyons, "50,000 NASA Jobs to Be Eliminated," New York Times, Jan. 14, 1970; O'Toole,
"Cutbacks Planned by NASA," Washington Post, Jan. 14, 1970.
76. Astronauts and Aeronautics, I970: Chronology on Science, Technology, and Policy, NASA SP-4015
(Washington, 1972) p. 203.
77. Toward the Endless Frontier, pp. 313-14.
78. Mueller to Administrator, "Manned Space Flight Weekly Report," Dec. 15, 1969; Dale D. Myers
to Administrator, "Manned Space Flight Weekly Report," Jan. 19, 1970.
79. NASA Release 70-5, Jan. 8, 1970.
80. Calio to Mgr., Apollo Spacecraft Program, "Recommendations for Science Sites for Apollo Mis-
sions 13-20," Oct. 20, 1969.
81. MSC, "Apollo 13 Mission Report," MSC-02680, Sept. 1970, p. 12-2 and App. A, p. A-2.
82. The best account of Apollo 13 is that of Henry S. F. Cooper, 13: The Flight That Failed (New York:
Dial Press, 1973), a taut narrative that captures the flavor of the entire mission. For a first-person
account by a participant, see mission commander James A. Lovell's chapter, "Houston, We've
Had A Problem," in Apollo Expeditions to the Moon, Edgar M. Cortright, ed., NASA SP-350
(Washington, 1975). A brief summary of the mission and the investigation is given in Benson
and Faherty, Moonport, pp. 489-94. Headquarters' Public Affairs Office prepared a 25-page book-
let on the flight, "Houston, we've got a problem," NASA EP-76 (Washington, 1970). A concise
summary of the constraints faced by. flight controllers and the rationale for the real-time deci-
sions made during Apollo 13 was presented by Glynn S. Lunney, one of 13's flight directors,
as AIAA Paper No. 70-1260, "Discussion of Several Problem Areas During the Apollo 13 Opera-
tion," at the AIAA 7th Annual Meeting and Technical Display, Houston, Oct. 19-22, 1970. The
Report of the Apollo 13 RevL,,w Board, a summary volume and eight technical appendices, was released
two months after the accident. It contains full technical details of the causes of the accident as
deduced from inflight telemetry, the history of the faulty tank, and tests performed to support
the investigation. Board chairman Edgar M. Cortright presented the board's findings to the House
space committee on June 16, 1970; see House, The Apollo 13 Accident, hearings before the Com-
mittee on Science and Astronautics, 91/2, June 16, 1970.
83. Apollo 13 Mission Report, pp. 11-9 to 11-10.
CHAPTER 12
1. U.S. Congress, House Committee on Science and Astronautics, 1971 NASA Authorization, Hear-
ings on H.R. 15695, 9112, Feb. 1970, vol. 1, pp. 2-38; W. David Compton and Charles D. Benson,
Living and Working in Space: A History of Skylab, NASA SP-4208 (washington, 1983), pp. 115-16.
2. Idem, 1971 NASA Authorization, vol. 1, p. 7. The Electronics Research Center (ERC) in Cambridge,
Mass., proposed in 1963, had provoked serious opposition from the start. Nonetheless, ERC was
approved and began operation in 1965 while permanent buildings were being constructed. By
late 1969, when ERC was abolished, some $80 million had been invested in buildings and equip-
ment. The facility was transferred to the Department of Transportation in March 1970. See House
Committee on Science and Technology, Toward the Endless Frontier: History of the Committee on
Science and Technology, 1959-79 (washington: U.S. Govt. Printing Office, 1980), pp. 219-31.
3. Thomas O'Toole, "3 Apollo Cancellations Weighed for Big Skylab," Washington Post, July 9, 1970.
4. National Archives and Records Service, Weekly Compilation of Presidential Documents, Aug. 17, 1970,
pp. 1056-57; cited in NASA, Astronautics and Aeronautics, 1970, p. 263.
5. Thomas O'Toole, "NASA Head Quits, Plans to Rejoin GE," Washington Post, July 29, 1970; Richard
D. Lyons, "Paine Quits Post in Space Agency," New York Times, July 29, 1970.
6. NASA, "FY 1971 Interim Operating Plan News Conference," Sept. 2, 1970, transcript; Thomas
O'Toole, "2 Moon Landings Canceled by NASA," Washington Post, Sept. 3, 1970.
7. "FY 1971 Interim Operating Plan News Conference." One Saturn V was earmarked for the launch
of Skylab; later NASA built a backup Skylab orbital workshop and committed another Saturn
V to launch it. Never used, the workshop is now in the National Air and Space Museum and
its launch vehicle was put on exhibit at Kennedy Space Center. The third Saturn V is on display
303
Where No Man Has Gone Before
at the Johnson Space Center beside a Mercury-Redstone--relics of the heroic age of manned space
flight; John E. Naugle to Dir., JSC, "Disposition of Residual Apollo Hardware," June 17, 1977.
8. "Retreat From the Moon," New York Times, Sept. 4, 1970.
9. Richard D. Lyons, "Scientists Decry Moon Flight Cut," New York Times, Sept. 4, 1970, and "New
Cuts For Apollo: 'No Gas for The Rolls Royce?'," ibid., Sept. 6, 1970.
10. Harold C. Urey, Washington Post, Sept. 17, 1970.
11. Gerald J. Wasserburg, Los Angeles Times, Sept. 15, 1970. "Return to the dark ages of planetary
science" seems to overstate the consequences of canceling two lunar exploration missions, but
as a veteran observer of science politics noted, scientists were insecure about financial support
and inclined to rhetorical extravagance when lamenting cutbacks in funding: "they recognize
no territory between paradise and hell." Daniel S. Greenberg, "Mr. President Meets Mr. Wiz-
ard," Washington Post, Dec. 6, 1976.
12. Edward Clinton Ezell and Linda Neuman Ezell, On Mars: Exploration of the Red Planet 1958-1978,
NASA SP-4212, pp. 185-92. See also House, Toward The Endless Frontier, pp. 272-76.
13. Compton and Benson, Living and Working in Space, pp. 182-85.
14. Letter to George P. Miller, signed by 39 lunar scientists, Sept. 10, 1970, copy included in House
Committee on Science and Astronautics press release, Sept. 21, 1970.
15. Miller to multiple addressees, Sept. 21, 1970, House Committee on Science and Astronautics press
release, Sept. 21, 1970.
16. Rocco A. Petrone to multiple addressees, "Apollo Site Selection Board Minutes of Meeting,'"
Mar. 16, 1970; James A. McDivitt to multiple addressees, "Apollo Site Selection Board Meeting
March 6, 1970"; Myers to Administrator, "Manned Space Flight Weekly Report--March 9, 1970,"
Mar. 9, 1970.
17. Calio to Mgr., Apollo Spacecraft Program, "Site Selections for Apollo Missions 14 and 15," May
8, 1970.
18. U.S. Congress, Senate, Apollo 13 Mission Review, Hearings before the Committee on Aeronautical
and Space Sciences, 91/2, June 30, 1970, p. 52; "Apollo 13 Rescheduled," NASA Release 70-5,
Jan. 8, 1970; John Noble Wilford, "Apollo 14 to Use Cart on the Moon," New York Times, Jan.
20, 1970; Richard D. Lyons, "NASA and 2 Companies Blamed for Apollo Blast," New York Times,
June 16, 1970.
19. Bendix Corp., Mission Assignments, "Apollo Lunar Surface Experiments Package (ALSEP),'"
no date [c. Dec. 1970], box 079-51, JSC History Office files.
20. "New Labor-Saving device: the MSC 'Rickshaw,"' MSC Roundup, Jan. 30, 1970.
21. MSC-03465-Rev. A, "Flight Crew Health Stabilization Program," Oct. 26, 1970; "MSC Flight Read-
iness Review, Apollo 14," part IV, Dec. 11, 1970, pp. 13-14; "Crew Health Stabilization Plan
Announced for Apollo 14," MSC Roundup, Oct. 9, 1970.
22. "MSC Flight Readiness Review, Apollo 14," part IV, pp. 27, 31-34; MSC-04112, "Apollo 14 Mis-
sion Report," May 1971, pp. 10-14 to 10-15.
23. Benson and Faherty, Moonport, pp. 494-96.
24. Myers to Administrator, "Manned Space Flight Weekly Report--January 11, 1971," Jan. 11, 1971.
25. Benson and Faherty, Moonport, p. 499.
26. MSC, "Apollo 14 Mission Report," MSC-04112, May 1971, pp. 1-1, 9-3, 14-1 to 14-5.
27. Ibid., p. 3-19.
28. Ibid., p. 6-2.
29. Ibid., pp. 6-2, 6-7.
30. MSC, "Apollo 14 Technical Air-to-Ground Voice Transcription" (hereinafter cited as "14 Air-to-
Ground"), pp. 400-401.
31. 14 Air-to-Ground, p. 449.
32. Ibid., pp. 449-531, 535-54, 575-85.
33. Ibid., pp. 637-68; MSC, "Apollo 14 Technical Crew Debriefing," Feb. 17, 1971, pp. 10-35 to 10-36,
10-50 to 10-57.
34. "Apollo 14 Mission Report," p. 1-2.
35. 14 Air-to-Ground, p. 723; "Moon Trip Prescribed For Golf Ills," Washington Post, Feb. 18, 1971.
Shepard's golf club was fashioned at his request by technicians in MSC's Technical Services Divi-
sion. According to Jack Kinzler, chief of Technical Services, it was "bootlegged" through the
shops because no one wanted to draw high-level managerial attention to it.
36. "'Apollo 14 Mission Report," p. 4-4, 4-5.
304
Source Notes
3O5
Where No Man Has Gone Before
63. NASA Release 69-115, Aug. 7, 1969; Thomas O'Toole, "Veteran Astronauts Lovell, Shepard to
Lead '70 Moon Flights," Washington Post, Aug. 7, 1969; "Before We Start to Mars, ibid., Aug.
8, 1969.
64. Paul Recer (Associated Press), "They Feud Over Moon Flights," The Miami Herald, Aug. 18, 1969.
65. B. J. Richey, "Lunar Landing Teams Are Unlikely To Include Scientists Until 1971,'" St. Louis Globe-
Democrat, Aug. 18, 1969.
66. Richard Witkin, "Scientist Expected to Be Picked for Moon Trip," New York Times, Dec. 12, 1969.
67. NASA Release 70-46, "Apollo 15 Crew Selected," Mar. 26, 1970.
68. Harrison H. Schmitt interview, May 30, 1984.
69. Homer E. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere: Early Years of Space Science, NASA SP-4211 (Washington,
1980), p. 210; handwritten notes on meetings with scientist-astronauts, Houston, Jan. 12-13, 1971,
in Newell's notebook, box 28 of the Newell files stored in the Federal Records Center, Suitland,
Md., accession no. 255-79-0649; Newell to Dr. Fletcher, July 21, 1971.
70. Ibid.
71. Dale D. Myers to Charles H. Townes, Mar. 1, 1971.
72. Compton and Benson, Living and Working in Space, p. 220.
73. NASA Release 71-31, "Apollo 16 Crew Selected," Mar. 3, 1971.
74. A. P. Vinogradov, "Preliminary Data on Lunar Ground Brought to Earth by Automatic Probe
Luna-16,' "' in Proceedings of the Second Lunar Science Conference, A. A. Levinson, ed. (Cambridge:
MIT Press, 1971), pp. 1-16.
75. Norman J. Hubbard and Paul W. Gast, "Chemical composition and origin of nonmare lunar
basalts," ibid., pp. 999-1020; John Noble Wilford, "Exotic Fragments Found In Apollo Lunar
Samples," New York Times, Jan. 11, 1971.
76. Wilford, "Exotic Fragments"; Ursula B. Marvin, J. A. Wood, G. J. Taylor, J. B. Reid, Jr., B. N.
Powell, J. S. Dickey, Jr., and J. F. Bower, "Relative Proportions and Probable Sources of Rock
Fragments in the Apollo 12 Samples," Proceedings of the Second Lunar Science Conference, pp. 679-99.
77. Arthur Hill, "Primitive Lunar Crust Is Hinted by Fragments," Houston Chronicle, Jan. 11, 1971.
78. Cappellari, "Where on the Moon?", pp. 990-94.
79. Earl H. Arnold, "Minutes, Interagency Committee on Back Contamination, January 15, 1970."
80. Space Science Board, National Academy of Sciences, "Report of Meeting on Review of Lunar
Quarantine Program, February 17, 1970."
81. J. W. Humphreys, Jr., to Dir., Apollo Program, "Quarantine for Apollo 14 and Subs," July 16, 1970.
82. Humphreys, TWX to multiple addressees, "Discontinuation of Lunar Quarantine," Apr. 28, 1971;
Myers to MSC Director, "Decision to Terminate Quarantine," May 10, 1971 with encl., "Deci-
sion to Terminate Quarantine Under NMI 1052.90 (Attachment A, Change 1, 2)," signed by George
M. Low, Apr. 26, 1971.
CHAPTER 13
306
Source Notes
307
Where No Man Has Gone Before
judgment" and "their actions will be given due consideration in their selection for future assign-
ments." Harold M. Schmeck, Jr., "Apollo 15 Crew Is Reprimanded,'" New York Times, July 12,
1972; "Apollo 15 'Postmen' Officially Reprimanded," Houston Post, July 12, 1972; "Postmark:
The Moon," Newsweek, July 24, 1972; Thomas O'Toole, "Ex-Astronauts Disregarded Warning
Against 'Souvenirs'," Washington Post, Aug. 1, 1972. The Senate space committee looked into
the matter, concluded that no laws had been violated, and took no action. They discovered that
unauthorized items had been taken on other lunar landing missions as well. Richard D. Lyons,
"Astronauts and Space Officials Heard At Inquiry on Exploitation of Souvenirs," New York Times,
Aug. 4, 1972. The results of NASA's own investigation were publicized in an 18-page press release,
NASA Release 72-189, "Articles Carried on Manned Space Flights," Sept. 15, 1972, which stated
that the astronauts' "official Efficiency Reports as military officers reflect a formal finding of
lack of judgment," and also noted changes in NASA Regulations that were promulgated to pre-
vent recurrence of such embarrassing incidents.
The incident caused an uproar among American philatelists. The journal of the American Phila-
telic Society carried two reports of an investigation intended to make known exactly what hap-
pened, so that collectors would be aware of the possibilities of fraud. Lester E. Winick, "Report
on Apollo 15 Covers--Smuggled and Authorized," The American Philatelist 86(10) (1972):887-95,
and '"Lookalike' Apollo 15 Covers Prompt Philatelists' Caution," Bid., 86(11) (Nov. 1972):992-98.
40. 15 Air-to-Ground, p. 1142. Scott correctly credited Galileo Galilei (1564-1642), Italian astronomer
and physicist, with the deduction that bodies of different weight should fail with the same velocity
in the absence of air resistance. He would have been more accurate to assign the credit for get-
ting him to the moon to Sir Isaac Newton (1642-1727), who first formulated the laws that gov-
ern the motion of a body moving in a gravitational field and provided a mathematical basis for
Galileo's hypothesis. Only with the development of high-speed electronic computers, however,
was it possible to solve the equations for the motion of a spacecraft with sufficient accuracy to
allow Scott to land at a specific spot on the plain at Hadley. The only notice taken of Scott's
demonstration, other than press reports, was in the preliminary science report. Joe Allen, con-
cluding a paper summarizing the scientific results, noted that the result was "predicted by well-
established theory, but [was] nonetheless reassuring considering.., that the homeward jour-
ney was based critically on the validity of the particular theory being tested." Apollo 15 Prelimi-
nary Science Report, NASA SP-289 (Washington, 1972), p. 2-11.
41. Fred Farrar, "Astronauts Leave Moon, Link Up with Mother Ship," Chicago Tribune, Aug. 3,
1971; Apollo 15 Mission Report, pp. 14-71 to 14-72.
42. Tom Wicker, "Man and the Moon," New York Times, Aug. 3, 1971.
43. Apollo 15 Mission Report, p. 1-3.
44. Ibid., p. 1-4; John Noble Wilford, "Worden Ventures Outside the Cabin of Apollo Craft," New
York Times, Aug. 6, 1971.
45. O'Toole, "Apollo 15 Lands Hard but Safely," Washington Post, Aug. 8, 1971; Apollo 15 Mission
Report, pp. 1-4, 14-17 to 14-21.
46. Apollo 15 Preliminary Examination Team, "The Apollo 15 Lunar Samples: A Preliminary Descrip-
tion," Science 175 (1972):363-75.
47. Gerald Wasserburg to Robert R. Gilruth, Aug. 9, 1971.
48. Larry A. Haskin to Gilruth, Aug. 5, 1971.
49. "Apollo 15 Science Briefing, Manned Spacecraft Center, August 11, 1971, 3:30 PM (CDT)."
50. "The Apollo 15 Lunar Samples"; Petrone to multiple addressees, "Report of Preliminary Scientific
Results of Apollo 15," Sept. 28, 1971, with encl., "Preliminary Scientific Results of Apollo 15
(As of September 24, 1971)."
51. "The Apollo 15 Lunar Samples."
52. I. Adler, J. Trombka, J. Gerard, R. Schmadebeck, P. Lowman, H. Blodgett, L. Yin, E. Eller,
R. Lamothe, P. Gorenstein, and P. Bjorkholm, "X-Ray Fluorescence Experiment, Preliminary
Report," Goddard Space Flight Center X-641-71-421, October 1971.
53. Gilruth to Myers, TWX, Aug. 31, 1971.
54. "Distribution of Apollo 15 Lunar Samples,'" NASA Release 71-223, Nov. 9, 1971.
55. NASA Release 71-149, "Apollo 17 Crew Named," Aug. 13, 1971.
56. Donald K. Slayton interview, Oct. 15, 1984.
57. Jim Maloney, "'A new goal for dropped astronaut," Houston Post, Sept. 8, 1971.
308
Source Notes
58. MSC, "Apollo 17 Crew Press Conference, Manned Spacecraft Center, August 19, 1971, 10:00
AM (CDT)," transcript; Reuters, "Geologist Defends Selection of Him for Moon Flight," New
York Times, Aug. 20, 1971.
59. N. W. Hinners, "Apollo 16 Site Selection," in Apollo 16 Preliminary Science Report, prepared by
NASA MSC, NASA SP-315 (Washington, 1972).
60. Petrone to Mgr., Apollo Spacecraft Program, MSC, "Selection of Landing Sites for Apollo 16
and 17," Mar. 11, 1971; Lee R. Scherer to multiple addressees, "Apollo 16 and 17 Site Selection
Discussions," May 5, 1971, with encl., "Minutes of the Ad Hoc Site Selection Committee Meet-
ing on Preliminary Apollo 16 and 17 Site Selection Discussions," Apr. 14, 1971; Harold C. Urey
to Hinners, May 11, 1971; James R. Arnold to Scherer, May 13, 1971; Paul W. Gast to Dir., Apollo
Lunar Exploration, "Site for Apollo 16," May 14, 1971; John A. O'Keefe to Hinners, May 14, 1971.
61. Petrone, TWX to multiple addressees, subject: Apollo 16 Landing Site, June 10, 1971; James A.
McDivitt to multiple addressees, "Apollo 16 Landing Site," June 11, 1971.
62. MSC, "Apollo 16 Mission Report," MSC-07230, Aug. 1972, pp. 12-1, A-7 to A-22; Richard R.
Baldwin, "Mission Description," in Apollo 16 Preliminary Science Report.
63. Apollo 16 Mission Report, pp. 3-1, 3-2.
64. Baldwin, "Mission Description." The cable incident was the first to knock out an experiment,
but every mission had experienced similar problems with cables that would not lie fiat on the
lunar surface. Furthermore, the space suits did not permit astronauts to see their own feet.
Nonetheless, it caused one columnist to splutter, '" . . . what we have been watching [is not]
science. Those two klutzes up there on the moon, bumping into each other, unable to repair
what their clumsiness has damaged, didn't look like scientists or lab technicians even. They
looked like.., a couple of miscast wahoo military officers." Nicholas von Hoffman, "Two Klutzes
On the Moon," Washington Post, Apr. 24, 1972. Von Hoffman was rather hyperbolically protest-
ing the continuation of Apollo and the amount of time devoted to coverage of the missions by
the television networks.
65. Apollo 16 Mission Report, p. 1-3; O'Toole, "90-Lb. Scientific Satellite Crashes On Moon, Ends
Study 47 Weeks Early," Washington Post, May 31, 1972.
66. Apollo 16 Mission Report, pp. 5-20 to 5-21, 3-9; Baldwin, "Mission Description."
67. O'Toole, "Scientists Think Apollo 16 Rocks Most Important Haul Yet," Washington Post, Apr.
30, 1972.
68. Idem, "Metallic Iron in Rocks Baffles Moon Scientists," ibid., May 17, 1972; "Moon Theory
Upset By Study of Rocks Astronauts Gathered," Wall Street Journal, May 17, 1972.
69. Hinners, "Apollo 16 Site Selection."
70. Allen L. Hammond, "Lunar Research: No Agreement on Evolutionary Models," Science 175
(1972):868-70.
71. Wilford, "Apollo 17 Crew to Seek Questions for Answers Found by Previous Moon Flights,"
New York Times, Nov. 12, 1972.
72. Bruce R. Doe to Homer E. Newell, Oct. 18, 1971.
73. Petrone to multiple addressees, "Apollo 17 Site Selection," Oct. 28, 1971.
74. N. W. Hinners to Capt. W. T. O'Bryant, "A.S.S.B. Minutes," March 23, 1972; O'Toole, "Moon
Landing Site Chosen For the Last Apollo Flight," Washington Post, Feb. 17, 1972.
75. Hinners to O'Bryant, "A.S.S.B. Minutes"; idem, "Apollo 17 Site Selection," in Apollo 17 Prelimi-
nary Science Report, NASA SP-330 (Washington, 1973), pp. 1-1 to 1-5; John R. Sevier, interview,
Apr. 24, 1986.
76. T. McGetchin and J. W. Head, "Lunar Cinder Cones," Bellcomm paper, Aug. 4, 1972; Apollo
15 Preliminary Science Report, p. 25-17.
77. OMSF, "Mission Operation Report, Apollo 17 Mission," report no. M-933-72-17, Nov. 8, 1972;
"Apollo 17 Site Selection," NASA Release 72-44, Feb. 16, 1972; Harrison H. Schmitt, "Apollo
17 Report on the Valley of Taurus-Littrow," Science 182 (1972):681-90; Apollo 17 Preliminary
Examination Team, "Apollo 17 Lunar Samples: Chemical and Petrographic Description," ibid.,
pp. 659-72.
78. McDivitt to multiple addressees, "Apollo launch dates," Feb. 22, 1971.
79. John O. Cappellari, ed., "Where on the Moon? An Apollo Systems Engineering Problem," Bell
System Technical Journal 51(5) (May-June 1972):1033-45.
309
Where No Man Has Gone Before
80. Hinners to O'Bryant, "A.S.S.B. Minutes," Feb. 11, 1972; Petrone, TWX to McDivitt, subject:
"Apollo 13 March Launch Window," Dec. 4, 1969; GiIruth, TWX to Petrone, subject: "Night
Launches," Jan. 28, 1970.
81. McDivitt to multiple addressees, "Apollo 17 Landing Site,'" Feb. 23, 1972.
82. JSC, "Apollo 17 Mission Report," JSC-07904, March 1973, p. 14-1; Benson and Faherty, Moon-
port, pp. 522-26.
83. Apollo 17 Mission Report, p. 1-1.
84. Ibid., p. 3-2.
85. Ibid., pp. 1-1 to 1-2; Schmitt, "Apollo 17 Report on the Valley of Taurus-Littrow."
86. MSC, "Apollo 17 Technical Air-to-Ground Voice Transcription," Dec. 1972 (hereinafter cited
as "17 Air-to-Ground"), tape 76A, pp. 4-8, tape 77A, p. 34, 39-41. This transcript is paginated
by tape number; tape numbers run sequentially in three series, A, B, and undesignated, cor-
responding to communication with the lunar module (A) and the command module (B) when
the two were separated, and with the command module when all three crewmen were aboard
before and after separation (undesignated).
87. Schmitt, "Apollo 17 Report," p. 682.
88. Apollo 17 Mission Report, pp. 4-5 to 4-11.
89. 17 Air-to-Ground, pp. 91A/1-94A/25; Apollo 17 Mission Report, pp. 10-15 to 10-16; Apollo Field
Geology Investigation Team, "Geologic Exploration of Taurus-Littrow: Apollo 17 Landing Site,"
Science 182 (1973):672-80.
90. 17 Air-to-Ground, pp. 96A/8-96A/10.
91. Ibid., pp. 96A/11-96A/55.
92. Apollo 17 Mission Report, pp. 10-16 to 10-17.
93. Ibid.; 17 Air-to-Ground, pp. 112A/20-113A/1.
94. 17 Air-to-Ground, pp. 113A/1-3.
95. "Apollo 17 at Taurus-Littrow," NASA EP-102, p. 30.
96. Apollo 17 Mission Report, pp. 3-2, 12-4, 12-5.
97. Ibid., p. 1-3.
98. William Hines, "End of a crazy business," Chicago Sun-Times, Dec. 21, 1972. Hines went on
to castigate the Apollo project from concept to execution, and concluded by quoting Max Born,
Nobel laureate in physics, who had said in 1958 as the "space race" began, "Intellect distin-
guishes the possible from the impossible; reason distinguishes the sensible from the senseless.
Spaceflight is a triumph of intellect and a tragic failure of reason."
99. Christian Science Monitor, Dec. 21, 1972, cited in Astronautics and Aeronautics, 1972: Chronology
of Science, Technology and Policy, NASA SP-4017 (Washington, 1974), p. 440.
100. New York Times, Dec. 14, 1972, cited in Astronautics and Aeronautics, 1972, p. 429.
101. Time, Dec. 11, 1972, cited in Astronautics and Aeronautics, 1972, p. 424.
CHAPTER 14
1. W. David Compton and Charles D. Benson, Living and Working in Space: A History of Skylab, NASA
SP-4208 (Washington, "1983), p. 231, 247, 220.
2. Edward C. Ezell and Linda N. Ezell, The Partnership: A History of the Apollo-Soyuz Test Project,
NASA SP-4209 (Washington, 1978), p. 247; "ASTP Crew Named," MSC Roundup, Feb. 2, 1973.
3. "Moon Rocks Issued," ibid.
4. "Post-Apollo Lunar Science," Report of a study by the Lunar Science Institute, July 1972.
5. Minutes, Apollo Lunar Sample Analysis Planning Team meeting, Jan. 29-Feb. 2, 1973.
6. Ibid.
7. John Noble Wilford, "Expert Describes Lunar Cataclysm," New York Times, Mar. 6, 1973.
8. Robert Gillette and Allen L. Hammond, "Lunar Science: Letting Bygones be Bygones," Science
179 (1973):1309; Noel W. Hinners, TWX to A. J. Calio, "Outline of Dr. Low's Talk for 4th Lunar
Science Conference," Mar. 2, 1973.
310
Source Notes
9. Wilford, "Expert Describes Cataclysm"; Boyce Rensberger, "Moon Dead for 3 Billion Years, Experts
Say," New York Times, Feb. 16, 1973; J. C. Huneke, E. K. Jessberger, F. A. Podosek, and G. J.
Wasserburg, "'4°Ar/39Ar Measurements in Apollo 16 and 17 Samples and the Chronology of Meta-
morphic and Volcanic Activity in the Taurus-LittTow Region," Proceedings of the Fourth Lunar Science
Conference (New York: Pergamon Press, 1973), pp. 1724-56.
10. Minutes, Lunar Sample Analysis Planning Team meeting.
11. Hammond, "Lunar Science: Analyzing the Apollo Legacy," Science 179 (1973):1313-15.
12. Gillette and Hammond, "Lunar Science: Letting Bygones be Bygones."
13. Robert Jastrow, "Moon Still Is A Generally Silent Witness," New York Times, Mar. 24, 1974.
14. G.J. Wasserburg, "The Moon and Sixpence of Science,'" Astronautics and Aeronautics 10(4) (Apr.
1972):16-21.
15. Material in this and the next paragraph is a synthesis of information from several sources: "Plane-
tology," L. S. Walter, B. M. French, and P. D. Lowman, eds., in Significant Achievements in Space
Science, 1967, NASA SP-167 (Washington, 1968), pp. 326-52; Harold Urey, "The Contending
Moons," Astronautics and Aeronautics 7(1) (Jan. 1969):37-41; A. L. Turkevich, W. A. Anderson,
T. E. Economou, E. J. Franzgrote, H. E. Griffin, S. L. Grotch, J. H. Patterson, and K. P. Sowin-
ski, "The Alpha-Scattering Chemical Analysis Experiment on the Surveyor Lunar Missions,"
in Surveyor Program Results, NASA SP-184 (Washington, 1969), pp. 271-350; Wasserburg, "The
Moon and Sixpence of Science."
16. Gary V. Latham, Maurice Ewing, Frank Press, George Sutton, James Dorman, Yosio Nakamura,
Nail Toksoz, David Lammlein, and Fred Duennebier, "Passive Seismic Experiment," in Apollo 16
Preliminary Science Report, NASA SP-315 (Washington, 1972), p. 9-1. This massive chunk of rock
struck approximately 145 kilometers (90 miles) north of the Apollo 14 station on May 13, 1972.
17. Hammond, "Lunar Science: Analyzing the Apollo Legacy."
18. Ibid.; Wasserburg, "The Moon and Sixpence of Science."
19. Material in the following paragraphs is based primarily on Harrison H. Schmitt's summary, "'Evo-
lution of the Moon: The 1974 Model," in The Soviet-American Conference on Cosmochemistry of the
Moon and Planets, John H. Pomero and Norman J. Hubbard, eds., NASA SP-370 (Washington,
1977), pp. 63-80, and S. Ross Taylor's Lunar Science: A Post-Apollo View (New York: Pergamon
Press, 1975).
20. The Lunar Geoscience Working Group, Status and Future of Lunar Geoscience, NASA SP-484
(Washington, 1986), pp. 3-32. Members of this working group were: P. D. Spudis, U.S. Geolog-
ical Survey, chairman; B. R. Hawke, Univ. of Hawaii; L. L. Hood, Univ. of Arizona; P. H. Schultz,
Brown Univ.; G. J. Taylor, Univ. of New Mexico; and D. E. Wilhelms, U.S. Geological Survey.
This 54-page booklet provides a brief summary of the current understanding of the moon and
a prospectus for future lunar exploration (manned and unmanned). It also contains a 5-page scien-
tific bibliography covering recent work in lunar science.
21. Wasserburg, "The Moon and Sixpence of Science."
22. Ibid.
23. Ibid.
24. R. Cargill Hall, Lunar Impact: A History of Project Ranger, NASA SP-4210 (Washington, 1977), pp.
308-309.
25. L. D. Jaffe and others, "Principal Scientific Results From the Surveyor Program, in Surveyor Pro-
gram Results, NASA SP-184 (Washington, 1969), pp. 13-17. Wasserburg remarks ("The Moon
and Sixpence of Science") that with hindsight, the clues from Surveyor provided broad answers
to the question of the moon's internal structure.
26. Astronautics and Aeronautics, 1970: Chronology on Science, Technology, and Policy, NASA SP-4015
(Washington, 1972), pp. 52-53; ibid., 1972, NASA SP-4017 (Washington, 1974), pp. 52-53.
27. Wasserburg, "'The Moon and Sixpence of Science."
28. Courtney G. Brooks, James M. Grimwood, and Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., Chariots for Apollo: A His-
tory of Manned Lunar Spacecraft, NASA SP-4205 (Washington, 1979), p. xv.
29. Ibid., p. 31.
30. Homer E. Newell, Beyond the Atmosphere: Early Years of Space Science, NASA SP-4211 (Washing-
ton, 1980), p. 246. Newell also commented that the Houston center "developed an arrogance
born of unbounded self-confidence and possession of a leading role in the nation's number-one
space project, Apollo."
31. Ibid., pp. 204-205.
311
Where No Man Has Gone Before
36. A Review of Space Research, report of the Summer Study conducted under the auspices of the Space
Science Board of the National Academy of Sciences at the State University of Iowa, June 17-August
10, 1962, National Academy of Sciences-National Research Council Publication 1079 (Washing-
ton, 1962), p. 11-19. A questionnaire sent to several prominent scientists before the study sought
opinions on the place of scientists in manned space flight. To the question, "How do we develop
our astro-scientists?" the consensus of replies included the statement that qualified scientists
"should go through astronaut training for part of each year to become familiar with problems
of space flight. It is hoped that this would not involve too large a fraction of their time, since
emphasis should be on their development as scientists."
37. An unnamed Marshall Space Flight Center engineer paraphrased Slayton's attitude as, "it is easier
to teach an astronaut to pick up rocks than to teach a geologist to land on the moon." Minutes
of the combined MSFC staff and board meeting, Nov. 10, 1969. This statement should be read
alongside the scientists' estimate of the difficulties of space flight training cited in 36.
38. Harrison H. Schmitt interview, May 30, 1984. Elbert King, who was involved with crew training
for the earlier missions, confirmed Schmitt's evaluation of Armstrong's ability as an observer:
"Armstrong... never said much, was kind of quiet on field trips, and we really didn't know
how much of this he was soaking up .... It turned out that he had really picked up a lot of
it and was doing very well with it." Elbert H. King, Jr., interview with Loyd S. Swenson, Jr.,
May 27, 1971, tape in ]SC History Office files.
39. Schmitt interview.
40. See, for example, the report of a series of science workshops sponsored by NASA's Ames Research
Center, The Search for Extraterrestrial Intelligence: SETI, NASA SP-419 (Washington, 1977). One
group stated the central proposition this way: "The conclusion that the origin and evolution of
life is inextricably interwoven with the origin and evolution of the cosmos seems inescapable"
(p. 41). The question arose again in the Viking mission to Mars, which carried experiments designed
to detect life. Some sdentists, it seems, desperately wanted to detect life on Mars. See Edward
Clinton Ezell and Linda Neuman Ezell, On Mars: Exploration of the Red Planet 1958-1978, NASA
SP-4212 (Washington, 1984) , pp. 409-14.
41. Richard S. Johnston, Lawrence F. Dietlein, M.D., and Charles A. Berry, M.D., eds., Biomedical
Results of Apollo, NASA SP-368 (Washington, 1975), pp. 410-11, 418.
42. William Hines, "End of a Crazy Business," Chicago Sun-Times, Dec. 21, 1972.
43. Foy D. Kohler and Dodd L. Harvey, "'Administering and Managing the U.S. and Soviet Space
Programs," Science 169 (1970):1049-55.
44. John Noble Wilford, "A Spacefaring People: Keynote Address, '" in Alex Roland, ed., A Spacefar-
ing People: Perspectives on Early Spaceflight, NASA SP-4405 (Washington, 1985), proceedings of a
conference on the history of space activity held at Yale University, Feb. 6-7, 1981.
312
!
i
ii
APPENDIX 1
ORGANIZATION CHARTS:
NASA, OMSF, OSSA, MSC
ADMINISTRATOR
DEPUTY
ADMINISTRATOR
ASSOCIATE
ADMINISTRATOR
I I I I
Office of Office of Office of Office of
Program Planning Public Business International
and Evaluation Information Adminish'ation Programs
I I
Space Flight Aeronautical and
Development Space Research
Office of
I I I I
Structures and Materials[ Aerodynamics
Space Flight Advanced
and Aircraft and Flight
Operations Technology Mechanics
Operating Problems
I I 1
Propulsion Space Science Power Plants
University
Office Research
of [
313
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
ADMINISTRATOR
DEPUTY
ADMINISTRATOR
I
ASSOCIATE
ADMINISTRATOR
I I I
Office of Office of Office of
Launch Vehicle Space Hight Advanced Research Life Sciences
Programs Office
Programsof ] Programs Pro_alns
Structures and
BioengineerLqg
Vehicles i and Applications
Manned Flight ] Operating Problems
Grants and
Power Plants
Operations Planetary Contracts
Launch I Lunar Programs
and J
Research Center
Operations (not sited)
Space Flight ]
I
Launch
Operations
Directorate
Propulsion
Laboratory
Jet
Wallops
Station
I-tt Research
Center
Flight
Research
Center
314
J
i
Appendix 1
ADMINISTRATOR
DEPUTY t
ADMINISTRATOR
I
ASSOCIATE
ADMINISTRATOR
I
MANNED SPACE VANUEDRESEARCH
FLIGHT APPLICATIONS SPACE SCIENCES
OFFICE OF I OFFICE OF 1 AND TECHNOLOGY
O_ICE OFAD- I OFFICE OF [
Launch Vehicles
Hight Missions Systems and Power
Spacecraft and ] Communications p Propulsion [ and Propulsion
Launch Vehicles
and Propulsion Systems and Control
Future ] Electronics I Planetary Prosrams
Lunar and [
Aerospace
Space Geophysics and [
Medicine
Vehicles
Astronomy Progran_ [
Nuclear Bioscience
Systems Pl_rams
Research
Director of [
I I I I I
Research
Center
Ames 1
Manned
Spacecraft
Center
!
I Research
[Center]
[ Space
I G°dd'_d
Center I
Flight
r-I Space Flight
Center
Wallops
Station Propulsion Research Operations
I Laboratory
Jet Center
Flight I Directorate
Launch
315
Where No Man Has Gone Before
ADMINISTRATOR
DEPUTY
ADMINISTRATOR
ADMINISTRATOR
ASSOCIATE
Director ]
Tracklng.and Data [
[
MANNED SPACE
FLIGHT OF
OFFICE ]
OFFICE OF
SCIENCE AND
APPLICATIONS J ADVANCED
AND OFFICE
RESEARCH
TECHNOLOGY
OF
I
Offices" Offices
I r_am
Offices" ] [
Manned Space
Division
Science
1
-7 [ 1
Spacecraft
Center
Manned I J-l
Space Flight
Center
Space
Center
Kennedy J
F I
Goddard Space Pacific Launch
Flight Center Laboratory Operations Office
J'et Propulsion I
I I I I
z .
316
ili
!
j
]
!i
Appendix 1
ADMINISTRATOR
DEPUTY
ADMINISTRATOR
ASSOCIATE
ADMINISTRATOR
I
OFFICE OF
OFFICE OF OFFICE OF OFFICE OF
ADVANCED
OFFICE OF TRACKING
MANNED SPACE RESEARCH
APPLICATIONS AND DATA
SPACE FLIGHT SCIENCE AND
ACQUISITION TECHNOLOGY
I
Program
Offices Offices ]
I I
Jet Propulsion Wallops
Space Hight Station
I Goddard Laboratory
Center
I I I
Manned
Spacecraft Space Flight Space
Center I Marshall
Center Kennedy
Center ]
I 1 I I
Ames
Research Research Research Research
Center Jl l_n_ey
Center Center Center
317
Where No Man Has Gone Before
isc tt
ence dTechnolosy
Advisory
Committee
ASSOCIATE
ADMINISTRATOR
FOR MANNED
SPACE FLIGHT
Bellcomm, Inc.
AA
OSSA
I
DIRECTOR
Program MSF Field Center MSF Space
Control
DIRECTOR [ Development
DIRECTOR Operations I I Medicine
DIRECTOR
I I I
Director
Apollo
Priam J Director
Gemini
Program
Director
Advanced
Programs
I I I
Director Director Director
Program Systems Test
Control Engineering ]_'o_rams
Director Director
Reliability Flight
and Quality Operations
318
Appendix 1
Science and
Technology _ ADMINISTRATOR
Advisory FOR MANNED
Committee t ASSOCIATE
SPACE FLIGHT
I
Manned Space Hight [
I Bellcomm, Inc. Experiments Board
I
DIRECTOR
Program MSF Field Center MSF Management Space
Control
DIRECTOR [ Development Operations Medicine
DIRECTOR J DIRECTOR ]
I I
Director
Apollo
Program io o,
i Apollo
Applications
Program
I I
Shuttle Station
Task Force
Space Task Force
Space
I Director
Operations
Lunar
Exploration
Quality &
__
Reliability
Lunar
[ Systems Science
J Devel_ent
I
Manned
Space Hight Space Spa/:ecraft
d Center
Marshall Center
Kennedy Center
319
Where No Man Has Gone Before
ADMINISTRATOR
FOR MANNED
ASSOCIATE
SPACE FLIGHT I
Manned
Experiments
Space Board
Flight
I I I
DIRECTOR DIRECTOR DIRECTOR
Administration
Budget and Engineering Reliability
Program
DIRECTOR
Analysis I and Operations Quality and Safety
! I
Space
Task
Station
Force
Advanced
Missions
Director
Life
Sciences L
I I [
i o,-,1 Apollo
Program
Director
Skylab
Program
Director
Space Shuttle
Program
Engineering Exploration
Operations
320
Appendix 1
Space
Science
Board
(NAS) F1Ass1'A
-- ADMINISTRATOR
FOR SPACE SCIENCE
AND APPLICATIONS
AA, OMSF I
I I
Director Director
Program Review and Grants and
Resources Management Research Contracts
Director Director
Lunar and Launch Vehicle
Planetary and Propulsion
Pro_ams [_o_ams
Division Division
I I I I ,,
Goddard
Space Flight
Center I " II Propulsion
Laboratory
Wallops
Station II Pd c - Operations
Office
321
WhereNo ManHasGone Before
Science ADMINISTRATOR
Board -- FOR SPACE SCIENCE
Space
_AS) f AND ASSOCIATE
APPLICATIONS
DEPUTY AA DEPUTY AA
Science Engineering
Director
Program Review
and Resources
Management
I " . I
I I I I
Goddard
Space blight
Center J] Jet
Propulsion
Laboratory II Wallopa
Station J[ Operations
Office
322
Appendix 1
ASSOCIATE
ADMINISTRATOR
FOR
SPACE SCIENCE
I 1
Director ] Director
Program Review and ] Advanced Launch Vehicles and
Pro_ams J Propulsion
DirectorPrograms
Resources Management I
Director Director
Planetary Physics and
Pmgrams Astronomy Programs
Space Flight
Station Propulsion
Center
Goddard Laboratory
323
WhereNo ManHas Gone Before
DIRECTOR
Chief
Assistants
Medical Advisor
Associate
Director
I I I
I I
Office Office
J Public Affairs I Legal
| I I 1
ASST. DIRECTOR ASST. DIRECTOR
Research and Engineering Operations Administration
Division Division
f Life Systems t Hight Operations
Flight Crew
Research Operations
Division Division
t Spacecraft
Prefiisht Operations
Systems Division
Evaluation and
Development
Division
t Ranse
Atlantic Operation
Missile
I 1
Apollo Spacecraft Mercury Gemini Spacecraft
Project Project Project
Office Office Office
I
I I I
Planning and
Resources Service Module Control Development Integration
324
Appendix 1
DIRECTOR
Deputy
Director
II Assistants
I I I I
Reliability and
Operations Liaison
Flisht Safety Office Affairs
Office Office Offices
Office
I 1 I
ASST. DIRECTOR ASST. DIRECTOR
Engineedng and Flight Crew Flight ASST. DIRECTOR
Development Operations ASST.Operations
DIRECTOR I [ Administration
I
Guidance and Astronaut
Control Div, Office Division and Engineerln 8
Flight Con/rol J I Office Services
of Technical
night Crew
Mechanics Div.
Structures and ] Support Div. Operations Dlv.
Recovery [
Division Division
Crew Systems [ Division
AircraftofficeOperatlons ] Mission Analysis I Technical Services I
Advanced Spacecraft J
Office
t Gemini Program
Technolosy Division J
Propulsion and
Program Control
Energy
Division
Systems Div.
Division
Test I
and Electronic
Instrumentation
Systems Div. I Systems
Engineering Div.
Operations
Planning
Project Office Division
Ground Systems ]
Reliability and
Quality Assurance
Division
325
Where No Man Has Gone Before
DIRECTOR
Deputy Assistants
Director
F I I
Liaison
Offices
Office Office Public
Office
Affairs [ I
I I
DIRECTOR DIRECTOR DIRECTOR
DIRECTOR
Hight Crew Flight Administration
Engineering and
Operations Operations
Development
I 1
]
land
DIRECTOR
Medical Research
Operations
[ DIRECTOR
Science and
Applications
I Bios_f_i_ec_al' 1 1 1 '
Operations
Office
Medical
L Space
Physics
Division
Sciences
Division
I I
Lunar Surface Applications
Environmental Project Office Project Office
Occupational
Medicine Office
and I
I 1
Apollo
Lunar Receiving
Spacecraft Applications
Laboratory
I ApolloOffice
Project Project Office
Project Office
326
Appendix 1
DIRECTOR
Assistants
Deputy
Director
I I I I
Space Station Legal Public Affairs Liaison
Task Group Office Office Offices
I I I I
DIRECTOR DIRECTOR DIRECTOR
Engineering and night Crew Flight Administration
Development Operations Operations I DIRECTOR
I
DIRECTOR DIRECTOR
Medical Research Science and
and Operations Applications
Biomedical Lunar
Laboratories Surface
Division
Project Office
Biomedical
Mapping
Technology Systems Sciences
Division I Advanced
Office Laboratory
I
Apollo
Spacecraft Applications Missions
I Project
Apollo
Office I Project Office AdvancedOffice
Program
327
Where No Man Has Gone Before
DIRECTOR
DEPUTY [ Assistants
DIRECTOR
I I
I
Planning
Office
Legal
I ]
[ Affairs
Public I[ Office,
s_fety I k Offices
Liaison
and Quality
Assurance Office
Office [ Office
I I I I I I
DIRECTOR [ DIRECTOR DIRECTOR
Crew
Crew Training [
Recovery Observations Systems
Medicine and Simula- Earth 1
Landing
Division and 1 Division Division
_ Preventive
Division tion Division
Crew Mission ]
Procedures Missions Environment
Operations planning and [
Science Div,
Support [ Test Space
Division ]
f Medical
Division I Division
Analysis Div. ]
Management
Support Programs and Power
Operations
Office Plight
Division f Advanced
Office Propulsion
Division [
Operations Observations ]
Office ircraft Office [ Division
Lu ]
Receiving
Laboratory t
Design
Spacecraft
Division
Engineering
I I L__ I I Analysis
Division
I il II ,, Project
Space Shuttle
Office
F-----'--
[
]
I
I Engineering
[
Space Shuttle
Office
Telemetry
Communlca-
tions Division
and [
]
[
Electronic
[ Systems lnie- Experiments
gration Office Project Support
_, Office
Lunar
Surface
Observations II _?:: I
Expts. j i Expts.
328
APPENDIX 2
1962
1963
1964
1965
1966
"Source: The Apollo Spacecraft: A Chrolonogy, vols. I_,, NASA SP-4009 (Washington, 1%9-1978).
329
Where No Man Has Gone Before
1967
1968
1969
1970
1971
1972
1973
330
d=
il I+
APPENDIX 3
Major questions in the exploration of the Moon fall chiefly in three categories
of basic problems: 1) structure and processes of the lunar interior, 2) the compo-
sition and structure of the surface of the Moon and the processes modifying the
surface, and 3) the history or evolutionary sequence of events by which the Moon
has arrived at its present configuration. The possibility that ancient rocks and
deposits on the Moon's surface may contain a unique record of events related
to the formation or accretion of the terrestrial planets gives the scientific explora-
tion of the moon unusual potential significance. There is also the minor possibil-
ity of finding prebiotic material ....
The major questions are as follows:
*Listed here are the "Fifteen Questions" that formed the basis for subsequent planning in lunar
exploration. Source: National Academy of Sciences-National Research Council Publication 1403, Space
Research: Directionsfor the Future (Washington, 1966), pp. 21-22.
331
Where No Man Has Gone Before
(4) What are the dominant processes of erosion, transport, and deposition
of material on the lunar surface?
(5) What volatile substances are present on or near the surface of the Moon
or in a transitory lunar atmosphere?
(6) Is there evidence of organic or proto-organic materials on or near the lunar
surface? Are living organisms present beneath the surface?
The Falmouth conference of 1965 made the first concerted effort to define a sys-
tematic 10-year program of lunar exploration, giving primary emphasis to manned
exploration. Working groups were established in the disciplines of geodesy/cartog-
raphy, geology, geophysics, bioscience, geochemistry (mineralogy and petrology),
particles and fields, lunar atmosphere measurements, and astronomy. At the con-
dusion of the conference each disciplinary working group prepared a report, from
which a summary was prepared by a coordinating committee. Following are
excerpts from the summary, which set forth the major requirements for the
program.*
MISSION SUMMARY
INTRODUCTION
In this chapter the major recommendations of the Working Groups are arranged by missions or
programs. The suggested priorities, instrument allocations, and mission characteristics for various
vehicles are indicated briefly ....
Although there was some overlap, most of the recommendations could be divided into these mis-
sions: Apollo, Lunar Orbiter, Apollo Extension System-Manned Lunar Orbiter (AES-MLO), Apollo
*NASA 1965 Summer Conference on Lunar Exploration and Science, NASA SP-88 (Washington, 1965).
332
Appendix3
Extension System-Manned Lunar Surface (AES-MLS) and Post-AES .... As the scientific instru-
ments and space vehicle characteristics and availability become more clearly defined, the assignment
of experiments will become clearer.
OVERALL PROGRAM
The plans and recommendations of the 1965 Lunar Exploration Summer Conference are based on
a 10-year program of exploration, beginning with the first manned lunar landing in the Apollo pro-
gram. The recommendations of this conference are limited to the 10-year period following the first
Apollo lunar landings because a decade seems to be the approximate maximum time for which develop-
ments can be meaningfully forecast. In addition, the long lead times involved in the development
of equipment for use in space flight require that recommendations be made to cover this period of
time. In carrying out these recommendations, it will be necessary for the National Aeronautics and
Space Administration to conduct its programs in a way that permits a maximum degree of flexibility
to meet changing requirements.
The need for flexibility is also important for determining the rate at which missions should be con-
ducted during this ten-year period. It is clearly desirable to schedule flight missions to provide ade-
quate time between missions to react to the findings of one mission by modifying experiments for
a later mission. One method of accomplishing this is through the modular construction of individual
experiments. It is also desirable to program certain types of experiments so that the time of the oper-
ation of the devices used on one mission will overlap with the operating time of devices operated
on a subsequent mission. This will provide not only scientific continuity in the experiments, but also
simultaneous data from a multiplicity of lunar locations.
In addition, overall program planning considerations dictate the scheduling of missions at relatively
close intervals. It is clearly desirable to maintain a certain degree of program momentum, both for
psychological reasons and to make certain that the project personnel analyzing the results are provided
with definite goals over a relatively long period of time.
On consideration of all of these factors, it was the feeling of the Working Groups that the National
Aeronautics and Space Administration should schedule lunar surface missions at a minimum rate
of one per year or possibly two through 1974. Lunar orbital missions should be conducted at the
rate of one per year. Since many of the lunar surface missions will require two flights each, three
to five Apollo/Saturn V vehicles are required annually.
Present indications are that lunar exploration should continue at the same rate in the latter half
of the 1970s. However, there seems to be no need now to plan the flight mission assignment sched-
ule for that period of time.
It is assumed that at least the first missions, with durations limited to a day or two and with explo-
ration limited to an area close to the point of landing, will be dominated by operational considera-
tions. Since the highest mission priority is assigned to the safety of the astronauts, the bulk of their
time and attention will be devoted to perfecting the procedures of flight. In the relatively short dura-
tion of these early missions, the time assigned to scientific lunar exploration as such will be limited.
All experiments should be designed to conserve the astronauts" time, the most valuable scientific
commodity on the early missions.
As flight procedures and techniques are perfected, and as improved flight equipment becomes avail-
able, plans should be made to gradually increase the duration of stays on the Moon, the distance
traveled from the point of landing, and the _oportion of the astronauts" time devoted to lunar explo-
ration. A judicious use of "manned" and "unmanned" spacecraft will be required to obtain maxi-
mum coverage. Recommendations were made by some groups concerning the specific instrumentation
to be carried on each of the first three landings.
Training of the astronauts in sampling techniques and field geology is of the utmost importance
to insure the intelligent collection of samples. To assure collection of sterile samples, training is required
for the astronauts in the nature of contamination, transfer of contaminants, aseptic transfer proce-
dures, and chemical cleanliness.
The highest priority activity for the early Apollo landings is to return the greatest number and vari-
ety of samples as is feasible. It is desirable that all samples be kept sterile and free of chemical con-
taminants from such sources as the LEM fuels, the LEM atmosphere or the outgassing or leakage
333
Where No Man Has Gone Before
of the astronaut's suit. A variety of easily obtainable samples should be collected, ranging from dust
to rock sizes. These samples should be taken as far from the LEM as possible. Both surface and sub-
surface samples are required. In the event of a semiaborted or shortened stay on the lunar surface,
the astronaut's first scientific duty is the collection of as many samples as possible, without regard
to sterility.
The second priority for the Early Apollo is the emplacement of the Lunar Surface Experiment Pack-
age (LSEP) by the astronauts. This should be emplaced to attain optimum operating conditions. Next
in priority are the lunar geological traverses by the astronauts. If feasible, these should be accurately
controlled with automatic procedures and monitoring. The description of topographic and geologic
relations along the traverse lines should be supplemented by stereoscopic photographs.
Equipment Requirements
The working groups were asked to consider equipment priority beginning with the most impor-
tant. Weights assigned are the absolute minimum needed to accomplish the task. In some cases (i.e.,
sample tools), added weight and complexity would be desirable if weight and space were available.
This priority list is as follows:
1. Sample containers (10 lb.) should keep samples sterile and chemically clean. Stainless steel
is acceptable. More studies should be completed relative to the use of Teflon in the lunar
environment.
2. Sampling tools (10 lb.) should be easily operable, light, and simple; e.g., space hardened rock
hammer, rubber mallet, sun compass.
3. Aseptic sample collection tool (10 lb.).
4. Photography (7 lb.): A stereoscopic camera with several filters and polarizing lenses.
5. LSEP experiments: Suggested experiments in order of priority are: a passive seismograph (25
lb.); a magnetometer/particle detector (13 lb.) and a heat flow measurement device (15 lb.);
an active seismograph experiment (7-10 lb.); a micrometeoroid detector (15 lb.). The gravimeter
should be considered for AES because of its weight and development complexities.
Preliminary Studies
Studies and tests should be started immediately to determine the amounts and effects of the out-
gassing of the astronauts' suits and the escape of the atmosphere from the LEM. Sterilization of the
escaping atmosphere from the LEM should be considered. Analyses of the possible contaminants
in the LEM fuel and the effects on sample collection should be undertaken.
Sample Investigations
Upon return of the lunar samples to Earth, they will be prepared at a Lunar Sample Receiving Labora-
tory (LSRL) for distribution. Here they will be logged in, cataloged, checked for outgassing, meas-
ured for low level radiation, and examined for pathogenic agents. Only those tests that must be done
immediately will be conducted at the LSRL. The portion of samples to be distributed will be pack-
aged and initial distribution to the selected scientific investigators will be made.
In the period before the end of the decade two classes of missions are scheduled.
Unmanned Missions
These missions will begin in the period of 1966-1967. The primary function for the approved mis-
sions is site selection, and hence, low altitude orbiters are desirable. However, should particles and
field experiments be included on later flights, altitudes of 150 to 2000 km are required. Following
are some specific recommendations for inclusion on these flights:
1. Cartography. Stereophotogrammetric analysis of the photography obtained by the first block
of Lunar Orbiters should be carried out to obtain information regarding the character of lunar
topography and to gain experience in analyzing lunar photography. It is recommended that
later first block Lunar Orbiters, or any second block, be placed in orbits of different inclina-
tions, with priority for a polar orbit.
2. Particles and Fields. A three-axis magnetometer and particle package to study day-night changes
in particle and field environment should be included. For these experiments the spacecraft
should be radioactvely and magnetically clean.
334
r_
4
Appendix 3
3. Lunar Atmospheres. Pressure, flux, and mass measurements for determination of neutral and
ionic constituents should be conducted. This study is advantageous for early flights because
of the uncontaminated state of the atmosphere.
Manned Missions
Role of AES-MLO
Since less than 1 percent of the lunar surface will be visited in the near future, a major source of
scientific knowledge will come from orbiting spacecraft. Extensive information can be easily obtained
for the following reasons:
1. Variation of orbital inclinations will permit mapping of the entire lunar surface.
2. Absence of atmosphere allows all regions of the electromagnetic spectrum to be accessible.
Thus, Manned Lunar Orbiters can provide useful additions to the subsurface information obtained
from geophysical studies and to the local studies from fixed and traversing surface experiments. Because
of the orbiter's nature, however, they cannot provide information with the same precision and detail
as the surface instruments. Orbital investigations offer the potential of identifying local areas of the
lunar surface with unusual properties that might be of interest for future manned exploration.
It is recommended that one orbiter carrying the remote sensing package be flown before the first
AES landings. Polar orbiters are desirable at the earliest time for total coverage of the lunar surface
by remote sensors. In the first phase of lunar exploration (complete orbital survey), five or six mis-
sions are believed to be appropriate. Subsequently, AES-MLOs will be necessary to support and sup-
plement the AES surface operations, as well as to monitor lunar activity. Launch rates should be
approximately one a year.
A systematic program of geologic mapping using orbital data is recommended with the prepara-
tion of geologic maps at the following scales:
1. 1:2,500,000. Synoptic map for general planning and collating of a wide variety of data about
the gross features of the Moon.
2. 1:1,000,000. Complete synoptic geologic mapping.
3. 1:250,000. Total coverage of the lunar surface. This is a long-range goal.
4. 1:100,000; 1:25,000. Special purpose, directed toward solution of selected topical problems.
Photography Equipment
For complete photographic coverage of the lunar surface the lunar Orbital Camera System should
include the following camera subsystems:
1. Metric (Mapping) Camera Subsystem. Designed for use in determining the lunar figure and
mapping of the lunar surface.
2. High Resolution Twin Convergent Panoramic Camera Subsystem. Designed for photography
of the highest resolution in keeping with coverage of large areas.
3. Ultrahigh Resolution Camera Subsystem. Designed to produce photography of extremely high
resolution and multispectral response of limited areas.
4. Multiband Synoptic Camera Subsystem. A means for obtaining large areas of multispectral
photographic coverage of the reflective properties of the lunar surface in the visible and near-
visible portion of the spectrum.
Remote Sensors
Imaging sensors will provide information about surface structure and composition from depths of
microns to a few meters. Imaging instruments, induding UV [ultraviolet] imagers, IR [infrared] imagers,
and high-resolution radars have proven value for surface and near-surface structure and composi-
tion studies and for the study of thermal anomalies. Coverage of the entire Moon with these instru-
ments is recommended at an early date.
Nonimaging remote sensors, such as the passive microwave, radar scatterometer, IR, X-ray_ gamma-
ray, and alpha-particle emission are recommended for inclusion in lunar orbital payloads pending
the results of current remote sensor feasibility studies ....
335
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
Atmospheric and ionospheric variability surveys should be conducted. The recommended charac-
teristics of the ion and neutral mass spectrometers are described in the Group Report. Ion traps, solar
wind detectors, and pressure gauges can be adapted from the unmanned programs.
Other experiments include the determination of the cosmic-ray albedo, the study of solar and lower-
energy galactic cosmic rays (particle telescope), and the search for water using a neutron instrument
to detect the hydrogen content of the surface.
There are three orbital instruments that have the potential of obtaining valuable data from depths
of kilometers and beyond. The first of these is a magnetometer, which will yield important informa-
tion on the geology of the lunar crust. Second is a gravity gradiometer yielding details of the varia-
tions in the lunar gravitational field. The third is the electromagnetic pulse probe, which has the potential
for probing to depth and differentiating the various layers present.
The AES-MLS is essentially a continuation of the early Apollo missions characterized by longer
stay time and larger scientific payloads.
It is suggested that this program can be usefully exploited in five or six missions, extending through
1974. The scientific requirements of this series include stay times up to 14 days and traverses up to
15 km from point of landing.
The longer stay time will probably permit the collection of more material than can be returned to
Earth. Hence aids to the selection of samples in the field or prior to return should be provided by
analytical equipment that will also measure sample characteristics that may be altered by return or
packaging. Sample return is still the most significant achievement in these missions. Local mapping
should also have a high priority so that sample location is accurately tied to the local geology.
The capability to off load several LSEP's during each AES mission is also an important aspect. In
this way, a small array of stations (LSEP's) could be set into operation, giving important information
for revealing the internal properties of the Moon.
The Moon should provide a unique base for astronomers because of its useful environmental charac-
teristics, the most important being the lack of an appreciable atmosphere. However, exhaustive studies
of the complete lunar environment are necessary before engineering design can be started.
The primary objective of analytical devices used on the lunar surface should be to extend the power
of the observer to differentiate materials that have similar characteristics. The optimum sample return
capability would be between 200 and 250 kg (450-600 lb.) per mission. The following basic types of
equipment are required for this phase of lunar exploration:
1. Automatic position recording systems. Essential for tracking and recording movements of the
astronaut, and the roving vehicle, and knowing the orientation of the camera. The system
would automatically telemeter this information back to Earth or to the LEM.
2. Local Scientific Survey Module (LSSIv0. This surface roving vehicle should have the capabil-
ity of carrying either one or two suited astronauts and scientific payload of at least 600 lb. An
operational range of 8 km radius is a minimum, and 15 km would be more useful. Remote
control of the LSSM would also be advantageous both before and after the arrival of the
astronauts.
3. Lunar Flying Vehicle (LFV). A LFV would be useful for extending the operational range of
the AES and for studying features inaccessible to the LSSM due to topography. It should be
able to carry a 300-lb. scientific payload over a distance of 15 km. Continued study should
determine how effectively it can be employed in surface operation.
4. Lunar Drills. The development of a 1-inch drill capable of penetrating to a depth of 3 meters
in either rubble or solid rock is recommended. It should be operable from a roving vehicle.
It is necessary for lunar heat flow studies and for obtaining biological samples.
Because of the liberal weight allowance for equipment delivered to the Moon's surface most Work-
ing Groups indicated a wide variety of experiments desired for inclusion in the program. Equipment
and experiments include instrumentation for performing gravity surveys, active seismic surveys, mag-
netic measurements, radioactivity measurements, environmental measurements, and in general
instrumentation and supporting equipment for conducting geological-geophysical surveys on the lunar
surface.
To obtain maxLmum output of scientific information from these experiments, astronauts should be
given scientific training in specific rather than general areas. The greatest need is for trained geolo-
gists; however, specialized training will be required in physics, meteorology, chemistry, and in other
fields.
336
Appendix3
POST-AES
The AES should be followed by a program including long-distance travel, up to 800 km and fixed-
site investigation from 2 months to I year. These missions should commence about 1975 and proceed
at a rate of one per year through 1980. Additional orbital flights also appear desirable during this
period so as to conduct simultaneous orbital and surface missions.
A long-range laboratory vehicle for geological and geophysical exploration is required to permit
the collection of data to form a broad regional integrated picture of the surface geology and crustal
structure. These data will also be essential as a basis for interpretation of the imagery and measure-
ments obtained from the remote sensing orbital vehicle and also to substantiate other investigations.
A series of traverses along the geological belt is suggested, requiring a vehicle with the following
characteristics:
1. A minimum range of 800 km.
2. Shelter for a three-person crew.
3. Mission duration capability of up to 2 months.
4. No constraints in returning to starting point.
A Lunar Base is a surface complex that will allow longer stay time, possibly up to a year, than is
presently envisioned by the AES concept. Primary needs for a base are visualized to be:
1. The measurement of presently occurring time-varying phenomena; many are geophysical in
nature.
2. The study of lunar surface processes.
3. Deep-drilling studies--most important for information on early history, crustal composition,
and surface properties of the past. The depth to be reached should probably exceed 300 meters.
4. Detailed study of a critical field area.
5. Construction and manning of large radio and optical telescopes, yet to be defined.
[A 36-page section following this summary in the original report, not reproduced here, is a detailed
listing of the requirements formulated by each disciplinary working group.]
The Santa Cruz Summer Study was organized along the same lines as the
Falmouth Conference, with five major objectives:
"I967 Summer Study of Lunar Science and Exploration, NASA SP-157 (Washington, 1967).
337
Where No Man Has Gone Before
The primary purpose of the Santa Cruz Conference was to arrive at a scientific consensus as to
what the future lunar manned and unmanned exploration program should be, particularly in the
time frame of the Apollo Applications Program (AAP). It was planned that the major results of the
conference would include (1) a recommended list of lunar missions with detailed mission plans and
priority experiment lists for each mission, (2) a priority list of major hardware items, and (3) recom-
mendations for instrument development and for Supporting Research and Technology Programs.
The details of the findings and recommendations of the working groups are reported in later sec-
tions [not included here]. The major recommendations of the conference and the proposed lunar explo-
ration program include (1) systems development, (2) proposed mission sequence, (3) program planning
and support, and (4) science mission plans.
SYSTEMS DEVELOPMENT
The most important recommendation of the conference relates to lunar surface mobility. To increase
the scientific return from lunar surface missions after the first few Apollo landings, the most impor-
tant need is for increased operating range on the Moon. On the early Apollo missions it is expected
that an astronaut will have an operating radius on foot of approximately 500 meters. It is imperative
that this radius be increased to more than 10 km as soon as possible.
To increase surface mobility the following recommendations are made:
1. It is recommended that a Lunar Flying Unit be developed immediately to be used in AAP and, if possible,
on late Apollo flights to increase the astronaut's mobility range.
This is the first step toward attaining reasonable mobility. It is expected that the Lunar Fly-
ing Unit (LFLO will provide a mobility radius of 5 to 10 kilometers, which is a considerable
improvement over the present capability, but not nearly enough. Exploration of lunar surface
features such as large craters and their environs will require a range of approximately 25 km
or more.
3. It is recommended that the dual-mode local scientific survey module (LSSM) be developed on the same
schedule as the dual-launch Saturn V. This wheeled vehicle should be capable of operating in
an automatic or manned mode. The primary purpose of the dual-launch system is to carry
the recommended LSSM and additional fuel for the Lunar Flying Units. The automated/manned
LSSM has a greater capability than the one now planned [i.e., the lunar roving vehide]. The
LSSM used in conjunction with Lunar Flying Units should provide a mobility radius of approx-
imately 25 kin.
The best type of lunar surface mobility system was the subject of considerable debate dur-
ing the conference. Two different philosophies of exploration on large-scale areas arose.
1. The Geochemistry Working Group strongly favored the large lunar flying vehicle. A
manned vehicle, which provides spot coverage over a wide area, would best afford the
opportunity of observation and sample collection.
2. A substantial, but divided, opinion of the Geology Working Group was that the com-
bination of Small Lunar Flying Units with the LSSM was best for spot coverage and
for continuous ground coverage. The Geology Working Group emphasized that the
continuous ground observation was essential to solve complex geological problems in
areas of limited size. The geologists felt that experience had shown that such studies
are critical to solving much larger problems and are necessary to place geochemical and
geophysical data in their proper geological context.
At the conclusion of the meeting, a substantial majority of the working groups were in favor of
the shorter range, continuous surface traverse using a dual-mode LSSM rather than spot coverage
over a large area with a Large Flying Unit. Another reason for the choice of the LSSM is that it is
probable that the manned half of a dual launch will carry two Lunar Flying Units. Starting with this,
the total mobility system using the LSSM seemed a better choice.
A very important reason for the choice of the LSSM involved the use of an automated mode of
operation. Agreement was unanimous on the need for long unmanned traverses on the lunar sur-
face. After the astronauts have returned to the Earth, the LSSM would be sent to a new destination.
On its journey, the LSSM would accomplish the following:
338
Appendix 3
1.
Stereo TV on the LSSN will permit the LSSM to be controlled from the earth. The LSSM would
collect samples along the route. Some of these samples would be aseptically handled and pack-
aged for return to the earth by the next manned lander.
2.
The LSSM would conduct a geophysical traverse of a large area using devices such as mag-
netometers, gravimeters, and radar probes.
3.
The LSSM would deploy several small ALSEP-type Remote Geophysical Monitors (RGM) along
the traverse. In this way, a network of such units could be built. The RGM would carry instru-
ments such as seismographs, atmospheric mass spectrometers, gravimeters, and mag-
netometers.
The dual-mode LSSM is more complicated and has greater capability than the vehide presently
planned. The LSSM should have the following characteristics and capabilities:
1. articulation;
2. the ability to pick up rocks;
3. stereo TV with the Apollo bandwidth and a fast shutter;
4. rock analysis (nondestructive) with a storage capacity of 50 pounds;
5. a headlight (night and shadow operation)
6. samples, stowage of approximately 100, maximum weight of 1 kg per sample with
some aseptically sealed;
7. the capability to carry and deploy 6 RGMs, each weighing 50 pounds and equipped
with instruments such as a gravimeter, a radar probe, and a magnetometer;
8. dead-reckoning navigation with altitude and horizontal ties to known controls;
9. capability for carrying two persons with optional steering modes and capability for
carrying 1 or 2 LFUs;
10. relay communications; and
11. the ability to carry a backup portable life support system (PLSS) or an independent
life support system.
Block II Surveyor
Other systems working with the automated LSSM are probably needed to develop the geophysical
network of Remote Geophysical Monitors on the Moon. This network requires about 10 automated
stations distributed over the front face of the Moon with spacings on the order of 1,000 km or more.
This system is required to obtain large-scale information about the interior of the Moon.
It is recommended that a Block II Surveyor, or another system, be available in the period from 1970 to 1975,
which is capable of deploying experiments such as the following:
One important, if not the most important, scientific result from the AAP missions will be the return
of lunar samples. The amount returned must increase as the capabilities of the vehicles allow.
It is recommended that the total returned payload from the Moon in AAP missions increase to 400 lb. so that
a minimum of 250 lb. of lunar samples can be returned.
A consensus of the conference was that a capability to return approximately 50 lb. of refrigerated samples was
needed as soon as possible.
339
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Modular ALSEP
It was clearly recognized at the conference that Apollo lunar surface experiments packages or their
derivatives such as Emplaced Scientific Stations or Remote Geophysical Monitors would be used on
essentially all AAP landing missions. A number of new experiments under development require the
ESS or RGM capability, and many of the current experiments should be used on the lunar surface
in networks. The capability should be established to include new experiments on an ALSEP prior
to a mission.
It is recommended that future ALSEP stations be designed to allow a substantial degree of flexibility to react
to new opportunities opened up by new developments or discoveries on the Moon. A modular concept to permit
accommodation of new instruments with minimum disturbance of the basic ALSEP system would greatly facili-
tate such flexibility.
It is expected that the number of candidate experiments for a particular ALSEP mission will exceed
the number that can be accommodated on that mission. Flight assignments for the mission should
be made as close to the flight time as is practical to reflect the state of knowledge at that time. The
experiments would, therefore, be built to meet a standard ALSEP electrical interface and a suitably
small choice of mechanical interfaces. This requires that the ALSEP central station have an appropri-
ate number of standard electrical plug-in stations and a central data processor that assigns experi-
ment data rates under the control of a stored program. The processor control program could be stored
prior to flight or, preferably, on command from Earth. Remote reprogramming is particularly desira-
ble as it permits the real-time assignment of experiment data rates in response to acquired data.
Telemetry Capability
When several scientific packages are operating on or near the Moon for long periods of time, the
capability to handle the increased data return will become a problem. The data return capability is
presently a problem in some unmanned programs.
It is strongly recommended that appropriate provision be made to insure continuous telemetry coverage of all
scientific packages, both single and simultaneous operations, on and around the Moon. Provision must also be
made to recover data continuously from the averted face of the Moon.
Orbital Subsatellites
Subsatellites could be injected from the AAP command and service module (CSM) vehicles into
precision orbits to study the lunar environment, including magnetic fields and particle environment
and the atmosphere and ionosphere.
It is recommended that a subsatellite system he developed for deploying systems of instruments in close orbit
around the Moon.
To understand how the mobility systems fit into the program of flights and why they have been
chosen, the proposed program of lunar landing missions should be examined. The program is not
in final form and will not be for some time, at least until further mission studies have been made.
The program of missions consists of three distinct mission types: (1) manned orbital flights; (2) single-
launch Saturn V lunar landing flights; and (3) dual-launched Saturn V lunar landing flights. The pro-
posed program is outlined in Table 1 and Figure 1 [not reproduced here].
34O
ii
Appendix 3
Tycho b -- m
Mare Orientale b
Hadley Rille b
Manned Orbiter
The first recommended AAP flight is a manned lunar orbital flight with these objectives.
1. AAP landing sites mapping photography (return of film necessary;
2. metric-mapping quality photography with returned film;
3. geochemical remote-sensing using gamma-rays and x-rays on a subsatellite left in lunar orbit
or using a directional detector system on the CSM; and
4. flying a family of remote sensors such as passive microwave radiometer, infrared radiometer,
radar reflectivity, radio noise survey, magnetometer and plasma probe, multicolor photome-
try, meteoroid detector, radio radiometer, and fluorescence photometer.
341
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Single-Launch Mode
The first AAP lunar landers will probably be single launches. Missions 2, 3, and 4 represent the
proposed early single-launch landers. Because the crater Copernicus is such a large feature and because
information about Copernicus is essential to the understanding of the Moon, two separate missions
are proposed: one to the central peaks and one to the crater wall. A proposed science mission plan
for the central peaks is presented later in this section.
The durations of this class of missions are flexible. It is desired that the single-launch missions be
started as soon as possible; however, a series of useful single launches could be continued for a num-
ber of missions. Suggested additional sites for the subsequent single missions are Copernicus H, Gam-
bart, MOsting C, Hyginus Rile, Flamsteed, Dionysius, Hipparchus, the dome near Lunar Orbiter
Photographic Site II-P-2, and the Surveyor landing and the Ranger impact sites. The Lunar Flying
Unit would be used for mobility on these missions.
Dr. George E. Mueller suggested that the conferees consider what scientific program should be
carried out on Apollo flights after the first two or three successful lunar landings. The following ground
rules were assumed:
1. Some system constraints will have been removed so that more payload is available on the Apollo
CSM.
2. The lunar module (I_M) will be able to land at rather rough sites but still in or near the Apollo
landing zone of :t: 10 o latitude.
3. No substantial hardware changes will be made in the CSM or the LM.
It was decided that all of the suggested single-launch AAP landing sites would be appropriate for
late Apollo, except Copernicus, which requires more mobility. The most appealing sites were Coper-
nicus H, Gambart, MOsting C, and the dome near site II-P-2. The lunar module might land close
enough to these sites to allow access to the interesting areas. There was a strong feeling that there
should be at least one highland landing site.
Additional mobility should be brought into the program as rapidly as possible. The LFU should
be used even if it has only a 1- or 2-kin range, which will significantly enhance the scientific return.
If the LFU is not ready, the schedule for the Apollo lunar program should be adjusted, after the first
few successful landers, to allow the LFU to be brought into these late Apollo missions.
Dual-Launch Mode
The future lunar exploration program must involve mobility systems that require two Saturn V
launches. The dual-mode LSSM and a large amount of additional fuel for the Lunar Flying Units
will be carried to the lunar surface in an unmanned lander. The manned Saturn V will land nearby
later. The present LSSM cannot be carried to the Moon in a manned single-launch system.
A major feature of the dual-launch system is that the unmanned LSSM would make a long traverse
(approximately 1,000 km) and arrive at the site of the next manned landing with a collection of sur-
face samples from an extensive region of the Moon. These would be returned to Earth by the next
manned lander. The suggested sequence of missions with automated LSSM traverses is shown in
Table l. This technique allows a much larger fraction of the lunar surface to be sampled than could
possibly be visited by humans during all of the proposed manned AAP missions (Fig. 1).
Fullback Position
If the AAP lunar program level should drop below one dual-launch or two single-launch missions
per year, then the Group for Lunar Exploration Planning (GLEP) should meet again to reconsider
mission plans. The program at this low level might need significant redirection. For example, in the
case of severe budgetary restrictions or other problems that would prevent developing the Saturn
V dual-launch capability, an automated system, such as Rover launched by a system less compli-
cated than a Saturn V, might need to be developed.
342
Appendix3
The selection of experiments from the scientific community was a major consideration at the Con-
ference.
To develop a strong science program in AAP, it is strongly recommended that any extension of the Apollo science
program (that is, new Apollo hardware, follow-on ALSEP, or AAP), be implemented by open solicitation of
experiments from the scientific community. Only in this way can the Manned Space Flight Program build the
broad base of scientific support and participation necessary for an active and productive research program.
It is recognized that the time scales involved may pose problems in certain disciplines in implementing
the above recommendation. However, there are experiments that could be delivered on a relatively
short time scale and thus allow the possibility of a wider NASA scientific program.
The NASA support of basic research programs has been a benefit to the space program and also
to universities and other research institutions. This support should not be confined to flight programs
but should be continued in all areas of basic science that contribute to the overall NASA objectives
of space exploration.
Many scientific experiments appear very promising for lunar exploration but are not feasible now
because (1) detector systems have not been developed to the point of having the desired sensitivity,
or (2) theoretical problems have not been fully investigated to insure proper design of the experiment
or full interpretation of the results.
Three stages in the development of an experiment and the necessary hardware can be visualized.
These are (1) detailed consideration of the importance and feasibility of an experiment, (2) develop-
ment of necessary scientific tools to implement the experiment, and (3) production of flight hardware.
To carry out the first two stages of producing an experiment listed previously, it is recommended that a strong
program in scientific instrument definition and development and a substantial lunar supporting research and
technology program be undertaken immediately. The amount of money being invested to produce experiments
for AAP flights in the present budget is not compattTaIe with the scope of the program. It is further recommended
that adequate time be included in program planning and launch schedules to allow for the scientific development
of the appropriate experiments.
It is now apparent that there is a need for more continuous scientific input into the development
of scientific flight hardware for lunar missions.
It is strongly recommended that a position of Project Scientist be established within the structure of the Manned
Space Flight Program. The responsibilities of the project scientist are to represent the scientific requirements
and objectives of the experiment to the project manager and staff and conversely to represent to the Principal
Investigator project requirements that may affect the experiment. At least one project scientist should be associated
with every MSC project that includes scientific experiments; more than one project scientist may be desirable
for a large project in which the number of scientific disciplines is large. Furthermore, it is strongly recommended
that project scientists be participating experimenters in the projects for which they are responsible. The position
of the project scientist within the organizational structure should be at a level that insures adequate science input
into the program.
After basic classroom work and tutorials, the astronaut should be provided the time and opportu-
nity to participate directly in the research and planning activities of the particular missions for which
he is selected. This may require one or more thorough refresher tutorial covering the specific topics
of prime scientific importance for the mission. In crew selection for any mission, flight-operations
ability is, without question, the primary criterion.
343
Where No Man Has Gone Before
It is strongly recommended that ability in field geology be the next most important factor in the selection of
the crew members who will actually land on the Moon for the Apollo missions. For some of the complicated
scientific missions in the later part of the AAP, the Santa Cruz Conference considers that the knowledge and
experience of an astronaut who is also a professional field geologist is essential. In the interest of maintaining
career proficiency, astronauts should be provided time to engage m some form of research activity within their
professional fields.
As previously stated, the science mission plans in this report are not in final form. Engineering
studies must be made and appropriate modifications and plans developed.
It is recommended that an immediate and intensive program of detailed mission analyses be undertaken for all
of the prime lunar landing sites and traverses that have been listed by this Conference.
Because of the rapid development of suitable launch capabiIity and the growth of an extensive body
of photogeologic maps of the lunar surfce and because of the lead-times required for development
of selected systems, the working groups felt that such analyses are urgent. The analyses must be
planned on an iterative basis to test the applicability of the recommended plans and of instrument
development for the achievement of the general scientific objectives for lunar exploration.
[The "Summary and Recommendations" continues with detailed (though tentative) plans for three
AAP missions--to Copernicus, the "Cobra Head" (Aristarchus region), and Alphonsus--including
landing sites, mission timelines, and surface activities. The balance of the report consists of the
individual reports of eight working groups: Geology, Geophysics, Geochemistry, Bioscience, Geodesy
and Cartography, Lunar Atmospheres, Particles and Fields, and Astronomy.]
(1) the age of the moon's formation or of its oldest crust; this age might make
it possible to distinguish among various theories of lunar origin. One key
site for locating such material was the Fra Mauro Formation. This wide-
spread blanket of debris is considered to consist of debris from the
"'Imbrian event," the cataclysmic occurrence that produced Mare Imbrium,
the enormous circular mare in the northwestern quadrant of the Earth-
344
Appendix3
facing side of the moon. The Fra Mauro Formation was given high pri-
ority on all lists of potential landing sites.
(2) The time at which the maria became filled with the relatively smooth mate-
rial, probably once-molten rock, that characterizes them. This date would
be relatively easy to establish, since mission planners preferred smooth,
level landing sites, most often found in the maria.
(3) The time of significant post-mare events, such as the impacts that created
the craters Copernicus and Tycho. Equally interesting was the origin of
the sinuous rilles, which appeared to have been formed largely in this
later period of lunar history.
Major Geomorphic Processes. The study of the processes by which lunar landforms
have been created and destroyed was important mainly to second- and third-order
questions about the moon, but was essential in holding the first-order questions
(above) together. Knowledge of dominant processes would provide the basis for
selection of samples and determining their place of origin, as well as providing
major clues to past energy expenditure on the moon. Regions of particular interest
in this regard were the sinuous rilles and areas of volcanic cratering. Since pho-
tography covered a large fraction of the lunar surface, data from a few landing
sites would enable geomorphologists to draw conclusions about most of the moon.
345
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Lunar Geophysics. The only source of information on the moon's internal struc-
ture was the emplaced ALSEP experiments, which included a seismometer and
a heat flow instrument. (Later ALSEPs would include different geophysical
instruments.)
Seismic data were expected to yield information on layering in the moon, the
rate of release of internal strain, and the number and energy of meteorite impacts.
It would be very useful to the seismologists to produce an impact of known energy
at a known location, such as by causing a spent S-IVB stage or a lunar module
ascent stage to crash on the lunar surface. It was important to have at least four
seismic instruments active at one time; they should be about 1,000 km apart with
as much angular separation as possible. Thus sites at high latitudes, such as Tycho,
were quite important.
Data on heat flow were difficult to interpret but could assist in determining
whether the moon had originally been hot or cold.
Lunar gravity and geodesy would determine the extent of the "mascons" (mass
concentrations) and whether the moon was in hydrostatic equilibrium. These were
well suited to study by orbiting instruments.
The laser retroreflectors were expected to make it possible to determine earth-
moon distances within a few centimeters, enabling scientists to measure the libra-
tions of the moon with previously unattainable accuracy. Best results would be
obtained with widely separated reflectors.
Characteristics of the Recommended Landing Sites. The short list of landing sites for
the first 10 lunar exploration missions should include:
(1) two types of mare material, "older" or eastern and "younger" or western;
(2) regional stratigraphic units, such as blanket (ejecta) deposits around mare
basins;
(3) various types and sizes of impact craters in the maria and in the highlands;
(4) morphological manifestations of volcanism in the maria and in the high-
lands; and
(5) areas that may give clues to the nature and extent of processes other than
impact and volcanism, which may have acted on the lunar surface.
Following is a description of the 10 prime sites chosen by the Group for Lunar
Exploration Planning. The sites were selected in order of their preferred execu-
tion on one "G, four "H,'" and five "J" missions.
(1) Landing Site 2 ("older" or eastern mare). This site is entirely within
relatively old mare (Imbrian) material. It includes many large subdued
craters 200 to 600 meters in diameter but comparatively few in the size
range 50-200 meters, a distribution common to many apparently old
surfaces. Determination of the age and nature of this Imbrian mare mate-
rial was a primary object of landing at this site.
(2) Landing Site 5 ("younger" or western mare) is located within relatively
young (Eratosthenian) mare material and displays many craters 50 to 200
meters in diameter and relatively fewer of the larger (200-600 meter)
craters. It is surrounded by well developed rays from Kepler, making
it likely that it contains material derived from considerable depth. The
chief goal of a landing at Site 5 was to determine the age and composi-
tion of Eratosthenian mare material.
346
Appendix3
(3) Fra Mauro Formation. This extensive geologic unit covers large portions
of the surface around Mare Imbrium and is thought to be material ejected
when Imbrium was formed. Samples from the Fra Mauro Formation
would help to understand its nature, composition, and formation and
its relation to the "Imbrian event."
(4) Rima Bode II, a single linear rille running close to a fresh, elongate cra-
ter and a crater chain, was of interest because both the rille and the cra-
ter were possible sources of several dark geologic units most probably
of volcanic origin. The site was selected as an example of a region where
material of deep-seated origin was expected. An alternative site was Hygi-
nus RiUe, similar in characteristics but apparently less fresh. Another site,
Littrow, would meet part of the objectives of a mission to Rima Bode II.
(5) Censorinus is a 3.8-km crater located within and near the edge of a high-
land block south-southeast of Mare Tranqillitatis. It offered the oppor-
tunity, early in the exploration program, to sample both highland material
and features associated with a fresh impact crater. The proposed site was
within the ejecta blanket about I km north of the crater rim and allowed
investigation of the crater on foot, without mobility aids. If Censorinus
presented operational difficulties, Littrow could be considered as an alter-
native site for this mission.
(6) Copernicus (peak). This bright crater, 95 km in diameter, is the source
of visible rays of ejected material extending for several hundred kilo-
meters. Its walls expose a 4-km vertical section of the lunar crust. The
floor, some 60 km across, contains multiple peaks with a maximum height
of 800 meters. A mission to the central peaks would be mainly a sam-
piing mission with the objective of bringing back material that once lay
at considerable depth.
(7) Marius Hills, a group of domes and cones near the center of Oceanus
Procellarum west-northwest of the crater Marius, are part of a ridge sys-
tem stretching some 1,900 km through Oceanus Procellarum. The vari-
ety of features in this area and their similarity to terrestrial volcanic
structures strongly suggests intensive and prolonged volcanic activity.
(8) Tycho (rim), like Censorinus a fresh impact crater, is in the southern high-
lands. It is much larger than Censorinus and offers an opportunity to
study many features common to large, fresh impact events, including
associated volcanism. The proposed landing site was near the Surveyor
V/I spacecraft, offering the option of returning some Surveyor parts. In
that area are several generations of flows, a pond or pool, ejected blocks
(probably from Tycho), and other ejecta features and structures.
(9) Rima Prinz I, in the Harbinger Mountains northeast of the Marius Hills, is
a double sinuous rille--a small meandering rille enclosed within a larger
sinuous rille. The origin of the rilles is of great interest because they
resemble channels carved by a flowing fluid. A landing near the mouth of
Rima Prinz I, selected because of the freshness of its details, would allow
examination of the lower part of the eroded valley, sampling the materials
and studying the exposed structures. An alternative, Schr_ter's Valley,
displays similar characteristics but appears older than Rima Prinz I.
347
Where No Man Has Gone Before
(10) Descartes. The area of the southern highlands north of the crater Des-
cartes and west of Mare Nectaris is characterized by hilly, groovy, and
furrowed deposits reminiscent of terrestrial volcanoes. A mission to a
region of intensive and prolonged volcanism within the lunar terrae was
considered most important, from both the geological and geochemical
viewpoints. An alternative to this site was Abulfeda, just to the
southwest.
The Group for Lunar Exploration Planning recommended this list of sites after
considering the expected evolution in capability as well as the constraints imposed
by operations. Those selected for "'J" missions, for example, were picked on
account of the additional time on the surface that would be available and the
increased mobility that would be provided by a powered vehicle. Tycho, accessi-
ble only in the early part of the year because of operational limitations, was
switched from the third to the second "J" mission for that reason, although it
was better than the Marius Hills site for exploration on foot.
The Apollo Site Selection Board accepted this list for planning purposes at its
meeting on July 10, 1969. As was to be expected, the list underwent considerable
revision during the next three years, both as to the choice of sites and the order
in which they would be explored, as mission planning became more detailed and
operational capability improved.
348
APPENDIX 4
1957
October: The Soviet Union placed the first artfficialearth satellite (Sputnik)
into orbit.
1958
April: The Air Force contracted with the Yerkes Observatory, University
of Chicago, to produce a new lunar photographic atlas.
The Air Force published a development plan for its manned space program,
which included two exploratory man-in-space projects, a lunar reconnais-
sance mission and a manned lunar landing and return; the plan envisioned
completion of the program in seven years at a cost of $1.5 billion.
June: The Air Force contracted with Rocketdyne to design a single-
chamber rocket engine burning kerosene and liquid oxygen and producing
1 to 1.5 million pounds of thrust.
July: President Eisenhower signed the National Aeronautics and Space
Act of 1958 (P.L. 85-568) establishing the National Aeronautics and Space
Administration.
October: The Special Committee on Space Technology, created in January
1958 and chaired by H. Guyford Stever of MIT, reported its recommenda-
tions: development of both clustered- and single-engine boosters of million-
pound thrust; vigorous attack on the problems of sustaining man in the space
environment; development of lifting reentry vehides; research on high-energy
propellant systems for launch vehicle upper stages; and evaluation of exist-
ing boosters and upper stages followed by intensive development of those
promising greatest utility.
November: A Space Task Group (STG) was organized at Langley Research Cen-
ter to implement NASA's first manned satellite project (Mercury). Robert
R. Gilruth was named project manager.
1959
349
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
lunar landing and return a few years later. NASA and industry officials envi-
sioned similar progress.
March: The first F-1 engine was successfully test-fired by Rocketdyne,
producing more than one million pounds of thrust.
April: NASA announced the selection of seven pilots for the Mercury
program.
NASA created a Research Steering Committee on Manned Space Flight.
Over the next several months this committee examined long-term human-
in-space problems to recommend future missions and coordination of research
programs at the NASA centers. At its May 25-26 meeting the committee
recommended the manned lunar landing as a focal point for studies in propul-
sion, vehicle configuration, structure, and guidance requirements, since a
lunar landing would constitute an end objective that did not have to be justi-
fied in terms of its contribution to a more useful goal.
November: STG appointed a panel to study preliminary design of a multiper-
son spacecraft for a circumlunar mission, conduct mission analyses, and plan
a test program.
1960
January: NASA presented its ten-year plan to Congress, calling for a pro-
gram leading to manned circumlunar flight and a permanent earth-orbiting
space station to start in 1965-1967 and a manned lunar landing some time
beyond 1970. Cost estimates for the plan ran to $1.5 billion annually for five
years.
February: NASA approved Project Ranger, a project to send an unmanned,
hard-landing spacecraft to the moon to relay television pictures of the lunar
surface to earth during the final stages of its flight.
March: The Army Ballistic Missile Agency's Development Operations Divi-
sion at Redstone Arsenal, Huntsville, Alabama, headed by Wernher von
Braun, was transferred to NASA as the George C. Marshall Space Flight
Center.
April-May: STG developed guidelines for the advanced manned spacecraft pro-
gram, including detailed propulsion and spacecraft requirements.
May: A meeting on space rendezvous was held at Langley Research Cen-
ter to discuss the problems of bringing two spacecraft together in space.
NASA began work on a project (later named Surveyor) to send a soft-landing
spacecraft to the moon to provide scientific and engineering data on the lunar
surface.
July: The House Committee on Science and Astronautics urged NASA
to intensify its efforts to send humans to the moon and back "in this decade."
In the committee's view, NASA's ten-year plan did not go far enough and
the space agency was not pressing forward with enough energy.
July: The name "Apollo" was approved for the advanced manned space
flight program.
NASA held its first NASA-Industry Program Plans Conference in Washing-
ton to brief industrial management on the overall space program. George
35O
Appendix4
M. Low, chief of NASA's Manned Space Flight program, stated that circum-
lunar flight and earth-orbiting missions would be carried out before 1970,
leading eventually to a manned lunar landing and a permanent space sta-
tion in earth orbit.
September: NASA issued a formal request for proposals for six-month feasibil-
ity studies for advanced manned spacecraft, to define a system fulfilling STG
guidelines, formulate a plan for implementing the program, identify areas
requiring long lead-time research and development, and estimate the total
cost of the program. In October proposals were received from 14 companies,
and in November contracts were awarded to Convair/Astronautics Division
of General Dynamics Corp., General Electric Company, and The Martin
Company.
November: A program of detailed studies of lunar geology was undertaken by
the U.S. Geological Survey, funded by NASA.
STG proposed to organize a number of Technical Liaison Groups to coor-
dinate the activities of NASA centers in research for Apollo.
1961
351
Where No Man Has Gone Before
1962
February: The first American to orbit the earth, Lt. Col. John H. Glenn, Jr.,
USMC, completed three orbits in a Mercury spacecraft and returned safely
to earth.
February-June: Several groups within NASA were intensively studying the var-
ious modes of going to the moon (direct ascent, rendezvous in earth orbit,
rendezvous in lunar orbit). The third method required a separate spacecraft
to detach itself, land on the moon, and return to lunar orbit to rendezvous
with the Apollo spacecraft.
March: At the request of the Office of Manned Space Flight, American Tele-
phone & Telegraph established a group called Bellcomm, Inc., to provide
independent analysis of systems and problems in the manned space flight
program. For the duration of Apollo, Bellcomm performed many services,
including advice on selection of landing sites, for OMSF.
July: NASA Headquarters announced that the lunar-orbit rendezvous
mode had been selected for the manned lunar landing project and that
requests for proposals would be issued for the second spacecraft (the "lunar
excursion module"). MSC invited 11 firms to submit proposals for the lunar
352
Appendix 4
1963
February: The President's budget request for fiscal 1964 included $5.712 bil-
lion for NASA. $1.207 billion was for Apollo--almost a threefold increase
over the previous year.
April: Preliminary plans for Apollo scientific instruments were completed.
Emphasis was placed on experiments that promised maximum return for the
least weight and complexity and were man-oriented and compatible with
weight and volume available in the spacecraft. Experiments would be selected
after evaluation of proposals from outside scientists.
May: The Mercury project ended with the 34-hour, 22-orbit flight of
astronaut L. Gordon Cooper, Jr., in the spacecraft Faith Z
August: NASA Headquarters approved the Lunar Orbiter project, which
would use unmanned spacecraft to take detailed photographs of the lunar
surface to be used in selecting landing sites for Apollo.
September: Dr. George E. MueUer became Associate Administrator for Manned
Space Flight, replacing D. Brainerd Holmes.
October: Headquarters sent MSC some general guidelines for scientific inves-
tigations of the moon. Principal scientific activity was expected to include
comprehensive observation of lunar phenomena, collection of geologic sam-
ples, and emplacement of monitoring equipment.
October: Fourteen more test pilots were selected as astronauts.
November: A Manned Space Science Division was established in the Office of
Space Science and Applications (OSSA), NASA Headquarters, to coordinate
the efforts of OSSA and the Office of Manned Space Flight in developing
scientific experiments for Apollo.
MSC's Space Environment Division recommended 10 specific areas on the
moon for evaluation as landing sites for Apollo. These sites and others would
be photographed by Lunar Orbiter, after which some would be selected as
targets for Surveyor, a project to land unmanned spacecraft on the moon
and study the surface.
353
WhereNo ManHas Gone Before
1964
1965
354
Appendix4
June: Six scientists were selected for training as NASA astronauts. Two
were qualified pilots; the other four were sent to Air Force flight training
school before beginning astronaut training.
July: OMSF established an Apollo Site Selection Board to work with
OSSA, MSC, and Bellcomm in choosing the sites where Apollo missions
would land on the moon.
The Space Science Board convened a Summer Study at Woods Hole, Mass.,
to recommend directions for future space research. The agenda included
manned exploration of the moon and planets. Conferees drew up a list of
15 questions that should determine the course of lunar research. Following
the Woods Hole sessions, another group met at Falmouth, Mass., to formu-
late specific recommendations for the Apollo and related unmanned projects.
August: Three firms were awarded six-month contracts to design prototypes
of an Apollo lunar surface experiments package, which would be left on the
moon and would return data by telemetry over a period of time.
September: Meeting with MSC scientists, Public Health Service physicians
insisted on rigorous quarantine of astronauts and lunar samples following
each lunar mission.
December: Two Gemini spacecraft performed the first space rendezvous,
maneuvering to a separation distance of one foot with no difficulty.
1966
February: OSSA selected the experiment complement for the Apollo lunar sur-
face experiments package (ALSEP).
The first Apollo spacecraft, a test version of the command and service mod-
ule, was launched from Cape Canaveral on a two-stage Saturn I-B rocket.
March: The Gemini VIII spacecraft performed a rendezvous with an
unmanned target vehicle, then docked with it--the first accomplishment of
this critical procedure. The mission was aborted soon afterwards when a small
thruster malfunctioned.
NASA Hedquarters selected the Bendix Corporation to build the lunar sur-
face experiments package.
May: Surveyor I, the first instrumented spacecraft designed to soft-land
on the moon and return scientific data, landed in Oceanus Procellarum.
August: Lunar Orbiter L the first of five photographic satellites to be launched
in the following 12 months, returned detailed photographs of nine primary
and seven alternate Apollo landing sites.
Contracts were let for the first two phases of construction of the lunar receiv-
ing laboratory at the Manned Spacecraft Center.
December: MSC created a Science and Applications Directorate to manage the
scientific activities of the center, removing this responsibility from the
Engineering and Development Directorate.
355
Where No Man Has Gone Before
1967
356
Appendix4
1968
January: The lunar module was given its first test (unmanned) in an earth-
orbiting mission.
August: Plans were set in motion to fly a circumlunar mission on the sec-
ond manned Apollo flight.
In view of problems in building the instruments and constraints appear-
ing in mission planning, OMSF decided not to fly the lunar surface experi-
ments package on the first lunar landing mission. Instead, a simplified set
of instruments (a laser reflector and a passive seismometer) would be devel-
oped for the first mission and the more extensive set currently in develop-
ment would be flown later.
October: Apollo 7, the first manned flight of the Apollo command module,
was launched for an 11-day earth-orbital test. All primary objectives of the
flight were met.
An operational readiness inspection of the lunar receiving laboratory was
conducted and numerous discrepancies were noted. A 10-day simulation of
LRL operations similarly uncovered many shortcomings in equipment and
procedures.
December: The first flight of a manned mission on a Saturn V was launched
on December 21. Apollo 8 flew to the moon, completed 10 orbits, and returned
safely to earth on December 27. While in lunar orbit the crew made numer-
ous visual and photographic observations of potential landing sites.
During the year: The Apollo Site Selection Board, working with the Group for
Lunar Exploration Planning and BeUcomm, selected five sites as alternatives
for the first lunar landing mission. Work continued into 1969 to produce and
refine a list from which sites for subsequent exploration missions would be
chosen.
1969
March: Apollo 9 checked out manned operation of the lunar module, includ-
ing rendezvous procedures, in a successful 10-day mission in earth orbit.
May: Apollo 10 carried out all phases of a lunar landing mission except
the final descent and landing. The lunar module descended to 50,000 feet
(15,000 meters) above the lunar surface, visually verified the approach to the
primary landing site for the first landing, and returned to lunar orbit to ren-
dezvous with the command module.
357
Where No Man Has Gone Before
1970
January: The Lunar Science Institute adjacent to the Manned Spacecraft Cen-
ter was officially dedicated.
Detailed reports on the analysis of samples from Apollo 11 were presented
at a Lunar Science Conference in Houston, the first of a series of annual con-
ferences on lunar (and later planetary) science.
Budget restrictions and the need to get on with post-Apollo development
forced NASA to cancel Apollo 20 and stretch out the remaining seven mis-
sions to six-month invervals.
April: Apollo 13, launched on April 11, was aborted two days later when
an oxygen tank containing an undetected defect exploded. Mission Control
teams devised emergency procedures to conserve oxygen and electrical
power, and the spacecraft and crew were brought back safely to earth on
April 17 after looping around the moon. An investigation board concluded
that the explosion resulted from a highly unlikely combination of circum-
stances that were traceable to human oversight.
358
Appendix4
September: Two more missions, Apollo 15 and 19, were canceled because of
budget cuts. The remaining four missions were designated Apollo 14, 15,
16 and 17.
1971
January: Apollo 14 landed at a site of prime scientific interest, the Fra Mauro
Formation. During two excursions to the lunar surface the astronauts
emplaced a second set of scientific instruments and collected some 92 pounds
(40 kg.) of samples, but failed to reach a crater that had been one of their
primary objectives. The orbiting CSM carried out considerable photography
during the mission, including photography of a landing site proposed for
a future mission ("bootstrap" photography).
April: On the recommendation of the Interagency Committee on Back Con-
tamination, NASA discontinued the practice of quarantining returned lunar
samples and astronauts. No evidence of viable organisms on the moon had
been produced on three lunar landing missions.
July: Apollo 15 carried the first extended lunar module and the first lunar
roving vehicle to the moon. The mission landed near Mount Hadley and
Hadley Rille and stayed almost 67 hours on the surface--twice as long as
any prior mission. The astronauts made three trips from their lunar module,
emplaced the third set of experiments (including a seismometer that com-
pleted a three-site seismic network on the moon), and drove the "rover"
a total distance of 171/2 miles (28 km.). The orbiting CSM carried the first scien-
tific instrument module (SIM), which housed sensors that recorded data from
the moon's surface. A moon-circling subsatellite was launched to measure
particles and fields in the lunar environment. During the trip back to earth
the command module pilot retrieved film cassettes from the SIM experiments,
the first extravehicular activity conducted during a moon-to-earth voyage.
1972
359 !
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
December: The last lunar exploration mission, Apollo 17, carried the first scien-
tist (geologist Harrison H. Schmitt) to the moon. After landing in the Taurus-
Littrow region, the astronauts stayed 75 hours, spent 22 hours outside the
lunar module, drove their rover 22 miles (35 km.), and collected nearly 250
pounds (113 kin.) of samples.
1973
February: The Manned Spacecraft Center was renamed the Lyndon B. Johnson
Space Center.
March: A Lunar Programs Office was established in the Office of Space
Sciences, NASA Headquarters, to conduct the Lunar Data Analysis and Syn-
thesis Program. The program would oversee the collection and scientific anal-
ysis of data from the lunar surface instruments and the lunar samples.
May: The first post-Apollo manned space flight program began with the
launch of Skylab 1, a Saturn S-IVB stage converted to a laboratory module
capable of supporting three-person crews for long periods in earth orbit.
Skylab was the outgrowth of earlier "Apollo Applications" planning intended
to use the hardware developed for Apollo to collect scientific data. Skylab 1
used the last Saturn V rocket ever launched. Crews occupied the laboratory
for periods of 28, 59, and 84 days; the last mission ended on February 8, 1974.
August: The Office of Manned Space Flight designated an official to be
responsible for the final phasing out of the Apollo project.
1975
360
ii
,] !!
APPENDIX 5
Launch
Mission vehicle CSM LM Call signs Date, time c Launch
No. No. a No. No. Crew b (CSM, LM) of launch site d
Apollo 7 205 101 None Schirra, Eisele, Apollo 7 11 Oct. 1968 ETR
Cunningham (no LM) 10:02:45 am. LC-34
Apollo 8 503 103 None Borman, Lovell, Apollo 8 21 Dec. 1968 KSC
Anders (no LM) 7:51:00 a.m. LC-39A
Apollo 10 505 106 4 Stafford, Young, Charlie Brown, 18 May 1969 KSC
Ceman Snoopy 11:49:00 a.m. LC-39B
Apollo 14 509 110 8 Shepard, Roosa, Kitty Hawk, 31Jan. 1971 KSC
Mitchell Antares 5:03:02 p.m. LC-39A
Source for all tabIes: "Apono Program Summary Report" JSC-09423, April I975
361
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Distance
Apollo 7 22 Oct. 1968 260:09:03 27°38'N, 64 ° 9'W Atlantic 1.9 U.S.S. Essex
6:11:48 a.m
Apollo 8 27 Dec. 1968 147:00:42 8 ° 6'N, 165 ° l_'V Pacific 1.4 U.S.S. Yorktown
10:51:42 a.m.
Apollo 9 13 March 1969 241:00:54 23°13'N, 67°59'W Atlantic 2.7 U.S.S. Guadalcanal
12:00:53 p.m.
Apollo 10 26 May 1969 192:03:23 15 ° 4'S, 164°39'W Pacific 1.3 U.S.S. Princeton
11:52:23 a.m.
Apollo 11 24 July 1969 195:18:35 13°18'N, 169 ° 9%V Pacific 1.7 U.S.S. Hornet
11:50:35 a.m.
Apollo 12 24 Nov. 1969 244:36:25 15_47'S, 165 ° 9"W Pacific 2.0 U.S.S. Hornet
3:58:25 p_m.
Apollo 13 17 April 1970 142:54:41 21o38'S, 165°22'W Pacific 1.0 U.S.S. lwo Jima
1:07:41 p.m.
Apollo 14 9 Feb. 1971 216:01:58 27 ° 1'S, 172°40"W Pacific 0.6 U.S.S. New Orleans
4:05:00 p.m.
Apollo 15 7 Aug. 197t 259:11:53 26 ° 8'N, 158 ° 8'W Pacific 1.0 U.S.S. Okinawa
3:45:53 p.m.
Apollo 16 27 Apr. 1972 265:51:05 0°42'S, 156°13'W Pacific 3.0 U.S.S. Ticonderoga
2:45:05 p.m.
Apollo 17 19 Dec. 1972 301:51:59 17°53'S, 166 ° 7'W Pacific 1.0 U.S.S. Ticonderoga
2:24:59 p.m
• Command module splashdown, Eastern Standard Time. c Best estimate; may be based on recovery ship position data, _ com-
b Hours:minutes:seconds. puter data, or trajectory reconstruction
362
Appendix5
Weight of
Lunar Time on samples
Duration coUected
Mission landing site Date, time a of: lunar
No. (lat., long,lname) Lunar landing Lunar liftoff surface b of EVAs c (kg.)
Apollo 12 3.2°S, 23.4°W 19 Nov. 1969 20 Nov. 1969 31:31:12 3:56:03 16.7
Oceanus 1:54:36 a.m. 9:25:48 a.m. 3:49:15 17,6
Apollo 14 d 3.6°S, 17.5°W 5 Feb. 1971 6 Feb. 1971 33:30:31 4:47:50 20.5
Fra Mauro 4:18:11 a.m 1:48:42 p.m. 4:34:41 22.3
9:22:31 42.8
0:33:07 • ---
Apollo 15 26A °N, 3.7°E 30 July 1971 2 Aug. 1971 66:54:53
Hadley-Apennine 5:16:29 p.m. 1:11:22 p.m. 6:32:42 14.5
7:12:14 34.9
4:49:50 27.3
19:07:53 76.7
Apollo 16 9.0°S, 15.5°E 20 Apr. 1972 23 Apr. 1972 71:02:13 7:11:02 29.9
Descartes 9:23:35 p.m. 8:25:48 p.m. 7:23:11 29.0
5:40:03 35.4
20:14:16 94.3
7:11:53 14.3
Apollo 17 20.2°N, 30.8°E 11 Dec. 1972 14 Dec. 1972 74:59:40
Taurus-Littrow 2:54:57 p.m. 5:54:37 p.m. 7:36:56 34.1
7:15:08 62.0
22:03:57 110.4
• Eastern Standard Time_ Liftoff time calculated from touchdown time plus time on lunar surface.
bTouchdown to [ifioff, hr:min:sec.
Extravehicular activity in hr:min:sec, LM hatch opening to closing Multiple EVAs shown separately.
d Apollo 13 was aborted following an explosion in the service module 55 hr, 54 rain after launch. Intended landing site, on the Fra Mauro forma-
tion, was used for Apollo 14.
"Standup" EVA--commander stood up in open upper LM hatch to make visual and photographic observations ol the landing area.
Source: JSC-09423, "Apollo Program Summary Report," April 1975.
363
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Mission
Experiment 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
1. Surface Experiments
Source: JSC, "What We've Learned About The Moon/' July 1980.
364
Appendix 5
Apollo Lunar Surface Experiments Package Arrays and Status as of April 1975"
Passive seismic Shot/period Z-axls Not deployed. Long-perlod Z-axis FulI operation Full operation
modulation drop in
since 1I!5/71.
Heat flow Not deployed Probe 2 not to full Inoperative since Pull operation
ex_eriment provides
useful data
ton gauge 14 hours after turn- data since 3/2"9:7"2 data since 2/22/73.
on I IF20i69
Instrument operaled
of lunation
* The Apollo 14 ALSEP station failed in January 1976 The stations still operating (12, 15, 16, and 17) were turned off September 30, 1977.
365
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Source: memos from D/rector, blight Operations, MSC, to multiple addressees, listing personnet assignments for the Mission ControJ Center
for each flight.
366
APPENDIX 6
Commander: Frank Borman, Colonel,** U.S. Air Force. Born March 14, 1928,
Gary, Indiana. B.S. 1950, U.S. Military Academy; M.S. (aeronautical engineer-
ing), 1957, California Institute of Technology. Chosen with the second group
of astronauts in 1962; backup command pilot for Gemini IV, command pilot
for Gemini VII, the longest manned mission (14 days) up to that time.
Command Module Pilot: James Arthur Lovell, Jr., Captain, U.S. Navy. Born
March 25, 1929, Cleveland, Ohio. B.S. 1952, U.S. Naval Academy. Chosen
with the second group of astronauts in 1962; backup pilot for Gemini W, pilot
for Gemini VII, backup command pilot for Gemini IX, command pilot for
Gemini XII; later served as backup commander for Apollo 11 and commander
for Apollo 13.
Lunar Module Pilot: William Anderson Anders, Major, U.S. Air Force. Born
October 17, 1933, in Hong Kong. B.S. 1955, U.S. Naval Academy; M.S.
(nuclear engineering), 1963, Air Force Institute of Technology. Chosen with
the third group of astronauts in 1963; backup pilot for Gemini XI; later served
as backup command module pilot for Apollo 11.
Commander: Thomas Patton Stafford, Colonel, U.S. Air Force. Born Septem-
ber 17, 1930, Weatherford, Oklahoma. B.S., 1952, U.S. Naval Academy. Cho-
sen with the second group of astronauts in 1962; backup pilot for Gemini
*Source: Astronauts and Cosmonauts, Biographicaland Statistical Data [Revised May 31, 1978], report
prepared for the House Committee on Science and Technology by the Congressional Research Ser-
vice, Library of Congress, July 1978; Apollo mission reports.
**Military ranks given are those held at the time of the mission.
367
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
m, pilot for Gemini VI, backup commander for Apollo 7; later commander,
ApoUo-Soyuz Test Project.
Command Module Pilot: John Watts Young, Commander, U.S. Navy. Born Sep-
tember 24, 1930, San Francisco, California. B.S. (aeronautical engineering),
1952, Georgia Institute of Technology. Chosen with the second group of
astronauts in 1962; pilot of Gemini HI, backup pilot for Gemini VI, command
pilot for Gemini X; later backup commander for Apollo 13, commander for
Apollo 16 (ninth man to walk on the moon), and backup commander for
Apollo 17. Later commanded several flights of the Space Shuttle Orbiter.
Lunar Module Pilot: Eugene Andrew Cernan, Commander, U.S. Navy. Born
March 14, 1934, Chicago, Illinois. B.S. (electrical engineering), 1956, Purdue
University; M.S. (aeronautical engineering), 1961, Purdue and the U.S. Naval
Postgraduate School. Chosen with the third group of astronauts in 1963. Pilot
for Gemini IX, backup pilot for Gemini XII, backup lunar module pilot for
Apollo 7; later backup commander for Apollo 14 and commander of Apollo
17 (eleventh man to walk on the moon).
Commander: Leroy Gordon Cooper, Colonel, U.S. Air Force. Born March 6,
1927, Shawnee, Oklahoma. B.S. (aeronautical engineering), 1956, U.S. Air
Force Institute of Technology. Chosen with the first group of astronauts in
1959. Backup pilot for Mercury-Atlas 8, pilot for Mercury-Atlas 9 (last flight
in the Mercury project), command pilot for Gemini V, backup command pilot
for Gemini XII.
Command Module Pilot: Donn Fulton Eisele, Major, U.S. Air Force. Born June
23, 1930, Columbus, Ohio. B.S., 1952, U.S. Naval Academy; M.S. (astronau-
tics), 1960, Air Force Institute of Technology. Chosen with the third group
of astronauts in 1963; command module pilot for Apollo 7.
368
Appendix 6
Chosen with the third group of astronauts in 1963. Backup pilot for Gemini
IX, pilot for Gemini XII; second man to walk on the moon.
Commander: Charles ("Pete") Conrad, Jr., Commander, U.S. Navy. Born June
2, 1930, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania. B.S. (aeronautical engineering), 1953,
Princeton University. Chosen with the second group of astronauts in 1962.
Served as pilot for Gemini V, backup command pilot of Gemini VIII, com-
mand pilot for Gemini XI, backup commander for Apollo 9; third man to walk
on the moon. Later served as commander of Skylab 2.
Command Module Pilot: Richard Francis Gordon, Jr., Commander, U.S. Navy.
Born October 5, 1929, Seattle, Washington. B.S. (chemistry), 1951, Univer-
sity of Washington. Chosen with the third group of astronauts in 1963. Served
as backup pilot for Gemini VIII, pilot for Gemini XI, backup command mod-
ule pilot for Apollo 9; later served as backup commander for Apollo 15.
Lunar Module Pilot: Alan LaVerne Bean, Commander, U.S. Navy. Born March
15, 1932, Wheeler, Texas. B.S. (aeronautical engineering), 1955, The Univer-
sity of Texas. Chosen with the third group of astronauts in 1963. Served as
backup command pilot for Gemini X, backup lunar module pilot for Apollo
9; fourth man to walk on the moon. Later served as commander for Skylab
3 and backup commander for the Apollo-Soyuz Test Project.
369
Where No Man Has Gone Before
launch when Thomas Mattingly (see Apollo 16 prime crew, below) was found
to have been exposed to rubella.
Lunar Module Pilot: Fred Wallace Haise (civilian). Born November 14, 1933,
Biloxi, Mississippi. B.S. (aeronautical engineering), 1951, University of Okla-
homa. Served as an aviator in the U.S. Marine Corps and the U.S. Air Force.
Chosen with the fifth group of astronauts in 1966. Served as backup lunar
module pilot for Apollo 11 and later as backup commander for Apollo 16.
Commander: Alan Bartlett Shepard, Jr., Captain, U.S. Navy. Born Novem-
ber 18, 1923, East Derry, New Hampshire. B.S., 1944, U.S. Naval Academy.
Chosen with the first group of astronauts in 1959, he was the United States'
first man in space (Mercury-Redstone 3, Freedom 7, suborbital flight March
1961) and backup pilot for Mercury-Atlas 9 (Faith 7). He was grounded
because of an inner-ear ailment until May 1969; On returning to flight sta-
tus he was assigned as commander of Apollo 14 and became the fifth man
(the only one of the first group of astronauts) to walk on the moon.
Command Module Pilot: Stuart Allen Roosa, Major, U.S. Air Force. Born
August 15, 1933, Durango, Colorado. B.S. (aeronautical engineering), 1960,
University of Colorado. Chosen with the fifth group of astronauts in 1966.
Apollo 14 was his first assignment; he later served as backup command
module pilot for Apollo 16 and Apollo 17.
Lunar Module Pilot: Edgar Dean Mitchell, Commander, U.S. Navy. Born Sep-
tember 17, 1930, Hereford, Texas. B.S. (industrial management), 1952, Car-
negie Institute of Technology; B.S. (aeronautical engineering), 1961, U.S.
Naval Postgraduate School, Sc.D. (aeronautics and astronautics), 1964, Mas-
sachusetts Institute of Technology. Chosen with the fifth group of astronauts
in 1966; sixth man to walk on the moon. Later served as backup lunar mod-
ule pilot for Apollo 16.
370
Appendix 6
14 was his first and only Apollo assignment; he later participated in the
approach and landing tests and the orbital flight tests of the Space Shuttle
Orbiter.
Commander: David Randolph Scott, Colonel, U.S. Air Force. Born June 6,
1932, in San Antonio, Texas. B.S., 1954, U.S. Military Academy; M.S. (aer-
onautics and astronautics) and Engineer of Aeronautics and Astronautics,
1963, Massachusetts Institute of Technology. Chosen with the third group
of astronauts in 1963. Served as pilot for Gemini VIII, command module
pilot for Apollo, 9; seventh man to walk on the moon.
Command Module Pilot: Alfred Merrill Worden, Major, U.S. Air Force. Born
February 7, 1932, in Jackson, Michigan. B.S., 1955, U.S. Military Academy;
M.S. (astronautical/aeronautical engineering and instrumentation engineer-
ing), 1963, University of Michigan. Chosen with the fifth group of astronauts
in 1966. Served as backup command module pilot on Apollo 12.
Lunar Module Pilot: James Benson Irwin, Lieutenant Colonel, U.S. Air Force.
Born March 17, 1930, Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania. B.S., 1951, U.S. Naval
Academy; M.S. (aeronautical and instrumentation engineering), 1957,
University of Michigan. Served as backup lunar module pilot on Apollo
12; eighth man to walk on the moon. Resigned from NASA and the Air
Force in 1972.
371
Where No Man Has Gone Before
ing), 1958, Auburn University. Chosen with the fifth group of astronauts in
1966. Served as command module pilot for Apollo 13 until three days before
launch, when it was discovered that he had been exposed to rubella (Ger-
man measles) and had no immunity. Later commanded the fourth orbital test
flight of the first Space Shuttle Orbiter, Columbia.
Lunar Module pilot: Charles Moss Duke, Jr., Lieutenant Colonel, U.S. Air Force.
Born October 3, 1935, Charlotte, North Carolina. B.S., 1957, U.S. Naval
Academy. Chosen with the fifth group of astronauts in 1966. Served as backup
lunar module pilot on Apollo 13. Tenth man to walk on the moon.
372
!:!
!;i
Appendix 6
Two other missions, Apollo 7 and Apollo 9, were earth-orbiting missions con-
ducted to test the redesigned Apollo (Block I1) spacecraft and the lunar module
before committing them to a lunar mission.
Commander: Walter Marty Schirra, Jr., Captain, U.S. Navy. Born March 12,
1923, Hackensack, New Jersey. B.S., 1945, U.S. Naval Academy. Chosen with
the first group of astronauts in 1959; the only member of this group to fly
in Mercury, Gemini, and Apollo. Served as backup pilot for Mercury-Atlas 7
(Aurora 7) and pilot for Mercury-Atlas 8 (Sigma 7), backup command pilot for
Gemini III, command pilot of Gemini VI (first mission to conduct a ren-
dezvous).
Command Module Pilot: Donn F. Eisele (see backup crew, Apollo 10).
Lunar Module Pilot (no lunar module assigned to this flight): Ronnie Walter
Cunningham (civilian). Born March 16, 1932, Creston, Iowa. B.A., 1960, and
M.A., 1961 (physics), University of California at Los Angeles. Chosen with
the third group of astronauts in 1963.
Commander: James Alton McDivitt, Colonel, U.S. Air Force. Born June 10, 1929,
Chicago, Illinois. B.S. (aeronautical engineering), 1959, University of Michi-
gan. Chosen with the second group of astronauts in 1962. Command pilot
for Gemini IV. Served as manager of the Apollo Spacecraft Project Office at
MSC from 1969 to 1972.
Command Module Pilot: David R. Scott (see prime crew, Apollo 15).
Lunar Module Pilot: Russell Louis Schweickart (civilian). Born October 25, 1935,
Neptune, New Jersey. B.S. (aeronautical engineering), 1956; M.S. (aeronau-
tics and astronautics), 1963, Massachusetts Institute of Technology. Chosen
with the third group of astronauts in 1963. Later served as backup commander
for Skylab 2.
373
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Support crews were assigned for the first time in Apollo, to assume some of the
large work load entailed by the greater complexity of the Apollo spacecraft and
the lunar missions. Their duties were many and varied: maintaining the flight
data file, filling in for prime and backup crew members at design reviews where
necessary, and keeping the prime and backup crews informed of changes in proce-
dures (simulations, experiments, etc.). Some support crewmen later served on
prime or backup crews but many did not. Following are the members of the sup-
port crews for all the Apollo missions.
Apollo 7
Edward Galen Givens, Jr., Major, U.S. Air Force, born January 5, 1930, Quanah,
Texas. B.S., 1952, U.S. Naval Academy. Chosen with the fifth group of
astronauts in 1966; killed in an automobile accident June 6, 1967.
Apollo 8
Apollo 9
Apollo 10
374
Appendix6
Apollo 11
William Reid Pogue, Lieutenant Colonel, U.S. Air Force. Born January 23, 1930,
Okemah, Oklahoma. B.S. (education), 1951, Oklahoma Baptist University;
M.S. (mathematics), 1960, Oklahoma State University. Chosen with the fifth
group of astronauts in 1966. Later served on support crews for Apollo 13 and
Apollo 14 and as pilot for Skylab 4.
Apollo 12
Paul Joseph Weitz, Lieutenant Commander, U.S. Navy. Born July 25, 1932, Erie,
Pennsylvania. B.S. (aeronautical engineering), 1954, Pennsylvania State
University; M.S. (aeronautical engineering), U.S. Naval Postgraduate School.
Chosen with the fifth group of astronauts in 1966. Later served as pilot on
Skylab 2.
Edward George Gibson (civilian). Born November 8, 1936, Buffalo, New York.
B.S. (engineering), 1959, University of Rochester; M.S. (engineering), 1960,
Ph.D. (engineering), 1964, California Institute of Technology. Chosen with
the first group of scientist-astronauts in 1965. Later served as scientist-pilot
on Skylab 4.
Apollo 13
Jack Robert Lousma, Lieutenant Colonel, U.S. Marine Corps. Born February
29, 1936, Grand Rapids, Michigan. B.S. (aeronautical engineering), 1959,
University of Michigan; Aeronautical Engineer, 1965, U.S. Naval Postgradu-
ate School. Chosen with the fifth goup of astronauts in 1966. Later served
as pilot for Skylab 3 and backup docking module pilot for the Apollo-Soyuz
Test Project.
Apollo 14
375
Where No Man Has Gone Before
1965, Stanford University. Chosen with the fifth group of astronauts in 1966.
Later served as backup pilot for Skylab 2.
Charles Gordon Fullerton, Lieutenant Colonel, U.S. Air Force. Born October
11, 1936, Rochester, New York. B.S. (mechanical engineering), 1957, M.S.
(mechanical engineering), 1958, California Institute of Technology. Transferred
to the NASA astronaut corps in 1969 from the Air Force Manned Orbiting
Laboratory project (canceled). Later served on the support crew for Apollo 17.
Apollo 15
Karl Gordon Henize (civilian). Born October 17, 1926, Cincinnati, Ohio. B.S.
(mathematics), 1947; M.S. (astronomy), 1948, University of Virginia; Ph.D.
(astronomy), 1954, University of Michigan. Chosen with the second group
of scientist-astronauts in 1967. Principal investigator for ultraviolet astronomy
experiments in the Skylab project. Later flew on Space Shuttle missions.
Robert Allan Ridley Parker (civilian). Born December 14, 1936, New York, New
York. B.A. (astronomy and physics), 1958, Amherst College; Ph.D.
(astronomy), 1962, California Institute of Technology. Chosen with the sec-
ond group of scientist-astronauts in 1967. Later served as support crewman
and mission scientist for Apollo 17 and chief scientist for the Skylab missions.
Joseph Percival Alien IV (civilian). Born June 27, 1937, Crawfordsville, Indi-
ana. B.A. (mathematics and physics), 1959, DePauw University; M.S.
(physics), 1961, Ph.D. (nuclear physics), 1965, Yale University. Chosen with
the second group of scientist-astronauts in 1967. Later served as mission scien-
tist for Apollo 15; left the astronaut corps in 1975 to serve as NASA's Assis-
tant Administrator for Legislative Affairs; returned in 1978 to participate in
the Space Shuttle program.
Apollo 16
376
Appendix6
Apollo 17
Robert Franklyn Overmyer, Lieutenant Colonel, U.S. Marine Corps. Born July
14, 1936, Lorain, Ohio. B.S. (physics), 1958, Baldwin-Wallace College, M.S.
(aeronautics), 1964, U.S. Naval Postgraduate School. Transferred to the NASA
astronaut corps in 1969 from the Air Force Manned Orbiting Laboratory proj-
ect (canceled). Later served as support crewman and capsule communicator
in Moscow for the Apollo-Soyuz Test Proiect and commanded STS Mission
31-B in the Space Shuttle program.
Selection criteria: under 40 years of age; less than 5 ft., 11 in. tall; hold a
bachelor's degree in engineering or equivalent; graduate of test pilot school; quali-
fied jet pilot with at least 1,500 hours of flying time.
Lt. M. Scott Carpenter, USN;
Capt. L. Gordon Cooper, USAF;
Lt. Col. John H. Glenn, Jr., USMC;
Capt. Virgil I. ("Gus") Grissom, USAF (died in AS-204 fire, Jan. 27, 1967);
Lt. Comdr. Walter M. Schirra, Jr., USN;
Lt. Comdr. Alan B. Shepard, Jr., USN; and
Capt. Donald K. ("Deke") Slayton, USAF.
377
WhereNo ManHasGoneBefore
378
Appendix6
379
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
astronaut corps so that they would be familiar with the spacecraft and the mis-
sion and would understand procedures.
Following is a list of CapComs for the Apollo missions.
Apollo 7: Stafford, Evans, Pogue, Swigert, Young, Cernan.
Apollo 8: Collins, Mattingly, Carr, Armstrong, Aldrin, Brand, Haise.
Apollo 9: Roosa, Evans, Worden, Conrad, Gordon, Bean.
Apollo 10: Duke, Engle, Lousma, McCandless.
Apollo 11: Duke, Evans, McCandless, Lovell, Anders, Mattingly, Haise, Lind,
Garriott, Schmitt.
*Apollo 12: Carr, Gibson, Weitz, Lind, Scott, Worden, Irwin.
Apollo 13: Kerwin, Brand, Lousma, Young, Mattingly.
Apollo 14: Fullerton, McCandless, Haise, Evans.
Apollo 15: Allen, Fullerton, Henize, Mitchell, Parker, Schmitt, Shepard, Gor-
don, Brand.
Apollo 16: Peterson, Fullerton, Irwin, Haise, Roosa, Mitchell, Hartsfield,
England, Overmyer.
Apollo 17: Fullerton, Overmyer, Parker, Allen, Shepard, Mattingly, Duke,
Roosa, Young.
*Four civilian non-astronauts served as backup CapComs on this mission: Dickie K. Warren, James
O. Rippey, James L. Lewis, and Michael R. Wash.
380
Appendix 6
Total hours
Astronaut in space a Missions b
a Liftoff to splashdown.
b A, Apollo; GT, Gemini-Titan; MA, Mercury-Atlas; MR, Mercury Redstone (suborbital).
Source: Astronautics and Aeronautics, annual summaries of space flights; Apollo mission
reports.
381
APPENDIX 7
*This discussion is based primarily on NASA Technical Note "IN D-7112, "Apollo Experience
Report--Simulation of Manned Space Flight for Crew Training," by C. H. Woodling, Stanley Faber,
John J. Van Bockel, Charles C. Olasky, Wayne K. Williams, John L. C. Mire, and James R. Homer,
March 1973.
382
Appendix 7
*In the early days of the project, details of spacecraft design changed so rapidly that it was difficult
to keep the simulators up to date. At one point during training for the first manned mission (AS-204),
Gus Grissom became so disgusted with the discrepancies between the simulator and the spacecraft
that he hung a lemon on the trainer. Courtney G. Brooks, James M. Grimwood, and Loyd S. Swen-
son, Jr., Chariots for Apollo: A History of Manned Lunar Spacecraft, NASA SP-4205 (Washington, 1979),
p. 209.
383
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
zero gravity. The alternative method used the buoyant effect of water. By attach-
ing weights to various parts of the body of a suited astronaut it was possible to
achieve "neutral buoyancy" in a large tank. Many tasks were rehearsed and proce-
dures modified in the neutral-buoyancy facilities at MSC and at Marshall Space
Flight Center. The method had the advantage of providing all the time needed;
its major disadvantage was that it was less realistic than the aircraft flights on
account of the viscosity of the water, which hampered movement. Still, it had
its place in zero-gravity training, and astronauts generally found that it gave a
conservative estimate of the difficulty of a task. Anything that could be done in
the neutral-buoyancy tank could usually be done in space.
Lunar surface simulations were conducted at a site off to one corner of the
Manned Spacecraft Center, where a few acres of ground had been pocked with
craters and strewn with rocks and gravel to simulate the moon's surface. Here
astronauts checked out deployment of the lunar surface experiments and prac-
ticed sampling. No attempt was made to approximate the reduced gravity of the
moon, although NASA engineers devised a suspension system that offset five-
sixths of the astronaut's weight, which was valuable for evaluating techniques
of locomotion and manipulation.
Field geology was another important phase of astronaut training. No terres-
trial site duplicates the lunar surface, but the rugged conditions expected to be
found on the moon have many counterparts on earth. Among the areas visited
by astronauts and their instructors were the Grand Canyon in Arizona; volcanic
areas in Iceland, Mexico, New Mexico, Alaska, and Hawaii; and the Ries Crater
area in West Germany. Each site had specific features applicable to lunar geol-
ogy, and each provided the opportunity to conduct surface operations analogous
to those to be used on the moon.
Besides such "hands-on" rehearsal of mission operations, astronauts sat
through many hours of classroom-type work--lengthy briefings on the spacecraft
systems, principles of propulsion, guidance and navigation, and orbital mechanics.
They also spent many a day in design reviews, crew compartment fit-and-function
reviews, and all the other reviews that punctuated the progress of spacecraft from
design to delivery and played important roles in the formulation of flight plans.
= This discussion does not by any means exhaustively cover the effort that went
into simulation and training, but it may indicate the complexity of the simulation
program and its importance to the Apollo project. The tables that follow give an
indication of the amount of time required to prepare for lunar missions.
384
Appendix 7
Lunar module
LM simulator 13,317 c
Lunar landing training vehicle 1,130 a
LM procedures simulator 770
Simulator briefings 533 Briefings
Full mission engineering simulator 179
64 Command and service module 4,060
Translation & docking simulator
Subtotal 15,993 Guidance and navigation 2,397
Lunar module 2,130
TOTAL 37,953 Lunar topography 1,458
Procedures Launch vehicle 656
Includes briefings, geology field trips, lunar surface simulations, and lunar roving vehicle trainer operation.
t'Related to zero-gravity flight operations
• Includes lunar roving vehicle navigation simuIator
a Includes lunar landing training vehicle flights (2 hr per flight), vehicle systems briefings, lunar landing research facility, and lunar landing
training vehicle time.
"Tables 1 through 4 adapted from C. H. Woodling et al., "Apollo Experience Report--Simulation of Manned Space Flight for
Crew Training," NASA TN D-7112, March 1973.
a Apollo 7, 8, 9, 10.
b Apollo If, 12, 13, 14.
c Apollo 15, 16, 17.
385
APPENDIX 8
Apollo 13, the third manned lunar landing and exploration mission, had been
tentatively scheduled in July 1969 for launch in March 1970, but by the end of
the year the launch date had been shifted to April. In August 1969 crew assign-
ments for Apollo 13 were announced: James A. Lovell commanded the prime
crew, which included Thomas K. Mattingly II as command module pilot and Fred
W. Haise as lunar module pilot. Their backups were John Young, John Swigert,
and Charles Duke. The target for the mission was the Fra Mauro Formation, a
site of major interest to scientists, specifically a spot just north of the crater Fra
Mauro, some 550 kilometers (340 miles) west-southwest of the center of the moon's
near side.
On March 24, 1970, during the countdown demonstration test for Apollo 13,
KSC test engineers encountered a problem with an oxygen tank in the service
module. The spacecraft carried two such tanks, each holding 320 pounds (145
kilograms) of supercritical oxygen. They provided the oxygen for the command
module atmosphere and (along with two tanks of hydrogen) three fuel cells, which
were the spacecraft's primary source of electrical power. Besides power, the chem-
ical reaction in the cells produced water, which not only supplied the crew's drink-
ing water but was circulated through cooling plates to remove heat from certain
critical electronic components. The tanks were designed to operate at pressures
of 865 to 935 pounds per square inch (psi) (6,000 to 6,450 kilopascals) and tem-
peratures between -340°F and +80°F (-207°C to + 27°C). Inside each spherical
tank were a quantity gauge, a thermostatically controlled heating element, and
two stirring fans driven by electric motors. The fans were occasionally operated
to homogenize the fluid in the tank; it tended to stratify, leading to erroneous
quantity readings. All wiring inside the tank was insulated with Teflon, a
fluorocarbon plastic that is ordinarily noncombustible. Each tank was fitted with
=
a relief valve designed to open when the pressure rose above 1,000 psi (6,900
kilopascals); the tanks themselves would rupture at pressures above 2,200 psi
(15,169 kilopascals). Both tanks were mounted on a shelf in the service module
between the fuel cells and the hydrogen tanks.
The countdown demonstration test called for the tanks to be filled, tested, and
then partially emptied by applying pressure to the vent line, thus forcing oxygen
out through the fill line. Number one tank behaved normally in this test, but num-
ber two released only 8 percent of its contents, not 50 percent as required. Test
*This narrative is based primarily on three sources: AIAA Paper No. 70-1260, by Glynn S. Lunney
(one of the three flight directors on Apollo 13), "Discussion of Several Problem Areas During the
Apollo 13 Operation,'" presented at the AIAA 7th Annual Meeting and Technical Display, Houston,
Texas, Oct. 19-22, 1970; NASA, "'Report of Apollo 13 Review Board," June 15, 1970; and "Apollo
13 Technical Air to Ground Voice Transcription," April 1970. See also the published House and Sen-
ate hearings cited in notes 75 and 79, Chapter 11.
386
Appendix 8
engineers decided to proceed with the rest of the test and investigate the prob-
lem later. The next day, after KSC engineers had discussed the problem with
colleagues at MSC, North American Rockwell (builders of the service module),
and Beech Aircraft (manufacturers of the oxygen tanks), they tried emptying the
tank again, with no success. Further talks led to the conclusion that the tank prob-
ably contained a loose-fitting fill tube, which could allow pressure to escape with-
out emptying the tank.
When normal procedures again failed to empty the tank, engineers decided
to use its internal heaters to boil off the contents and applied direct-current power
at 65 volts to the heaters. This was successful but slow, requiring eight hours
of heating. It was then decided that if the tank could then be filled normally it
would not cause a problem in flight. A third test gave the same result as the sec-
ond, requiring heating to empty the tank.
In view of the difficulty of replacing the oxygen shelf--a job that would take
at least 45 hours--and the possibility that other components might be damaged
in the process and the launch delayed for a month, NASA and contractor offi-
cials decided not to replace the tanks.
The spacecraft was launched on April 11, 1970, and the mission was quite routine
for the first two days. At 30 hours and 40 minutes after launch (30:40 ground
elapsed time, or g.e.t.), the crew ignited their main engine to put the spacecraft
on a hybrid trajectory, a flight path that saved fuel in reaching the desired lunar
landing point.* At 46:40** the crew routinely switched on the fans in the oxygen
tanks briefly. A few seconds later the quantity indicator for tank number two went
off the high end of the scale, where it stayed. The tanks were stirred twice more
during the next few hours; and at 55:53, after a master alarm had indicated low
pressure in a hydrogen tank, the Mission Control Center (MCC) directed the
crew to switch on all tank stirrers and heaters. Shortly thereafter the crew heard
a loud "'bang" and felt unusual vibrations in the spacecraft. Mission controllers
noticed that all telemetry readings from the spacecraft dropped out for 1.8 seconds.
In the CM, the caution and warning system alerted the crew to low voltage on
d.c. main bus B, one of two power distribution systems in the spacecraft. At this
point command module pilot Jack Swigert told Houston, "Hey, we've had a
problem here."
Because of the interruption of telemetry that had just occurred, flight controllers
in the MCC had difficulty for the next few minutes determining whether they
were getting true readings from the spacecraft sensors or whether the sensors
had somehow lost power. Before long, however, both MCC and the crew real-
ized that oxygen tank number two had lost all of its contents, oxygen tank num-
ber one was slowly losing its contents, and the CM would soon be out of oxygen
and without electrical power. Among the first actions taken were shutting down
one fuel cell and switching off nonessential systems in the CM to minimize power
consumption; shortly after, the second fuel cell was shut down as well. When
*The "hybrid" trajectory was designed so that if the main propulsion engine failed, the attitude-
control rockets on the spacecraft could change the flight path enough to bring it back to a safe reentry
after it rounded the moon.
**This and all subsequent times are in hours and minutes g.e.t. Launch time was 12:13 p.m. East-
ern Standard Time on April 11.
387
Where No Man Has Gone Before
the remaining oxygen ran out, the CM would be dead; its only other power source
was three reentry batteries providing 120 ampere-hours, and these had to be
reserved for the critical reentry period.
An hour and a half after the "'bang," MCC notified the crew that "we're start-
ing to think about the lifeboat"--using the lunar module (LM) and its limited
supplies to sustain the crew for the rest of the mission. Plans for such a contin-
gency had been studied for several years, although none had anticipated a situa-
tion as grave as that of Apollo 13. Many of these studies were retrieved and their
results were adapted to the situation as it developed.
Shortly after the accident, mission commander James Lovell reported seeing
a swarm of particles surrounding the spacecraft, which meant trouble. Particles
could easily be confused with stars, and the sole means of determining the
spacecraft's attitude was by locating certain key stars in the onboard sextant.
Navigational sightings from the LM were difficult in any case as long as it was
attached to the command module, and this would only complicate matters. Flight
controllers decided to align the lunar module's guidance system with that in the
command module while the CM still had power. That done, the last fuel cell and
all systems in the command module were shut down, and the crew moved into
the lunar module. Their survival depended on this craft's oxygen and water sup-
plies, guidance system, and descent propulsion engine (DPS). Normally all course
corrections were made using the service propulsion system (SPS) on the service
module, but flight controllers ruled out using it, partly because it required more
electrical power than was available and partly because no one knew whether the
service module had been structurally weakened by the explosion. If it had, an
SPS burn might be dangerous. The DPS would have to serve in its place.
When word got out that Apollo 13 was in trouble, off-duty flight controllers
and spacecraft systems experts began to gather at MSC, to be available if needed.
Others stood by at NASA centers and contractor plants around the country, in
touch with Houston by telephone. Flight directors Eugene Kranz, Glynn Lun-
ney, and Gerald Griffin soon had a large pool of talent to help them solve prob-
lems as they arose, provide information that might not be at their fingertips, and
work on solutions to problems they could anticipate farther along in the mission.
Astronauts manned the CM and LM training simulators at Houston and at
Kennedy Space Center, testing new procedures as they were devised and modify-
ing them as necessary. MSC director Robert R. Gilruth, Dale D. Myers, director
=
of manned space flight, and NASA administrator Thomas O. Paine were all on
hand at Mission Control to provide high-level authority for changes.
Soon after the explosion, the assessment of life-support systems determined
that although oxygen supplies were adequate, the system for removing carbon
dioxide (CO2) in the lunar module was not. The system used canisters filled with
lithium hydroxide to absorb CO2 as did the system in the command module.
Unfortunately the canisters were not interchangeable between the two systems,
so the astronauts were faced with plenty of capacity for removing CO2 but no
way of using it. A team in Houston immediately set about improvising a way
to use the CM canisters, using materials available in the spacecraft.
Flight controllers, meanwhile, were addressing operational problems. Their first
critical decision was to put the crippled spacecraft back on a free-return trajec-
388
Appendix8
389
WhereNo ManHasGoneBefore
out, checked in the simulators, and modified. Fifteen hours before beginning reen-
try the revised sequence of activities was read to the crew, to give them time to
review and practice it.
The husbanding of expendable resources, particularly electrical power, paid off
on the morning of landing, when it was discovered that power reserves in the
LM were adequate to allow use of it in the CM. Some of the early CM activities
could then be done at a less hurried pace. The Apollo 13 command module
splashed down within a mile of the recovery carrier with about 20 percent of its
battery power remaining. Three weary, chilled astronauts came aboard the U.S.S.
Iwo fima on April 17 and were flown to Hawaii for an emotional reunion with
their families.
Mission Control teams and their hundreds of helpers were no less drained. The
usual cigars were lighted up after recovery, but the splashdown parties that eve-
ning were subdued: most of those who went quit early and went home to bed.
Their efforts were recognized the next day when President Richard M. Nixon,
on his way to Hawaii, stopped in Houston to present the Presidential Medal of
Freedom, the nation's highest civilian award, to the entire team.
NASA immediately convened an investigation board* to determine the cause
of the accident and postponed Apollo 14 until its results were in. Lacking the
spacecraft itself--the service module had been jettisoned before reentry, and the
crew had been able to take only a few rather poor photographs of it--the board
initially had only the data from inflight telemetry to work with. When it became
clear that the fault lay in oxygen tank number two, the board carefully reviewed
its entire history, from fabrication to launch, as recorded in the detailed documen-
tation that followed every piece of equipment from plant to launch pad. Under
the board's direction, MSC and other NASA centers conducted tests under simu-
lated mission conditions to verify its findings. The investigation, which concluded
in a few weeks, turned up a highly improbable sequence of human error and
oversight that led inexorably to the failure in flight.
Board Chairman Edgar M. Cortright, director of Langley Research Center,
explained the board's findings to congressional committees in June. The accident,
he reported, was not a random malfunction but resulted from an unusual combi-
nation of mistakes as well as "a somewhat deficient and unforgiving design."
As the board's report reconstructed the events leading up to the accident, the
tank left Beech Aircraft's plant on May 3, 1967, after passing all acceptance tests.
It was installed as part of a shelf assembly in service module no. 106 on June
4, 1963, having passed all tests conducted at North American Rockwell during
assembly. Design changes in the service module, however, necessitated remov-
ing the entire shelf from SM 106 for modification. During removal, which was
accomplished by use of a special fixture that fit under the shelf to lift it upward,
*Board members were: Edgar M. Cortright, director, Langley Research Center, chairman; Robert
F. Allnut, assistant to the administrator, NASA Hqs.; Nell Armstrong, MSC; John F. Clark, director,
Goddard Space Flight Center; Brig. Gen. Walter R. Hedrick, Jr. , Hqs. USAF; Vincent L. Johnson,
deputy associate administrator for engineering, Office of Space Science and Applications; Milton Klein,
manager, AEC-MASA space nuclear propulsion office; and Hans M. Mark, director, Ames Research
Center.
390
oRIGINAL PAGE IS
OF POOR QUALITY
Appendix 8
workmen overlooked one bolt that held down the back of the shelf, with the result
that the removal fixture broke, dropping the shelf two inches. The board con-
cluded that this incident might have jarred loose a poorly fitting fill tube. Subse-
quent tests did not detect any flaws, and after modification the shelf was shipped
to Kennedy Space Center for installation in SM 109, the Apollo 13 spacecraft.
What was not known was that this oxygen tank was fitted with obsolete ther-
mostatic switches protecting its heating elements. Original specifications for the
switches called for operation on 28 volts d.c.; in 1965 this was changed to 65 volts
d.c. to match the test and checkout equipment at the Cape. Later tanks conformed
to the new specifications, but this one, which should have been modified, was
not, and the discrepancy was overlooked at all stages thereafter.
391
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Closeout cap
Blowout disc -_
o
==== Fan
Temperature --- b[] e motor
sensor o-_
eo
oo
oe
o o
o ¢
Io c
o Q
'o o
Capacitance oo
'o o
!o o -_---- Heater
To fuel
oo
oo
cell/ECS._. I oo
oo
oo
oo
Insulation
oo
oo
oo :3 Eli Fan
oo
motor'
Pressure 9O
Pressure switch
transducer
:,...
F=--Closeout cap
_"---Overboard
In a normal checkout of a normal tank, this would not have mattered, because
the switches would not have opened during normal operation. But the impro-
vised procedure used when this tank failed to empty (the result of a loose fitting,
as noted above) raised the temperature in the tank above 80°F (27°C), at which
point the switches opened. Tests conducted during the investigation showed that
the higher current produced by the 65-volt power source caused an arc between
the contact points as they separated, welding them together and preventing their
opening when the temperature dropped. This went undetected during the detank-
ing procedure at the Cape; it could have been noticed if anyone had monitored
392
Appendix 8
the heater current, which would have shown that the heaters were operating when
they should not have been. But all attention was on the specific malfunction, and
no one was aware that the heaters were on continuously for eight hours on two
separate occasions. The result, as tests showed, was that the heater tube reached
1,000 °F (538 °C) in spots, damaging the Teflon insulation on the adjacent fan-motor
wiring and exposing bare wire. From that point on, the board concluded, the
tank was hazardous when filled with oxygen and electrically powered. Teflon
can be ignited at a high enough temperature in the presence of pure oxygen, and
the tank contained small amounts of other combustibles as well.
Unfortunately for Apollo 13, the tank functioned normally for the first 56 hours
of the mission, when the heaters and the fans were energized during routine oper-
ations. At that point an arc from a short circuit probably ignited the Teflon, and
the rapid pressure rise that followed either ruptured the tank or damaged the
conduit carrying wiring into the tank, expelling high-pressure oxygen. The board
could not determine exactly how the tank failed or whether additional combus-
tion occurred outside the tank, but the pressure increase blew off the panel cov-
ering that sector of the service module and damaged the directional antenna,
causing the interruption of telemetry observed in Houston. It also evidently
damaged the oxygen distribution system, or the other oxygen tank, as well, lead-
ing to the loss of all oxygen supplies and aborting the mission.
The board pointed out that although the circumstances of the tank failure were
highly unusual and that the system had worked flawlessly on six successful mis-
sions, Apollo 13 was a failure whose causes had to be eliminated as completely
as possible. It recommended that the oxygen tanks be modified to remove all com-
bustible material from contact with oxygen and that all test procedures be
thoroughly reviewed for adequacy.
Compared to the AS-204 fire in 1967, Apollo 13 was only a frightening near-
miss, and because its cause was localized and comparatively easy to discover,
it had fewer adverse effects on the program. Only the skill and dedication of
hundreds of members of the often-celebrated "manned space flight team" saved
it, however, and the accident served to remind NASA and the public that manned
flight in space, no matter how commonplace it seemed to the casual observer,
was not yet a routine operation. The same lesson had to be learned once more
sixteen years later, when on January 28, 1986, the space shuttle Challenger and
all seven of its crew were lost a minute after launch. An unforgiving design and
the failure of human judgment under pressure combined again to bring a pro-
gram to a halt while corrective measures were taken.
393
BIBLIOGRAPHIC ESSAY
The primary source material for the present history was the large collection of
documents from the Apollo project maintained, at this writing (1987), in the
History Office at the Lyndon B. Johnson Space Center (JSC) in Houston. More
than 31,000 documents collected by the JSC historian over a 20-year period occupy
nearly 150 linear meters of shelf space in more than 775 document boxes.
Most of these documents came from the "reading files" of JSC engineers and
managers. For the most part they are copies of the letters, memoranda, and telexes
generated in the management of the Apollo spacecraft project at JSC. Original
documents will not be found in this collection; they constitute "'record copies, '"
which by law must be retired to Federal Archives and Records Centers--in the
case of JSC, that in Ft. Worth, Texas--whence they may be recalled through the
records management office at JSC. Thus the History Office collection is an unoffi-
cial "historian's source file" rather than an archive. Besides correspondence, these
files contain NASA and contractor reports, working papers, minutes of meet-
ings, and other types of documentation. They have been supplemented over the
last 20 years with copies of documents obtained from NASA Headquarters and
other NASA centers by the compilers of the Apollo chronology and the authors
of Chariots for Apollo: A History of Manned Lunar Spacecraft. Storage space was always
at a premium, and earlier researchers culled the documentation and discarded
a considerable amount of material. The basic arrangement of all the Apollo files
is chronological, mainly because the documents were in chronological order when
they reached the History Office.
By far the largest part of this collection was obtained from the Apollo Space-
craft Program Office at JSC, which directed the design, construction, and testing
of the two Apollo spacecraft (command/service module and lunar module). These
documents deal largely with the development of the spacecraft themselves, but
they contain at least some papers from every organizational element of the proj-
ect: mission planning and analysis, lunar landing site selection, flight planning,
z astronaut training, testing programs, etc.
Smaller collections in the historian's source file, separate from the main Apollo
chronological file, include:
• 130 boxes of documents pertaining to individual Apollo missions, from the first
unmanned test flight of the spacecraft to the last manned lunar mission, Apollo
17. The collection includes premission planning documents, press kits, flight
plans, transcripts of onboard and air-to-ground communications, crew debrief-
ings, mission reports, mission science reports, and flight controller logs. The
comprehensiveness of these documents varies from mission to mission.
• 30 boxes of documents related to the planning and execution of the scientific
experiments conducted during the Apollo missions, in earth and lunar orbit
and on the lunar surface.
• 18 boxes of documents on the construction and operation of the Lunar Receiv-
ing Laboratory at JSC, from 1964 to 1978, and I box relating to the establish-
ment of the Lunar Science Institute.
394
Bibliographic Essay
The most important part of the program not represented in the History Office
files is the biomedical. JSC's Life Sciences Directorate has compiled its own histor-
ical files, which are presently housed in the Historical Research Center of the Hous-
ton Academy of Medicine-Texas Medical Center library, 1133 M. D. Anderson
Blvd., Houston, Texas 77030, Where they may be consulted by qualified
researchers.
The chronological arrangement of the Apollo files makes an index almost
indispensable, and part of the historian's task under the contract which supported
the writing of this volume was the preparation of an index. Each document in
the Apollo files is individually entered in a computer-stored index, except for occa-
sional folders or boxes that were indexed as a unit (e.g., a series of periodic
reports). The index entry contains the date of the document, its originator, its
title or subject, the name of the person who signed it, and its location (box num-
ber) in the file. Using remote terminals in the History Office, the user can rapidly
search the entire file in a variety of ways (e.g., by date, originator, subject, or
combinations of these categories) and obtain printouts of the retrieved entries.
A printout of the complete index, available in the History Office, include tabula-
tions of the number of documents by originator and by subject. This can be use-
ful for quick surveys of the files or for manual searches.
A guide to the Apollo files, available for use in the JSC History Office, includes
a more detailed description of the indexing system and an inventory of the Apollo
collection. The JSC History office does not have adequate full-time staff to pro-
vide extensive assistance or to conduct document searches, but those who wish
to use the files on site can be given some guidance. Arrangements to use the JSC
History Office files can be made through the History Office Coordinator, Manage-
ment Analysis Office, mail code BY, NASA Lyndon B. Johnson Space Center,
Houston, Texas 77058.
395
Where No Man Has Gone Before
396
Bibliographic
Essay
Besides these primary documents, the JSC History Office holds a large collec-
tion of important secondary sources. This includes a near-complete series of con-
gressional authorization hearings, pIus other congressional documents, such as
staff reports and a few appropriations hearings, for the period 1958-1972. Another
useful source is the weekly publication called Current News, a daily compilation
of clippings from the national press related to space programs put out by the Office
of Public Affairs at NASA Headquarters. For the space flight historian Current
News serves as a kind of reader's guide to press coverage of major events and
an indicator of the state of public opinion concerning the space program. Most
of the references to newspaper articles in the notes in this volume were taken
from Current News, supplemented where possible by consultation of the files of
important newspapers available in local libraries.
Oral history interviews with key participants in the Apollo program provided
details and insights not often available in the formal documentation. Many of
the 300-odd interviews in the JSC History Office files were taken while Apollo
was still in progress, many of them before the first lunar landing, and are almost
"real-time" discussions of the problems encountered during the program. These
interviews were taken by earlier historians with different questions in mind, and
consequently they were not as useful for the present work as they might have
been. The present author, working more than 10 years after Apollo ended, found
fewer of those participants easily accessible within the constraints of his contract
but was able to record interviews with a few of them. Their recollections frequently
lacked detail because of the passage of time but sometimes yielded information
on attitudes and relationships that were useful in reconstructing how and why
things happened as they did.
The History Office at Headquarters has a large collection of material on all
aspects of the space program. Its holdings are described in History at NASA, NASA
HHR-50 (Washington, June 1986), available from the History Office, mail code
XH, NASA Headquarters, Washington, D.C. 20546. The official files of Head-
quarters program and project offices have been retired to the Federal Archives
and Records Center at Suitland, Maryland. They can be recalled through the His-
tory Office in Headquarters, which has an inventory of these holdings. For the
scientific aspects of Apollo the papers of Homer E. NeweU, associate administra-
tor for space science and applications from 1961 to 1967, were most useful.
NeweU's own inventory of these documents is more informative than most. Copies
of pertinent documents from the Newell files were added to the JSC collection
by the present author.
Most of the secondary literature on Project Apollo deals with the accomplish-
ment of the primary objective, the first lunar landing. Considerably less has been
published on the second phase of the project, lunar exploration.
The classic study of the origin of Project Apollo is John M. Logsdon's The Deci-
sion to Go to the Moon: Project Apollo and the National Interest (Cambridge, Mass.:
MIT Press, 1970), which deals in detail with the domestic and international polit-
ical climate in which President John F. Kennedy formulated his challenge to the
nation to send people to the moon and back "'before this decade is out." An impor-
tant recent effort to set the entire manned space flight program in a global (and
internal American) political context is Walter A. McDougall's... The Heavens and
397
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
the Earth: A Political History of the Space Age (New York: Basic Books, Inc., 1985).
The role of Congress, particularly the House of Representatives space commit-
tee, is well covered in Toward the Endless Frontier: History of the Committee on Science
Technology, 1959-79, (Washington: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1980), writ-
ten by Ken Hechler, a Ph.D. historian and member of the committee for 18 years.
Other accounts of the manned space flight program include John Noble Wilford,
We Reach the Moon (New York: Bantam Books, 1969); Hugo Young, Bryan Sil-
cock, and Peter Dunn, Journey to Tranquility (Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday and
Co., 1970); and Richard S. Lewis, Appointment on the Moon: The Inside Story of
America's Space Venture (New York: Viking Press, 1968). Lewis's The Voyages of
Apollo: The Exploration of the Moon (New York: Quadrangle Press, 1974) covers
some of the same ground as the present volume, discussing each of the Apollo
lunar landing missions and its scientific results. Henry S. F. Cooper, space cor-
respondent for The New Yorker magazine, has written some good journalistic
accounts of the Apollo project in Apollo on the Moon (New York: Dial Press, 1969)
and Moon Rocks (New York: Dial Press, 1970).
Apollo's two accidents, the fatal AS-204 spacecraft fire and the aborted mis-
sion of Apollo 13, were the subjects of popular books. The tragedy of Apollo 204
is covered in Murder on Pad 34, by Eric Bergaust (New York: G. P. Putnam's Sons,
1968), a sensationalized book that is far from objective. Henry Cooper's 13: The
Flight That Failed (New York: Dial Press, 1973) is an hour-by-hour account of the
near-disastrous flight of Apollo 13. Detailed accounts of these grim milestones,
including the reports of NASA's investigating boards, are found in published
hearings of House committees: U.S. Congress, House Subcommittee on NASA
Oversight, Investigation into Apollo 204 Accident, 90th Cong., 1st sess. (hereafter
90/1) (Washington: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1967) (3 vols.), and House
Committee on Science and Astronautics, The Apollo 13 Accident, 91/2 (Washing-
ton: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1970).
NASA's own publications comprise the most complete historical treatments of
manned space flight projects now available. A basic chronological reference, based
largely on journalistic sources, is the annual series starting with Astronautics and
Aeronautics, 1963: Chronology on Science, Technology, and Policy, which now covers
the years 1963-1977. Chronologies of individual projects include James M. Grim-
wood, Project Mercury: A Chronology, NASA SP-4001 (Washington, 1963); James
M. Grimwood and Barton C. Hacker, with Peter Vorzimmer, Project Gemini Tech-
nology and Operations: A Chronology, NASA SP-4203 (Washington, 1969); and The
Apollo Spacecraft: A Chronology, NASA SP-4009 (vol. I, by Ivan D. Ertel and Mary
Louise Morse, 1969; vol. II, by Mary Louise Morse and Jean Karnahan Bays, 1973;
vol. III, by Courtney G. Brooks and Ivan D. Ertel, 1976; vol. IV, by Courtney
G. Brooks, Roland W. Newkirk, and Ivan D. Ertel, 1978). These chronologies,
based largely on NASA documentation, were compiled during research on pro-
ject histories.
NASA has published histories of all the projects that contributed to the accom-
plishment of the lunar landing. Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., James M. Grimwood, and
Charles C. Alexander, This New Ocean: A History of Project Mercury, NASA SP-4201
(Washington, 1966), gives a full account of the early years of the space age and
of NASA along with the development of Project Mercury itself. The second
manned space flight project, Gemini, is treated in Barton C. Hacker and James
398
!iI
Bibliographic Essay
399
WhereNo Man Has Gone Before
40O
Bibliographic Essay
401
Index
INDEX
A
AAAS. See American Association for the quarantine, 223
Advancement of Science Apollo 13, 175, 178, 204-5, 386-93
AAP. See Apollo Applications Program abortion, vii-viii, 177, 199, 206
Abelson, Philip H., 9-10 crew selection, 167-68, 219
AC-Deico Electronics, 213 landing site, 177, 191, 196-98, 214, 217
Air Force Flight Test Center, 59 launch schedule, 156, 157-58
Aldrin, Edwin E., Jr., "Buzz" quarantine, 223
on the moon, 142-47, 149, 164, 185, 188, Apollo 14, 159, 203, 221,233, 244
211 crew selection, 168, 219
quarantine, 153, 155 landing site, 177, 199, 204, 214, 217-19,
selection and training, 136-37, 139-42 223
Alfred P. Sloan Foundation, 10 on the moon, 206-9
Allen, Joseph P. IV, 219, 235-36, 238 training, 220
ALSEE See Apollo Lunar Surface Experiments Apollo 15, 242, 244, 246, 247, 248, 249, 259,
Package 261
America (Apollo 17), 249, 252 cancellation, 204-5, 218, 220, 243
American Association for the Advancement of crew selection, 219, 221
Science (AAAS), 155, 171, 194 landing site selection, 214, 217-18
Ames Research Center, 95, 96 lunar rover, 227-31
Anders, Edward, 190 on the moon, 231-40
Anders, William A., 133 redesignation, 202
Anderson, Clinton P., 10 sample analysis, 240-42
Antares (Apollo 14), 206-11 Apollo 16, 159, 211, 247, 249
Apollo 5, 114 crew selection, 221
Apollo 6, 114 landing site selection, 214, 217-19, 244
Apollo 7, 132, 136, 206 on the moon, 245-46
Apollo 8, 124, 137, 139, 206 redesignation, 202
lunar orbit, 113, 124, 132-34 Apollo 17, vii, 211, 2t3, 255, 259, 267
Apollo 9, 137, 139, 164, 193, 206 crew selection, 220, 221, 242
operations, 124, 136 landing site selection, 214, 219, 247-49
Apollo I0, 136, 137, 139, 141, 142, 163, 164 on the moon, 249-52
crew training and operations, 124, 136, quarantine, 223
137-39 redesignation, 202
Apollo 11, vi, 203, 219 sample analysis, 253, 256
accomplishments and results, 1, 16, 155, Apollo 18, 211
158, 169, 177, 188, 193, 238, cancellation, 202
258, 262, 265 landing site selection, 214, 217
biological isolation garments, 187 Apollo 19, 211
crew selection, 136 cancellation, 202, 205, 218, 220
landing site, 75, 160, 162, 164, 165, 170, landing site selection, 214
188, 214, 217 Apollo 20, 211
launch plans, 125, 157 cancellation,- 196, 201
lunar samples, 147-51, 152, 172, 174, 189, landing site selection, 214
190-91, 211, 222 Apollo Applications Program (AAP),
lunar surface experiments, 166-67, 205 experiments, 69
mission planning, 126 funding, 86, 101, 102
on the moon, 142-47 plans; vi, 67, 87, 97, 100, 135-36, 196
quarantine, 151-52, 153, 223 program office, 103
significance, 156 Apollo fire, vii, 91-94, 95-96, 102, 113, 135
training, 139, 142 Apollo Lunar Surface Experiments Package
Apollo 12, vii, 193, 198, 205, 209, 243, 261 (ALSEP), 84-85, 134. See also Lunar Sur-
crew selection and training, 164 face Experiments Package; early Apollo
landing site, 75, 161, 165-67, 199, 206, 214, scientific e_periments package (EASEP)
217 development problems, 95-96, 115
launch schedule, 156, 157-58 management, 86, 87
lunar samples, 188-89, 190, 211,222 utilization, 162, 166-67
mission planning, 174-75 Apollo Program Office, 103, 193
on the moon, 177-86 Apollo Lunar Exploration Office, 103, 130
Apollo Site Selection Board biological isolation garments, 106, 122, 174,
Apollo 12, 188 187
Apollo 16, 244 Boeing Company, 39, 213, 227
Apollo 17, 247, 249 Borman, Frank, 64, 133, 134
establishment, 78 Brand, Vance D., 219
function, 80, 89, 126-27, 160, 163, 164-65, Brown & Root-Northrop, 54, 119, 151
214-15 budget, 4-5, 7-11, 194, 196, 201-4
Apollo-Soyuz Test Project, 255 charts, 329-380
Apollo Spacecraft Program Office, 86 Lunar Receiving Laboratory, 42-44, 48-51,
Armstrong, Neil A. 86, 104
lunar landing, 209, 265, 142-43 Ranger, 17, 50-51
on the moon, 142-47, 150, 155, 165, 182, reductions, 101-2, 125, 156, 193, 201-4
188, 211, 253
quarantine, 151-52, 153 C
scientific observation, 185, 267 Calio, Anthony J., 174, 191, 193, 218
selection, 65, 137 Cambridge Research Laboratory, 118
training, 139-42, 164 Cape Canaveral, 69, 79
7
asteroids, 29 Carr, Gerald P., 164, 178
Astronaut Office, 59, 69-70, 220, 243 Casper (Apollo16), 244-45
astronaut selection, 20, 22, 36, 40, 55-72, Cernan, Eugene A.
367-81 on the moon, 249-52, 267, 269
age limit, 60 selection and training, 136-39, 168, 220,
Apollo 9, 136 242--44
Apollo 10, 136 Chaffee, Roger B., 91-94
Apollo 11, 136 Cimarron, New Mexico, 62
Apollo 12, 164, 167-68 "cold moon" theory, 29
Apollo 13, 167-68, 219 Collins, Michael, 137, 143-47, 152, 153, 164,
Apollo 14, 168-219 265
Apollo 15, 219-20, 221 Columbia (Apollo 11), 143-47
Apollo 16, 221 command and service module, 69, 74, 158. See
Apollo 17, 220, 221,242 a/so command module; service module
"Excess Eleven," 136 operations, 69, 74, 137, 158, 179, 226
"The Fourteen," 69, 136 command module, vii, 72, 81, 265. See also
Gemini, 61-65, 69, 135, 164, 193 command and service module
"Next Nine," 69 Apollo 7, 113
"Original Seven," 55-56, 63, 69 Apollo 8, 133
scientist-astronauts, 16, 23, 31, 55, 57-58, Apollo 9, 137
62, 65-72, 135-36, 167-69, 193, 266-69 Apollo 10, 139,163
astronaut training, vii, 23, 36, 55-72, 135-39, Apollo 11 (Columbia), 143-47
382-85 Apollo 12 (YankeeClipper), 178-80,188
Apollo 11, 139-42 Apollo 14 (KittyHawk), 206-7, 209,225
Apollo 12, 164 Apollo 15(Endeavour), 225,226,231-32,
scientific instruction, 19, 22, 40, 57-58, 233, 238, 240
60-63, 99, 264 Apollo I6 (Casper), 244-45
simplification, 116 Apollo 17 (America), 249, 252
test pilots, 36, 55-57 Block I/II, 114
Atomic Energy Commission, 51, 105 contamination control, 47, 106, 121-23,
174, 268-69
B fire, vii, 91-94, 102
back-contamination, 44-48, 50, 54, 104, 151, lunar surface experiments package, 81
i 268-69. See also contamination; problems, 90, 132
Interagency Committee on Back recovery, 121,268-69
Contamination Communicable Disease Center, 47
control, 120-24, 125, 145 Congress
Baylor College of Medicine, 106-7 astronaut selection, 61, 65, 68
Bean, Alan L., 164, 175, 178-89, 211 fire investigation, 93
Bell, ER., 105 funding. See budget
Bell Aerosystems, 139 Lunar Receiving Laboratory, 48-51
Bellcomm, Inc., 40, 75, 126-27, 163 project oversight, 13
Bendix Corporation, 85, 95, 115, 118 support for space programs, 131, 132,
Berkner, Lloyd V., 30 170-71
biological containment, 49, 125, 150, 268 Conrad, Charles, "Pete," 1r., 164, 175, 178-89,
191, 211
4O4
J
Index
405
Where No Man Has Gone Before
406
Index
407 --_
Where No Man Has Gone Before
408
Index
Nixon, Richard M., 144, 147, 157, 178, 193, OSSA. See office of Space Science and
201, 203, 225 Applications
North American Aviation (NAA), 88, 109, 113,
159 P
North American Rockwell, 193 Paine, Thomas O., 122, 156, 157, 193, 196,
Notkin & Company, 51 201-2
Parker, Robert A., 219
O "parking orbit," 39
Oak Ridge National Laboratory, 51, 105 Petrone, Rocco A., 193, 247
Oceanus Procellarum, 75, 79, 164, 188, 189, Philco Aeronutronics Division, 66
222 Phillips, C. Briggs, 104
Office of Manned Space Flight Philhps, Samuel C.
budget, 9 Apollo 4, 109
contamination control, 124 Apollo Site Selection Board, 78
extended lunar missions, 211-14 contamination control, 122, 124
landing site selection, 39-40, 78, 130 landing site selection, 128, 160, 162, 163,
Lunar Receiving Laboratory, 48 165
lunar sample distribution, 152 lunar surface experiments package, 95-96,
Management Council, 212 115-18
mission planning, 65, 87, 94, 125 mission planning, 159
Office of Systems Studies, 21 program critique, 88
organizational charts, 319-320 reassignment, 193
reorganization, 24 sample handling, 152
Science and Technology Advisory PHS. See U.S. PubEc Health Service
Committee, 115, 170, 214-15 Picketing, John E., 50
scientific emphasis in Apollo, 13, 17, 18, Picketing, W_dliam C., 19
23, 25, 26, 31, 35, 68, 89, 263 Piland, Joseph V., 54, 103
Office of Space Science and Applications Pfland, Robert O., 54, 85-86, 88
(OSSA) Planetary Biology Subcommittee, 104
biosciences programs, 46 planetary exploration, 1, 5-6, 31, 37, 194
budget, 101-2 Planetology Subcommittee, 52-53, 103, 118
landing site selection, 39, 78 "pogo" effects, 114
Lunar and Planetary Missions Board, President's Science Advisory Committee
101-2, 202, 214 (PSAC), 5, 26, 96-97, 131, 169
Lunar Receiving Laboratory, 52-53, 103-4, Project Gemini
110 accomplishments and conclusions, 71, 88,
lunar sample distribution, 152 89, 92, 116, 117, 136
Lunar Science Division, 103 astronaut selection and training, 61-65, 69,
lunar surface experiments, 33-34, 80 135, 164, 193
organization, 87, 89, 97 earth-orbital flights, 32
organizational charts, 321-22 purpose, 5, 25, 60
Planetology Subcommittee, 52-53, 103, Project Mercury
118 accomplishments and conclusions, 7, 17,
scientific emphasis in Apollo, 35, 68, 171, 25, 32, 58, 60, 71, 85, 92
264 astronaut selection, 55-56, 59, 62, 6,3-65
Space Sciences Steering Committee, 52, 78, cost, 11
103, 118 mission planning, 15
office of Space Sciences. See also Office of purpose, 3
Space Science and AppEcations scientific emphasis, 22
Lunar and Planetary Programs Office, 21 Project Ranger
Lunar Exploration Committee, 18 budget, 77
mission planning, 27, 31, 32-33 landing site selection, 58-40, 69, 75, 76,
organizational chart, 323 77-78
scientific emphasis in Apollo, 13, 17, purpose, 2, 15, 22, 262
18-19, 21-23 science on Ranger, 18, 19, 21, 26, 31
olivine, 150, 183, 189, 260 PSAC. See President's Science Advisory
OMSF. See office of Manned Space Flight Committee
Operational Readiness Inspection Board, 119 Public Health Service. See U.S. Public Health
origin of the moon, 27-29, 222-23, 258-61, Service
331-32 pyroxene, 150, 260
Orion (Apollo 16), 244-45
OSS. See office of Space Sciences
4O9
Where No Man Has Gone Before
410
Index
411
Where No Man Has Gone Before
Worden, Alfred M.
on the moon, 226, 231-33, 238, 240, 249
selection and training, 164, 219, 242, 267
Working Group on Lunar Exploration, 14-15
Y
Yankee Clipper (Apollo 12), 178-80, 188
Young, John W., 63, 65, 136, 139, 167, 221,
245 -46
412
About The Author
William David Compton, born in DeLeon, Texas (1927), took B.S. and M.S.
degrees at North Texas State Teachers College and a Ph.D. at the University of
Texas. He taught chemistry at West Texas State College, Colorado School of Mines,
and Prescott College (Arizona). While at Prescott he took a year's leave to study
history of technology, earning an M.Sc. from the University of London (Imperial
College of Science and Technology) in 1972. In 1974 he was awarded a contract to
write NASA's history of the Skylab project in collaboration with Charles D.
Benson. Living and Working in Space: A History of Skylab was published in 1983 as
NASA SP-4208. After three years of working for a Houston engineering consult-
ing firm, Dr. Compton won a second contract from the Johnson Space Center to
write the present volume. He also contributed a chapter on NASA and the space
sciences to a commemorative volume, 100 Years of Science and Technology in Texas,
published in 1986 by Sigma Xi on the occasion of the society's centenary and Texas'
sesquicentennial. In 1983 he wrote the prize essay in the Dr. Robert H. Goddard
Historical Essay competition sponsored by the National Space Club of Washing-
ton, D.C.
413
_=
i
The NASA History Series
HISTORIES
Anderson, Frank W., Jr., Orders of Magnitude: A History of NACA and NASA,
1915-1980 (NASA SP-4403, 2d ed., 1981).
Benson, Charles D., and William Barnaby Faherty, Moonpart: A History of Apollo
Launch Facilities and Operations (NASA SP4204, 1978).
Bilstein, Roger E., Stages to Saturn: A Technological History of the ApolloSaturn
Launch Vehicles (NASA SP-4206, 1980).
Boone, W. Fred, NASA Office of Delaware Affairs: The First Five Years (NASA
HHR-32, 1970, mulfilith).
Brooks, Courtney G., James M. Grimwood, and Loyd S. Swenson, Jr., Chariots for
Apollo: A History of Manned Lunar Spacecraft (NASA SP-4205, 1979).
Byers, Bruce K., Destination Moon: A History of the Lunar Orbiter Program (NASA TM
X-3487, 1977, multilith).
Compton, W. David, and Charles D. Benson, Living and Working in Space: A History
of Skylab (NASA SP4208, 1983).
Corliss, W'flliam R., NASA Sounding Rockets, 1958-1968: A Historical Summary
(NASA SP-4401, 1971).
Ezell, Edward Clinton, and Linda Neuman EzeU, On Mars: Exploration of the Red
Planet, 1958-1978 (NASA SP-4212, I984).
Ezell, Edward Clinton, and Linda Neuman Ezell, The Partnership: A History of the
Apollo-Soyuz Test Project (NASA SP4209, 1978).
Green, Constance McL., and Milton Lomask, Vanguard: A History (NASA SP-4202,
1970; also Washington: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1971).
Hacker, Barton C., and James W. Grimwood, On the Shoulders of Titans: A History of
Project Gemini (NASA SP-4203, 1977).
Hall, R. Cargill, Lunar Impact: A History of Project Ranger (NASA SP-4210, 1977).
Hallion, Richard P., On the Frontier: Flight Research at Dryden, 1946-198I (NASA
SP-4303, 1984).
Hansen, James R., Engineer in Charge: A History of the Langley Aeronautical Laborato-
ry, 1917-1958 (NASA SP4305).
Hartman, Edwin P., Adventures in Research: A History of Ames Research Center,
1940-1965 (NASA SP-4302, 1970).
Levine, Arnold, Managing NASA in the Apollo Era (NASA SP-4102, 1982).
Muenger, Elizabeth A., Searching the Horizon: A History of Ames Research Center,
1940-1976 (NASA SP-4304, 1985).
Newell, Homer E., Beyond the Atmosphere: Early Years of Space Science (NASA
SP-4211, 1980).
Pitt, John A., The Human Factor: Biomedicine in the Manned Space Program to 1980
(NASA SP4213, 1985).
Roland, Alex, Model Research: The National Advisory Committee for Aeronautics,
1915-1958 (NASA SP4103, 1985).
Rosenthal, Alfred, Venture into Space: Early Years of Goddard Space Flight Center
(NASA SP-4301, 1968).
Rosholt, Robert L., An Administrative History of NASA, 1958-1963 (NASA SP4101,
1966).
PAI__INT[NllON/t_tY _I.A/_
o
\
\
il
L_
f _
ii